[PowerPC] Document requirements for VSX feature
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1274 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1275 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1276 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3877 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3878 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3879 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3880 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3881 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3882
3883 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3884 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3885 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3886 classes.
3887
3888 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3889 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3890 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3891
3892 @smallexample
3893 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3894 @end smallexample
3895
3896 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3897 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3898 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3899 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3900 every function in a given file:
3901
3902 @smallexample
3903 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3904 @end smallexample
3905
3906 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3907 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3908
3909 @kindex info breakpoints
3910 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3911 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3912 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3913 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3914 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3915 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3916 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3917
3918 @table @emph
3919 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3920 @item Type
3921 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3922 @item Disposition
3923 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3924 @item Enabled or Disabled
3925 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3926 that are not enabled.
3927 @item Address
3928 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3929 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3930 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3931 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3932 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3933 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3934 @item What
3935 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3936 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3937 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3938 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3939 @end table
3940
3941 @noindent
3942 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3943 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3944 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3945 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3946 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3947 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3948
3949 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3950 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3951 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3952 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3953
3954 @noindent
3955 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3956 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3957 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3958 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3959 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3963 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3964 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3965 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3966 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3967 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3968
3969 @noindent
3970 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3971 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3972
3973 @end table
3974
3975 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3976 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3977 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3978 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3979
3980 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3981 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3982 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3983 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3984
3985 @itemize @bullet
3986 @item
3987 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3988
3989 @item
3990 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3991 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3992
3993 @item
3994 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3995 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3996
3997 @item
3998 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3999 several places where that function is inlined.
4000 @end itemize
4001
4002 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4003 the relevant locations.
4004
4005 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4006 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4007 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4008 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4009 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4010 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4011 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4012
4013 For example:
4014
4015 @smallexample
4016 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4017 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4018 stop only if i==1
4019 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4020 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4021 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4025 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4026 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4027 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4028 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4029 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4030 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4031 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4032 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4033 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4034 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4035
4036 @cindex pending breakpoints
4037 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4038 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4039 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4040 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4041 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4042 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4043 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4044 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4045 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4046 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4047 is not yet resolved.
4048
4049 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4050 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4051 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4052 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4053 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4054 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4055
4056 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4057 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4058 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4059 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4060
4061 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4062 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4063 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4066 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4067 address specification to an address:
4068
4069 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4070 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4071 @table @code
4072 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4073 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4074 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4075
4076 @item set breakpoint pending on
4077 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4078 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4079
4080 @item set breakpoint pending off
4081 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4082 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4083 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4084
4085 @item show breakpoint pending
4086 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4087 @end table
4088
4089 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4090 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4091 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4092
4093 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4094 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4095 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4096 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4097 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4098 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4099 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4100 breakpoints.
4101
4102 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4103
4104 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4105 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4106 @table @code
4107 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4108 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4109 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4110 breakpoint must be used.
4111
4112 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4113 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4114 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4115 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4116 @end table
4117
4118 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4119 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4120 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4121 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4122 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4123 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4124 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4125 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4126 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4127
4128 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4129 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4130 @table @code
4131 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4132 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4133 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4134 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4135
4136 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4137 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4138 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4139 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4140 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4141 @end table
4142
4143 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4144 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4145 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4146
4147 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4148 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4149
4150 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4151
4152 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4153 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4154 @table @code
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4157 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4158 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4159 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4160
4161 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4162 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4163 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4164 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4165 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4166 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4167 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4168 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4169 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4170 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4171 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4172 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4173 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4174
4175 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4176 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4177 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4178 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4179 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4180 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4181 @end table
4182
4183
4184 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4185 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4186 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4187 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4188 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4189 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4190 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4191 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4192
4193
4194 @node Set Watchpoints
4195 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4196
4197 @cindex setting watchpoints
4198 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4199 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4200 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4201 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4202 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4203
4204 @itemize @bullet
4205 @item
4206 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4207
4208 @item
4209 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4210 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4211 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4212
4213 @item
4214 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4215 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4216 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4217 @end itemize
4218
4219 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4220 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4221 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4222 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4223 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4224 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4225 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4226 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4227 the expression changes.
4228
4229 @cindex software watchpoints
4230 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4231 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4232 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4233 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4234 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4235 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4236 culprit.)
4237
4238 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4239 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4240 slow down the running of your program.
4241
4242 @table @code
4243 @kindex watch
4244 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4245 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4246 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4247 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4248 to watch the value of a single variable:
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4255 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4256 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4257 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4258 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4259 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4260
4261 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4262 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4263 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4264 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4265 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4266 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4267 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4268 error.
4269
4270 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4271 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4272 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4273 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4274 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4275 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4276 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4277 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4278 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4279 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4280 Examples:
4281
4282 @smallexample
4283 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4284 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4285 @end smallexample
4286
4287 @kindex rwatch
4288 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4289 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4290 by the program.
4291
4292 @kindex awatch
4293 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4294 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4295 or written into by the program.
4296
4297 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4298 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4299 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4300 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4301 @end table
4302
4303 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4304 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4305 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4306 a never-changing value:
4307
4308 @smallexample
4309 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4310 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4311 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4312 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4313 @end smallexample
4314
4315 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4316 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4317 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4318 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4319 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4320 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4321
4322 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4323 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4324 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4325 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4326 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4327 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4328 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4329 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4330
4331 @table @code
4332 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4333 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4334 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4335
4336 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4337 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4338 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4339 @end table
4340
4341 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4342 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4343 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4344
4345 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4346
4347 @smallexample
4348 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4349 @end smallexample
4350
4351 @noindent
4352 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4353
4354 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4355 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4356 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4357 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4358 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4359 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4360 will print a message like this:
4361
4362 @smallexample
4363 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4364 @end smallexample
4365
4366 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4367 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4368 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4369 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4370 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4371 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4372 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4373 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4374
4375 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4376 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4377 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4378 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4379 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4380 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4381
4382 @smallexample
4383 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 @noindent
4387 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4388
4389 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4390 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4391 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4392 expression with separately allocated resources.
4393
4394 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4395 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4396 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4397
4398 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4399 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4400 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4401 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4402 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4403 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4404 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4405 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4406 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4407
4408 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4409 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4410 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4411 watched expression from every thread.
4412
4413 @quotation
4414 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4415 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4416 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4417 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4418 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4419 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4420 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4421 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4422 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4423 @end quotation
4424
4425 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4426
4427 @node Set Catchpoints
4428 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4429 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4430 @cindex exception handlers
4431 @cindex event handling
4432
4433 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4434 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4435 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4436
4437 @table @code
4438 @kindex catch
4439 @item catch @var{event}
4440 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4441
4442 @table @code
4443 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4444 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4445 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4446 @kindex catch throw
4447 @kindex catch rethrow
4448 @kindex catch catch
4449 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4450 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4451
4452 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4453 regular expression will be caught.
4454
4455 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4456 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4457 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4458 exception being thrown.
4459
4460 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4461 @value{GDBN}:
4462
4463 @itemize @bullet
4464 @item
4465 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4466 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4467 supported.
4468
4469 @item
4470 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4471 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4472 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4473 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4474 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4475 built.
4476
4477 @item
4478 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4479 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4480
4481 @item
4482 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4483 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4484 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4485 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4486
4487 @item
4488 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4489 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4490 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4491 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4492 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4493 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4494 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4495 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4496 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4497
4498 @item
4499 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4500
4501 @item
4502 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4503 @end itemize
4504
4505 @item exception
4506 @kindex catch exception
4507 @cindex Ada exception catching
4508 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4509 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4510 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4511 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4512 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4513
4514 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4515 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4516 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4517 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4518 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4519 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4520 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4521 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4522
4523 @item handlers
4524 @kindex catch handlers
4525 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4526 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4527 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4528 specified at the end of the command
4529 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4530 only when this specific exception is handled.
4531 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4532
4533 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4534 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4535 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4536 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4537 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4538 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4539 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4540 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4541 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4542
4543 @item exception unhandled
4544 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4545 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4546
4547 @item assert
4548 @kindex catch assert
4549 A failed Ada assertion.
4550
4551 @item exec
4552 @kindex catch exec
4553 @cindex break on fork/exec
4554 A call to @code{exec}.
4555
4556 @item syscall
4557 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4558 @kindex catch syscall
4559 @cindex break on a system call.
4560 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4561 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4562 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4563 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4564 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4565 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4566 will be caught.
4567
4568 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4569 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4570 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4571 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4572
4573 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4574 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4575 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4576 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4577
4578 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4579 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4580 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4581 available choices.
4582
4583 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4584 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4585 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4586 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4587 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4588 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4589 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4590 behind the OS upgrades).
4591
4592 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4593 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4594 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4595 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4596 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4597 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4598 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4599 syscall groups available on your environment.
4600
4601 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4602 arguments to it:
4603
4604 @smallexample
4605 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4606 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4607 (@value{GDBP}) r
4608 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4609
4610 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4611 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4612 (@value{GDBP}) c
4613 Continuing.
4614
4615 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4616 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4617 (@value{GDBP})
4618 @end smallexample
4619
4620 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4621
4622 @smallexample
4623 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4624 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4625 (@value{GDBP}) r
4626 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4627
4628 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4629 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4630 (@value{GDBP}) c
4631 Continuing.
4632
4633 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4634 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4635 (@value{GDBP})
4636 @end smallexample
4637
4638 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4639 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4640 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4641
4642 @smallexample
4643 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4644 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4645 (@value{GDBP}) r
4646 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4647
4648 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4649 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4650 (@value{GDBP}) c
4651 Continuing.
4652
4653 Program exited normally.
4654 (@value{GDBP})
4655 @end smallexample
4656
4657 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4661 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4662 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4663 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4664 (@value{GDBP}) r
4665 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4666
4667 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4668 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4669
4670 (@value{GDBP}) c
4671 Continuing.
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4675 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4676 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4677 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4678
4679 @smallexample
4680 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4681 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4682 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4683 (@value{GDBP})
4684 @end smallexample
4685
4686 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4687 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4688 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4689 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4690 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4691 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4695 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4696 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4697 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4698 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4699 (@value{GDBP})
4700 @end smallexample
4701
4702 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4703
4704 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4705 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4709 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4710 @end smallexample
4711
4712 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4713
4714 @item fork
4715 @kindex catch fork
4716 A call to @code{fork}.
4717
4718 @item vfork
4719 @kindex catch vfork
4720 A call to @code{vfork}.
4721
4722 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4723 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4724 @kindex catch load
4725 @kindex catch unload
4726 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4727 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4728 matches one of the affected libraries.
4729
4730 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4731 @kindex catch signal
4732 The delivery of a signal.
4733
4734 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4735 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4736 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4737
4738 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4739 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4740 signal names.
4741
4742 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4743 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4744 will be caught.
4745
4746 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4747 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4748 catchpoint.
4749
4750 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4751 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4752 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4753 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4754 commands.
4755
4756 @end table
4757
4758 @item tcatch @var{event}
4759 @kindex tcatch
4760 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4761 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4762
4763 @end table
4764
4765 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4766
4767
4768 @node Delete Breaks
4769 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4770
4771 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4772 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4773 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4774 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4775 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4776 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4777
4778 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4779 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4780 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4781 their breakpoint numbers.
4782
4783 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4784 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4785 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4786
4787 @table @code
4788 @kindex clear
4789 @item clear
4790 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4791 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4792 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4793 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4794
4795 @item clear @var{location}
4796 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4797 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4798 most useful ones are listed below:
4799
4800 @table @code
4801 @item clear @var{function}
4802 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4803 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4804
4805 @item clear @var{linenum}
4806 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4807 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4808 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @cindex delete breakpoints
4812 @kindex delete
4813 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4814 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4815 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4816 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4817 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4818 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4819 @end table
4820
4821 @node Disabling
4822 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4823
4824 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4825 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4826 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4827 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4828 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4829
4830 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4831 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4832 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4833 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4834 do not know which numbers to use.
4835
4836 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4837 affects all of its locations.
4838
4839 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4840 different states of enablement:
4841
4842 @itemize @bullet
4843 @item
4844 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4845 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4846 @item
4847 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4850 disabled.
4851 @item
4852 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4853 N times, then becomes disabled.
4854 @item
4855 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4856 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4857 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4858 @end itemize
4859
4860 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4861 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4862
4863 @table @code
4864 @kindex disable
4865 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4866 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4867 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4868 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4869 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4870 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4871 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4872
4873 @kindex enable
4874 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4876 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4877
4878 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4879 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4880 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4881
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4884 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4885 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4886 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4887 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4888 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4892 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4893 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4894 @end table
4895
4896 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4897 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4898 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4899 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4900 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4901 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4902 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4903 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4904 Stepping}.)
4905
4906 @node Conditions
4907 @subsection Break Conditions
4908 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4909 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4910
4911 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4912 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4913 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4914 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4915 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4916 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4917 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4918 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4919
4920 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4921 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4922 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4923 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4924 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4925
4926 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4927 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4928 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4929 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4930 one.
4931
4932 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4933 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4934 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4935 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4936 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4937 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4938 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4939 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4940 conditions for the
4941 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4942 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4943
4944 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4945 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4946 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4947 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4948 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4949 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4950
4951 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4952 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4953 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4954 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4955 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4956
4957 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4958 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4959 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4960 with the @code{condition} command.
4961
4962 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4963 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4964 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4965 catchpoint.
4966
4967 @table @code
4968 @kindex condition
4969 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4970 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4971 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4972 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4973 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4974 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4975 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4976 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4977 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4978 prints an error message:
4979
4980 @smallexample
4981 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4982 @end smallexample
4983
4984 @noindent
4985 @value{GDBN} does
4986 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4987 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4988 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4989
4990 @item condition @var{bnum}
4991 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4992 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4993 @end table
4994
4995 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4996 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4997 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4998 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4999 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5000 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5001 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5002 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5003 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5004 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5005 your program reaches it.
5006
5007 @table @code
5008 @kindex ignore
5009 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5010 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5011 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5012 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5013 takes no action.
5014
5015 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5016 a count of zero.
5017
5018 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5019 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5020 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5021 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5022
5023 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5024 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5025 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5026
5027 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5028 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5029 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5030 Variables}.
5031 @end table
5032
5033 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5034
5035
5036 @node Break Commands
5037 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5038
5039 @cindex breakpoint commands
5040 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5041 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5042 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5043 enable other breakpoints.
5044
5045 @table @code
5046 @kindex commands
5047 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5048 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5049 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5050 @itemx end
5051 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5052 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5053 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5054
5055 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5056 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5057
5058 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5059 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5060 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5061 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5062 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5063 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5064 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5065 Expressions}).
5066 @end table
5067
5068 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5069 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5070
5071 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5072 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5073 that resumes execution.
5074
5075 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5076 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5077 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5078 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5079 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5080
5081 @kindex silent
5082 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5083 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5084 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5085 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5086 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5087 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5088
5089 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5090 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5091 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5092
5093 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5094 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5095
5096 @smallexample
5097 break foo if x>0
5098 commands
5099 silent
5100 printf "x is %d\n",x
5101 cont
5102 end
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5106 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5107 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5108 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5109 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5110 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5111 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5112
5113 @smallexample
5114 break 403
5115 commands
5116 silent
5117 set x = y + 4
5118 cont
5119 end
5120 @end smallexample
5121
5122 @node Dynamic Printf
5123 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5124
5125 @cindex dynamic printf
5126 @cindex dprintf
5127 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5128 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5129 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5130 having to recompile it.
5131
5132 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5133 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5134 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5135 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5136 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5137 redirects to files and so forth.
5138
5139 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5140 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5141 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5142 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5143 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5144 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5145 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5146
5147 @table @code
5148 @kindex dprintf
5149 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5150 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5151 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5152 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5153
5154 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5155 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5156 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5157 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5158 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5159 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @item gdb
5163 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5164 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5165
5166 @item call
5167 @kindex dprintf-style call
5168 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5169 @code{printf}).
5170
5171 @item agent
5172 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5173 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5174 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5175 support running commands on the target.
5176 @end table
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5179 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5180 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5181 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5182 command.
5183
5184 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5185 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5186 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5187 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5188 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5189 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5190
5191 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5192 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5193 you could do the following:
5194
5195 @example
5196 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5197 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5198 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5199 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5200 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5201 (gdb) info break
5202 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5203 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5204 continue
5205 (gdb)
5206 @end example
5207
5208 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5209 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5210 the variable settings.
5211
5212 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5213 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5215 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5216 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5217 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5218
5219 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5220 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5221 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5222
5223 @end table
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5226 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5227 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5228 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5229 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5230 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5231
5232 @node Save Breakpoints
5233 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5234
5235 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5236 breakpoints}} command.
5237
5238 @table @code
5239 @kindex save breakpoints
5240 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5241 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5242 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5243 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5244 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5245 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5246 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5247 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5248 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5249 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5250 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5251 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5252 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5253 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5254 that can no longer be recreated.
5255 @end table
5256
5257 @node Static Probe Points
5258 @subsection Static Probe Points
5259
5260 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5261 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5262 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5263 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5264 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5265
5266 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5267 ELF-compatible systems:
5268
5269 @itemize @bullet
5270
5271 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5272 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5273 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5274 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5275 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5276 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5277 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5278 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5279
5280 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5281 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5282 C@t{++} languages.
5283 @end itemize
5284
5285 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5286 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5287 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5288 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5289 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5290 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5291 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5292 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5293 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5294
5295 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5296 probes}, with optional arguments:
5297
5298 @table @code
5299 @kindex info probes
5300 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5301 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5302 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5303 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5304
5305 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5306 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5307 probes from all providers are listed.
5308
5309 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5310 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5311 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5312
5313 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5314 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5315 given, all object files are considered.
5316
5317 @item info probes all
5318 List the available static probes, from all types.
5319 @end table
5320
5321 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5322 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5323 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5324 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5325 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5326
5327 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5328 commands, with optional arguments:
5329
5330 @table @code
5331 @kindex enable probes
5332 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5333 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5334 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5335 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5336
5337 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5338 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5339 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5340
5341 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5342 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5343 given, all object files are considered.
5344
5345 @kindex disable probes
5346 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5347 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5348 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5349 @end table
5350
5351 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5352 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5353 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5354 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5355 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5356 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5357 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5358 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5359 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5360 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5361 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5362 at the current probe point.
5363
5364 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5365 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5366 an error message.
5367
5368
5369 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5370 @node Error in Breakpoints
5371 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5372
5373 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5374 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5375
5376 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5377 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5378 @smallexample
5379 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5380 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5381 @end smallexample
5382
5383 @noindent
5384 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5385 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5386 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5387
5388 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5389 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5390
5391 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5392 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5393 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5394
5395 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5396 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5397 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5398 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5399
5400 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5401 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5402 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5403 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5404 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5405 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5406 first in the bundle.
5407
5408 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5409 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5410 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5411 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5412 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5413 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5414 is hit.
5415
5416 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5417 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5418
5419 @smallexample
5420 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5424 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5425 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5426 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5427 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5428 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5429 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5430 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5431
5432 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5433 adjusted breakpoints:
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5437 to 0x00010410.
5438 @end smallexample
5439
5440 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5441 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5442 frequently than expected.
5443
5444 @node Continuing and Stepping
5445 @section Continuing and Stepping
5446
5447 @cindex stepping
5448 @cindex continuing
5449 @cindex resuming execution
5450 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5451 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5452 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5453 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5454 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5455 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5456 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5457 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5458 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5459 handlers}).)
5460
5461 @table @code
5462 @kindex continue
5463 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5464 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5465 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5466 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5467 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5468 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5469 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5470 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5471 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5472 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5473
5474 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5475 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5476 @code{continue} is ignored.
5477
5478 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5479 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5480 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5481 @code{continue}.
5482 @end table
5483
5484 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5485 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5486 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5487 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5488
5489 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5490 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5491 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5492 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5493 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5494 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex step
5498 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5499 @item step
5500 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5501 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5502 abbreviated @code{s}.
5503
5504 @quotation
5505 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5506 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5507 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5508 @c distinction here.
5509 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5510 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5511 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5512 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5513 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5514 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5515 below.
5516 @end quotation
5517
5518 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5519 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5520 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5521 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5522 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5523 called within the line.
5524
5525 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5526 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5527 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5528 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5529 was any debugging information about the routine.
5530
5531 @item step @var{count}
5532 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5533 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5534 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5535
5536 @kindex next
5537 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5538 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5539 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5540 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5541 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5542 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5543 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5544 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5545
5546 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5547
5548
5549 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5550 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5551 @c
5552 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5553 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5554 @c function are executed without stopping.
5555
5556 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5557 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5558 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5559
5560 @kindex set step-mode
5561 @item set step-mode
5562 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5563 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5564 @itemx set step-mode on
5565 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5566 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5567 information rather than stepping over it.
5568
5569 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5570 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5571 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5572
5573 @item set step-mode off
5574 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5575 debug information. This is the default.
5576
5577 @item show step-mode
5578 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5579 source line debug information.
5580
5581 @kindex finish
5582 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5583 @item finish
5584 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5585 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5586 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5587
5588 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5589 ,Returning from a Function}).
5590
5591 @kindex until
5592 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5593 @cindex run until specified location
5594 @item until
5595 @itemx u
5596 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5597 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5598 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5599 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5600 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5601 than the address of the jump.
5602
5603 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5604 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5605 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5606 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5607 through the next iteration.
5608
5609 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5610 stack frame.
5611
5612 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5613 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5614 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5615 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5616 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (@value{GDBP}) f
5620 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5621 206 expand_input();
5622 (@value{GDBP}) until
5623 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5624 @end smallexample
5625
5626 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5627 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5628 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5629 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5630 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5631 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5632 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5633
5634 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5635 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5636 argument.
5637
5638 @item until @var{location}
5639 @itemx u @var{location}
5640 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5641 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5642 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5643 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5644 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5645 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5646 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5647 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5648 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5649 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5650 invocations have returned.
5651
5652 @smallexample
5653 94 int factorial (int value)
5654 95 @{
5655 96 if (value > 1) @{
5656 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5657 98 @}
5658 99 return (value);
5659 100 @}
5660 @end smallexample
5661
5662
5663 @kindex advance @var{location}
5664 @item advance @var{location}
5665 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5666 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5667 @ref{Specify Location}.
5668 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5669 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5670 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5671 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5672
5673
5674 @kindex stepi
5675 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5676 @item stepi
5677 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5678 @itemx si
5679 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5680
5681 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5682 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5683 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5684 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5685
5686 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5687
5688 @need 750
5689 @kindex nexti
5690 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5691 @item nexti
5692 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5693 @itemx ni
5694 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5695 proceed until the function returns.
5696
5697 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5698
5699 @end table
5700
5701 @anchor{range stepping}
5702 @cindex range stepping
5703 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5704 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5705 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5706 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5707 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5708 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5709 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5710 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5711 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5712 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5713 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5714 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5715 if necessary:
5716
5717 @table @code
5718 @kindex set range-stepping
5719 @kindex show range-stepping
5720 @item set range-stepping
5721 @itemx show range-stepping
5722 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5723
5724 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5725 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5726 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5727 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5728 default is @code{on}.
5729
5730 @end table
5731
5732 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5733 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5734 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5735
5736 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5737 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5738 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5739 a particular file when stepping.
5740
5741 For example, consider the following C function:
5742
5743 @smallexample
5744 101 int func()
5745 102 @{
5746 103 foo(boring());
5747 104 bar(boring());
5748 105 @}
5749 @end smallexample
5750
5751 @noindent
5752 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5753 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5754 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5755 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5756
5757 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5758 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5759 is called from many places.
5760
5761 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5762 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5763 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5764 @code{foo}.
5765
5766 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5767 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5768 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5769
5770 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5771 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5772 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5773 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5774 the underlying system.
5775 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5776 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5777
5778 @table @code
5779 @kindex skip
5780 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5781 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5782 that specify what to skip.
5783 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5784
5785 @table @code
5786 @item -file @var{file}
5787 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5788 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5789
5790 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5791 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5792 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5793 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5794 over when stepping.
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5798 @end smallexample
5799
5800 @item -function @var{linespec}
5801 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5802 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5803 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804 @xref{Specify Location}.
5805
5806 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5807 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5808 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5809 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5810
5811 This form is useful for complex function names.
5812 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5813 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5814 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5815 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5816 regular expression makes this easier.
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5820 @end smallexample
5821
5822 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5823 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5827 @end smallexample
5828 @end table
5829
5830 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5831 will be skipped.
5832
5833 @kindex skip function
5834 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5835 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5836 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5837 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5838
5839 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5840 will be skipped.
5841
5842 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5843 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5844
5845 @kindex skip file
5846 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5847 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5848 will be skipped over when stepping.
5849
5850 @smallexample
5851 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5852 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5853 @end smallexample
5854
5855 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5856 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5857 @end table
5858
5859 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5860 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5861
5862 @table @code
5863 @kindex info skip
5864 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5865 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5866 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5867 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5868
5869 @table @emph
5870 @item Identifier
5871 A number identifying this skip.
5872 @item Enabled or Disabled
5873 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5874 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5875 @item Glob
5876 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item File
5879 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5880 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @item RE
5882 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5883 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5884 @item Function
5885 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5886 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5887 @end table
5888
5889 @kindex skip delete
5890 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5891 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5892 skips.
5893
5894 @kindex skip enable
5895 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5896 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5897 skips.
5898
5899 @kindex skip disable
5900 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5901 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5902 skips.
5903
5904 @kindex set debug skip
5905 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5906 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5907
5908 @kindex show debug skip
5909 @item show debug skip
5910 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5911
5912 @end table
5913
5914 @node Signals
5915 @section Signals
5916 @cindex signals
5917
5918 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5919 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5920 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5921 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5922 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5923 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5924 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5925 requested an alarm).
5926
5927 @cindex fatal signals
5928 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5929 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5930 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5931 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5932 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5933 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5934
5935 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5936 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5937 signal.
5938
5939 @cindex handling signals
5940 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5941 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5942 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5943 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5944 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @kindex info signals
5948 @kindex info handle
5949 @item info signals
5950 @itemx info handle
5951 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5952 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5953 the defined types of signals.
5954
5955 @item info signals @var{sig}
5956 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5957
5958 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5959
5960 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5961 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5962 for details about this command.
5963
5964 @kindex handle
5965 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5966 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5967 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5968 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5969 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5970 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5971 say what change to make.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 @c @group
5975 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5976 Their full names are:
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @item nostop
5980 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5981 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5982
5983 @item stop
5984 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5985 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5986
5987 @item print
5988 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5989
5990 @item noprint
5991 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5992 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5993
5994 @item pass
5995 @itemx noignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5997 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5998 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5999
6000 @item nopass
6001 @itemx ignore
6002 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6003 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6004 @end table
6005 @c @end group
6006
6007 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6008 program until you
6009 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6010 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6011 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6012 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6013 program sees that signal when you continue.
6014
6015 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6016 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6017 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6018 erroneous signals.
6019
6020 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6021 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6022 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6023 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6024 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6025 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6026 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6027 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6028 Program a Signal}.
6029
6030 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6031 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6032
6033 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6034 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6035 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6036 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6037 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6038 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6039 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6040 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6041 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6042 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6043 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6044 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6045 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6046
6047 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6048
6049 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6050 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6051 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6052 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6053
6054 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6055 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6056 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6057 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6058
6059 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6060 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6061
6062 @smallexample
6063 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6064 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6065 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6066 (@value{GDBP}) c
6067 Continuing.
6068
6069 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6070 main () sigusr1.c:28
6071 28 p = 0;
6072 (@value{GDBP}) si
6073 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6074 9 @{
6075 @end smallexample
6076
6077 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6078 program to receive the signal first:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) n
6082 28 p = 0;
6083 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6084 (@value{GDBP}) si
6085 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6086 9 @{
6087 (@value{GDBP})
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @cindex extra signal information
6091 @anchor{extra signal information}
6092
6093 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6094 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6095 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6096 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6097 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6098 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6099 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6100 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6101 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6102 system header.
6103
6104 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6105 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6106
6107 @smallexample
6108 @group
6109 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6110 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6111 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6112 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6113 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6114 type = struct @{
6115 int si_signo;
6116 int si_errno;
6117 int si_code;
6118 union @{
6119 int _pad[28];
6120 struct @{...@} _kill;
6121 struct @{...@} _timer;
6122 struct @{...@} _rt;
6123 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6124 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6125 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6126 @} _sifields;
6127 @}
6128 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6129 type = struct @{
6130 void *si_addr;
6131 @}
6132 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6133 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6134 @end group
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6138
6139 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6140 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6141 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6142 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6143 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6144 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6145 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6146 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6147 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6148 information is displayed.
6149
6150 The usual output of a segfault is:
6151 @smallexample
6152 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6153 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6154 68 value = *(p + len);
6155 @end smallexample
6156
6157 While a bound violation is presented as:
6158 @smallexample
6159 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6160 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6161 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6162 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6163 68 value = *(p + len);
6164 @end smallexample
6165
6166 @node Thread Stops
6167 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6168
6169 @cindex stopped threads
6170 @cindex threads, stopped
6171
6172 @cindex continuing threads
6173 @cindex threads, continuing
6174
6175 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6176 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6177 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6178 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6179 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6180 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6181 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6182 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6183 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6184
6185 @menu
6186 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6187 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6188 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6189 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6190 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6191 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6192 @end menu
6193
6194 @node All-Stop Mode
6195 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6196
6197 @cindex all-stop mode
6198
6199 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6200 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6201 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6202 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6203 underfoot.
6204
6205 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6206 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6207 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6208
6209 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6210 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6211 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6212 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6213 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6214 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6215 stops.
6216
6217 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6218 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6219 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6220 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6221
6222 @cindex automatic thread selection
6223 @cindex switching threads automatically
6224 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6225 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6226 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6227 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6228 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6229 thread.
6230
6231 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6232 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6233
6234 @table @code
6235 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6236 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6237 @cindex lock scheduler
6238 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6239 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6240 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6241 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6242 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6243 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6244 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6245 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6246 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6247 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6248 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6249 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6250 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6251 @code{on} in replay mode.
6252
6253 @item show scheduler-locking
6254 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6255 @end table
6256
6257 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6258 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6259 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6260 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6261 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6262 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6263 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6264 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6265 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6266 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6267 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6268 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6269 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6270 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6274 @item set schedule-multiple
6275 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6276 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6277 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6278 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6279 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6280 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6281
6282 @item show schedule-multiple
6283 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6284 multiple processes.
6285 @end table
6286
6287 @node Non-Stop Mode
6288 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6289
6290 @cindex non-stop mode
6291
6292 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6293 @c with more details.
6294
6295 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6296 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6297 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6298 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6299 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6300 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6301
6302 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6303 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6304 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6305 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6306 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6307 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6308 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6309 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6310 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6311 independently and simultaneously.
6312
6313 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6314 or attach to your program:
6315
6316 @smallexample
6317 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6318 set pagination off
6319
6320 # Finally, turn it on!
6321 set non-stop on
6322 @end smallexample
6323
6324 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6325
6326 @table @code
6327 @kindex set non-stop
6328 @item set non-stop on
6329 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6330 @item set non-stop off
6331 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6332 @kindex show non-stop
6333 @item show non-stop
6334 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6338 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6339 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6340 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6341 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6342 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6343 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6344 default.
6345
6346 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6347 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6348 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6349
6350 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6351 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6352 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6353 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6354 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6355
6356 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6357 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6358 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6359 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6360 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6361
6362 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6363
6364 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6365 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6366 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6367 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6368 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6369 previously current thread.
6370
6371 @node Background Execution
6372 @subsection Background Execution
6373
6374 @cindex foreground execution
6375 @cindex background execution
6376 @cindex asynchronous execution
6377 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6378
6379 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6380 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6381 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6382 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6383 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6384 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6385
6386 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6387 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6388
6389 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6390 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6391 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6392 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6393 are:
6394
6395 @table @code
6396 @kindex run&
6397 @item run
6398 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6399
6400 @item attach
6401 @kindex attach&
6402 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6403
6404 @item step
6405 @kindex step&
6406 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6407
6408 @item stepi
6409 @kindex stepi&
6410 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6411
6412 @item next
6413 @kindex next&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6415
6416 @item nexti
6417 @kindex nexti&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6419
6420 @item continue
6421 @kindex continue&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6423
6424 @item finish
6425 @kindex finish&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6427
6428 @item until
6429 @kindex until&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6431
6432 @end table
6433
6434 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6435 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6436 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6437 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6438 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6439 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6440
6441 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6442 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6443
6444 @table @code
6445 @kindex interrupt
6446 @item interrupt
6447 @itemx interrupt -a
6448
6449 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6450 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6451 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6452 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6453 @end table
6454
6455 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6456 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6457
6458 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6459 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6460 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6461
6462 @table @code
6463 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6464 @cindex thread breakpoints
6465 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6466 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6467 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6468 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6469 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6470 specify some source line.
6471
6472 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6473 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6474 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6475 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6476 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6477
6478 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6479 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6480 program.
6481
6482 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6483 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6484 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6485
6486 @smallexample
6487 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6488 @end smallexample
6489
6490 @end table
6491
6492 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6493 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6494 thread list. For example:
6495
6496 @smallexample
6497 (@value{GDBP}) c
6498 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6499 @end smallexample
6500
6501 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6502 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6503 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6504 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6505 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6506 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6507 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6508 command.
6509
6510 @node Interrupted System Calls
6511 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6512
6513 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6514 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6515 @cindex premature return from system calls
6516 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6517 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6518 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6519 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6520 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6521 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6522 stop execution.
6523
6524 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6525 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6526 style anyways.
6527
6528 For example, do not write code like this:
6529
6530 @smallexample
6531 sleep (10);
6532 @end smallexample
6533
6534 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6535 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6536
6537 Instead, write this:
6538
6539 @smallexample
6540 int unslept = 10;
6541 while (unslept > 0)
6542 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6543 @end smallexample
6544
6545 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6546 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6547 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6548 @value{GDBN}.
6549
6550 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6551 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6552 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6553 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6554
6555 @node Observer Mode
6556 @subsection Observer Mode
6557
6558 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6559 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6560 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6561 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6562 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6563
6564 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6565 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6566 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6567 mode.
6568
6569 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6570 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6571 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6572 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6573 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6574
6575 @table @code
6576
6577 @kindex observer
6578 @item set observer on
6579 @itemx set observer off
6580 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6581 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6582 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6583 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6584
6585 @item show observer
6586 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6587
6588 @kindex may-write-registers
6589 @item set may-write-registers on
6590 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6591 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6592 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6593 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6594
6595 @item show may-write-registers
6596 Show the current permission to write registers.
6597
6598 @kindex may-write-memory
6599 @item set may-write-memory on
6600 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6601 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6602 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6603 defaults to @code{on}.
6604
6605 @item show may-write-memory
6606 Show the current permission to write memory.
6607
6608 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6609 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6610 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6611 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6612 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6613 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6614
6615 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6616 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6617
6618 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6619 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6620 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6621 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6622 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6623 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6624 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6625
6626 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6627 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6628
6629 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6630 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6631 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6632 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6633 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6634 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6635 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6636
6637 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6639
6640 @kindex may-interrupt
6641 @item set may-interrupt on
6642 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6643 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6644 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6645 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6646 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6647
6648 @item show may-interrupt
6649 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6650
6651 @end table
6652
6653 @node Reverse Execution
6654 @chapter Running programs backward
6655 @cindex reverse execution
6656 @cindex running programs backward
6657
6658 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6659 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6660 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6661 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6662
6663 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6664 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6665 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6666 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6667 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6668 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6669
6670 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6671 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6672 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6673 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6674 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6675 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6676 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6677 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6678 prior values@footnote{
6679 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6680 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6681 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6682
6683 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6684 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6685 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6686 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6687 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6688 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6689 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6690 }.
6691
6692 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6693 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6694
6695 @table @code
6696 @kindex reverse-continue
6697 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6698 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6699 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6700 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6701 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6702 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6703 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6704
6705 @kindex reverse-step
6706 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6707 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6708 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6709 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6710
6711 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6712 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6713 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6714 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6715 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6716 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6717
6718 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6719 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6720
6721 @kindex reverse-stepi
6722 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6723 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6724 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6725 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6726 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6727 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6728 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6729
6730 @kindex reverse-next
6731 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6732 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6733 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6734 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6735 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6736 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6737 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6738 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6739 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6740 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6741
6742 @kindex reverse-nexti
6743 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6744 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6745 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6746 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6747 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6748 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6749 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6750 frame) is reached.
6751
6752 @kindex reverse-finish
6753 @item reverse-finish
6754 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6755 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6756 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6757 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6758
6759 @kindex set exec-direction
6760 @item set exec-direction
6761 Set the direction of target execution.
6762 @item set exec-direction reverse
6763 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6764 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6765 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6766 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6767 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6768 @item set exec-direction forward
6769 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6770 This is the default.
6771 @end table
6772
6773
6774 @node Process Record and Replay
6775 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6776 @cindex process record and replay
6777 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6778
6779 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6780 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6781 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6782
6783 @cindex replay mode
6784 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6785 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6786 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6787 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6788 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6789 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6790 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6791 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6792 execution log.
6793
6794 @cindex record mode
6795 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6796 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6797 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6798 for future replay.
6799
6800 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6801 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6802 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6803 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6804 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6805 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6806
6807 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6808 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6809 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6810 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6811
6812 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6813 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @kindex target record
6817 @kindex target record-full
6818 @kindex target record-btrace
6819 @kindex record
6820 @kindex record full
6821 @kindex record btrace
6822 @kindex record btrace bts
6823 @kindex record btrace pt
6824 @kindex record bts
6825 @kindex record pt
6826 @kindex rec
6827 @kindex rec full
6828 @kindex rec btrace
6829 @kindex rec btrace bts
6830 @kindex rec btrace pt
6831 @kindex rec bts
6832 @kindex rec pt
6833 @item record @var{method}
6834 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6835 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6836 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6837 recording methods are available:
6838
6839 @table @code
6840 @item full
6841 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6842 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6843 execution.
6844
6845 @item btrace @var{format}
6846 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6847 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6848 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6849 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6850 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6851 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6852 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6853
6854 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6855 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6856 formats are available:
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @item bts
6860 @cindex branch trace store
6861 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6862 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6863 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6864
6865 @item pt
6866 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6867 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6868 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6869 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6870
6871 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6872 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6873 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6874
6875 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6876 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6877 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6878 buffer-size with care.
6879 @end table
6880
6881 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6882 @end table
6883
6884 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6885 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6886 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6887 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6888
6889 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6890 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6891 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6892 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6893 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6894
6895 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6896 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6897 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6898 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6899 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6900 does not support these two modes.
6901
6902 @kindex record stop
6903 @kindex rec s
6904 @item record stop
6905 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6906 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6907 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6908
6909 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6910 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6911 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6912 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6913 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6914
6915 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6916 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6917 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6918 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6919 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6920
6921 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6922 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6923
6924 @kindex record goto
6925 @item record goto
6926 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6927 ways to specify the location to go to:
6928
6929 @table @code
6930 @item record goto begin
6931 @itemx record goto start
6932 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6933
6934 @item record goto end
6935 Go to the end of the execution log.
6936
6937 @item record goto @var{n}
6938 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6939 @end table
6940
6941 @kindex record save
6942 @item record save @var{filename}
6943 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6944 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6945 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6946
6947 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6948
6949 @kindex record restore
6950 @item record restore @var{filename}
6951 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6953
6954 @kindex set record full
6955 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6956 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6957 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6958 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6959
6960 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6961 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6962 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6963 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6964 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6965 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6966 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6967 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6968
6969 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6970 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6971 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6972
6973 @kindex show record full
6974 @item show record full insn-number-max
6975 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6976 recording method.
6977
6978 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6979 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6980 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6981 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6982 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6983 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6984 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6985 oldest one to be deleted.
6986
6987 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6988 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6989
6990 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6991 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6992
6993 @item set record full memory-query
6994 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6995 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6996 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6997 case.
6998
6999 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7000 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7001 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7002 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7003 results.
7004
7005 @item show record full memory-query
7006 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7007
7008 @kindex set record btrace
7009 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7010 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7011 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7012 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7013 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7014 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7015 You can use the following command for that:
7016
7017 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7018 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7019 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7020 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7021 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7022 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7023 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7024 position.
7025
7026 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7027 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7028 errata when decoding the trace.
7029
7030 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7031 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7032 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7033 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7034 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7035 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7036 which the trace was recorded.
7037
7038 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7039 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7040 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7041 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7042 disable the workarounds.
7043
7044 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7045 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7046 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7047 (default).
7048
7049 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7050 identifiers are currently supported:
7051
7052 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7053
7054 @item @code{intel}
7055 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7056
7057 @end multitable
7058
7059 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7060 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7061
7062 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7063 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7064 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7065
7066 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7067 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7068 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7069 supports.
7070
7071 @smallexample
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7077 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7078 (gdb) info record
7079 Active record target: record-btrace
7080 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7081 Buffer size: 16kB.
7082 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7083 @end smallexample
7084
7085 @kindex show record btrace
7086 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7087 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7088
7089 @item show record btrace cpu
7090 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7091 workarounds.
7092
7093 @kindex set record btrace bts
7094 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7095 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7096 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7097 format. Default is 64KB.
7098
7099 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7100 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7101 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7102 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7103 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7104 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7105 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7106
7107 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7109
7110 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7111 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7112
7113 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7114 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7115 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7116
7117 @kindex set record btrace pt
7118 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7119 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7120 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7121 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7122
7123 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7124 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7125 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7126 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7127 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7128 actual buffer size for each thread.
7129
7130 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7131 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7132
7133 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7134 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7135
7136 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7137 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7138 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7139
7140 @kindex info record
7141 @item info record
7142 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7143 method:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146 @item full
7147 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7148 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7149
7150 @itemize @bullet
7151 @item
7152 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7153 @item
7154 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7155 @item
7156 Highest recorded instruction number.
7157 @item
7158 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7159 @item
7160 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7161 @item
7162 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7163 @end itemize
7164
7165 @item btrace
7166 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7167
7168 @itemize @bullet
7169 @item
7170 Recording format.
7171 @item
7172 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7173 @item
7174 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7175 instructions.
7176 @item
7177 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185
7186 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7187 @itemize @bullet
7188 @item
7189 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7190 @end itemize
7191 @end table
7192
7193 @kindex record delete
7194 @kindex rec del
7195 @item record delete
7196 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7197 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7198 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7199 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7200
7201 @kindex record instruction-history
7202 @kindex rec instruction-history
7203 @item record instruction-history
7204 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7205 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7206 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7207 are printed in execution order.
7208
7209 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7210 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7211 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7212
7213 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7214 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7215 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7216 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7217 @code{/p} modifier.
7218
7219 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7220 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7221 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7222
7223 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7224 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7225
7226 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7227 disassemble:
7228
7229 @table @code
7230 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7231 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7232 @var{insn}.
7233
7234 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7235 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7236 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7237 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7238 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7239 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history
7242 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7243
7244 @item record instruction-history -
7245 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7246
7247 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7248 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7249 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7250 number @var{end} is included.
7251 @end table
7252
7253 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7254
7255 @kindex set record
7256 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7257 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7258 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7260 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7261
7262 @kindex show record
7263 @item show record instruction-history-size
7264 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7265 instruction-history} command.
7266
7267 @kindex record function-call-history
7268 @kindex rec function-call-history
7269 @item record function-call-history
7270 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7271 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7272 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7273 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7274 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7275 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7276 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7277 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7278 given together.
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7282 1 void foo (void)
7283 2 @{
7284 3 @}
7285 4
7286 5 void bar (void)
7287 6 @{
7288 7 ...
7289 8 foo ();
7290 9 ...
7291 10 @}
7292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7293 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7294 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7295 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7299 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7300 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7301 to print:
7302
7303 @table @code
7304 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7305 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7308 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7309 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7310 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7311 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history
7314 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7315
7316 @item record function-call-history -
7317 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7318
7319 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7320 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7321 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7322 @end table
7323
7324 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7325
7326 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7327 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7328 Define how many lines to print in the
7329 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7330 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7331
7332 @item show record function-call-history-size
7333 Show how many lines to print in the
7334 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7335 @end table
7336
7337
7338 @node Stack
7339 @chapter Examining the Stack
7340
7341 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7342 stopped and how it got there.
7343
7344 @cindex call stack
7345 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7346 is generated.
7347 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7348 the arguments of the call,
7349 and the local variables of the function being called.
7350 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7351 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7352 stack}.
7353
7354 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7355 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7356
7357 @cindex selected frame
7358 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7359 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7360 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7361 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7362 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7363 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7364
7365 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7366 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7367 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7368
7369 @menu
7370 * Frames:: Stack frames
7371 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7372 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7373 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7374 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7375 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7376
7377 @end menu
7378
7379 @node Frames
7380 @section Stack Frames
7381
7382 @cindex frame, definition
7383 @cindex stack frame
7384 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7385 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7386 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7387 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7388 which the function is executing.
7389
7390 @cindex initial frame
7391 @cindex outermost frame
7392 @cindex innermost frame
7393 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7394 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7395 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7396 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7397 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7398 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7399 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7400 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7401
7402 @cindex frame pointer
7403 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7404 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7405 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7406 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7407 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7408 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7409
7410 @cindex frame level
7411 @cindex frame number
7412 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7413 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7414 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7415 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7416 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7417 describe this number.
7418
7419 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7420 @c underflow problems.
7421 @cindex frameless execution
7422 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7423 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7424 @smallexample
7425 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7426 @end smallexample
7427 generates functions without a frame.)
7428 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7429 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7430 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7431 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7432 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7433 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7434 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7435
7436 @node Backtrace
7437 @section Backtraces
7438
7439 @cindex traceback
7440 @cindex call stack traces
7441 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7442 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7443 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7444 stack.
7445
7446 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7447 @kindex backtrace
7448 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7449 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7450 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7451 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7452 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7453 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7454
7455 @table @code
7456 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7457 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7458 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7459 be one of the following:
7460
7461 @table @code
7462 @item @var{n}
7463 @itemx @var{n}
7464 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7465 number.
7466
7467 @item -@var{n}
7468 @itemx -@var{n}
7469 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7470 number.
7471
7472 @item full
7473 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7474 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7475
7476 @item no-filters
7477 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7478 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7479 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7480 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7481 support.
7482
7483 @item hide
7484 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7485 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7486 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7487 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7488 @end table
7489 @end table
7490
7491 @kindex where
7492 @kindex info stack
7493 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7494 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7495
7496 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7497 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7498 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7499 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7500 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7501 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7502 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7503 multi-threaded program.
7504
7505 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7506 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7507 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7508 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7509 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7510 line number.
7511
7512 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7513 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7514
7515 @smallexample
7516 @group
7517 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7518 at builtin.c:993
7519 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7520 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7521 at macro.c:71
7522 (More stack frames follow...)
7523 @end group
7524 @end smallexample
7525
7526 @noindent
7527 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7528 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7529 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7530
7531 @noindent
7532 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7533 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7534 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7535 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7536 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7537
7538 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7539 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7540 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7541 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7542 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7543 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7544 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7545 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7546 such a backtrace might look like:
7547
7548 @smallexample
7549 @group
7550 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7551 at builtin.c:993
7552 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7553 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7554 at macro.c:71
7555 (More stack frames follow...)
7556 @end group
7557 @end smallexample
7558
7559 @noindent
7560 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7561 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7562
7563 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7564 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7565 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7566
7567 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7568 @cindex program entry point
7569 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7570 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7571 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7572 @code{main}@footnote{
7573 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7574 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7575 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7576 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7577 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7578 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7579
7580 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7581 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7582
7583 @table @code
7584 @item set backtrace past-main
7585 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7586 @kindex set backtrace
7587 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-main off
7590 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7591 default.
7592
7593 @item show backtrace past-main
7594 @kindex show backtrace
7595 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-entry
7598 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7599 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7600 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7601 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7602
7603 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7604 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7605 application. This is the default.
7606
7607 @item show backtrace past-entry
7608 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7609
7610 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7611 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7612 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7613 @cindex backtrace limit
7614 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7615 or zero means unlimited levels.
7616
7617 @item show backtrace limit
7618 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7619 @end table
7620
7621 You can control how file names are displayed.
7622
7623 @table @code
7624 @item set filename-display
7625 @itemx set filename-display relative
7626 @cindex filename-display
7627 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7628
7629 @item set filename-display basename
7630 Display only basename of a filename.
7631
7632 @item set filename-display absolute
7633 Display an absolute filename.
7634
7635 @item show filename-display
7636 Show the current way to display filenames.
7637 @end table
7638
7639 @node Selection
7640 @section Selecting a Frame
7641
7642 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7643 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7644 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7645 of the stack frame just selected.
7646
7647 @table @code
7648 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7649 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7650 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7651 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7652 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7653 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame level
7657 @item @var{num}
7658 @item level @var{num}
7659 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7660 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7661 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7662 for @code{main}.
7663
7664 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7665 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7666 commands are equivalent:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7670 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @kindex frame address
7674 @item address @var{stack-address}
7675 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7676 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7677 @command{info frame}, for example:
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 (gdb) info frame
7681 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7682 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7683 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7684 source language c++.
7685 Arglist at unknown address.
7686 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7687 @end smallexample
7688
7689 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7690 indicated by the line:
7691
7692 @smallexample
7693 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7694 @end smallexample
7695
7696 @kindex frame function
7697 @item function @var{function-name}
7698 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7699 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7700 most stack frame is selected.
7701
7702 @kindex frame view
7703 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7704 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7705 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7706 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7707
7708 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7709 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7710 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7711 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7712
7713 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7714 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7715 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7716 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7717
7718 @end table
7719
7720 @kindex up
7721 @item up @var{n}
7722 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7723 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7724 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7725
7726 @kindex down
7727 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7728 @item down @var{n}
7729 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7730 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7731 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7732 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7733 @end table
7734
7735 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7736 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7737 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7738 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7739
7740 @need 1000
7741 For example:
7742
7743 @smallexample
7744 @group
7745 (@value{GDBP}) up
7746 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7747 at env.c:10
7748 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7749 @end group
7750 @end smallexample
7751
7752 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7753 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7754 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7755 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7756 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7757 for details.
7758
7759 @table @code
7760 @kindex select-frame
7761 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7762 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7763 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7764 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7765 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7766 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7767 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex down-silently
7770 @kindex up-silently
7771 @item up-silently @var{n}
7772 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7773 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7774 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7775 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7776 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7777 distracting.
7778 @end table
7779
7780 @node Frame Info
7781 @section Information About a Frame
7782
7783 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7784 stack frame.
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @item frame
7788 @itemx f
7789 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7790 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7791 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7792 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7793 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7794
7795 @kindex info frame
7796 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7797 @item info frame
7798 @itemx info f
7799 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7800 including:
7801
7802 @itemize @bullet
7803 @item
7804 the address of the frame
7805 @item
7806 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7807 @item
7808 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7809 @item
7810 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame's arguments
7813 @item
7814 the address of the frame's local variables
7815 @item
7816 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7817 @item
7818 which registers were saved in the frame
7819 @end itemize
7820
7821 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7822 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7823 the usual conventions.
7824
7825 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7826 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7827 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7828 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7829 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7830 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7831
7832 @kindex info args
7833 @item info args [-q]
7834 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7835
7836 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7837 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7838 have been printed.
7839
7840 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7841 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7842 with the provided regexp(s).
7843
7844 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7845 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7846
7847 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7848 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7849 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7850 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7851 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7852 of special characters or quotes.
7853
7854 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7855 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7856 @var{type_regexp}.
7857
7858 @item info locals [-q]
7859 @kindex info locals
7860 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7861 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7862 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7863
7864 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7865 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7866 have been printed.
7867
7868 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7869 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7870 with the provided regexp(s).
7871
7872 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7873 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7874
7875 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7876 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7877 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7878 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7879 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7880 of special characters or quotes.
7881
7882 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7883 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7884 @var{type_regexp}.
7885
7886 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7887 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7888 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7889 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7890 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7891 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7892 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7893 @smallexample
7894 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7895 @end smallexample
7896 @noindent
7897 or the equivalent shorter form
7898 @smallexample
7899 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7900 @end smallexample
7901
7902 @end table
7903
7904 @node Frame Apply
7905 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7906 @kindex frame apply
7907 @cindex apply command to several frames
7908 @table @code
7909 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7910 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7911 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @item @code{all}
7915 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7916
7917 @item @var{count}
7918 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7919 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7920
7921 @item @var{-count}
7922 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7923 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7924
7925 @item @code{level}
7926 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7927 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7928 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7929 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7930 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7931 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7932
7933 @end table
7934
7935 @end table
7936
7937 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7938 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7939 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7940 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7941
7942 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7943 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7944 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7945 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7946 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7947
7948 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7949 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7950 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7951 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7952
7953 @table @code
7954 @item -c
7955 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7956 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7957 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7958 @item -s
7959 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7960 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7961 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7962 are not printed.
7963 @item -q
7964 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7965 information.
7966 @end table
7967
7968 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7969 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7970 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7971 @code{#1 main} frame.
7972
7973 @smallexample
7974 @group
7975 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7976 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7977 No symbol "j" in current context.
7978 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7979 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7980 No symbol "j" in current context.
7981 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7982 $1 = 5
7983 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7984 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7985 $2 = 5
7986 (gdb)
7987 @end group
7988 @end smallexample
7989
7990 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7991 information before the command output:
7992
7993 @smallexample
7994 @group
7995 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7996 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7997 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7998 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7999 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8000 (gdb)
8001 @end group
8002 @end smallexample
8003
8004 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8005 @smallexample
8006 @group
8007 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8008 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8009 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8010 (gdb)
8011 @end group
8012 @end smallexample
8013
8014 @table @code
8015
8016 @kindex faas
8017 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8018 @item faas @var{command}
8019 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8020 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8021
8022 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8023 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8024 is, using:
8025 @smallexample
8026 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8027 @end smallexample
8028
8029 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8030 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8031 @end table
8032
8033
8034 @node Frame Filter Management
8035 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8036 @cindex managing frame filters
8037
8038 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8039 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8040
8041 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8042 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8043
8044 @table @code
8045 @kindex info frame-filter
8046 @item info frame-filter
8047 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8048 their name, priority and enabled status.
8049
8050 @kindex disable frame-filter
8051 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8052 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8053 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8054 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8055 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8056 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8057 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8058 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8059 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8060 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8061 may be enabled again later.
8062
8063 @kindex enable frame-filter
8064 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8065 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8066 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8067 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8068 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8069 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8070 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8071 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8072 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8073
8074 Example:
8075
8076 @smallexample
8077 (gdb) info frame-filter
8078
8079 global frame-filters:
8080 Priority Enabled Name
8081 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8082 100 Yes Reverse
8083
8084 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8085 Priority Enabled Name
8086 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8087
8088 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8089 Priority Enabled Name
8090 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8091
8092 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8093 (gdb) info frame-filter
8094
8095 global frame-filters:
8096 Priority Enabled Name
8097 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8098 100 Yes Reverse
8099
8100 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8101 Priority Enabled Name
8102 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8103
8104 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8105 Priority Enabled Name
8106 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8107
8108 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8109 (gdb) info frame-filter
8110
8111 global frame-filters:
8112 Priority Enabled Name
8113 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8114 100 Yes Reverse
8115
8116 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8117 Priority Enabled Name
8118 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8119
8120 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8121 Priority Enabled Name
8122 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8126 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8127 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8128 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8129 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8130 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8131 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8132
8133 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8134 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8135 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8136 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8137 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8138 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8139 dictionary resides.
8140
8141 Example:
8142
8143 @smallexample
8144 (gdb) info frame-filter
8145
8146 global frame-filters:
8147 Priority Enabled Name
8148 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8149 100 Yes Reverse
8150
8151 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8152 Priority Enabled Name
8153 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8154
8155 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8156 Priority Enabled Name
8157 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8158
8159 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8160 (gdb) info frame-filter
8161
8162 global frame-filters:
8163 Priority Enabled Name
8164 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8165 50 Yes Reverse
8166
8167 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8168 Priority Enabled Name
8169 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8170
8171 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8172 Priority Enabled Name
8173 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8174 @end smallexample
8175 @end table
8176
8177 @node Source
8178 @chapter Examining Source Files
8179
8180 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8181 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8182 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8183 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8184 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8185 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8186 source files by explicit command.
8187
8188 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8189 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8190 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8191
8192 @menu
8193 * List:: Printing source lines
8194 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8195 * Edit:: Editing source files
8196 * Search:: Searching source files
8197 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8198 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8199 @end menu
8200
8201 @node List
8202 @section Printing Source Lines
8203
8204 @kindex list
8205 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8206 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8207 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8208 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8209 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8210
8211 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8212
8213 @table @code
8214 @item list @var{linenum}
8215 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8216 current source file.
8217
8218 @item list @var{function}
8219 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8220 @var{function}.
8221
8222 @item list
8223 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8224 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8225 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8226 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8227 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8228
8229 @item list -
8230 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8231 @end table
8232
8233 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8234 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8235 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8236
8237 @table @code
8238 @kindex set listsize
8239 @item set listsize @var{count}
8240 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8241 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8242 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8243 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8244
8245 @kindex show listsize
8246 @item show listsize
8247 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8248 @end table
8249
8250 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8251 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8252 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8253 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8254 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8255
8256 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8257 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8258 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8259 to specify some source line.
8260
8261 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8262
8263 @table @code
8264 @item list @var{location}
8265 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8266
8267 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8268 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8269 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8270 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8271 the same source file as the first location.
8272
8273 @item list ,@var{last}
8274 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8275
8276 @item list @var{first},
8277 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8278
8279 @item list +
8280 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8281
8282 @item list -
8283 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8284
8285 @item list
8286 As described in the preceding table.
8287 @end table
8288
8289 @node Specify Location
8290 @section Specifying a Location
8291 @cindex specifying location
8292 @cindex location
8293 @cindex source location
8294
8295 @menu
8296 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8297 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8298 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8299 @end menu
8300
8301 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8302 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8303 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8304 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8305 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8306
8307 @node Linespec Locations
8308 @subsection Linespec Locations
8309 @cindex linespec locations
8310
8311 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8312 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8313 specifying a linespec:
8314
8315 @table @code
8316 @item @var{linenum}
8317 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8318
8319 @item -@var{offset}
8320 @itemx +@var{offset}
8321 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8322 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8323 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8324 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8325 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8326 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8327 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8328 linespec.
8329
8330 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8331 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8332 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8333 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8334 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8335 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8336 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8337
8338 @item @var{function}
8339 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8340 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8341
8342 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8343 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8344 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8345 means in all packages.
8346
8347 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8348 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8349 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8350
8351 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8352 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8353 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8354 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8355
8356 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8357
8358 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8359 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8360
8361 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8362 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8363 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8364 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8365 functions in different source files.
8366
8367 @item @var{label}
8368 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8369 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8370 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8371 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8372
8373 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8374 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8375 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8376 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8377 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8378 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8379
8380 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8381 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8382 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8383 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8384 each one of those probes.
8385 @end table
8386
8387 @node Explicit Locations
8388 @subsection Explicit Locations
8389 @cindex explicit locations
8390
8391 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8392 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8393
8394 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8395 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8396 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8397 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8398 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8399
8400 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8401 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8402 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8403 the symbol table to know.
8404
8405 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8406 following table:
8407
8408 @table @code
8409 @item -source @var{filename}
8410 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8411 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8412 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8413 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8414 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8415
8416 @item -function @var{function}
8417 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8418 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8419 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8420 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8421
8422 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8423 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8424 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8425 means in all packages.
8426
8427 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8428 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8429 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8430 breakpoint on both symbols.
8431
8432 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8433
8434 @item -qualified
8435
8436 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8437 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8438
8439 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8440 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8441 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8442
8443 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8444 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8445 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8446
8447 @item -label @var{label}
8448 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8449 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8450 selected stack frame.
8451
8452 @item -line @var{number}
8453 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8454 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8455 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8456 relative to the current line.
8457 @end table
8458
8459 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8460 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8461
8462 @node Address Locations
8463 @subsection Address Locations
8464 @cindex address locations
8465
8466 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8467 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8468
8469 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8470 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8471 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8472 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8473 source files.
8474
8475 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8476 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8477 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8478 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8479 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8480 of @var{address}:
8481
8482 @table @code
8483 @item @var{expression}
8484 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8485
8486 @item @var{funcaddr}
8487 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8488 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8489 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8490 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8491 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8492 (although the Pascal form also works).
8493
8494 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8495 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8496
8497 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8498 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8499 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8500 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8501 functions with identical names in different source files.
8502 @end table
8503
8504 @node Edit
8505 @section Editing Source Files
8506 @cindex editing source files
8507
8508 @kindex edit
8509 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8510 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8511 The editing program of your choice
8512 is invoked with the current line set to
8513 the active line in the program.
8514 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8515 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8516
8517 @table @code
8518 @item edit @var{location}
8519 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8520 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8521 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8522 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8523 command most commonly used:
8524
8525 @table @code
8526 @item edit @var{number}
8527 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8528
8529 @item edit @var{function}
8530 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8531 @end table
8532
8533 @end table
8534
8535 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8536 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8537 @footnote{
8538 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8539 following command-line syntax:
8540 @smallexample
8541 ex +@var{number} file
8542 @end smallexample
8543 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8544 the file where to start editing.}.
8545 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8546 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8547 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8548 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8549 @smallexample
8550 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8551 export EDITOR
8552 gdb @dots{}
8553 @end smallexample
8554 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8555 @smallexample
8556 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8557 gdb @dots{}
8558 @end smallexample
8559
8560 @node Search
8561 @section Searching Source Files
8562 @cindex searching source files
8563
8564 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8565 regular expression.
8566
8567 @table @code
8568 @kindex search
8569 @kindex forward-search
8570 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8571 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8572 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8573 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8574 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8575 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8576 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8577 @code{fo}.
8578
8579 @kindex reverse-search
8580 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8581 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8582 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8583 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8584 this command as @code{rev}.
8585 @end table
8586
8587 @node Source Path
8588 @section Specifying Source Directories
8589
8590 @cindex source path
8591 @cindex directories for source files
8592 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8593 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8594 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8595 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8596 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8597 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8598 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8599
8600 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8601 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8602 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8603 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8604 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8605 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8606 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8607 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8608 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8609 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8610 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8611
8612 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8613 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8614 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8615 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8616 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8617 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8618
8619 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8620 source files.
8621
8622 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8623 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8624 each line is in the file.
8625
8626 @kindex directory
8627 @kindex dir
8628 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8629 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8630 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8631
8632 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8633 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8634
8635 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8636 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8637 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8638 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8639 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8640 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8641 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8642 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8643 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8644 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8645 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8646 name to look up the sources.
8647
8648 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8649 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8650 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8651 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8652 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8653 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8654 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8655 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8656
8657 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8658 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8659 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8660 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8661 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8662 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8663 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8664
8665 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8666 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8667 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8668 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8669 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8670 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8671 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8672 command.
8673
8674 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8675 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8676 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8677 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8678 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8679 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8680 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8681
8682 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8683 @cindex default source path substitution
8684 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8685 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8686 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8687 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8688 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8689 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8690 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8691 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8692 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8693 together.
8694
8695 @table @code
8696 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8697 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8698 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8699 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8700 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8701 part of absolute file names) or
8702 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8703 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8704
8705 @kindex cdir
8706 @kindex cwd
8707 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8708 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8709 @cindex compilation directory
8710 @cindex current directory
8711 @cindex working directory
8712 @cindex directory, current
8713 @cindex directory, compilation
8714 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8715 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8716 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8717 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8718 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8719 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8720
8721 @item directory
8722 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8723
8724 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8725 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8726
8727 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8728 @kindex set directories
8729 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8730 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8731
8732 @item show directories
8733 @kindex show directories
8734 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8735
8736 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8737 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8738 @kindex set substitute-path
8739 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8740 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8741 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8742
8743 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8744 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8745
8746 @smallexample
8747 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8748 @end smallexample
8749
8750 @noindent
8751 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8752 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8753 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8754
8755 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8756 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8757 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8758 the substitution.
8759
8760 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8761
8762 @smallexample
8763 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8764 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8765 @end smallexample
8766
8767 @noindent
8768 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8769 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8770 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8771 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8772
8773
8774 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8775 @kindex unset substitute-path
8776 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8777 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8778 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8779
8780 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8781
8782 @item show substitute-path [path]
8783 @kindex show substitute-path
8784 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8785 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8786
8787 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8788 rules.
8789
8790 @end table
8791
8792 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8793 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8794 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8795
8796 @enumerate
8797 @item
8798 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8799
8800 @item
8801 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8802 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8803 directories in one command.
8804 @end enumerate
8805
8806 @node Machine Code
8807 @section Source and Machine Code
8808 @cindex source line and its code address
8809
8810 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8811 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8812 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8813 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8814 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8815 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8816 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8817 well as hex.
8818
8819 @table @code
8820 @kindex info line
8821 @item info line
8822 @itemx info line @var{location}
8823 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8824 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8825 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8826 information about the current source line is printed.
8827 @end table
8828
8829 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8830 the object code for the first line of function
8831 @code{m4_changequote}:
8832
8833 @smallexample
8834 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8835 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8836 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8837 @end smallexample
8838
8839 @noindent
8840 @cindex code address and its source line
8841 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8842 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8843 @smallexample
8844 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8845 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8846 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8847 @end smallexample
8848
8849 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8850 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8851 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8852 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8853 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8854 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8855 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8856 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8857 Variables}).
8858
8859 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8860 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8861 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8862 line.
8863
8864 @table @code
8865 @kindex disassemble
8866 @cindex assembly instructions
8867 @cindex instructions, assembly
8868 @cindex machine instructions
8869 @cindex listing machine instructions
8870 @item disassemble
8871 @itemx disassemble /m
8872 @itemx disassemble /s
8873 @itemx disassemble /r
8874 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8875 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8876 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8877 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8878 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8879 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8880 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8881 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8882 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8883 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8884
8885 @table @code
8886 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8887 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8888 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8889 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8890 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8891 @end table
8892
8893 @noindent
8894 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8895 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8896
8897 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8898 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8899
8900 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8901 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8902 @end table
8903
8904 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8905 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8909 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8910 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8911 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8912 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8913 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8914 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8915 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8916 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8917 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8918 End of assembler dump.
8919 @end smallexample
8920
8921 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8922 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8923 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8924
8925 @smallexample
8926 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8927 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8928 5 @{
8929 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8930 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8931 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8932 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8933 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8934
8935 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8936 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8937 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8938
8939 7 return 0;
8940 8 @}
8941 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8942 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8943 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8944
8945 End of assembler dump.
8946 @end smallexample
8947
8948 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8949 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8950 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8951 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8952 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8953 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8954 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8955 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8956 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8957
8958 @file{foo.h}:
8959
8960 @smallexample
8961 int
8962 foo (int a)
8963 @{
8964 if (a < 0)
8965 return a * 2;
8966 if (a == 0)
8967 return 1;
8968 return a + 10;
8969 @}
8970 @end smallexample
8971
8972 @file{foo.c}:
8973
8974 @smallexample
8975 #include "foo.h"
8976 volatile int x, y;
8977 int
8978 main ()
8979 @{
8980 x = foo (y);
8981 return 0;
8982 @}
8983 @end smallexample
8984
8985 @smallexample
8986 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8987 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8988 5 @{
8989
8990 6 x = foo (y);
8991 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8992 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8993
8994 7 return 0;
8995 8 @}
8996 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8997 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8998 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8999 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9000
9001 End of assembler dump.
9002 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9003 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9004 foo.c:
9005 5 @{
9006 6 x = foo (y);
9007 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9008
9009 foo.h:
9010 4 if (a < 0)
9011 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9012 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9013
9014 6 if (a == 0)
9015 7 return 1;
9016 8 return a + 10;
9017 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9018 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9019 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9020 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9021
9022 foo.c:
9023 6 x = foo (y);
9024 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9025
9026 7 return 0;
9027 8 @}
9028 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9029 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9030
9031 foo.h:
9032 5 return a * 2;
9033 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9034 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9035 End of assembler dump.
9036 @end smallexample
9037
9038 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9039
9040 @smallexample
9041 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9042 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9043 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9044 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9045 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9046 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9047 End of assembler dump.
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9051 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9052 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9053 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9054
9055 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9056 mnemonics or other syntax.
9057
9058 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9059 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9060 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9061 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9062 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9063
9064 @table @code
9065 @kindex set disassembler-options
9066 @cindex disassembler options
9067 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9068 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9069 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9070 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9071 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9072 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9073 The default value is the empty string.
9074
9075 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9076 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9077 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9078 and S/390.
9079
9080 @kindex show disassembler-options
9081 @item show disassembler-options
9082 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9083 @end table
9084
9085 @table @code
9086 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9087 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9088 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9089 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9090 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9091 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9092
9093 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9094 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9095 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9096 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9097
9098 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9099 @item show disassembly-flavor
9100 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9101 @end table
9102
9103 @table @code
9104 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9105 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9106 @item set disassemble-next-line
9107 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9108 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9109 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9110 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9111 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9112 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9113 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9114 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9115 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9116 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9117 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9118 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9119 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9120 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9121 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9122 instruction.
9123 @end table
9124
9125
9126 @node Data
9127 @chapter Examining Data
9128
9129 @cindex printing data
9130 @cindex examining data
9131 @kindex print
9132 @kindex inspect
9133 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9134 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9135 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9136 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9137 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9138 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9139
9140 @table @code
9141 @item print @var{expr}
9142 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9143 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9144 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9145 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9146 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9147 Formats}.
9148
9149 @item print
9150 @itemx print /@var{f}
9151 @cindex reprint the last value
9152 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9153 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9154 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9155 @end table
9156
9157 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9158 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9159 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9160
9161 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9162 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9163 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9164 Table}.
9165
9166 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9167 @kindex explore
9168 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9169 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9170 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9171 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9172 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9173 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9174 embedded in the higher level data types.
9175
9176 @table @code
9177 @item explore @var{arg}
9178 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9179 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9180 @end table
9181
9182 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9183 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9184 C program as
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 struct SimpleStruct
9188 @{
9189 int i;
9190 double d;
9191 @};
9192
9193 struct ComplexStruct
9194 @{
9195 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9196 int arr[10];
9197 @};
9198 @end smallexample
9199
9200 @noindent
9201 followed by variable declarations as
9202
9203 @smallexample
9204 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9205 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9210 @code{explore} command as follows.
9211
9212 @smallexample
9213 (gdb) explore cs
9214 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9215 the following fields:
9216
9217 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9218 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9219
9220 Enter the field number of choice:
9221 @end smallexample
9222
9223 @noindent
9224 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9225 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9226 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9227 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9228 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9229 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9230 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9231 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9232
9233 @smallexample
9234 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9235 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9236 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9237 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9238
9239 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9240 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9241
9242 Press enter to return to parent value:
9243 @end smallexample
9244
9245 @noindent
9246 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9247 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9248 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9249 to explore.
9250
9251 @smallexample
9252 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9253 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9254
9255 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9256
9257 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9258
9259 Press enter to return to parent value:
9260 @end smallexample
9261
9262 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9263 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9264 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9265 level data structure).
9266
9267 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9268 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9269 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9270 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9271 same example as above, your can explore the type
9272 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9273 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9274
9275 @smallexample
9276 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9277 @end smallexample
9278
9279 @noindent
9280 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9281 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9282 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9283 example.
9284
9285 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9286 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9287 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9288 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9289 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9290
9291 @table @code
9292 @item explore value @var{expr}
9293 @cindex explore value
9294 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9295 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9296 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9297 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9298 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9299
9300 @item explore type @var{arg}
9301 @cindex explore type
9302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9303 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9304 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9305 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9306 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9307 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9308 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9309 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9310 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9311 @end table
9312
9313 @menu
9314 * Expressions:: Expressions
9315 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9316 * Variables:: Program variables
9317 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9318 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9319 * Memory:: Examining memory
9320 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9321 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9322 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9323 * Value History:: Value history
9324 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9325 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9326 * Registers:: Registers
9327 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9328 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9329 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9330 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9331 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9332 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9333 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9334 character set than GDB does
9335 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9336 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9337 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9338 @end menu
9339
9340 @node Expressions
9341 @section Expressions
9342
9343 @cindex expressions
9344 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9345 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9346 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9347 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9348 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9349 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9350 @ref{Compilation}.
9351
9352 @cindex arrays in expressions
9353 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9354 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9355 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9356 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9357 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9358 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9359
9360 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9361 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9362 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9363 languages.
9364
9365 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9366 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9367
9368 @cindex casts, in expressions
9369 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9370 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9371 at that address in memory.
9372 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9373
9374 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9375 to programming languages:
9376
9377 @table @code
9378 @item @@
9379 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9380 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9381
9382 @item ::
9383 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9384 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9385
9386 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9387 @cindex type casting memory
9388 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9389 @cindex casts, to view memory
9390 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9391 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9392 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9393 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9394 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9395 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9396 @end table
9397
9398 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9399 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9400 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9401
9402 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9403 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9404 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9405 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9406 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9407 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9408 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9409
9410 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9411 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9412 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9413 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9414 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9415 as well.
9416
9417 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9418 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9419 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9420 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9421 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9422 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9423 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9424 choices.
9425
9426 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9427 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9428 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9429
9430 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9431 @smallexample
9432 @group
9433 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9434 [0] cancel
9435 [1] all
9436 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9437 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9438 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9439 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9440 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9441 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9442 > 2 4 6
9443 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9444 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9445 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9446 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9447 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9448 breakpoints.
9449 (@value{GDBP})
9450 @end group
9451 @end smallexample
9452
9453 @table @code
9454 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9455 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9456 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9457
9458 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9459 is ambiguous.
9460
9461 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9462 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9463 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9464 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9465 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9466 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9467 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9468 in the use of the menu.
9469
9470 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9471 when an ambiguity is detected.
9472
9473 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9474 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9475
9476 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9477 @item show multiple-symbols
9478 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9479 @end table
9480
9481 @node Variables
9482 @section Program Variables
9483
9484 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9485 in your program.
9486
9487 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9488 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9489
9490 @itemize @bullet
9491 @item
9492 global (or file-static)
9493 @end itemize
9494
9495 @noindent or
9496
9497 @itemize @bullet
9498 @item
9499 visible according to the scope rules of the
9500 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @noindent This means that in the function
9504
9505 @smallexample
9506 foo (a)
9507 int a;
9508 @{
9509 bar (a);
9510 @{
9511 int b = test ();
9512 bar (b);
9513 @}
9514 @}
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 @noindent
9518 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9519 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9520 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9521 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9522
9523 @cindex variable name conflict
9524 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9525 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9526 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9527 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9528 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9529 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9530 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9531
9532 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9533 @ifnotinfo
9534 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9535 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9536 @end ifnotinfo
9537 @smallexample
9538 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9539 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9540 @end smallexample
9541
9542 @noindent
9543 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9544 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9545 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9546 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9547
9548 @smallexample
9549 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9550 @end smallexample
9551
9552 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9553 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9554 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9555 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9556 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9557
9558 @smallexample
9559 void
9560 foo (int a)
9561 @{
9562 if (a < 10)
9563 bar (a);
9564 else
9565 process (a); /* Stop here */
9566 @}
9567
9568 int
9569 bar (int a)
9570 @{
9571 foo (a + 5);
9572 @}
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 @noindent
9576 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9577 here is what you might see
9578 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9579
9580 @smallexample
9581 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9582 $1 = 10
9583 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9584 $2 = 5
9585 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9586 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9587 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9588 $3 = 5
9589 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9590 $4 = 0
9591 @end smallexample
9592
9593 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9594 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9595 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9596 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9597 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9598
9599 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9600 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9601 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9602 @code{some_global}.
9603
9604 @smallexample
9605 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9606 $1 = 23
9607 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9608 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9609 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9610 $2 = 27
9611 @end smallexample
9612
9613 @cindex wrong values
9614 @cindex variable values, wrong
9615 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9616 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9617 @quotation
9618 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9619 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9620 scope, and just before exit.
9621 @end quotation
9622 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9623 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9624 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9625 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9626 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9627 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9628 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9629 variable definitions may be gone.
9630
9631 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9632 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9633 when compiling.
9634
9635 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9636 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9637 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9638 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9639 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9640 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9641 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9642
9643 @smallexample
9644 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9645 @end smallexample
9646
9647 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9648 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9649 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9650 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9651 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9652
9653 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9654 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9655 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9656 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9657
9658 @cindex no debug info variables
9659 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9660 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9661 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9662 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9663 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9664 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9665 example, in a C program:
9666
9667 @smallexample
9668 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9669 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9670 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9671 $1 = 3.14
9672 @end smallexample
9673
9674 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9675 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9676 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9677 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9678 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9679
9680 @smallexample
9681 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9682 29 i++;
9683 (gdb) next
9684 30 e (i);
9685 (gdb) print i
9686 $1 = 31
9687 (gdb) print i@@entry
9688 $2 = 30
9689 @end smallexample
9690
9691 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9692 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9693 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9694 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9695 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9696 For program code
9697
9698 @smallexample
9699 char var0[] = "A";
9700 signed char var1[] = "A";
9701 @end smallexample
9702
9703 You get during debugging
9704 @smallexample
9705 (gdb) print var0
9706 $1 = "A"
9707 (gdb) print var1
9708 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 @node Arrays
9712 @section Artificial Arrays
9713
9714 @cindex artificial array
9715 @cindex arrays
9716 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9717 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9718 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9719 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9720 program.
9721
9722 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9723 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9724 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9725 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9726 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9727 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9728 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9729 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9730 example. If a program says
9731
9732 @smallexample
9733 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9734 @end smallexample
9735
9736 @noindent
9737 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9738
9739 @smallexample
9740 p *array@@len
9741 @end smallexample
9742
9743 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9744 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9745 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9746 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9747 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9748
9749 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9750 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9751 The value need not be in memory:
9752 @smallexample
9753 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9754 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9755 @end smallexample
9756
9757 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9758 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9759 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9760 @smallexample
9761 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9762 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9766 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9767 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9768 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9769 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9770 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9771 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9772 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9773 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9774 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9775
9776 @smallexample
9777 set $i = 0
9778 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9779 @key{RET}
9780 @key{RET}
9781 @dots{}
9782 @end smallexample
9783
9784 @node Output Formats
9785 @section Output Formats
9786
9787 @cindex formatted output
9788 @cindex output formats
9789 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9790 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9791 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9792 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9793 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9794
9795 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9796 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9797 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9798 letters supported are:
9799
9800 @table @code
9801 @item x
9802 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9803 hexadecimal.
9804
9805 @item d
9806 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9807
9808 @item u
9809 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9810
9811 @item o
9812 Print as integer in octal.
9813
9814 @item t
9815 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9816 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9817 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9818 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9819
9820 @item a
9821 @cindex unknown address, locating
9822 @cindex locate address
9823 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9824 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9825 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9826
9827 @smallexample
9828 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9829 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9830 @end smallexample
9831
9832 @noindent
9833 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9834 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9835
9836 @item c
9837 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9838 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9839 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9840 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9841
9842 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9843 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9844 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9845 data.
9846
9847 @item f
9848 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9849 using typical floating point syntax.
9850
9851 @item s
9852 @cindex printing strings
9853 @cindex printing byte arrays
9854 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9855 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9856 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9857 natural types.
9858
9859 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9860 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9861 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9862 array.
9863
9864 @item z
9865 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9866 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9867 to the size of the integer type.
9868
9869 @item r
9870 @cindex raw printing
9871 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9872 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9873 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9874 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9875 pretty-printer which might exist.
9876 @end table
9877
9878 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9879
9880 @smallexample
9881 p/x $pc
9882 @end smallexample
9883
9884 @noindent
9885 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9886 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9887
9888 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9889 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9890 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9891
9892 @node Memory
9893 @section Examining Memory
9894
9895 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9896 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9897
9898 @cindex examining memory
9899 @table @code
9900 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9901 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9902 @itemx x @var{addr}
9903 @itemx x
9904 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9905 @end table
9906
9907 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9908 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9909 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9910 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9911 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9912
9913 @table @r
9914 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9915 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9916 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9917 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9918 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9919 @c 4.1.2.
9920
9921 @item @var{f}, the display format
9922 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9923 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9924 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9925 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9926 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9927
9928 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9929 The unit size is any of
9930
9931 @table @code
9932 @item b
9933 Bytes.
9934 @item h
9935 Halfwords (two bytes).
9936 @item w
9937 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9938 @item g
9939 Giant words (eight bytes).
9940 @end table
9941
9942 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9943 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9944 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9945 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9946 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9947 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9948 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9949 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9950 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9951 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9952 be altered.
9953
9954 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9955 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9956 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9957 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9958 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9959 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9960 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9961 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9962 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9963 a value from memory).
9964 @end table
9965
9966 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9967 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9968 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9969 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9970 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9971
9972 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9973 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9974 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9975
9976 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9977 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9978 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9979 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9980 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9981
9982 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9983 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9984 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9985 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9986 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9987 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9988 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9989 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9990 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9991
9992 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9993 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9994 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9995 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9996 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9997 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9998
9999 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10000 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10001 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10002 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10003 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10004 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10005 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10006
10007 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10008 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10009
10010 @smallexample
10011 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10012 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10013 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10014 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10015 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10016 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10017 @end smallexample
10018
10019 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10020 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10021 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10022 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10023 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10024 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10025 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10026 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10027 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10028
10029 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10030 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10031 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10032
10033 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10034 @cindex addressable memory unit
10035 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10036 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10037 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10038 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10039 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10040 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10041 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10042 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10043 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10044
10045 @cindex remote memory comparison
10046 @cindex target memory comparison
10047 @cindex verify remote memory image
10048 @cindex verify target memory image
10049 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10050 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10051 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10052 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10053 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10054 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10055
10056 @table @code
10057 @kindex compare-sections
10058 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10059 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10060 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10061 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10062 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10063 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10064
10065 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10066 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10067 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10068 @end table
10069
10070 @node Auto Display
10071 @section Automatic Display
10072 @cindex automatic display
10073 @cindex display of expressions
10074
10075 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10076 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10077 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10078 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10079 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10080 The automatic display looks like this:
10081
10082 @smallexample
10083 2: foo = 38
10084 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10085 @end smallexample
10086
10087 @noindent
10088 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10089 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10090 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10091 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10092 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10093 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10094
10095 @table @code
10096 @kindex display
10097 @item display @var{expr}
10098 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10099 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10100
10101 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10102
10103 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10104 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10105 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10106 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10107 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10108
10109 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10110 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10111 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10112 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10113 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10114 @end table
10115
10116 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10117 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10118 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10119
10120 @table @code
10121 @kindex delete display
10122 @kindex undisplay
10123 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10124 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10125 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10126 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10127 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10128 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10129 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10130
10131 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10132 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10133
10134 @kindex disable display
10135 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10136 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10137 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10138 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10139 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10140 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10141 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10142 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10143
10144 @kindex enable display
10145 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10146 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10147 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10148 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10149 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10150 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10151 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10152
10153 @item display
10154 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10155 done when your program stops.
10156
10157 @kindex info display
10158 @item info display
10159 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10160 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10161 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10162 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10163 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10164 @end table
10165
10166 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10167 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10168 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10169 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10170 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10171 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10172 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10173 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10174 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10175 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10176 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10177
10178 @node Print Settings
10179 @section Print Settings
10180
10181 @cindex format options
10182 @cindex print settings
10183 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10184 and symbols are printed.
10185
10186 @noindent
10187 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10188
10189 @table @code
10190 @kindex set print
10191 @item set print address
10192 @itemx set print address on
10193 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10194 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10195 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10196 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10197 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10198 @code{set print address on}:
10199
10200 @smallexample
10201 @group
10202 (@value{GDBP}) f
10203 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10204 at input.c:530
10205 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10206 @end group
10207 @end smallexample
10208
10209 @item set print address off
10210 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10211 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10212
10213 @smallexample
10214 @group
10215 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10216 (@value{GDBP}) f
10217 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10218 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10219 @end group
10220 @end smallexample
10221
10222 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10223 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10224 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10225 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10226
10227 @kindex show print
10228 @item show print address
10229 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10230 @end table
10231
10232 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10233 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10234 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10235 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10236 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10237 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10238 it prints a symbolic address:
10239
10240 @table @code
10241 @item set print symbol-filename on
10242 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10243 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10244 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10245 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10246
10247 @item set print symbol-filename off
10248 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10249 default.
10250
10251 @item show print symbol-filename
10252 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10253 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10254 @end table
10255
10256 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10257 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10258 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10259
10260 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10261 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10262
10263 @table @code
10264 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10265 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10266 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10267 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10268 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10269 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10270 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10271 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10272
10273 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10274 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10275 symbolic address.
10276 @end table
10277
10278 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10279 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10280 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10281 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10282 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10283 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10284 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10285 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10286
10287 @smallexample
10288 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10289 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10290 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10291 @end smallexample
10292
10293 @quotation
10294 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10295 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10296 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10297 @end quotation
10298
10299 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10300 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10301
10302 @table @code
10303 @item set print symbol on
10304 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10305 one exists.
10306
10307 @item set print symbol off
10308 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10309 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10310 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10311
10312 @item show print symbol
10313 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10314 address.
10315 @end table
10316
10317 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10318
10319 @table @code
10320 @item set print array
10321 @itemx set print array on
10322 @cindex pretty print arrays
10323 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10324 but uses more space. The default is off.
10325
10326 @item set print array off
10327 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10328
10329 @item show print array
10330 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10331 arrays.
10332
10333 @cindex print array indexes
10334 @item set print array-indexes
10335 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10336 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10337 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10338 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10339
10340 @item set print array-indexes off
10341 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10342
10343 @item show print array-indexes
10344 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10345 arrays.
10346
10347 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10348 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10349 @cindex number of array elements to print
10350 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10351 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10352 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10353 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10354 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10355 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10356 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10357 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10358
10359 @item show print elements
10360 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10361 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10362
10363 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10364 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10365 @cindex printing frame argument values
10366 @cindex print all frame argument values
10367 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10368 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10369 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10370 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10371 values are:
10372
10373 @table @code
10374 @item all
10375 The values of all arguments are printed.
10376
10377 @item scalars
10378 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10379 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10380 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10381 only scalar arguments are shown:
10382
10383 @smallexample
10384 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10385 at frame-args.c:23
10386 @end smallexample
10387
10388 @item none
10389 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10390 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10391
10392 @smallexample
10393 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10394 at frame-args.c:23
10395 @end smallexample
10396 @end table
10397
10398 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10399 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10400 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10401 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10402 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10403 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10404 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10405 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10406 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10407 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10408
10409 @item show print frame-arguments
10410 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10411
10412 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10413 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10414
10415 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10416 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10417 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10418 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10419 This is the default.
10420
10421 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10422 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10423
10424 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10425 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10426 @kindex set print entry-values
10427 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10428 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10429 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10430 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10431 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10432
10433 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10434 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10435 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10436 @code{no} setting.
10437
10438 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10439 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10440 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10441 this information.
10442
10443 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10444
10445 @table @code
10446 @item no
10447 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10448 point.
10449 @smallexample
10450 #0 equal (val=5)
10451 #0 different (val=6)
10452 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10453 #0 born (val=10)
10454 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10455 @end smallexample
10456
10457 @item only
10458 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10459 values are never printed.
10460 @smallexample
10461 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10462 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10463 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10464 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10465 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @item preferred
10469 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10470 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10471 value for such parameter.
10472 @smallexample
10473 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10474 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10475 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10476 #0 born (val=10)
10477 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10478 @end smallexample
10479
10480 @item if-needed
10481 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10482 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10483 parameter.
10484 @smallexample
10485 #0 equal (val=5)
10486 #0 different (val=6)
10487 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10488 #0 born (val=10)
10489 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10490 @end smallexample
10491
10492 @item both
10493 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10494 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10495 optimizations.
10496 @smallexample
10497 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10498 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10499 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10500 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10501 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10502 @end smallexample
10503
10504 @item compact
10505 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10506 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10507 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10508 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10509 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10510 @smallexample
10511 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10512 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10513 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10514 #0 born (val=10)
10515 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10516 @end smallexample
10517
10518 @item default
10519 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10520 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10521 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10522 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10523 @smallexample
10524 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10525 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10526 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10527 #0 born (val=10)
10528 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10529 @end smallexample
10530 @end table
10531
10532 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10533 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10534
10535 @item show print entry-values
10536 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10537 entry.
10538
10539 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10540 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10541 @cindex repeated array elements
10542 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10543 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10544 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10545 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10546 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10547 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10548 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10549 is 10.
10550
10551 @item show print repeats
10552 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10553 elements.
10554
10555 @item set print null-stop
10556 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10557 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10558 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10559 contain only short strings.
10560 The default is off.
10561
10562 @item show print null-stop
10563 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10564 @sc{null} character.
10565
10566 @item set print pretty on
10567 @cindex print structures in indented form
10568 @cindex indentation in structure display
10569 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10570 per line, like this:
10571
10572 @smallexample
10573 @group
10574 $1 = @{
10575 next = 0x0,
10576 flags = @{
10577 sweet = 1,
10578 sour = 1
10579 @},
10580 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10581 @}
10582 @end group
10583 @end smallexample
10584
10585 @item set print pretty off
10586 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10587
10588 @smallexample
10589 @group
10590 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10591 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10592 @end group
10593 @end smallexample
10594
10595 @noindent
10596 This is the default format.
10597
10598 @item show print pretty
10599 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10600
10601 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10602 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10603 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10604 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10605 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10606 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10607 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10608 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10609
10610 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10611 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10612 international character sets, and is the default.
10613
10614 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10615 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10616
10617 @item set print union on
10618 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10619 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10620 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10621
10622 @item set print union off
10623 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10624 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10625 instead.
10626
10627 @item show print union
10628 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10629 structures and other unions.
10630
10631 For example, given the declarations
10632
10633 @smallexample
10634 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10635 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10636 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10637 Bug_forms;
10638
10639 struct thing @{
10640 Species it;
10641 union @{
10642 Tree_forms tree;
10643 Bug_forms bug;
10644 @} form;
10645 @};
10646
10647 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10648 @end smallexample
10649
10650 @noindent
10651 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10652
10653 @smallexample
10654 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10655 @end smallexample
10656
10657 @noindent
10658 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10659
10660 @smallexample
10661 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10662 @end smallexample
10663
10664 @noindent
10665 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10666 and in Pascal.
10667 @end table
10668
10669 @need 1000
10670 @noindent
10671 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10672
10673 @table @code
10674 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10675 @item set print demangle
10676 @itemx set print demangle on
10677 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10678 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10679 linkage. The default is on.
10680
10681 @item show print demangle
10682 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10683
10684 @item set print asm-demangle
10685 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10686 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10687 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10688 The default is off.
10689
10690 @item show print asm-demangle
10691 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10692 or demangled form.
10693
10694 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10695 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10696 @kindex set demangle-style
10697 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10698 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10699 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10700
10701 @table @code
10702 @item auto
10703 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10704 This is the default.
10705
10706 @item gnu
10707 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10708
10709 @item hp
10710 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10711
10712 @item lucid
10713 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10714
10715 @item arm
10716 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10717 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10718 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10719 require further enhancement to permit that.
10720
10721 @end table
10722 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10723
10724 @item show demangle-style
10725 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10726
10727 @item set print object
10728 @itemx set print object on
10729 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10730 @cindex display derived types
10731 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10732 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10733 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10734 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10735 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10736 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10737 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10738
10739 @item set print object off
10740 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10741 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10742
10743 @item show print object
10744 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10745
10746 @item set print static-members
10747 @itemx set print static-members on
10748 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10749 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10750
10751 @item set print static-members off
10752 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10753
10754 @item show print static-members
10755 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10756
10757 @item set print pascal_static-members
10758 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10759 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10760 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10761 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10762
10763 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10764 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10765
10766 @item show print pascal_static-members
10767 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10768
10769 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10770 @item set print vtbl
10771 @itemx set print vtbl on
10772 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10773 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10774 @cindex VTBL display
10775 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10776 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10777 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10778
10779 @item set print vtbl off
10780 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10781
10782 @item show print vtbl
10783 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10784 @end table
10785
10786 @node Pretty Printing
10787 @section Pretty Printing
10788
10789 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10790 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10791 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10792
10793 @menu
10794 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10795 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10796 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10797 @end menu
10798
10799 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10800 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10801
10802 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10803 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10804 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10805
10806 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10807 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10808 pretty-printers with their names.
10809 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10810 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10811 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10812 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10813
10814 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10815 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10816 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10817 do anything special.
10818
10819 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10820
10821 @itemize @bullet
10822 @item
10823 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10824 all inferiors.
10825
10826 @item
10827 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10828 when debugging that program.
10829 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10830
10831 @item
10832 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10833 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10834 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10835 @end itemize
10836
10837 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10838 pretty-printers are selected,
10839
10840 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10841 for new types.
10842
10843 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10844 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10845
10846 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10847
10848 @smallexample
10849 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10850 $1 = @{
10851 static npos = 4294967295,
10852 _M_dataplus = @{
10853 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10854 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10855 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10856 @},
10857 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10858 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10859 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10860 @}
10861 @}
10862 @end smallexample
10863
10864 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10868 $2 = "abcd"
10869 @end smallexample
10870
10871 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10872 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10873 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10874
10875 @table @code
10876 @kindex info pretty-printer
10877 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10878 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10879 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10880
10881 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10882 whose pretty-printers to list.
10883 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10884 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10885 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10886 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10887 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10888
10889 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10890 to list.
10891
10892 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10893 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10894 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10895 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10896
10897 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10898 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10899 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10900 @end table
10901
10902 Example:
10903
10904 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10905 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10906 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10907 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10908
10909 @smallexample
10910 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10911 library1.so:
10912 foo
10913 library2.so:
10914 bar
10915 bar1
10916 bar2
10917 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10918 library2.so:
10919 bar
10920 bar1
10921 bar2
10922 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10923 1 printer disabled
10924 2 of 3 printers enabled
10925 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10926 library1.so:
10927 foo [disabled]
10928 library2.so:
10929 bar
10930 bar1
10931 bar2
10932 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10933 1 printer disabled
10934 1 of 3 printers enabled
10935 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10936 library1.so:
10937 foo [disabled]
10938 library2.so:
10939 bar
10940 bar1 [disabled]
10941 bar2
10942 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10943 1 printer disabled
10944 0 of 3 printers enabled
10945 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10946 library1.so:
10947 foo [disabled]
10948 library2.so:
10949 bar [disabled]
10950 bar1 [disabled]
10951 bar2
10952 @end smallexample
10953
10954 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10955 as can each individual subprinter.
10956
10957 @node Value History
10958 @section Value History
10959
10960 @cindex value history
10961 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10962 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10963 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10964 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10965 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10966 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10967 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10968 symbol table.
10969
10970 @cindex @code{$}
10971 @cindex @code{$$}
10972 @cindex history number
10973 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10974 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10975 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10976 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10977 history number.
10978
10979 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10980 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10981 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10982 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10983 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10984 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10985 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10986
10987 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10988 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10989
10990 @smallexample
10991 p *$
10992 @end smallexample
10993
10994 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10995 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10996
10997 @smallexample
10998 p *$.next
10999 @end smallexample
11000
11001 @noindent
11002 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11003 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11004
11005 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11006 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11007
11008 @smallexample
11009 print x
11010 set x=5
11011 @end smallexample
11012
11013 @noindent
11014 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11015 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11016
11017 @table @code
11018 @kindex show values
11019 @item show values
11020 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11021 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11022 values} does not change the history.
11023
11024 @item show values @var{n}
11025 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11026
11027 @item show values +
11028 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11029 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11030 @end table
11031
11032 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11033 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11034
11035 @node Convenience Vars
11036 @section Convenience Variables
11037
11038 @cindex convenience variables
11039 @cindex user-defined variables
11040 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11041 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11042 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11043 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11044 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11045
11046 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11047 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11048 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11049 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11050 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11051
11052 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11053 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11054 For example:
11055
11056 @smallexample
11057 set $foo = *object_ptr
11058 @end smallexample
11059
11060 @noindent
11061 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11062 @code{object_ptr}.
11063
11064 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11065 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11066 value with another assignment at any time.
11067
11068 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11069 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11070 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11071 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11072
11073 @table @code
11074 @kindex show convenience
11075 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11076 @item show convenience
11077 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11078 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11079 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11080
11081 @kindex init-if-undefined
11082 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11083 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11084 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11085 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11086 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11087 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11088 override default values used in a command script.
11089
11090 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11091 any side-effects do not occur.
11092 @end table
11093
11094 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11095 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11096 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 set $i = 0
11100 print bar[$i++]->contents
11101 @end smallexample
11102
11103 @noindent
11104 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11105
11106 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11107 values likely to be useful.
11108
11109 @table @code
11110 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11111 @item $_
11112 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11113 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11114 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11115 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11116 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11117 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11118 to the type of @code{$__}.
11119
11120 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11121 @item $__
11122 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11123 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11124 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11125
11126 @item $_exitcode
11127 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11128 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11129 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11130 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11131
11132 @item $_exitsignal
11133 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11134 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11135 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11136 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11137
11138 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11139 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11140 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11141 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11142 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11143
11144 @smallexample
11145 #include <signal.h>
11146
11147 int
11148 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11149 @{
11150 raise (SIGALRM);
11151 return 0;
11152 @}
11153 @end smallexample
11154
11155 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11156 or signalled would be:
11157
11158 @smallexample
11159 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11160 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11161 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11162 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11163 >echo The program has exited\n
11164 >else
11165 >echo The program has signalled\n
11166 >end
11167 >end
11168 (@value{GDBP}) run
11169 Starting program:
11170
11171 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11172 The program no longer exists.
11173 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11174 The program has signalled
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11178 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11179 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11180 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11181
11182 @smallexample
11183 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11184 The program has exited
11185 @end smallexample
11186
11187 @item $_exception
11188 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11189 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11190
11191 @item $_probe_argc
11192 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11193 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11194
11195 @item $_sdata
11196 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11197 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11198 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11199 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11200 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11201
11202 @item $_siginfo
11203 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11204 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11205 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11206 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11207 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11208
11209 @item $_tlb
11210 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11211 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11212 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11213 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11214 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11215 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11216
11217 @item $_inferior
11218 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11219 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11220
11221 @item $_thread
11222 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11223
11224 @item $_gthread
11225 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11226
11227 @end table
11228
11229 @node Convenience Funs
11230 @section Convenience Functions
11231
11232 @cindex convenience functions
11233 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11234 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11235 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11236 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11237 @value{GDBN}.
11238
11239 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11240 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11241
11242 @table @code
11243
11244 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11245 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11246 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11247 returns zero.
11248
11249 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11250 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11251 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11252 it is @code{void}:
11253
11254 @smallexample
11255 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11256 $1 = void
11257 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11258 $2 = 1
11259 (@value{GDBP}) run
11260 Starting program: ./a.out
11261 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11262 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11263 $3 = 0
11264 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11265 $4 = 0
11266 @end smallexample
11267
11268 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11269 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11270 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11271 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11272 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11273 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11274 anymore.
11275
11276 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11277 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11278
11279 @smallexample
11280 void
11281 foo (void)
11282 @{
11283 @}
11284 @end smallexample
11285
11286 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11287
11288 @smallexample
11289 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11290 $1 = void
11291 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11292 $2 = 1
11293 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11294 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11295 $3 = void
11296 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11297 $4 = 1
11298 @end smallexample
11299
11300 @end table
11301
11302 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11303 @code{Python} support.
11304
11305 @table @code
11306
11307 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11308 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11309 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11310 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11311 Otherwise it returns zero.
11312
11313 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11314 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11315 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11316 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11317 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11318 regular expression support.
11319
11320 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11321 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11322 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11323 Otherwise it returns zero.
11324
11325 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11326 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11327 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11328
11329 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11330 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11331 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11332 Otherwise it returns zero.
11333
11334 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11335 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11336 The default is 1.
11337
11338 Example:
11339
11340 @smallexample
11341 (gdb) backtrace
11342 #0 bottom_func ()
11343 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11344 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11345 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11346 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11347 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11348 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11349 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11350 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11351 $1 = 1
11352 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11353 $1 = 1
11354 @end smallexample
11355
11356 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11357 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11358 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11359 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11360
11361 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11362 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11363 The default is 1.
11364
11365 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11366 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11367 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11368 Otherwise it returns zero.
11369
11370 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11371 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11372 The default is 1.
11373
11374 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11375 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11376 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11377 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11378
11379 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11380 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11381 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11382 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11383
11384 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11385 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11386 The default is 1.
11387
11388 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11389 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11390 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11391 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11392
11393 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11394 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11395 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11396
11397 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11398 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11399 an enumerated type:
11400
11401 @smallexample
11402 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11403 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11404 @end smallexample
11405
11406 @end table
11407
11408 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11409 convenience functions.
11410
11411 @table @code
11412 @item help function
11413 @kindex help function
11414 @cindex show all convenience functions
11415 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11416 @end table
11417
11418 @node Registers
11419 @section Registers
11420
11421 @cindex registers
11422 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11423 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11424 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11425 your machine.
11426
11427 @table @code
11428 @kindex info registers
11429 @item info registers
11430 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11431 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11432
11433 @kindex info all-registers
11434 @cindex floating point registers
11435 @item info all-registers
11436 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11437 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11438
11439 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11440 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11441 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11442 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11443
11444 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11445 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11446 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11447 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11448 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11449 @end table
11450
11451 @anchor{standard registers}
11452 @cindex stack pointer register
11453 @cindex program counter register
11454 @cindex process status register
11455 @cindex frame pointer register
11456 @cindex standard registers
11457 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11458 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11459 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11460 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11461 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11462 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11463 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11464 you could print the program counter in hex with
11465
11466 @smallexample
11467 p/x $pc
11468 @end smallexample
11469
11470 @noindent
11471 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11472
11473 @smallexample
11474 x/i $pc
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 @noindent
11478 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11479 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11480 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11481 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11482 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11483 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11484 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11485
11486 @smallexample
11487 set $sp += 4
11488 @end smallexample
11489
11490 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11491 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11492 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11493 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11494 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11495 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11496 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11497
11498 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11499 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11500 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11501 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11502 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11503 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11504 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11505
11506 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11507 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11508 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11509 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11510 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11511 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11512 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11513 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11514 prints the data in both formats.
11515
11516 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11517 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11518 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11519 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11520 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11521 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11522 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11523
11524 @smallexample
11525 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11526 $1 = @{
11527 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11528 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11529 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11530 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11531 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11532 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11533 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11534 @}
11535 @end smallexample
11536
11537 @noindent
11538 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11539 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11540 value to a @code{struct} member:
11541
11542 @smallexample
11543 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11544 @end smallexample
11545
11546 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11547 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11548 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11549 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11550 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11551 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11552
11553 @cindex caller-saved registers
11554 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11555 @cindex volatile registers
11556 @cindex <not saved> values
11557 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11558 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11559 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11560 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11561 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11562 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11563 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11564 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11565 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11566 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11567 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11568 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11569 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11570 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11571 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11572 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11573 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11574 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11575 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11576 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11577 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11578 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11579 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11580
11581 @node Floating Point Hardware
11582 @section Floating Point Hardware
11583 @cindex floating point
11584
11585 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11586 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11587
11588 @table @code
11589 @kindex info float
11590 @item info float
11591 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11592 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11593 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11594 the ARM and x86 machines.
11595 @end table
11596
11597 @node Vector Unit
11598 @section Vector Unit
11599 @cindex vector unit
11600
11601 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11602 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11603
11604 @table @code
11605 @kindex info vector
11606 @item info vector
11607 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11608 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11609 @end table
11610
11611 @node OS Information
11612 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11613 @cindex OS information
11614
11615 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11616 you debug your program.
11617
11618 @cindex auxiliary vector
11619 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11620 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11621 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11622 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11623 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11624 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11625 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11626 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11627 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11628 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11629 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11630 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11631
11632 @table @code
11633 @kindex info auxv
11634 @item info auxv
11635 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11636 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11637 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11638 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11639 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11640 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11641 an unrecognized tag.
11642 @end table
11643
11644 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11645 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11646 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11647 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11648 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11649 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11650 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11651
11652 @table @code
11653 @kindex info os
11654 @item info os @var{infotype}
11655
11656 Display OS information of the requested type.
11657
11658 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11659
11660 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11661 @table @code
11662 @kindex info os cpus
11663 @item cpus
11664 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11665 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11666 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11667 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11668 kernel initialization.
11669
11670 @kindex info os files
11671 @item files
11672 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11673 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11674 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11675 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11676
11677 @kindex info os modules
11678 @item modules
11679 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11680 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11681 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11682 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11683 in memory.
11684
11685 @kindex info os msg
11686 @item msg
11687 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11688 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11689 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11690 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11691 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11692 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11693 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11694 the message queue was last changed.
11695
11696 @kindex info os processes
11697 @item processes
11698 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11699 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11700 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11701 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11702 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11703 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11704
11705 @kindex info os procgroups
11706 @item procgroups
11707 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11708 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11709 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11710 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11711 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11712 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11713 and the process group leader is listed first.
11714
11715 @kindex info os semaphores
11716 @item semaphores
11717 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11718 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11719 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11720 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11721 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11722
11723 @kindex info os shm
11724 @item shm
11725 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11726 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11727 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11728 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11729 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11730 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11731 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11732
11733 @kindex info os sockets
11734 @item sockets
11735 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11736 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11737 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11738 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11739 connection.
11740
11741 @kindex info os threads
11742 @item threads
11743 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11744 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11745 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11746 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11747 process is not listed.
11748 @end table
11749
11750 @item info os
11751 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11752 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11753 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11754 types, this command will report an error.
11755 @end table
11756
11757 @node Memory Region Attributes
11758 @section Memory Region Attributes
11759 @cindex memory region attributes
11760
11761 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11762 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11763 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11764 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11765 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11766 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11767 user can override the fetched regions.
11768
11769 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11770 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11771 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11772 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11773 all memory.
11774
11775 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11776 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11777
11778 @table @code
11779 @kindex mem
11780 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11781 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11782 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11783 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11784 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11785 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11786
11787 @item mem auto
11788 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11789 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11790
11791 @kindex delete mem
11792 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11793 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11794 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11795
11796 @kindex disable mem
11797 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11798 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11799 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11800 It may be enabled again later.
11801
11802 @kindex enable mem
11803 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11804 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11805
11806 @kindex info mem
11807 @item info mem
11808 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11809 for each region:
11810
11811 @table @emph
11812 @item Memory Region Number
11813 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11814 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11815 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11816
11817 @item Lo Address
11818 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11819
11820 @item Hi Address
11821 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11822
11823 @item Attributes
11824 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11825 @end table
11826 @end table
11827
11828
11829 @subsection Attributes
11830
11831 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11832 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11833 write accesses to a memory region.
11834
11835 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11836 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11837 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11838
11839 @table @code
11840 @item ro
11841 Memory is read only.
11842 @item wo
11843 Memory is write only.
11844 @item rw
11845 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11846 @end table
11847
11848 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11849 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11850 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11851 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11852 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11853
11854 @table @code
11855 @item 8
11856 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11857 @item 16
11858 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11859 @item 32
11860 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11861 @item 64
11862 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11863 @end table
11864
11865 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11866 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11867 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11868 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11869 @c
11870 @c @table @code
11871 @c @item hwbreak
11872 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11873 @c @item swbreak (default)
11874 @c @end table
11875
11876 @subsubsection Data Cache
11877 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11878 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11879 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11880 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11881 registers.
11882
11883 @table @code
11884 @item cache
11885 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11886 @item nocache
11887 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11888 @end table
11889
11890 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11891 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11892 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11893 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11894 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11895
11896 @table @code
11897 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11898 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11899 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11900 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11901 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11902 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11903 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11904 The default value is @code{on}.
11905 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11906 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11907 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11908 @end table
11909
11910
11911 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11912 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11913 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11914 @c
11915 @c @table @code
11916 @c @item verify
11917 @c @item noverify (default)
11918 @c @end table
11919
11920 @node Dump/Restore Files
11921 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11922 @cindex dump/restore files
11923 @cindex append data to a file
11924 @cindex dump data to a file
11925 @cindex restore data from a file
11926
11927 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11928 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11929 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11930 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11931 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11932 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11933 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11934
11935 @table @code
11936
11937 @kindex dump
11938 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11939 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11940 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11941 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11942
11943 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11944 @table @code
11945 @item binary
11946 Raw binary form.
11947 @item ihex
11948 Intel hex format.
11949 @item srec
11950 Motorola S-record format.
11951 @item tekhex
11952 Tektronix Hex format.
11953 @item verilog
11954 Verilog Hex format.
11955 @end table
11956
11957 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11958 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11959 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11960 form.
11961
11962 @kindex append
11963 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11964 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11965 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11966 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11967 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11968
11969 @kindex restore
11970 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11971 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11972 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11973 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11974 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11975
11976 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11977 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11978 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11979 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11980 from that location.
11981
11982 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11983 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11984 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11985 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11986
11987 @end table
11988
11989 @node Core File Generation
11990 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11991 @cindex dump core from inferior
11992
11993 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11994 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11995 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11996 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11997 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11998 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11999 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12000
12001 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12002 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12003 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12004
12005 @table @code
12006 @kindex gcore
12007 @kindex generate-core-file
12008 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12009 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12010 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12011 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12012 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12013 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12014
12015 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12016 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12017
12018 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12019 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12020 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12021 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12022 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12023
12024 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12025 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12026 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12027 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12028 Enable or disable the use of the file
12029 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12030 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12031 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12032 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12033
12034 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12035 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12036 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12037 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12038 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12039 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12040 about the bits that can be set in the
12041 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12042 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12043
12044 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12045 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12046 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12047 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12048 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12049 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12050 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12051 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12052
12053 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12054 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12055 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12056 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12057 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12058 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12059 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12060
12061 The default value is @code{off}.
12062 @end table
12063
12064 @node Character Sets
12065 @section Character Sets
12066 @cindex character sets
12067 @cindex charset
12068 @cindex translating between character sets
12069 @cindex host character set
12070 @cindex target character set
12071
12072 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12073 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12074 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12075 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12076 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12077 @dfn{target character set}.
12078
12079 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12080 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12081 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12082 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12083 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12084 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12085 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12086 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12087 character and string literals in expressions.
12088
12089 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12090 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12091 target-charset} command, described below.
12092
12093 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12094 support:
12095
12096 @table @code
12097 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12098 @kindex set target-charset
12099 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12100 list of supported target character sets, type
12101 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12102
12103 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12104 @kindex set host-charset
12105 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12106
12107 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12108 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12109 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12110 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12111 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12112
12113 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12114 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12115 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12116
12117 @item set charset @var{charset}
12118 @kindex set charset
12119 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12120 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12121 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12122 for both host and target.
12123
12124 @item show charset
12125 @kindex show charset
12126 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12127
12128 @item show host-charset
12129 @kindex show host-charset
12130 Show the name of the current host character set.
12131
12132 @item show target-charset
12133 @kindex show target-charset
12134 Show the name of the current target character set.
12135
12136 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12137 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12138 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12139 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12140 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12141 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12142
12143 @item show target-wide-charset
12144 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12145 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12146 @end table
12147
12148 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12149 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12150 @file{charset-test.c}:
12151
12152 @smallexample
12153 #include <stdio.h>
12154
12155 char ascii_hello[]
12156 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12157 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12158 char ibm1047_hello[]
12159 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12160 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12161
12162 main ()
12163 @{
12164 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12165 @}
12166 @end smallexample
12167
12168 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12169 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12170 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12171
12172 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12173
12174 @smallexample
12175 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12176 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12177 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12178 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12179 @dots{}
12180 (@value{GDBP})
12181 @end smallexample
12182
12183 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12184 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12185 strings:
12186
12187 @smallexample
12188 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12189 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12190 (@value{GDBP})
12191 @end smallexample
12192
12193 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12194 initial character set:
12195 @smallexample
12196 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12197 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12198 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12199 (@value{GDBP})
12200 @end smallexample
12201
12202 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12203 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12204 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12205 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12206 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12207
12208 @smallexample
12209 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12210 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12211 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12212 $2 = 72 'H'
12213 (@value{GDBP})
12214 @end smallexample
12215
12216 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12217 literals you use in expressions:
12218
12219 @smallexample
12220 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12221 $3 = 43 '+'
12222 (@value{GDBP})
12223 @end smallexample
12224
12225 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12226 character.
12227
12228 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12229 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12230 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12231
12232 @smallexample
12233 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12234 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12235 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12236 $5 = 200 '\310'
12237 (@value{GDBP})
12238 @end smallexample
12239
12240 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12241 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12242
12243 @smallexample
12244 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12245 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12246 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12247 @end smallexample
12248
12249 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12250 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12251 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12252 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12253 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12254
12255 @smallexample
12256 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12257 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12258 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12259 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12260 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12261 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12262 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12263 $7 = 72 '\110'
12264 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12265 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12266 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12267 $9 = 200 'H'
12268 (@value{GDBP})
12269 @end smallexample
12270
12271 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12272 string literals you use in expressions:
12273
12274 @smallexample
12275 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12276 $10 = 78 '+'
12277 (@value{GDBP})
12278 @end smallexample
12279
12280 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12281 character.
12282
12283 @node Caching Target Data
12284 @section Caching Data of Targets
12285 @cindex caching data of targets
12286
12287 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12288 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12289 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12290 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12291 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12292 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12293 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12294 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12295 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12296 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12297 is executing.
12298 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12299 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12300 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12301 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12302 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12303 in the code segment.
12304 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12305 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12306
12307 @table @code
12308 @kindex set remotecache
12309 @item set remotecache on
12310 @itemx set remotecache off
12311 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12312 with old scripts.
12313
12314 @kindex show remotecache
12315 @item show remotecache
12316 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12317
12318 @kindex set stack-cache
12319 @item set stack-cache on
12320 @itemx set stack-cache off
12321 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12322 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12323
12324 @kindex show stack-cache
12325 @item show stack-cache
12326 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12327
12328 @kindex set code-cache
12329 @item set code-cache on
12330 @itemx set code-cache off
12331 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12332 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12333 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12334
12335 @kindex show code-cache
12336 @item show code-cache
12337 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12338 accesses.
12339
12340 @kindex info dcache
12341 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12342 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12343 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12344 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12345 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12346 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12347
12348 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12349 printed in hex.
12350
12351 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12352 @cindex dcache size
12353 @kindex set dcache size
12354 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12355
12356 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12357 @cindex dcache line-size
12358 @kindex set dcache line-size
12359 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12360 Must be a power of 2.
12361
12362 @item show dcache size
12363 @kindex show dcache size
12364 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12365
12366 @item show dcache line-size
12367 @kindex show dcache line-size
12368 Show default size of dcache lines.
12369
12370 @end table
12371
12372 @node Searching Memory
12373 @section Search Memory
12374 @cindex searching memory
12375
12376 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12377 @code{find} command.
12378
12379 @table @code
12380 @kindex find
12381 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12382 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12383 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12384 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12385 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12386 @end table
12387
12388 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12389 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12390
12391 @table @r
12392 @item @var{s}, search query size
12393 The size of each search query value.
12394
12395 @table @code
12396 @item b
12397 bytes
12398 @item h
12399 halfwords (two bytes)
12400 @item w
12401 words (four bytes)
12402 @item g
12403 giant words (eight bytes)
12404 @end table
12405
12406 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12407 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12408 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12409 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12410 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12411
12412 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12413 value's type in the current language.
12414 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12415 pattern as a mixture of types.
12416 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12417 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12418 which is typically four bytes.
12419
12420 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12421 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12422 @end table
12423
12424 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12425 (@code{"}).
12426 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12427 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12428
12429 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12430 number of matches found.
12431
12432 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12433 @samp{$_}.
12434 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12435
12436 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12437
12438 @smallexample
12439 void
12440 hello ()
12441 @{
12442 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12443 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12444 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12445 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12446 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12447 @}
12448 @end smallexample
12449
12450 @noindent
12451 you get during debugging:
12452
12453 @smallexample
12454 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12455 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12456 1 pattern found
12457 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12458 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12459 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12460 2 patterns found.
12461 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12462 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12463 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12464 2 patterns found.
12465 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12466 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12467 1 pattern found
12468 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12469 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12470 1 pattern found
12471 (gdb) print $numfound
12472 $1 = 1
12473 (gdb) print $_
12474 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12475 @end smallexample
12476
12477 @node Value Sizes
12478 @section Value Sizes
12479
12480 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12481 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12482 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12483 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12484 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12485
12486 @table @code
12487 @kindex set max-value-size
12488 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12489 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12490 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12491 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12492 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12493
12494 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12495 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12496
12497 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12498 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12499 currently 16 bytes.
12500
12501 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12502 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12503 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12504 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12505 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12506 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12507 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12508 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12509
12510 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12511
12512 @kindex show max-value-size
12513 @item show max-value-size
12514 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12515 allocate for the contents of a value.
12516 @end table
12517
12518 @node Optimized Code
12519 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12520 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12521 @cindex debugging optimized code
12522
12523 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12524 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12525 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12526 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12527 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12528 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12529 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12530
12531 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12532 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12533 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12534 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12535
12536 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12537 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12538 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12539 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12540 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12541 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12542
12543 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12544 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12545 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12546 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12547 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12548
12549 @menu
12550 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12551 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12552 @end menu
12553
12554 @node Inline Functions
12555 @section Inline Functions
12556 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12557
12558 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12559 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12560 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12561 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12562 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12563 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12564 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12565 @code{info frame} command.
12566
12567 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12568 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12569 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12570 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12571 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12572 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12573 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12574 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12575 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12576 local variables in the caller.
12577
12578 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12579 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12580 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12581 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12582 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12583 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12584 instructions are executed.
12585
12586 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12587 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12588 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12589 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12590
12591 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12592 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12593
12594 @itemize @bullet
12595 @item
12596 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12597 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12598 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12599 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12600 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12601 or inside the inlined function instead.
12602
12603 @item
12604 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12605 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12606 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12607 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12608
12609 @end itemize
12610
12611 @node Tail Call Frames
12612 @section Tail Call Frames
12613 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12614
12615 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12616 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12617 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12618 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12619 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12620
12621 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12622 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12623 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12624 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12625 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12626 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12627 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12628
12629 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12630 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12631 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12632 this information.
12633
12634 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12635 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12636
12637 @smallexample
12638 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12639 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12640 (gdb) info frame
12641 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12642 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12643 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12644 source language c++.
12645 Arglist at unknown address.
12646 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12647 @end smallexample
12648
12649 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12650 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12651 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12652 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12653 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12654 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12655
12656 @table @code
12657 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12658 @item set debug entry-values
12659 @kindex set debug entry-values
12660 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12661 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12662 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12663 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12664 result.
12665
12666 @item show debug entry-values
12667 @kindex show debug entry-values
12668 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12669 values at function entry and tail calls.
12670 @end table
12671
12672 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12673 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12674 reference by variable @code{x}):
12675
12676 @smallexample
12677 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12678 void (*x) (void) = c;
12679 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12680 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12681 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12682
12683 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12684 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12685 a () at t.c:3
12686 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12687 (gdb) bt
12688 #0 a () at t.c:3
12689 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12690 @end smallexample
12691
12692 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12693
12694 @smallexample
12695 int i;
12696 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12697 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12698 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12699 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12700 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12701 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12702 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12703 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12704
12705 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12706 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12707 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12708 (gdb) bt
12709 #0 f () at t.c:2
12710 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12711 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12712 @end smallexample
12713
12714 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12715 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12716
12717 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12718 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12719 @set ARROW @click{}
12720 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12721 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12722 @end ifset
12723 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12724 @set ARROW ->
12725 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12726 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12727 @end ifclear
12728
12729 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12730 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12731 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12732
12733 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12734 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12735 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12736 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12737 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12738 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12739
12740 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12741 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12742 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12743 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12744 omitted.
12745
12746 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12747 entry may fail:
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 int v;
12751 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12752 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12753 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12754 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12755 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12756 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12757
12758 (gdb) bt
12759 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12760 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12761 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12762 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12763 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12764 @end smallexample
12765
12766 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12767 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12768 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12769 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12770 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12771
12772 @node Macros
12773 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12774
12775 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12776 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12777 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12778 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12779 where it was defined.
12780
12781 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12782 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12783 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12784 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12785
12786 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12787 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12788 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12789 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12790 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12791 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12792 see @ref{List}.
12793
12794 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12795 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12796 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12797
12798 @table @code
12799
12800 @kindex macro expand
12801 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12802 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12803 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12804 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12805 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12806 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12807 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12808 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12809 it can be any string of tokens.
12810
12811 @kindex macro exp1
12812 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12813 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12814 @cindex expand macro once
12815 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12816 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12817 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12818 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12819 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12820 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12821 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12822 can be any string of tokens.
12823
12824 @kindex info macro
12825 @cindex macro definition, showing
12826 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12827 @cindex macros, from debug info
12828 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12829 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12830 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12831 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12832 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12833 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12834
12835 @kindex info macros
12836 @item info macros @var{location}
12837 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12838 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12839 command-line where those definitions were established.
12840
12841 @kindex macro define
12842 @cindex user-defined macros
12843 @cindex defining macros interactively
12844 @cindex macros, user-defined
12845 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12846 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12847 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12848 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12849 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12850 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12851 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12852 @var{arglist}.
12853
12854 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12855 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12856 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12857 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12858 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12859
12860 @kindex macro undef
12861 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12862 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12863 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12864 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12865 in the program being debugged.
12866
12867 @kindex macro list
12868 @item macro list
12869 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12870 @end table
12871
12872 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12873 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12874 show our source files:
12875
12876 @smallexample
12877 $ cat sample.c
12878 #include <stdio.h>
12879 #include "sample.h"
12880
12881 #define M 42
12882 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12883
12884 main ()
12885 @{
12886 #define N 28
12887 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12888 #undef N
12889 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12890 #define N 1729
12891 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12892 @}
12893 $ cat sample.h
12894 #define Q <
12895 $
12896 @end smallexample
12897
12898 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12899 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12900 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12901 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12902 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12903 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12904 information.
12905
12906 @smallexample
12907 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12908 $
12909 @end smallexample
12910
12911 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12912
12913 @smallexample
12914 $ gdb -nw sample
12915 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12916 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12917 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12918 (@value{GDBP})
12919 @end smallexample
12920
12921 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12922 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12923 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12924
12925 @smallexample
12926 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12927 3
12928 4 #define M 42
12929 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12930 6
12931 7 main ()
12932 8 @{
12933 9 #define N 28
12934 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12935 11 #undef N
12936 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12937 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12938 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12939 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12940 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12941 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12942 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12943 #define Q <
12944 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12945 expands to: (42 + 1)
12946 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12947 expands to: once (M + 1)
12948 (@value{GDBP})
12949 @end smallexample
12950
12951 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12952 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12953 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12954 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12955
12956 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12957 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12958
12959 @smallexample
12960 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12961 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12962 (@value{GDBP}) run
12963 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12964
12965 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12966 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12967 (@value{GDBP})
12968 @end smallexample
12969
12970 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12971
12972 @smallexample
12973 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12974 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12975 #define N 28
12976 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12977 expands to: 28 < 42
12978 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12979 $1 = 1
12980 (@value{GDBP})
12981 @end smallexample
12982
12983 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12984 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12985 thereof) in force at each point:
12986
12987 @smallexample
12988 (@value{GDBP}) next
12989 Hello, world!
12990 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12991 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12992 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12993 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12994 (@value{GDBP}) next
12995 We're so creative.
12996 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12997 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12998 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12999 #define N 1729
13000 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13001 expands to: 1729 < 42
13002 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13003 $2 = 0
13004 (@value{GDBP})
13005 @end smallexample
13006
13007 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13008 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13009 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13010 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13011
13012 @smallexample
13013 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13014 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13015 -D__STDC__=1
13016 (@value{GDBP})
13017 @end smallexample
13018
13019
13020 @node Tracepoints
13021 @chapter Tracepoints
13022 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13023 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13024
13025 @cindex tracepoints
13026 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13027 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13028 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13029 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13030 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13031 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13032 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13033
13034 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13035 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13036 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13037 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13038 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13039 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13040 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13041 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13042 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13043 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13044 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13045
13046 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13047 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13048 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13049 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13050 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13051 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13052 Packets}.
13053
13054 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13055 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13056 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13057
13058 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13059
13060 @menu
13061 * Set Tracepoints::
13062 * Analyze Collected Data::
13063 * Tracepoint Variables::
13064 * Trace Files::
13065 @end menu
13066
13067 @node Set Tracepoints
13068 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13069
13070 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13071 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13072 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13073 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13074 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13075 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13076 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13077
13078 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13079 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13080 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13081 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13082 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13083 tracepoint was hit.
13084
13085 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13086 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13087 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13088 either.
13089
13090 @cindex fast tracepoints
13091 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13092 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13093 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13094
13095 @cindex static tracepoints
13096 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13097 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13098 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13099 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13100 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13101 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13102 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13103 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13104 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13105 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13106 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13107 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13108 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13109 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13110 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13111 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13112 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13113 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13114 static tracepoint marker.
13115
13116 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13117 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13118
13119 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13120 conditions and actions.
13121
13122 @menu
13123 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13124 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13125 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13126 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13127 * Trace State Variables::
13128 * Tracepoint Actions::
13129 * Listing Tracepoints::
13130 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13131 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13132 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13133 @end menu
13134
13135 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13136 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13137
13138 @table @code
13139 @cindex set tracepoint
13140 @kindex trace
13141 @item trace @var{location}
13142 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13143 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13144 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13145 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13146 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13147 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13148 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13149 in tracing}).
13150 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13151 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13152 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13153 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13154 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13155 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13156 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13157 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13158 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13159 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13160 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13161 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13162
13163 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13164
13165 @smallexample
13166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13167
13168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13169
13170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13171
13172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13173
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13175 @end smallexample
13176
13177 @noindent
13178 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13179
13180 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13181 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13182 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13183 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13184 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13185 information on tracepoint conditions.
13186
13187 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13188 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13189 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13190 @kindex ftrace
13191 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13192 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13193 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13194 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13195 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13196 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13197 message.
13198
13199 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13200 @code{trace}.
13201
13202 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13203 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13204 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13205 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13206 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13207 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13208 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13209 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13210
13211 @example
13212 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13213 @end example
13214
13215 @noindent
13216 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13217 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13218
13219 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13220 @cindex set static tracepoint
13221 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13222 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13223 @kindex strace
13224 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13225 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13226 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13227 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13228 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13229
13230 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13231 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13232 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13233 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13234 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13235 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13236 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13237 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13238 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13239 tracing engine:
13240
13241 @smallexample
13242 main ()
13243 @{
13244 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13245 @}
13246 @end smallexample
13247
13248 @noindent
13249 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13250 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13251
13252 @smallexample
13253 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13254 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13255 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13256 Data: "str %s"
13257 [etc...]
13258 @end smallexample
13259
13260 @noindent
13261 so you may probe the marker above with:
13262
13263 @smallexample
13264 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13265 @end smallexample
13266
13267 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13268 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13269 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13270 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13271 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13272 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13273 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13274 the @samp{Data:} field.
13275
13276 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13277 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13278 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13279
13280 @vindex $tpnum
13281 @cindex last tracepoint number
13282 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13283 @cindex tracepoint number
13284 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13285 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13286
13287 @kindex delete tracepoint
13288 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13289 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13290 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13291 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13292 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13293
13294 Examples:
13295
13296 @smallexample
13297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13298
13299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13300 @end smallexample
13301
13302 @noindent
13303 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13304 @end table
13305
13306 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13307 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13308
13309 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13310
13311 @table @code
13312 @kindex disable tracepoint
13313 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13314 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13315 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13316 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13317 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13318 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13319 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13320 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13321 next trace experiment.
13322
13323 @kindex enable tracepoint
13324 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13325 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13326 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13327 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13328 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13329 next time a trace experiment is run.
13330 @end table
13331
13332 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13333 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13334
13335 @table @code
13336 @kindex passcount
13337 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13338 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13339 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13340 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13341 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13342 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13343 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13344 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13345 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13346 user.
13347
13348 Examples:
13349
13350 @smallexample
13351 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13352 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13353
13354 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13355 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13356 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13360 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13361 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13362 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13363 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13364 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13365 @end smallexample
13366 @end table
13367
13368 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13369 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13370 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13371 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13372
13373 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13374 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13375 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13376 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13377 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13378 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13379 is true.
13380
13381 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13382 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13383 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13384 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13385 just as with breakpoints.
13386
13387 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13388 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13389 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13390 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13391 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13392 accesses, and so forth.
13393
13394 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13395 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13396 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13397 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13398 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13399 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13400 search through.
13401
13402 @smallexample
13403 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13404 @end smallexample
13405
13406 @node Trace State Variables
13407 @subsection Trace State Variables
13408 @cindex trace state variables
13409
13410 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13411 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13412 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13413 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13414 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13415 integers.
13416
13417 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13418 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13419 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13420 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13421
13422 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13423 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13424 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13425 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13426 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13427 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13428 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13429 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13430 variable with the same name.
13431
13432 @table @code
13433
13434 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13435 @kindex tvariable
13436 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13437 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13438 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13439 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13440 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13441 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13442 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13443 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13444 value. The default initial value is 0.
13445
13446 @item info tvariables
13447 @kindex info tvariables
13448 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13449 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13450 currently running.
13451
13452 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13453 @kindex delete tvariable
13454 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13455 are specified.
13456
13457 @end table
13458
13459 @node Tracepoint Actions
13460 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13461
13462 @table @code
13463 @kindex actions
13464 @cindex tracepoint actions
13465 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13466 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13467 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13468 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13469 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13470 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13471 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13472 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13473 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13474 @code{while-stepping}.
13475
13476 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13477 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13478 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13479
13480 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13481 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13482 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13483
13484 @smallexample
13485 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13486
13487 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13488
13489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13490 @end smallexample
13491
13492 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13493 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13494 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13495 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13496 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13497 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13498 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13499 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13500
13501 @smallexample
13502 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13503 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13504 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13505 > collect bar,baz
13506 > collect $regs
13507 > while-stepping 12
13508 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13509 > end
13510 end
13511 @end smallexample
13512
13513 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13514 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13515 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13516 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13517 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13518 special arguments are supported:
13519
13520 @table @code
13521 @item $regs
13522 Collect all registers.
13523
13524 @item $args
13525 Collect all function arguments.
13526
13527 @item $locals
13528 Collect all local variables.
13529
13530 @item $_ret
13531 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13532 of a backtrace.
13533
13534 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13535 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13536 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13537 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13538 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13539 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13540
13541 @item $_probe_argc
13542 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13543 tracepoint is located.
13544 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13545
13546 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13547 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13548 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13549 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13550
13551 @item $_sdata
13552 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13553 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13554 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13555 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13556 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13557 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13558 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13559 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13560 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13561
13562 @smallexample
13563 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13564 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13565 @end smallexample
13566
13567 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13568 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13569 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13570 @value{GDBN}.
13571 @end table
13572
13573 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13574 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13575 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13576
13577 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13578 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13579 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13580 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13581 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13582 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13583 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13584 @samp{mystr}.
13585
13586 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13587 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13588
13589 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13590 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13591 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13592 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13593 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13594 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13595 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13596 action were used.
13597
13598 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13599 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13600 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13601 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13602 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13603 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 > while-stepping 12
13607 > collect $regs, myglobal
13608 > end
13609 >
13610 @end smallexample
13611
13612 @noindent
13613 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13614 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13615 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13616 @code{stepping}.
13617
13618 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13619 @kindex set default-collect
13620 @cindex default collection action
13621 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13622 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13623 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13624 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13625 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13626 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13627
13628 @item show default-collect
13629 @kindex show default-collect
13630 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13631 tracepoint hit.
13632
13633 @end table
13634
13635 @node Listing Tracepoints
13636 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13637
13638 @table @code
13639 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13640 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13641 @cindex information about tracepoints
13642 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13643 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13644 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13645 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13646 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13647 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13648
13649 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13650 tracing:
13651
13652 @itemize @bullet
13653 @item
13654 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13655
13656 @item
13657 the state about installed on target of each location
13658 @end itemize
13659
13660 @smallexample
13661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13662 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13663 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13664 while-stepping 20
13665 collect globfoo, $regs
13666 end
13667 collect globfoo2
13668 end
13669 pass count 1200
13670 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13671 collect $eip
13672 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13673 installed on target
13674 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13675 installed on target
13676 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13677 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13678 not installed on target
13679 (@value{GDBP})
13680 @end smallexample
13681
13682 @noindent
13683 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13684 @end table
13685
13686 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13687 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13688
13689 @table @code
13690 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13691 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13692 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13693 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13694 program.
13695
13696 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13697
13698 @table @emph
13699 @item Count
13700 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13701 stable identifier.
13702 @item ID
13703 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13704 @item Enabled or Disabled
13705 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13706 that are not enabled.
13707 @item Address
13708 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13709 @item What
13710 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13711 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13712 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13713 will be left blank.
13714 @end table
13715
13716 @noindent
13717 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13718
13719 @table @emph
13720 @item Data
13721 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13722 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13723 marker call.
13724 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13725 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13726 @end table
13727
13728 @smallexample
13729 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13730 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13731 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13732 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13733 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13734 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13735 Data: str %s
13736 (@value{GDBP})
13737 @end smallexample
13738 @end table
13739
13740 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13741 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13742
13743 @table @code
13744 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13745 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13746 @cindex collected data discarded
13747 @item tstart
13748 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13749 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13750 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13751 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13752 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13753 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13754 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13755 information, and so forth.
13756
13757 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13758 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13759 @item tstop
13760 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13761 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13762 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13763 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13764 needs to be stopped quickly.
13765
13766 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13767 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13768 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13769
13770 @kindex tstatus
13771 @cindex status of trace data collection
13772 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13773 @item tstatus
13774 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13775 collection.
13776 @end table
13777
13778 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13779
13780 @smallexample
13781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13783 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13784 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13785 > while-stepping 11
13786 > collect $regs
13787 > end
13788 > end
13789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13790 [time passes @dots{}]
13791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13792 @end smallexample
13793
13794 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13795 @cindex disconnected tracing
13796 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13797 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13798 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13799 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13800 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13801 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13802 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13803 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13804
13805 @table @code
13806 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13807 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13808 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13809 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13810 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13811 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13812 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13813 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13814
13815 @item show disconnected-tracing
13816 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13817 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13818
13819 @end table
13820
13821 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13822 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13823 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13824 it will continue after reconnection.
13825
13826 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13827 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13828 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13829 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13830 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13831 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13832 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13833 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13834 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13835 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13836
13837 @cindex circular trace buffer
13838 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13839 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13840 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13841 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13842 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13843 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13844 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13845 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13846 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13847 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13848 the next run.
13849
13850 @table @code
13851 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13852 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13853 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13854 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13855 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13856 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13857 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13858
13859 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13860 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13861 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13862 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13863 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13864 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13865
13866 @end table
13867
13868 @table @code
13869 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13870 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13871 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13872 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13873 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13874 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13875 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13876 likes. This is also the default.
13877
13878 @item show trace-buffer-size
13879 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13880 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13881 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13882 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13883 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13884 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13885 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13886 @end table
13887
13888 @table @code
13889 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13890 @kindex set trace-user
13891
13892 @item show trace-user
13893 @kindex show trace-user
13894
13895 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13896 @kindex set trace-notes
13897 Set the trace run's notes.
13898
13899 @item show trace-notes
13900 @kindex show trace-notes
13901 Show the trace run's notes.
13902
13903 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13904 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13905 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13906 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13907 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13908
13909 @item show trace-stop-notes
13910 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13911 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13912
13913 @end table
13914
13915 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13916 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13917
13918 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13919 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13920 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13921 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13922 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13923 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13924 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13925 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13926 mentioned here.
13927
13928 @itemize @bullet
13929
13930 @item
13931 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13932 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13933 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13934 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13935 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13936 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13937 cannot be collected either.
13938
13939 @item
13940 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13941 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13942 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13943 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13944 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13945 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13946 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13947 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13948 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13949 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13950
13951 @item
13952 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13953 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13954 in a misleading way.
13955
13956 @item
13957 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13958 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13959 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13960 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13961 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13962 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13963 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13964 by @code{ptr}.
13965
13966 @item
13967 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13968 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13969 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13970 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13971 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13972 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13973 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13974 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13975 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13976 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13977 invalid address.
13978
13979 @item
13980 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13981 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13982 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13983 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13984 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13985 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13986 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13987 it to zero.
13988
13989 @end itemize
13990
13991 @node Analyze Collected Data
13992 @section Using the Collected Data
13993
13994 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13995 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13996 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13997 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13998 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13999 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14000 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14001 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14002 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14003 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14004 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14005 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14006 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14007 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14008 the buffer will fail.
14009
14010 @menu
14011 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14012 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14013 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14014 @end menu
14015
14016 @node tfind
14017 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14018
14019 @kindex tfind
14020 @cindex select trace snapshot
14021 @cindex find trace snapshot
14022 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14023 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14024 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14025 snapshot is selected.
14026
14027 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14028
14029 @table @code
14030 @item tfind start
14031 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14032 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14033
14034 @item tfind none
14035 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14036
14037 @item tfind end
14038 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14039
14040 @item tfind
14041 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14042 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14043
14044 @item tfind -
14045 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14046 retracing earlier steps.
14047
14048 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14049 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14050 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14051 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14052 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14053
14054 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14055 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14056 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14057 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14058 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14059
14060 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14061 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14062 addresses (exclusive).
14063
14064 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14065 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14066 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14067
14068 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14069 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14070 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14071 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14072 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14073 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14074 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14075 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14076 @end table
14077
14078 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14079 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14080 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14081 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14082 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14083 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14084 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14085 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14086 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14087 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14088 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14089 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14090 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14091 tracepoint as the current one.
14092
14093 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14094 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14095 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14096 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14097 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14098
14099 @smallexample
14100 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14102 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14103 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14104 > tfind
14105 > end
14106
14107 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14108 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14109 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14110 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14111 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14112 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14113 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14114 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14115 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14116 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14117 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14118 @end smallexample
14119
14120 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14121 the buffer:
14122
14123 @smallexample
14124 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14125 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14126 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14127 > tfind line
14128 > end
14129
14130 Frame 0, X = 1
14131 Frame 7, X = 2
14132 Frame 13, X = 255
14133 @end smallexample
14134
14135 @node tdump
14136 @subsection @code{tdump}
14137 @kindex tdump
14138 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14139 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14140
14141 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14142 the current trace snapshot.
14143
14144 @smallexample
14145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14146 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14147 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14148 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14149 > end
14150
14151 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14152
14153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14154 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14155 at gdb_test.c:444
14156 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14157
14158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14159 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14160 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14161 d1 0x18 24
14162 d2 0x80 128
14163 d3 0x33 51
14164 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14165 d5 0x22 34
14166 d6 0xe0 224
14167 d7 0x380035 3670069
14168 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14169 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14170 a2 0x100 256
14171 a3 0x322000 3284992
14172 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14173 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14174 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14175 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14176 ps 0x0 0
14177 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14178 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14179 fpstatus 0x0 0
14180 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14181 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14182 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14183 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14184 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14185 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14186 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14187 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14188 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14189
14190 (@value{GDBP})
14191 @end smallexample
14192
14193 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14194 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14195 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14196 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14197
14198 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14199 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14200 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14201 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14202 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14203 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14204 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14205 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14206 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14207 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14208
14209 @node save tracepoints
14210 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14211 @kindex save tracepoints
14212 @kindex save-tracepoints
14213 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14214
14215 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14216 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14217 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14218 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14219 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14220 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14221
14222 @node Tracepoint Variables
14223 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14224 @cindex tracepoint variables
14225 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14226
14227 @table @code
14228 @vindex $trace_frame
14229 @item (int) $trace_frame
14230 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14231 snapshot is selected.
14232
14233 @vindex $tracepoint
14234 @item (int) $tracepoint
14235 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14236
14237 @vindex $trace_line
14238 @item (int) $trace_line
14239 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14240
14241 @vindex $trace_file
14242 @item (char []) $trace_file
14243 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14244
14245 @vindex $trace_func
14246 @item (char []) $trace_func
14247 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14248 @end table
14249
14250 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14251 use @code{output} instead.
14252
14253 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14254 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14255 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14256 which are managed by the target.
14257
14258 @smallexample
14259 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14260
14261 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14262 > output $trace_file
14263 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14264 > tfind
14265 > end
14266 @end smallexample
14267
14268 @node Trace Files
14269 @section Using Trace Files
14270 @cindex trace files
14271
14272 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14273 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14274 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14275 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14276 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14277
14278 @table @code
14279
14280 @kindex tsave
14281 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14282 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14283 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14284 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14285 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14286 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14287 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14288 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14289 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14290 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14291 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14292 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14293 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14294 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14295 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14296
14297 @kindex target tfile
14298 @kindex tfile
14299 @kindex target ctf
14300 @kindex ctf
14301 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14302 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14303 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14304 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14305 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14306 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14307 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14308 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14309 the host.
14310
14311 @smallexample
14312 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14313 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14314 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14315 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14316 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14317 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14318 i = 0
14319 a = 0
14320 b = 1 '\001'
14321 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14322 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14323 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14324 $1 = 1
14325 @end smallexample
14326
14327 @end table
14328
14329 @node Overlays
14330 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14331 @cindex overlays
14332
14333 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14334 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14335 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14336 use overlays.
14337
14338 @menu
14339 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14340 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14341 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14342 mapped by asking the inferior.
14343 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14344 @end menu
14345
14346 @node How Overlays Work
14347 @section How Overlays Work
14348 @cindex mapped overlays
14349 @cindex unmapped overlays
14350 @cindex load address, overlay's
14351 @cindex mapped address
14352 @cindex overlay area
14353
14354 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14355 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14356 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14357 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14358 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14359
14360 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14361 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14362 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14363 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14364 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14365 largest overlay as well.
14366
14367 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14368 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14369 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14370 there.
14371
14372 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14373 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14374 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14375
14376 @smallexample
14377 @group
14378 Data Instruction Larger
14379 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14380 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14381 | | | | | |
14382 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14383 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14384 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14385 | and heap | | | | | |
14386 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14387 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14388 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14389 | | | | | |
14390 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14391 address | | | | | |
14392 | overlay | <-' | | |
14393 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14394 | | <---. | | load address
14395 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14396 | | | |
14397 +-----------+ | |
14398 +-----------+
14399 | |
14400 +-----------+
14401
14402 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14403 @end group
14404 @end smallexample
14405
14406 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14407 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14408 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14409 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14410 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14411 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14412 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14413 program and the overlay area.
14414
14415 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14416 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14417 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14418 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14419 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14420 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14421 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14422
14423 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14424 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14425 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14426
14427 @itemize @bullet
14428
14429 @item
14430 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14431 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14432 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14433 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14434
14435 @item
14436 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14437 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14438 your program's performance.
14439
14440 @item
14441 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14442 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14443 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14444 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14445 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14446 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14447 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14448
14449 @item
14450 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14451 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14452 instruction and data spaces.
14453
14454 @end itemize
14455
14456 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14457 improved in many ways:
14458
14459 @itemize @bullet
14460
14461 @item
14462 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14463 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14464 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14465 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14466 area in the usual way.
14467
14468 @item
14469 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14470 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14471
14472 @item
14473 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14474 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14475 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14476 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14477 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14478 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14479 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14480
14481 @end itemize
14482
14483
14484 @node Overlay Commands
14485 @section Overlay Commands
14486
14487 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14488 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14489 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14490 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14491 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14492 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14493
14494 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14495 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14496
14497 @table @code
14498 @item overlay off
14499 @kindex overlay
14500 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14501 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14502 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14503 overlay support is disabled.
14504
14505 @item overlay manual
14506 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14507 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14508 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14509 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14510 commands described below.
14511
14512 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14513 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14514 @cindex map an overlay
14515 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14516 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14517 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14518 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14519 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14520 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14521
14522 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14523 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14524 @cindex unmap an overlay
14525 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14526 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14527 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14528 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14529
14530 @item overlay auto
14531 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14532 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14533 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14534 Overlay Debugging}.
14535
14536 @item overlay load-target
14537 @itemx overlay load
14538 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14539 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14540 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14541 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14542 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14543 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14544
14545 @item overlay list-overlays
14546 @itemx overlay list
14547 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14548 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14549 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14550
14551 @end table
14552
14553 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14554 of the function the address falls in:
14555
14556 @smallexample
14557 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14558 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14559 @end smallexample
14560 @noindent
14561 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14562 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14563 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14564 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14565
14566 @smallexample
14567 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14568 No sections are mapped.
14569 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14570 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14571 @end smallexample
14572 @noindent
14573 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14574 name normally:
14575
14576 @smallexample
14577 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14578 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14579 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14580 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14581 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14582 @end smallexample
14583
14584 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14585 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14586 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14587 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14588 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14589
14590 @itemize @bullet
14591 @item
14592 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14593 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14594 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14595 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14596 @item
14597 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14598 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14599 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14600 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14601 breakpoints properly.
14602 @end itemize
14603
14604
14605 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14606 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14607 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14608
14609 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14610 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14611 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14612 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14613 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14614 current state of the overlays.
14615
14616 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14617 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14618
14619 @table @asis
14620
14621 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14622 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14623
14624 @smallexample
14625 struct
14626 @{
14627 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14628 unsigned long vma;
14629
14630 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14631 unsigned long size;
14632
14633 /* The overlay's load address. */
14634 unsigned long lma;
14635
14636 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14637 zero otherwise. */
14638 unsigned long mapped;
14639 @}
14640 @end smallexample
14641
14642 @item @code{_novlys}:
14643 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14644 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14645
14646 @end table
14647
14648 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14649 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14650 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14651 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14652 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14653 currently mapped.
14654
14655 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14656 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14657 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14658 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14659 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14660 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14661 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14662 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14663 are not being executed.
14664
14665 @node Overlay Sample Program
14666 @section Overlay Sample Program
14667 @cindex overlay example program
14668
14669 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14670 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14671 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14672 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14673 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14674 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14675 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14676
14677 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14678 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14679 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14680 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14681
14682 @table @file
14683 @item overlays.c
14684 The main program file.
14685 @item ovlymgr.c
14686 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14687 @item foo.c
14688 @itemx bar.c
14689 @itemx baz.c
14690 @itemx grbx.c
14691 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14692 @item d10v.ld
14693 @itemx m32r.ld
14694 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14695 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14696 @end table
14697
14698 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14699 cross-compiler like this:
14700
14701 @smallexample
14702 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14703 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14704 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14705 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14706 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14707 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14708 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14709 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14710 @end smallexample
14711
14712 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14713 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14714 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14715
14716
14717 @node Languages
14718 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14719 @cindex languages
14720
14721 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14722 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14723 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14724 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14725 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14726 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14727
14728 @cindex working language
14729 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14730 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14731 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14732 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14733 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14734 language}.
14735
14736 @menu
14737 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14738 * Show:: Displaying the language
14739 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14740 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14741 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14742 @end menu
14743
14744 @node Setting
14745 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14746
14747 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14748 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14749 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14750 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14751 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14752 are printed, etc.
14753
14754 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14755 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14756 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14757 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14758 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14759 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14760 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14761 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14762 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14763 Displaying the Language}.
14764
14765 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14766 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14767 another language. In that case, make the
14768 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14769 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14770 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14771
14772 @menu
14773 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14774 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14775 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14776 @end menu
14777
14778 @node Filenames
14779 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14780
14781 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14782 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14783
14784 @table @file
14785 @item .ada
14786 @itemx .ads
14787 @itemx .adb
14788 @itemx .a
14789 Ada source file.
14790
14791 @item .c
14792 C source file
14793
14794 @item .C
14795 @itemx .cc
14796 @itemx .cp
14797 @itemx .cpp
14798 @itemx .cxx
14799 @itemx .c++
14800 C@t{++} source file
14801
14802 @item .d
14803 D source file
14804
14805 @item .m
14806 Objective-C source file
14807
14808 @item .f
14809 @itemx .F
14810 Fortran source file
14811
14812 @item .mod
14813 Modula-2 source file
14814
14815 @item .s
14816 @itemx .S
14817 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14818 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14819 @end table
14820
14821 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14822 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14823
14824 @node Manually
14825 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14826
14827 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14828 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14829 your program.
14830
14831 @kindex set language
14832 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14833 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14834 a language, such as
14835 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14836 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14837
14838 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14839 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14840 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14841 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14842 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14843 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14844 command such as:
14845
14846 @smallexample
14847 print a = b + c
14848 @end smallexample
14849
14850 @noindent
14851 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14852 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14853 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14854 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14855
14856 @node Automatically
14857 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14858
14859 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14860 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14861 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14862 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14863 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14864 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14865 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14866 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14867 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14868
14869 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14870 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14871 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14872 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14873 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14874
14875 @node Show
14876 @section Displaying the Language
14877
14878 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14879 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14880
14881 @table @code
14882 @item show language
14883 @anchor{show language}
14884 @kindex show language
14885 Display the current working language. This is the
14886 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14887 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14888
14889 @item info frame
14890 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14891 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14892 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14893 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14894 information listed here.
14895
14896 @item info source
14897 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14898 Display the source language of this source file.
14899 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14900 information listed here.
14901 @end table
14902
14903 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14904 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14905 with a language explicitly:
14906
14907 @table @code
14908 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14909 @kindex set extension-language
14910 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14911 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14912
14913 @item info extensions
14914 @kindex info extensions
14915 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14916 @end table
14917
14918 @node Checks
14919 @section Type and Range Checking
14920
14921 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14922 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14923 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14924 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14925 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14926 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14927 errors when your program is running.
14928
14929 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14930 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14931 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14932 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14933
14934 @menu
14935 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14936 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14937 @end menu
14938
14939 @cindex type checking
14940 @cindex checks, type
14941 @node Type Checking
14942 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14943
14944 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14945 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14946 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14947 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14948
14949 @smallexample
14950 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14951
14952 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14953 $1 = 2
14954 @exdent but
14955 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14956 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14957 @end smallexample
14958
14959 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14960 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14961
14962 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14963 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14964 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14965 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14966 expressions like the second example above.
14967
14968 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14969 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14970 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14971 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14972 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14973 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14974
14975 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14976
14977 @kindex set check type
14978 @kindex show check type
14979 @table @code
14980 @item set check type on
14981 @itemx set check type off
14982 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14983 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14984 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14985
14986 @item show check type
14987 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14988 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @cindex range checking
14992 @cindex checks, range
14993 @node Range Checking
14994 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14995
14996 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14997 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14998 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14999 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15000 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15001
15002 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15003 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15004 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15005 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15006
15007 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15008 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15009 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15010 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15011 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15012 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15013
15014 @smallexample
15015 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15016 @end smallexample
15017
15018 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15019 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15020 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15021
15022 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15023
15024 @kindex set check range
15025 @kindex show check range
15026 @table @code
15027 @item set check range auto
15028 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15029 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15030 each language.
15031
15032 @item set check range on
15033 @itemx set check range off
15034 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15035 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15036 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15037 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15038
15039 @item set check range warn
15040 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15041 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15042 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15043 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15044 systems).
15045
15046 @item show range
15047 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15048 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15049 @end table
15050
15051 @node Supported Languages
15052 @section Supported Languages
15053
15054 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15055 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15056 @c This is false ...
15057 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15058 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15059 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15060 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15061 language.
15062
15063 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15064 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15065 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15066 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15067 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15068 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15069 language reference or tutorial.
15070
15071 @menu
15072 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15073 * D:: D
15074 * Go:: Go
15075 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15076 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15077 * Fortran:: Fortran
15078 * Pascal:: Pascal
15079 * Rust:: Rust
15080 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15081 * Ada:: Ada
15082 @end menu
15083
15084 @node C
15085 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15086
15087 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15088 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15089
15090 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15091 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15092 together.
15093
15094 @cindex C@t{++}
15095 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15096 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15097 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15098 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15099 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15100 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15101 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15102
15103 @menu
15104 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15105 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15106 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15107 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15108 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15109 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15110 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15111 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15112 @end menu
15113
15114 @node C Operators
15115 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15116
15117 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15118
15119 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15120 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15121 often defined on groups of types.
15122
15123 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15124
15125 @itemize @bullet
15126
15127 @item
15128 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15129 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15130
15131 @item
15132 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15133 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15134
15135 @item
15136 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15137
15138 @item
15139 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15140
15141 @end itemize
15142
15143 @noindent
15144 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15145 in order of increasing precedence:
15146
15147 @table @code
15148 @item ,
15149 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15150 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15151 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15152
15153 @item =
15154 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15155 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15156
15157 @item @var{op}=
15158 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15159 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15160 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15161 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15162 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15163
15164 @item ?:
15165 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15166 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15167 should be of an integral type.
15168
15169 @item ||
15170 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15171
15172 @item &&
15173 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15174
15175 @item |
15176 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15177
15178 @item ^
15179 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15180
15181 @item &
15182 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15183
15184 @item ==@r{, }!=
15185 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15186 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15187
15188 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15189 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15190 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15191 and non-zero for true.
15192
15193 @item <<@r{, }>>
15194 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15195
15196 @item @@
15197 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15198
15199 @item +@r{, }-
15200 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15201 pointer types.
15202
15203 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15204 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15205 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15206 integral types.
15207
15208 @item ++@r{, }--
15209 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15210 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15211 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15212 operation takes place.
15213
15214 @item *
15215 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15216 @code{++}.
15217
15218 @item &
15219 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15220
15221 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15222 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15223 to examine the address
15224 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15225 stored.
15226
15227 @item -
15228 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15229 precedence as @code{++}.
15230
15231 @item !
15232 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15233 @code{++}.
15234
15235 @item ~
15236 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15237 @code{++}.
15238
15239
15240 @item .@r{, }->
15241 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15242 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15243 pointer based on the stored type information.
15244 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15245
15246 @item .*@r{, }->*
15247 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15248
15249 @item []
15250 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15251 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15252
15253 @item ()
15254 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15255
15256 @item ::
15257 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15258 and @code{class} types.
15259
15260 @item ::
15261 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15262 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15263 above.
15264 @end table
15265
15266 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15267 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15268 predefined meaning.
15269
15270 @node C Constants
15271 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15272
15273 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15274
15275 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15276 following ways:
15277
15278 @itemize @bullet
15279 @item
15280 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15281 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15282 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15283 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15284 @code{long} value.
15285
15286 @item
15287 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15288 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15289 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15290 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15291 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15292 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15293 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15294 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15295 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15296 constant.
15297
15298 @item
15299 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15300 integral equivalents.
15301
15302 @item
15303 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15304 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15305 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15306 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15307 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15308 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15309 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15310 @samp{\n} for newline.
15311
15312 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15313 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15314 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15315 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15316
15317 @item
15318 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15319 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15320 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15321 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15322 characters.
15323
15324 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15325 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15326 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15327
15328 @item
15329 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15330 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15331
15332 @item
15333 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15334 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15335 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15336 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15337 @end itemize
15338
15339 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15340 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15341
15342 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15343 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15344
15345 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15346 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15347 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15348 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15349 @quotation
15350 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15351 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15352 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15353 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15354 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15355 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15356 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15357 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15358 @end quotation
15359
15360 @enumerate
15361
15362 @cindex member functions
15363 @item
15364 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15365
15366 @smallexample
15367 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15368 @end smallexample
15369
15370 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15371 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15372 @item
15373 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15374 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15375 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15376 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15377 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15378
15379 @cindex call overloaded functions
15380 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15381 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15382 @item
15383 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15384 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15385 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15386 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15387 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15388 default arguments.
15389
15390 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15391 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15392 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15393 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15394 number of function arguments.
15395
15396 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15397 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15398 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15399
15400 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15401 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15402 @smallexample
15403 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15404 @end smallexample
15405
15406 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15407 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15408
15409 @cindex reference declarations
15410 @item
15411 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15412 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15413 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15414
15415 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15416 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15417 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15418 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15419 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15420
15421 @item
15422 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15423 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15424 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15425 necessary, for example in an expression like
15426 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15427 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15428 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15429
15430 @item
15431 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15432 specification.
15433 @end enumerate
15434
15435 @node C Defaults
15436 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15437
15438 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15439
15440 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15441 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15442 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15443 selects the working language.
15444
15445 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15446 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15447 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15448 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15449 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15450 for further details.
15451
15452 @node C Checks
15453 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15454
15455 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15456
15457 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15458 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15459 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15460 constants to pointers.
15461
15462 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15463 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15464 that is not itself an array.
15465
15466 @node Debugging C
15467 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15468
15469 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15470 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15471 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15472 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15473
15474 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15475 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15476 ,Expressions}.
15477
15478 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15479 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15480
15481 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15482
15483 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15484 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15485
15486 @table @code
15487 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15488 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15489 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15490 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15491 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15492 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15493
15494 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15495 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15496 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15497 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15498 classes.
15499 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15500
15501 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15502 @item catch throw
15503 @itemx catch rethrow
15504 @itemx catch catch
15505 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15506 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15507
15508 @cindex inheritance
15509 @item ptype @var{typename}
15510 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15511 @var{typename}.
15512 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15513
15514 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15515 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15516 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15517 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15518 multiple inheritance is in use.
15519
15520 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15521 @item demangle @var{name}
15522 Demangle @var{name}.
15523 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15524
15525 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15526 @item set print demangle
15527 @itemx show print demangle
15528 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15529 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15530 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15531 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15532 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15533
15534 @item set print object
15535 @itemx show print object
15536 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15537 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15538
15539 @item set print vtbl
15540 @itemx show print vtbl
15541 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15542 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15543 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15544 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15545
15546 @kindex set overload-resolution
15547 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15548 @item set overload-resolution on
15549 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15550 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15551 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15552 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15553 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15554 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15555
15556 @item set overload-resolution off
15557 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15558 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15559 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15560 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15561 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15562 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15563 argument types.
15564
15565 @kindex show overload-resolution
15566 @item show overload-resolution
15567 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15568
15569 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15570 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15571 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15572 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15573 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15574 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15575 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15576
15577 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15578
15579 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15580 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15581 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15582 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15583 for more detail.
15584
15585 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15586 function that returns a std::string:
15587
15588 @smallexample
15589 std::string function(int);
15590 @end smallexample
15591
15592 @noindent
15593 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15594 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15595
15596 @smallexample
15597 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15598 @end smallexample
15599
15600 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15601 tag. For example:
15602
15603 @smallexample
15604 (gdb) b function(int)
15605 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15606 (gdb) info breakpoints
15607 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15608 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15609 at main.cc:10
15610 @end smallexample
15611
15612 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15613 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15614 name, like:
15615
15616 @smallexample
15617 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15618 @end smallexample
15619 @end table
15620
15621 @node Decimal Floating Point
15622 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15623 @cindex decimal floating point format
15624
15625 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15626 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15627 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15628 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15629
15630 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15631 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15632 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15633 configured target.
15634
15635 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15636 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15637 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15638
15639 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15640 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15641 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15642
15643 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15644 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15645 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15646
15647 @node D
15648 @subsection D
15649
15650 @cindex D
15651 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15652 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15653 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15654
15655 @node Go
15656 @subsection Go
15657
15658 @cindex Go (programming language)
15659 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15660 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15661
15662 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15663
15664 @table @code
15665 @cindex current Go package
15666 @item The current Go package
15667 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15668 specifying global variables and functions.
15669
15670 For example, given the program:
15671
15672 @example
15673 package main
15674 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15675 func main () @{
15676 // ...
15677 @}
15678 @end example
15679
15680 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15681
15682 @example
15683 (gdb) p myglob
15684 (gdb) p main.myglob
15685 @end example
15686
15687 @cindex builtin Go types
15688 @item Builtin Go types
15689 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15690 as a string.
15691
15692 @cindex builtin Go functions
15693 @item Builtin Go functions
15694 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15695 function and handles it internally.
15696
15697 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15698 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15699 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15700 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15701 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15702 @end table
15703
15704 @node Objective-C
15705 @subsection Objective-C
15706
15707 @cindex Objective-C
15708 This section provides information about some commands and command
15709 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15710 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15711 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15712
15713 @menu
15714 * Method Names in Commands::
15715 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15716 @end menu
15717
15718 @node Method Names in Commands
15719 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15720
15721 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15722 names as line specifications:
15723
15724 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15725 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15726 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15727 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15728 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15729 @itemize
15730 @item @code{clear}
15731 @item @code{break}
15732 @item @code{info line}
15733 @item @code{jump}
15734 @item @code{list}
15735 @end itemize
15736
15737 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15738
15739 @smallexample
15740 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15741 @end smallexample
15742
15743 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15744 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15745 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15746 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15747 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15748 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15749 debugged, enter:
15750
15751 @smallexample
15752 break -[Fruit create]
15753 @end smallexample
15754
15755 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15756 enter:
15757
15758 @smallexample
15759 list +[NSText initialize]
15760 @end smallexample
15761
15762 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15763 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15764 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15765 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15766
15767 @smallexample
15768 break create
15769 @end smallexample
15770
15771 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15772 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15773 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15774 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15775 none apply.
15776
15777 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15778 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15779
15780 @smallexample
15781 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15782 @end smallexample
15783
15784 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15785 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15786 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15787 @kindex print-object
15788 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15789
15790 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15791
15792 @smallexample
15793 print -[@var{object} hash]
15794 @end smallexample
15795
15796 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15797 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15798 @noindent
15799 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15800 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15801 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15802 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15803 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15804 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15805
15806 @node OpenCL C
15807 @subsection OpenCL C
15808
15809 @cindex OpenCL C
15810 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15811
15812 @menu
15813 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15814 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15815 * OpenCL C Operators::
15816 @end menu
15817
15818 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15819 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15820
15821 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15822 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15823 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15824 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15825 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15826
15827 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15828 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15829
15830 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15831 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15832 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15833 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15834
15835 @node OpenCL C Operators
15836 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15837
15838 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15839 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15840 vector data types.
15841
15842 @node Fortran
15843 @subsection Fortran
15844 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15845
15846 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15847 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15848
15849 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15850 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15851 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15852 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15853 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15854 underscore.
15855
15856 @menu
15857 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15858 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15859 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15860 @end menu
15861
15862 @node Fortran Operators
15863 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15864
15865 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15866
15867 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15868 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15869 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @item **
15873 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15874 of the second one.
15875
15876 @item :
15877 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15878 represent a section of array.
15879
15880 @item %
15881 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15882 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15883 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15884 union type.
15885 @end table
15886
15887 @node Fortran Defaults
15888 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15889
15890 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15891
15892 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15893 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15894 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15895 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15896
15897 @node Special Fortran Commands
15898 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15899
15900 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15901
15902 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15903 such as displaying common blocks.
15904
15905 @table @code
15906 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15907 @kindex info common
15908 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15909 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15910 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15911 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15912 printed.
15913 @end table
15914
15915 @node Pascal
15916 @subsection Pascal
15917
15918 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15919 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15920 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15921 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15922 syntax.
15923
15924 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15925 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15926 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15927
15928 @node Rust
15929 @subsection Rust
15930
15931 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15932 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15933 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15934 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15935
15936 @itemize @bullet
15937 @item
15938 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15939 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15940 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15941
15942 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15943 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15944 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15945 @samp{B}.
15946
15947 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15948 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15949
15950 @item
15951 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15952 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15953 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15954 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15955 @samp{K::x::y}.
15956
15957 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15958 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15959 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15960 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15961 scope.
15962
15963 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15964 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15965
15966 @item
15967 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15968 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15969
15970 @item
15971 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15972
15973 @item
15974 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15975 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15976 never be destroyed.
15977
15978 @item
15979 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15980 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15981 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15982
15983 @item
15984 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15985 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15986 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15987 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15988 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15989 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15990 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15991 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15992
15993 @item
15994 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15995 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15996 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15997 @itemize @bullet
15998
15999 @item
16000 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16001
16002 @item
16003 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16004
16005 @item
16006 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16007 type names.
16008
16009 @item
16010 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16011
16012 @item
16013 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16014 available in the crate.
16015 @end itemize
16016 @end itemize
16017
16018 @node Modula-2
16019 @subsection Modula-2
16020
16021 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16022
16023 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16024 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16025 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16026 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16027 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16028 table.
16029
16030 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16031 @menu
16032 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16033 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16034 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16035 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16036 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16037 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16038 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16039 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16040 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16041 @end menu
16042
16043 @node M2 Operators
16044 @subsubsection Operators
16045 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16046
16047 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16048 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16049 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16050 following definitions hold:
16051
16052 @itemize @bullet
16053
16054 @item
16055 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16056 their subranges.
16057
16058 @item
16059 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16060
16061 @item
16062 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16063
16064 @item
16065 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16066 @var{type}}.
16067
16068 @item
16069 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16070
16071 @item
16072 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16073
16074 @item
16075 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16076 @end itemize
16077
16078 @noindent
16079 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16080 increasing precedence:
16081
16082 @table @code
16083 @item ,
16084 Function argument or array index separator.
16085
16086 @item :=
16087 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16088 @var{value}.
16089
16090 @item <@r{, }>
16091 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16092 types.
16093
16094 @item <=@r{, }>=
16095 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16096 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16097 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16098
16099 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16100 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16101 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16102 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16103 comment character.
16104
16105 @item IN
16106 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16107 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16108
16109 @item OR
16110 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16111
16112 @item AND@r{, }&
16113 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16114
16115 @item @@
16116 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16117
16118 @item +@r{, }-
16119 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16120 and difference on set types.
16121
16122 @item *
16123 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16124 on set types.
16125
16126 @item /
16127 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16128 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16129
16130 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16131 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16132 precedence as @code{*}.
16133
16134 @item -
16135 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16136
16137 @item ^
16138 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16139
16140 @item NOT
16141 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16142 @code{^}.
16143
16144 @item .
16145 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16146 precedence as @code{^}.
16147
16148 @item []
16149 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16150
16151 @item ()
16152 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16153 as @code{^}.
16154
16155 @item ::@r{, }.
16156 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16157 @end table
16158
16159 @quotation
16160 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16161 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16162 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16163 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16164 @end quotation
16165
16166
16167 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16168 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16169 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16170
16171 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16172 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16173
16174 @table @var
16175
16176 @item a
16177 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16178
16179 @item c
16180 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16181
16182 @item i
16183 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16184
16185 @item m
16186 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16187 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16188 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16189
16190 @item n
16191 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16192
16193 @item r
16194 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16195
16196 @item t
16197 represents a type.
16198
16199 @item v
16200 represents a variable.
16201
16202 @item x
16203 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16204 explanation of the function for details.
16205 @end table
16206
16207 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16208
16209 @table @code
16210 @item ABS(@var{n})
16211 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16212
16213 @item CAP(@var{c})
16214 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16215 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16216
16217 @item CHR(@var{i})
16218 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16219
16220 @item DEC(@var{v})
16221 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16222
16223 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16224 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16225 new value.
16226
16227 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16228 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16229 set.
16230
16231 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16232 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16233
16234 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16235 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16236
16237 @item INC(@var{v})
16238 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16239
16240 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16241 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16242 new value.
16243
16244 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16245 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16246 there. Returns the new set.
16247
16248 @item MAX(@var{t})
16249 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16250
16251 @item MIN(@var{t})
16252 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16253
16254 @item ODD(@var{i})
16255 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16256
16257 @item ORD(@var{x})
16258 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16259 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16260 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16261 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16262
16263 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16264 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16265 variable or a type.
16266
16267 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16268 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16269
16270 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16271 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16272 variable or a type.
16273
16274 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16275 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16276 @end table
16277
16278 @quotation
16279 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16280 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16281 an error.
16282 @end quotation
16283
16284 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16285 @node M2 Constants
16286 @subsubsection Constants
16287
16288 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16289 ways:
16290
16291 @itemize @bullet
16292
16293 @item
16294 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16295 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16296 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16297 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16298
16299 @item
16300 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16301 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16302 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16303 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16304 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16305 digits.
16306
16307 @item
16308 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16309 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16310 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16311 followed by a @samp{C}.
16312
16313 @item
16314 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16315 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16316 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16317 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16318 sequences.
16319
16320 @item
16321 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16322
16323 @item
16324 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16325 @code{FALSE}.
16326
16327 @item
16328 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16329
16330 @item
16331 Set constants are not yet supported.
16332 @end itemize
16333
16334 @node M2 Types
16335 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16336 @cindex Modula-2 types
16337
16338 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16339 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16340 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16341 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16342 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16343 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16344
16345 The first example contains the following section of code:
16346
16347 @smallexample
16348 VAR
16349 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16350 r: [20..40] ;
16351 @end smallexample
16352
16353 @noindent
16354 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16355 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16356
16357 @smallexample
16358 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16359 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16360 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16361 SET OF CHAR
16362 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16363 21
16364 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16365 [20..40]
16366 @end smallexample
16367
16368 @noindent
16369 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16370
16371 @smallexample
16372 VAR
16373 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16374 @end smallexample
16375
16376 @noindent
16377 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16378
16379 @smallexample
16380 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16381 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16382 @end smallexample
16383
16384 @noindent
16385 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16386 expressions using the debugger.
16387
16388 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16389 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16390
16391 @smallexample
16392 VAR
16393 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16394 @end smallexample
16395
16396 @smallexample
16397 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16398 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16399 @end smallexample
16400
16401 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16402 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16403 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16404 above.
16405
16406 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16407
16408 @smallexample
16409 TYPE
16410 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16411 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16412 VAR
16413 s: t ;
16414 BEGIN
16415 s := blue ;
16416 @end smallexample
16417
16418 @noindent
16419 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16420 and value of a variable.
16421
16422 @smallexample
16423 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16424 $1 = blue
16425 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16426 type = [blue..yellow]
16427 @end smallexample
16428
16429 @noindent
16430 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16431 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16432 their @code{C} counterparts.
16433
16434 @smallexample
16435 VAR
16436 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16437 BEGIN
16438 s[1] := 1 ;
16439 @end smallexample
16440
16441 @smallexample
16442 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16443 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16444 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16445 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16446 @end smallexample
16447
16448 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16449 pointer types as shown in this example:
16450
16451 @smallexample
16452 VAR
16453 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16454 BEGIN
16455 NEW(s) ;
16456 s^[1] := 1 ;
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @noindent
16460 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16461
16462 @smallexample
16463 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16464 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16465 @end smallexample
16466
16467 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16468 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16469 types:
16470
16471 @smallexample
16472 TYPE
16473 foo = RECORD
16474 f1: CARDINAL ;
16475 f2: CHAR ;
16476 f3: myarray ;
16477 END ;
16478
16479 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16480 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16481 VAR
16482 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16483 @end smallexample
16484
16485 @noindent
16486 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16487 below.
16488
16489 @smallexample
16490 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16491 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16492 f1 : CARDINAL;
16493 f2 : CHAR;
16494 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16495 END
16496 @end smallexample
16497
16498 @node M2 Defaults
16499 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16500 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16501
16502 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16503 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16504 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16505 selected the working language.
16506
16507 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16508 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16509 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16510 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16511
16512 @node Deviations
16513 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16514 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16515
16516 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16517 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16518
16519 @itemize @bullet
16520 @item
16521 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16522 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16523 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16524 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16525 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16526 returned a pointer.)
16527
16528 @item
16529 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16530 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16531 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16532 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16533
16534 @item
16535 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16536 argument.
16537
16538 @item
16539 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16540 @end itemize
16541
16542 @node M2 Checks
16543 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16544 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16545
16546 @quotation
16547 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16548 range checking.
16549 @end quotation
16550 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16551
16552 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16553
16554 @itemize @bullet
16555 @item
16556 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16557 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16558
16559 @item
16560 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16561 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16562 @end itemize
16563
16564 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16565 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16566
16567 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16568 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16569
16570 @node M2 Scope
16571 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16572 @cindex scope
16573 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16574 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16575 @ifinfo
16576 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16577 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16578 @end ifinfo
16579 @ifnotinfo
16580 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16581 @end ifnotinfo
16582
16583 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16584 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16585 similar syntax:
16586
16587 @smallexample
16588
16589 @var{module} . @var{id}
16590 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16591 @end smallexample
16592
16593 @noindent
16594 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16595 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16596 identifier within your program, except another module.
16597
16598 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16599 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16600 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16601 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16602
16603 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16604 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16605 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16606 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16607 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16608 @var{module}.
16609
16610 @node GDB/M2
16611 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16612
16613 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16614 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16615 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16616 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16617 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16618 analogue in Modula-2.
16619
16620 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16621 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16622 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16623 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16624 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16625 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16626
16627 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16628 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16629 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16630
16631 @node Ada
16632 @subsection Ada
16633 @cindex Ada
16634
16635 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16636 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16637 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16638 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16639 to be difficult.
16640
16641
16642 @cindex expressions in Ada
16643 @menu
16644 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16645 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16646 in @value{GDBN}.
16647 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16648 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16649 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16650 subprograms.
16651 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16652 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16653 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16654 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16655 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16656 Profile
16657 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16658 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16659 @end menu
16660
16661 @node Ada Mode Intro
16662 @subsubsection Introduction
16663 @cindex Ada mode, general
16664
16665 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16666 syntax, with some extensions.
16667 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16668
16669 @itemize @bullet
16670 @item
16671 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16672 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16673 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16674 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16675
16676 @item
16677 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16678 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16679
16680 @item
16681 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16682 @end itemize
16683
16684 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16685 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16686 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16687 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16688 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16689
16690 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16691 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16692 was translated from an Ada source file.
16693
16694 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16695 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16696 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16697 middle (to allow based literals).
16698
16699 @node Omissions from Ada
16700 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16701 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16702
16703 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16704
16705 @itemize @bullet
16706 @item
16707 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16708
16709 @itemize @minus
16710 @item
16711 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16712 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16713
16714 @item
16715 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16716
16717 @item
16718 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16719
16720 @item
16721 @t{'Tag}.
16722
16723 @item
16724 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16725 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16726
16727 @item
16728 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16729 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16730
16731 @item
16732 @t{'Address}.
16733 @end itemize
16734
16735 @item
16736 The names in
16737 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16738 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16739 not currently available.
16740
16741 @item
16742 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16743 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16744 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16745 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16746 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16747 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16748 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16749 indeterminate values.
16750
16751 @item
16752 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16753 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16754 are not implemented.
16755
16756 @item
16757 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16758 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16759 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16760 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16761 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16762
16763 @smallexample
16764 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16765 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16766 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16767 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16768 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16769 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16770 @end smallexample
16771
16772 Changing a
16773 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16774 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16775 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16776 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16777 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16778 declared to have a type such as:
16779
16780 @smallexample
16781 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16782 Id : Integer;
16783 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16784 end record;
16785 @end smallexample
16786
16787 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16788 assignments:
16789
16790 @smallexample
16791 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16792 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16793 @end smallexample
16794
16795 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16796 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16797 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16798 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16799 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16800 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16801 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16802 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16803
16804 @item
16805 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16806
16807 @item
16808 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16809 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16810 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16811 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16812 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16813 the proper resolution.
16814
16815 @item
16816 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16817
16818 @item
16819 Entry calls are not implemented.
16820
16821 @item
16822 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16823 formats are not supported.
16824
16825 @item
16826 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16827
16828 @item
16829 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16830 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16831 context.
16832 Should your program
16833 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16834 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16835 @end itemize
16836
16837 @node Additions to Ada
16838 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16839 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16840
16841 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16842 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16843
16844 @itemize @bullet
16845 @item
16846 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16847 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16848 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16849 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16850 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16851 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16852 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16853 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16854
16855 @item
16856 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16857 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16858 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16859
16860 @item
16861 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16862 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16863
16864 @item
16865 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16866 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16867 @end itemize
16868
16869 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16870 additions specific to Ada:
16871
16872 @itemize @bullet
16873 @item
16874 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16875 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16876
16877 @smallexample
16878 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16879 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16880 @end smallexample
16881
16882 @item
16883 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16884 the value of its right-hand operand.
16885 This allows, for example,
16886 complex conditional breaks:
16887
16888 @smallexample
16889 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16890 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16891 @end smallexample
16892
16893 @item
16894 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16895 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16896 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16897 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16898 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16899 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16900 in strings. For example,
16901 @smallexample
16902 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16903 @end smallexample
16904 @noindent
16905 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16906 after each period.
16907
16908 @item
16909 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16910 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16911 to write
16912
16913 @smallexample
16914 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16915 @end smallexample
16916
16917 @item
16918 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16919 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16920 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16921 of 3 might print as
16922
16923 @smallexample
16924 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16925 @end smallexample
16926
16927 @noindent
16928 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16929 clause.
16930
16931 @item
16932 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16933 multi-character subsequence of
16934 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16935 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16936 in place of @t{a'length}.
16937
16938 @item
16939 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16940 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16941 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16942 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16943 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16944 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16945 For example,
16946 @smallexample
16947 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16948 @end smallexample
16949
16950 @item
16951 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16952 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16953 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16954 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16955 object.
16956
16957 @end itemize
16958
16959 @node Overloading support for Ada
16960 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16961 @cindex overloading, Ada
16962
16963 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16964 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16965 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16966 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16967 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16968 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16969
16970 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16971 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16972 use, for instance:
16973
16974 @smallexample
16975 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16976 Multiple matches for f
16977 [0] cancel
16978 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16979 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16980 >
16981 @end smallexample
16982
16983 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16984 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16985 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16986
16987 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16988 case:
16989
16990 @table @code
16991
16992 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16993 @item set ada print-signatures
16994 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16995 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16996 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16997
16998 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16999 @item show ada print-signatures
17000 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17001 overloads selection menu.
17002 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17003
17004 @end table
17005
17006 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17007 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17008
17009 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17010 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17011 before reaching the main procedure.
17012 As defined in the Ada Reference
17013 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17014 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17015 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17016 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17017
17018 @node Ada Exceptions
17019 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17020
17021 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17022
17023 @table @code
17024 @kindex info exceptions
17025 @item info exceptions
17026 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17027 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17028 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17029 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17030 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17031 @end table
17032
17033 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17034 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17035 argument.
17036
17037 @smallexample
17038 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17039 All defined Ada exceptions:
17040 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17041 program_error: 0x613d20
17042 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17043 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17044 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17045 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17046 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17047 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17048 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17049 @end smallexample
17050
17051 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17052 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17053
17054 @node Ada Tasks
17055 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17056 @cindex Ada, tasking
17057
17058 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17059 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17060
17061 @table @code
17062 @kindex info tasks
17063 @item info tasks
17064 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17065
17066
17067 @smallexample
17068 @iftex
17069 @leftskip=0.5cm
17070 @end iftex
17071 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17072 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17073 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17074 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17075 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17076 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17077
17078 @end smallexample
17079
17080 @noindent
17081 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17082 task currently being inspected.
17083
17084 @table @asis
17085 @item ID
17086 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17087
17088 @item TID
17089 The Ada task ID.
17090
17091 @item P-ID
17092 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17093
17094 @item Pri
17095 The base priority of the task.
17096
17097 @item State
17098 Current state of the task.
17099
17100 @table @code
17101 @item Unactivated
17102 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17103 executing.
17104
17105 @item Runnable
17106 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17107 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17108
17109 @item Terminated
17110 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17111 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17112 terminated themselves.
17113
17114 @item Child Activation Wait
17115 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17116
17117 @item Accept Statement
17118 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17119
17120 @item Waiting on entry call
17121 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17122
17123 @item Async Select Wait
17124 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17125 select statement.
17126
17127 @item Delay Sleep
17128 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17129 alternative open.
17130
17131 @item Child Termination Wait
17132 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17133 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17134 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17135
17136 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17137 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17138 finish terminating.
17139
17140 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17141 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17142 @end table
17143
17144 @item Name
17145 Name of the task in the program.
17146
17147 @end table
17148
17149 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17150 @item info task @var{taskno}
17151 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17152 the following example:
17153 @smallexample
17154 @iftex
17155 @leftskip=0.5cm
17156 @end iftex
17157 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17158 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17159 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17160 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17161 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17162 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17163 Name: task_1
17164 Thread: 0
17165 LWP: 0x1fac
17166 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17167 Base Priority: 15
17168 State: Runnable
17169 @end smallexample
17170
17171 @item task
17172 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17173 @cindex current Ada task ID
17174 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17175
17176 @smallexample
17177 @iftex
17178 @leftskip=0.5cm
17179 @end iftex
17180 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17181 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17182 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17183 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17184 (@value{GDBP}) task
17185 [Current task is 2]
17186 @end smallexample
17187
17188 @item task @var{taskno}
17189 @cindex Ada task switching
17190 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17191 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17192 from the current task to the given task.
17193
17194 @smallexample
17195 @iftex
17196 @leftskip=0.5cm
17197 @end iftex
17198 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17199 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17200 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17201 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17202 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17203 [Switching to task 1]
17204 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17205 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17206 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17207 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17208 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17209 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17210 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17211 @end smallexample
17212
17213 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17214 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17215 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17216 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17217 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17218 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17219 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17220 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17221 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17222
17223 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17224 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17225 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17226 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17227 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17228
17229 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17230 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17231 program.
17232
17233 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17234 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17235 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17236
17237 For example,
17238
17239 @smallexample
17240 @iftex
17241 @leftskip=0.5cm
17242 @end iftex
17243 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17244 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17245 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17246 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17247 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17248 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17249 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17250 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17251 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17252 Continuing.
17253 task # 1 running
17254 task # 2 running
17255
17256 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17257 15 flush;
17258 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17259 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17260 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17261 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17262 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17263 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17264 @end smallexample
17265 @end table
17266
17267 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17268 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17269 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17270
17271 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17272 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17273 the platform being used.
17274 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17275 switching is not supported.
17276
17277 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17278 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17279 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17280 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17281 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17282 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17283
17284 @node Ravenscar Profile
17285 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17286 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17287
17288 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17289 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17290 requirements.
17291
17292 @table @code
17293 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17294 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17295 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17296 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17297 Profile. This is the default.
17298
17299 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17300 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17301 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17302 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17303 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17304 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17305 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17306
17307 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17308 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17309 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17310 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17311
17312 @end table
17313
17314 @node Ada Settings
17315 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17316 @cindex Ada settings
17317
17318 @table @code
17319 @kindex set varsize-limit
17320 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17321 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17322 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17323 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17324 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17325 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17326 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17327
17328 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17329 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17330 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17331 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17332 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17333 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17334 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17335 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17336 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17337 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17338 size is less than @var{size}.
17339
17340 @kindex show varsize-limit
17341 @item show varsize-limit
17342 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17343 @end table
17344
17345 @node Ada Glitches
17346 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17347 @cindex Ada, problems
17348
17349 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17350 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17351 @value{GDBN},
17352 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17353 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17354
17355 @itemize @bullet
17356 @item
17357 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17358 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17359
17360 @item
17361 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17362 argument lists are treated as positional).
17363
17364 @item
17365 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17366
17367 @item
17368 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17369 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17370 the host machine.
17371
17372 @item
17373 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17374 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17375 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17376 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17377 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17378 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17379 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17380 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17381 you can usually resolve the confusion
17382 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17383 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17384 @end itemize
17385
17386 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17387 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17388 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17389 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17390 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17391 enabled.
17392
17393 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17394 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17395 @table @code
17396
17397 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17398 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17399 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17400 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17401 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17402 This is the default.
17403
17404 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17405 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17406 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17407 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17408 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17409 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17410 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17411
17412 @end table
17413
17414 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17415 @cindex GNAT encoding
17416 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17417 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17418 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17419 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17420 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17421 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17422
17423 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17424 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17425 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17426 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17427 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17428 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17429 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17430 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17431
17432 @table @code
17433
17434 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17435 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17436 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17437 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17438
17439 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17440 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17441 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17442
17443 @end table
17444
17445 @node Unsupported Languages
17446 @section Unsupported Languages
17447
17448 @cindex unsupported languages
17449 @cindex minimal language
17450 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17451 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17452 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17453 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17454 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17455 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17456
17457 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17458 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17459 language.
17460
17461 @node Symbols
17462 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17463
17464 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17465 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17466 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17467 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17468 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17469 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17470 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17471
17472 @cindex symbol names
17473 @cindex names of symbols
17474 @cindex quoting names
17475 @anchor{quoting names}
17476 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17477 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17478 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17479 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17480 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17481 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17482 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17483 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17484
17485 @smallexample
17486 p 'foo.c'::x
17487 @end smallexample
17488
17489 @noindent
17490 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17491
17492 @table @code
17493 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17494 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17495 @kindex set case-sensitive
17496 @item set case-sensitive on
17497 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17498 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17499 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17500 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17501 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17502 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17503 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17504 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17505 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17506 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17507 case-insensitive matches.
17508
17509 @kindex show case-sensitive
17510 @item show case-sensitive
17511 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17512 lookups.
17513
17514 @kindex set print type methods
17515 @item set print type methods
17516 @itemx set print type methods on
17517 @itemx set print type methods off
17518 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17519 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17520 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17521 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17522 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17523 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17524
17525 @kindex show print type methods
17526 @item show print type methods
17527 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17528 classes.
17529
17530 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17531 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17532 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17533 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17534 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17535 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17536 types defined in classes.
17537
17538 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17539 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17540 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17541 printing classes.
17542
17543 @kindex set print type typedefs
17544 @item set print type typedefs
17545 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17546 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17547
17548 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17549 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17550 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17551 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17552 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17553 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17554 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17555 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17556 types.
17557
17558 @kindex show print type typedefs
17559 @item show print type typedefs
17560 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17561 printing classes.
17562
17563 @kindex info address
17564 @cindex address of a symbol
17565 @item info address @var{symbol}
17566 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17567 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17568 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17569 is always stored.
17570
17571 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17572 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17573 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17574
17575 @kindex info symbol
17576 @cindex symbol from address
17577 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17578 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17579 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17580 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17581 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17582
17583 @smallexample
17584 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17585 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17586 @end smallexample
17587
17588 @noindent
17589 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17590 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17591
17592 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17593 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17594
17595 @smallexample
17596 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17597 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17598 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17599 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17600 @end smallexample
17601
17602 @kindex demangle
17603 @cindex demangle
17604 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17605 Demangle @var{name}.
17606 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17607 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17608
17609 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17610 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17611
17612 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17613 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17614
17615 @kindex whatis
17616 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17617 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17618 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17619 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17620
17621 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17622 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17623 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17624
17625 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17626 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17627 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17628 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17629 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17630 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17631 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17632 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17633 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17634
17635 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17636 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17637 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17638 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17639 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17640 unroll it.
17641
17642 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17643 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17644 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17645
17646 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17647 Available flags are:
17648
17649 @table @code
17650 @item r
17651 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17652 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17653 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17654
17655 @item m
17656 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17657
17658 @item M
17659 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17660 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17661
17662 @item t
17663 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17664 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17665 names are substituted when printing other types.
17666
17667 @item T
17668 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17669 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17670
17671 @item o
17672 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17673 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17674
17675 For example, given the following declarations:
17676
17677 @smallexample
17678 struct tuv
17679 @{
17680 int a1;
17681 char *a2;
17682 int a3;
17683 @};
17684
17685 struct xyz
17686 @{
17687 int f1;
17688 char f2;
17689 void *f3;
17690 struct tuv f4;
17691 @};
17692
17693 union qwe
17694 @{
17695 struct tuv fff1;
17696 struct xyz fff2;
17697 @};
17698
17699 struct tyu
17700 @{
17701 int a1 : 1;
17702 int a2 : 3;
17703 int a3 : 23;
17704 char a4 : 2;
17705 int64_t a5;
17706 int a6 : 5;
17707 int64_t a7 : 3;
17708 @};
17709 @end smallexample
17710
17711 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17712
17713 @smallexample
17714 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17715 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17716 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17717 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17718 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17719 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17720
17721 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17722 @}
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17726 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17727 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17728 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17729 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17730 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17731 its fields.
17732
17733 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17734
17735 @smallexample
17736 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17737 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17738 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17739 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17740 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17741 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17742 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17743
17744 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17745 @} fff1;
17746 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17747 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17748 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17749 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17750 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17751 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17752 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17753 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17754 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17755 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17756
17757 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17758 @} f4;
17759
17760 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17761 @} fff2;
17762
17763 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17764 @}
17765 @end smallexample
17766
17767 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17768 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17769 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17770 of these structures' fields.
17771
17772 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17773 bitfields:
17774
17775 @smallexample
17776 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17777 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17778 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17779 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17780 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17781 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17782 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17783 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17784 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17785 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17786 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17787
17788 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17789 @}
17790 @end smallexample
17791
17792 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17793 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17794 @end table
17795
17796 @kindex ptype
17797 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17798 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17799 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17800 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17801
17802 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17803 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17804 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17805 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17806 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17807 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17808 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17809 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17810
17811 For example, for this variable declaration:
17812
17813 @smallexample
17814 typedef double real_t;
17815 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17816 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17817 complex_t var;
17818 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17819 @end smallexample
17820
17821 @noindent
17822 the two commands give this output:
17823
17824 @smallexample
17825 @group
17826 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17827 type = complex_t
17828 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17829 type = struct complex @{
17830 real_t real;
17831 double imag;
17832 @}
17833 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17834 type = struct complex
17835 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17836 type = struct complex
17837 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17838 type = struct complex @{
17839 real_t real;
17840 double imag;
17841 @}
17842 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17843 type = real_t *
17844 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17845 type = double *
17846 @end group
17847 @end smallexample
17848
17849 @noindent
17850 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17851 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17852
17853 @cindex incomplete type
17854 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17855 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17856 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17857 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17858 given these declarations:
17859
17860 @smallexample
17861 struct foo;
17862 struct foo *fooptr;
17863 @end smallexample
17864
17865 @noindent
17866 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17867
17868 @smallexample
17869 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17870 $1 = <incomplete type>
17871 @end smallexample
17872
17873 @noindent
17874 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17875 completely specified.
17876
17877 @cindex unknown type
17878 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17879 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17880 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17881 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17882 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17883 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17884 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17885 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17886
17887 @smallexample
17888 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17889 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17890 @end smallexample
17891
17892 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17893 of such variables.
17894
17895 @kindex info types
17896 @item info types @var{regexp}
17897 @itemx info types
17898 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17899 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17900 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17901 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17902 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17903 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17904 name is @code{value}.
17905
17906 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17907 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17908 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17909
17910 @kindex info type-printers
17911 @item info type-printers
17912 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17913 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17914 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17915 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17916 type printers.
17917
17918 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17919
17920 @kindex enable type-printer
17921 @kindex disable type-printer
17922 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17923 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17924 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17925
17926 @kindex info scope
17927 @cindex local variables
17928 @item info scope @var{location}
17929 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17930 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17931 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17932 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17933 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17934
17935 @smallexample
17936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17937 Scope for command_line_handler:
17938 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17939 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17940 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17941 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17942 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17943 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17944 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17945 @end smallexample
17946
17947 @noindent
17948 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17949 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17950 collect}.
17951
17952 @kindex info source
17953 @item info source
17954 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17955 the function containing the current point of execution:
17956 @itemize @bullet
17957 @item
17958 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17959 @item
17960 the directory it was compiled in,
17961 @item
17962 its length, in lines,
17963 @item
17964 which programming language it is written in,
17965 @item
17966 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17967 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17968 @item
17969 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17970 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17971 @item
17972 whether the debugging information includes information about
17973 preprocessor macros.
17974 @end itemize
17975
17976
17977 @kindex info sources
17978 @item info sources
17979 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17980 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17981 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17982
17983 @kindex info functions
17984 @item info functions [-q]
17985 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17986 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17987 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17988 number.
17989
17990 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
17991 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
17992 have been printed.
17993
17994 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
17995 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
17996 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
17997
17998 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
17999 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18000 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18001 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18002 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18003 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18004 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18005
18006 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18007 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18008 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18009 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18010 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18011 of special characters or quotes.
18012 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18013 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18014 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18015 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18016 int.
18017
18018 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18019 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18020 @var{type_regexp}.
18021
18022
18023 @kindex info variables
18024 @item info variables [-q]
18025 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18026 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18027 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18028 their respective source line numbers.
18029
18030 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18031 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18032 have been printed.
18033
18034 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18035 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18036 with the provided regexp(s).
18037
18038 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18039 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18040
18041 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18042 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18043 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18044 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18045 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18046 of special characters or quotes.
18047
18048 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18049 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18050 @var{type_regexp}.
18051
18052 @kindex info classes
18053 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18054 @item info classes
18055 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18056 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18057 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18058 expression.
18059
18060 @kindex info selectors
18061 @item info selectors
18062 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18063 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18064 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18065 expression.
18066
18067 @ignore
18068 This was never implemented.
18069 @kindex info methods
18070 @item info methods
18071 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18072 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18073 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18074 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18075 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18076 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18077 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18078 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18079 @end ignore
18080
18081 @cindex opaque data types
18082 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18083 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18084 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18085 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18086 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18087 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18088 another source file. The default is on.
18089
18090 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18091 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18092
18093 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18094 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18095 is printed as follows:
18096 @smallexample
18097 @{<no data fields>@}
18098 @end smallexample
18099
18100 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18101 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18102 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18103
18104 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18105 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18106 @item set print symbol-loading
18107 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18108 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18109 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18110 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18111 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18112 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18113 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18114 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18115 can be annoying.
18116 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18117 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18118 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18119 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18120
18121 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18122 @item show print symbol-loading
18123 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18124 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18125
18126 @kindex maint print symbols
18127 @cindex symbol dump
18128 @kindex maint print psymbols
18129 @cindex partial symbol dump
18130 @kindex maint print msymbols
18131 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18132 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18133 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18134 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18135 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18136 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18137 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18138 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18139 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18140 that objfile.
18141 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18142 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18143 @code{main}.
18144 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18145 source file.
18146
18147 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18148 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18149 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18150 tables.
18151 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18152 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18153 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18154 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18155 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18156 ``ELF symbols''.
18157
18158 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18159 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18160
18161 @kindex maint info symtabs
18162 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18163 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18164 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18165 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18166 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18167 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18168 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18169
18170 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18171 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18172 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18173 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18174 structure in more detail. For example:
18175
18176 @smallexample
18177 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18178 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18179 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18180 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18181 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18182 readin no
18183 fullname (null)
18184 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18185 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18186 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18187 dependencies (none)
18188 @}
18189 @}
18190 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18191 (@value{GDBP})
18192 @end smallexample
18193 @noindent
18194 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18195 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18196 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18197 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18198 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18199
18200 @smallexample
18201 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18202 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18203 line 1574.
18204 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18205 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18206 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18207 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18208 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18209 dirname (null)
18210 fullname (null)
18211 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18212 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18213 debugformat DWARF 2
18214 @}
18215 @}
18216 (@value{GDBP})
18217 @end smallexample
18218
18219 @kindex maint info line-table
18220 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18221 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18222 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18223
18224 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18225 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18226 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18227
18228 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18229 @cindex symbol cache size
18230 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18231 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18232 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18233 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18234 with different sizes.
18235
18236 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18237 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18238 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18239
18240 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18241 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18242 @item maint print symbol-cache
18243 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18244 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18245
18246 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18247 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18248 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18249 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18250 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18251
18252 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18253 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18254 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18255 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18256 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18257 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18258
18259 @end table
18260
18261 @node Altering
18262 @chapter Altering Execution
18263
18264 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18265 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18266 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18267 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18268 program.
18269
18270 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18271 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18272 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18273
18274 @menu
18275 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18276 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18277 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18278 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18279 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18280 * Patching:: Patching your program
18281 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18282 @end menu
18283
18284 @node Assignment
18285 @section Assignment to Variables
18286
18287 @cindex assignment
18288 @cindex setting variables
18289 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18290 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18291
18292 @smallexample
18293 print x=4
18294 @end smallexample
18295
18296 @noindent
18297 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18298 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18299 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18300 information on operators in supported languages.
18301
18302 @kindex set variable
18303 @cindex variables, setting
18304 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18305 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18306 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18307 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18308 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18309
18310 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18311 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18312 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18313 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18314 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18315 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18316 command @code{set width}:
18317
18318 @smallexample
18319 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18320 type = double
18321 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18322 $4 = 13
18323 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18324 Invalid syntax in expression.
18325 @end smallexample
18326
18327 @noindent
18328 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18329 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18330
18331 @smallexample
18332 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18336 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18337 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18338 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18339 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18340 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18341
18342 @smallexample
18343 @group
18344 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18345 type = double
18346 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18347 $1 = 1
18348 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18349 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18350 $2 = 1
18351 (@value{GDBP}) r
18352 The program being debugged has been started already.
18353 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18354 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18355 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18356 Invalid bfd target.
18357 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18358 The current BFD target is "=4".
18359 @end group
18360 @end smallexample
18361
18362 @noindent
18363 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18364 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18365 @code{g}, use
18366
18367 @smallexample
18368 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18369 @end smallexample
18370
18371 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18372 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18373 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18374 same length or shorter.
18375 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18376 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18377
18378 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18379 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18380 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18381 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18382 and representation in memory), and
18383
18384 @smallexample
18385 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18386 @end smallexample
18387
18388 @noindent
18389 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18390
18391 @node Jumping
18392 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18393
18394 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18395 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18396 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18397
18398 @table @code
18399 @kindex jump
18400 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18401 @item jump @var{location}
18402 @itemx j @var{location}
18403 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18404 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18405 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18406 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18407 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18408
18409 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18410 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18411 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18412 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18413 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18414 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18415 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18416 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18417 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18418 @end table
18419
18420 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18421 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18422 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18423 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18424 example,
18425
18426 @smallexample
18427 set $pc = 0x485
18428 @end smallexample
18429
18430 @noindent
18431 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18432 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18433 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18434
18435 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18436 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18437 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18438 detail.
18439
18440 @c @group
18441 @node Signaling
18442 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18443 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18444
18445 @table @code
18446 @kindex signal
18447 @item signal @var{signal}
18448 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18449 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18450 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18451 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18452
18453 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18454 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18455 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18456 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18457 signal.
18458
18459 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18460 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18461 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18462 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18463 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18464 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18465 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18466 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18467
18468 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18469 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18470 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18471 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18472 passes the signal directly to your program.
18473
18474 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18475 after executing the command.
18476
18477 @kindex queue-signal
18478 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18479 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18480 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18481 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18482 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18483 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18484 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18485 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18486 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18487
18488 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18489 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18490 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18491 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18492 @code{continue} command.
18493
18494 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18495 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18496 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18497 (@pxref{Signals}).
18498 @end table
18499 @c @end group
18500
18501 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18502 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18503
18504 @node Returning
18505 @section Returning from a Function
18506
18507 @table @code
18508 @cindex returning from a function
18509 @kindex return
18510 @item return
18511 @itemx return @var{expression}
18512 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18513 command. If you give an
18514 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18515 value.
18516 @end table
18517
18518 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18519 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18520 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18521 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18522
18523 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18524 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18525 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18526 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18527 of functions.
18528
18529 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18530 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18531 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18532 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18533 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18534
18535 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18536 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18537 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18538 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18539 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18540 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18541 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18542 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18543 assignment into the right register(s).
18544
18545 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18546 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18547 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18548 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18549 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18550 into a @code{long long int}:
18551
18552 @smallexample
18553 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18554 29 return 31;
18555 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18556 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18557 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18558 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18559 (@value{GDBP})
18560 @end smallexample
18561
18562 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18563 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18564 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18565 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18566 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18567 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18568 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18569 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18570
18571 @smallexample
18572 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18573 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18574 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18575 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18576 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18577 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18578 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18579 (@value{GDBP})
18580 @end smallexample
18581
18582 @node Calling
18583 @section Calling Program Functions
18584
18585 @table @code
18586 @cindex calling functions
18587 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18588 @item print @var{expr}
18589 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18590 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18591 debugged.
18592
18593 @kindex call
18594 @item call @var{expr}
18595 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18596 returned values.
18597
18598 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18599 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18600 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18601 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18602 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18603 value history.
18604 @end table
18605
18606 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18607 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18608 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18609 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18610
18611 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18612 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18613 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18614 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18615 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18616 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18617 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18618 in that case is controlled by the
18619 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18620
18621 @table @code
18622 @item set unwindonsignal
18623 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18624 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18625 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18626 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18627 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18628 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18629 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18630 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18631 received.
18632
18633 @item show unwindonsignal
18634 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18635 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18636 @value{GDBN}.
18637
18638 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18639 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18640 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18641 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18642 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18643 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18644 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18645 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18646 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18647 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18648
18649 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18650 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18651 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18652 @value{GDBN}.
18653
18654 @end table
18655
18656 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18657
18658 @cindex no debug info functions
18659 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18660 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18661 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18662 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18663 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18664 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18665
18666 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18667 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18668 declared return type. For example:
18669
18670 @smallexample
18671 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18672 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18673 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18674 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18675 @end smallexample
18676
18677 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18678 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18679 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18680 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18681
18682 @smallexample
18683 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18684 @end smallexample
18685
18686 @noindent
18687 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18688
18689 @smallexample
18690 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18691 @end smallexample
18692
18693 @noindent
18694 these calls are equivalent:
18695
18696 @smallexample
18697 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18698 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18699 @end smallexample
18700
18701 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18702 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18703 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18704 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18705 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18706 float parameters, and no debug info:
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 float
18710 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18711 float v1, v2;
18712 @{
18713 return v1 * v2;
18714 @}
18715 @end smallexample
18716
18717 @noindent
18718 you call it like this:
18719
18720 @smallexample
18721 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18722 @end smallexample
18723
18724 @node Patching
18725 @section Patching Programs
18726
18727 @cindex patching binaries
18728 @cindex writing into executables
18729 @cindex writing into corefiles
18730
18731 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18732 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18733 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18734 patching your program's binary.
18735
18736 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18737 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18738 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18739 repairs.
18740
18741 @table @code
18742 @kindex set write
18743 @item set write on
18744 @itemx set write off
18745 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18746 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18747 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18748
18749 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18750 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18751 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18752
18753 @item show write
18754 @kindex show write
18755 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18756 as well as reading.
18757 @end table
18758
18759 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18760 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18761 @cindex injecting code
18762 @cindex writing into executables
18763 @cindex compiling code
18764
18765 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18766 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18767 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18768 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18769
18770 @table @code
18771 @kindex compile code
18772 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18773 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18774 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18775 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18776 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18777 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18778 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18779 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18780 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18781 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18782 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18783 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18784
18785 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18786 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18787 E.g.:
18788
18789 @smallexample
18790 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18791 @end smallexample
18792
18793 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18794 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18795 from actual source code. E.g.:
18796
18797 @smallexample
18798 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18799 @end smallexample
18800
18801 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18802 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18803 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18804 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18805 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18806 editor.
18807
18808 @smallexample
18809 compile code
18810 >printf ("hello\n");
18811 >printf ("world\n");
18812 >end
18813 @end smallexample
18814
18815 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18816 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18817 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18818 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18819 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18820 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18821 inferior symbols otherwise.
18822
18823 @kindex compile file
18824 @item compile file @var{filename}
18825 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18826 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 compile file /home/user/example.c
18830 @end smallexample
18831 @end table
18832
18833 @table @code
18834 @item compile print @var{expr}
18835 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18836 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18837 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18838 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18839 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18840 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18841 Formats}.
18842
18843 @item compile print
18844 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18845 @cindex reprint the last value
18846 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18847 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18848 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18849 multiple-line editor.
18850 @end table
18851
18852 @noindent
18853 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18854
18855 @table @code
18856 @anchor{set debug compile}
18857 @item set debug compile
18858 @cindex compile command debugging info
18859 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18860 injecting the code. The default is off.
18861
18862 @item show debug compile
18863 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18864 compiling and injecting the code.
18865
18866 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18867 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18868 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18869 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18870 The default is off.
18871
18872 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18873 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18874 C@t{++} type conversion.
18875 @end table
18876
18877 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18878
18879 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18880 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18881 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18882 injecting process.
18883
18884 @noindent
18885 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18886
18887 @table @asis
18888 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18889 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18890 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18891 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18892
18893 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18894 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18895 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18896 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18897 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18898 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18899 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18900 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18901
18902 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18903 @end table
18904
18905 @noindent
18906 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18907
18908 @table @code
18909 @item set compile-args
18910 @cindex compile command options override
18911 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18912 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18913 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18914 compilation.
18915
18916 @item show compile-args
18917 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18918 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18919 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18920 @end table
18921
18922 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18923
18924 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18925 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18926 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18927
18928 @table @asis
18929 @item C code examples and caveats
18930 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18931 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18932 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18933 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18934 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18935
18936 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18937 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18938 much like any other normal debugging session.
18939
18940 @smallexample
18941 void function1 (void)
18942 @{
18943 int i = 42;
18944 printf ("function 1\n");
18945 @}
18946
18947 void function2 (void)
18948 @{
18949 int j = 12;
18950 function1 ();
18951 @}
18952
18953 int main(void)
18954 @{
18955 int k = 6;
18956 int *p;
18957 function2 ();
18958 return 0;
18959 @}
18960 @end smallexample
18961
18962 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18963 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18964 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18965
18966 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18967 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18968 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18969 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18970 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18971
18972 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18973 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18974 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18975 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18976 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18977 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18978 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18979 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18980 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18981 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18982
18983 @smallexample
18984 compile code k = 3;
18985 @end smallexample
18986
18987 @noindent
18988 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18989 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18990 @code{compile} command changes it.
18991
18992 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18993 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18994 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18995 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18996 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18997
18998 @smallexample
18999 compile code j = 3;
19000 @end smallexample
19001
19002 @noindent
19003 will result in a compilation error message.
19004
19005 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19006 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19007 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19008
19009 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19010 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19011 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19012 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19013
19014 @smallexample
19015 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19016 @end smallexample
19017
19018 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19019 command has completed:
19020
19021 @smallexample
19022 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19023 @end smallexample
19024
19025 @noindent
19026 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19027 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19028 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19029 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19030 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19031
19032 @smallexample
19033 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19034 @end smallexample
19035
19036 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19037 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19038 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19039 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19040 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19041 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19042 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19043 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19044
19045 @smallexample
19046 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19047 @end smallexample
19048
19049 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19050 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19051 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19052 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19053 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19054 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19055 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19056
19057 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19058 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19059 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19060 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19061 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19062 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19063
19064 @smallexample
19065 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19066 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19067 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19068 Compilation failed.
19069 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19070 42
19071 @end smallexample
19072
19073 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19074 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19075 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19076 will print to the console.
19077 @end table
19078
19079 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19080
19081 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19082 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19083 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19084 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19085 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19086 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19087 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19088 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19089
19090
19091 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19092 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19093 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19094 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19095 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19096 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19097 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19098
19099 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19100 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19101 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19102 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19103 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19104 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19105 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19106
19107 @table @code
19108 @item set compile-gcc
19109 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19110 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19111 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19112 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19113 default.
19114
19115 @item show compile-gcc
19116 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19117 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19118 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19119 @end table
19120
19121 @node GDB Files
19122 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19123
19124 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19125 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19126 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19127 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19128
19129 @menu
19130 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19131 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19132 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19133 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19134 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19135 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19136 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19137 @end menu
19138
19139 @node Files
19140 @section Commands to Specify Files
19141
19142 @cindex symbol table
19143 @cindex core dump file
19144
19145 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19146 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19147 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19148 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19149
19150 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19151 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19152 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19153 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19154 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19155 new files are useful.
19156
19157 @table @code
19158 @cindex executable file
19159 @kindex file
19160 @item file @var{filename}
19161 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19162 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19163 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19164 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19165 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19166 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19167 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19168 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19169
19170 @cindex unlinked object files
19171 @cindex patching object files
19172 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19173 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19174 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19175 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19176 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19177 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19178 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19179 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19180
19181 @item file
19182 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19183 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19184
19185 @kindex exec-file
19186 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19187 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19188 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19189 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19190 discard information on the executable file.
19191
19192 @kindex symbol-file
19193 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19194 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19195 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19196 table and program to run from the same file.
19197
19198 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19199 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19200 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19201 enabled.
19202
19203 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19204 program's symbol table.
19205
19206 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19207 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19208 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19209 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19210 @value{GDBN}.
19211
19212 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19213 executing it once.
19214
19215 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19216 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19217 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19218 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19219 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19220 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19221 optimized code.
19222
19223 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19224 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19225 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19226 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19227 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19228
19229 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19230 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19231 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19232 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19233 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19234 Warnings and Messages}.)
19235
19236 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19237 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19238 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19239 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19240 in stabs format.
19241
19242 @kindex readnow
19243 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19244 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19245 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19246 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19247 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19248 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19249 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19250 entire symbol table available.
19251
19252 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19253 @cindex never read symbols
19254 @cindex symbols, never read
19255 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19256 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19257 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19258 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19259 @xref{--readnever}.
19260
19261 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19262 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19263 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19264 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19265 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19266 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19267 @c files.
19268
19269 @kindex core-file
19270 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19271 @itemx core
19272 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19273 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19274 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19275 executable file itself for other parts.
19276
19277 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19278 to be used.
19279
19280 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19281 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19282 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19283 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19284 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19285
19286 @kindex add-symbol-file
19287 @cindex dynamic linking
19288 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19289 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19290 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19291 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19292 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19293 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19294 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19295 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19296 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19297 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19298 can be given as an expression.
19299
19300 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19301 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19302 specified explicitly.
19303
19304 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19305 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19306 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19307 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19308
19309 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19310
19311 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19312 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19313 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19314 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19315 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19316 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19317 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19318 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19319 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19320
19321 @itemize @bullet
19322 @item
19323 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19324 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19325 @item
19326 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19327 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19328 @item
19329 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19330 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19331 @end itemize
19332
19333 @noindent
19334 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19335 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19336 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19337 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19338 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19339 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19340 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19341 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19342 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19343 way.
19344
19345 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19346
19347 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19348 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19349 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19350 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19351 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19352 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19353
19354 @smallexample
19355 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19356 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19357 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19358 (y or n) y
19359 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19360 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19361 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19362 (gdb)
19363 @end smallexample
19364
19365
19366 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19367
19368 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19369 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19370 @cindex load symbols from memory
19371 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19372 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19373 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19374 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19375 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19376 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19377 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19378 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19379 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19380
19381 @kindex section
19382 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19383 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19384 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19385 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19386 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19387 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19388 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19389 their addresses.
19390
19391 @kindex info files
19392 @kindex info target
19393 @item info files
19394 @itemx info target
19395 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19396 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19397 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19398 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19399 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19400 current ones.
19401
19402 @kindex maint info sections
19403 @item maint info sections
19404 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19405 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19406 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19407 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19408 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19409 may be arbitrarily combined):
19410
19411 @table @code
19412 @item ALLOBJ
19413 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19414 @item @var{sections}
19415 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19416 @item @var{section-flags}
19417 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19418 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19419 @table @code
19420 @item ALLOC
19421 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19422 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19423 @item LOAD
19424 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19425 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19426 @item RELOC
19427 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19428 @item READONLY
19429 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19430 @item CODE
19431 Section contains executable code only.
19432 @item DATA
19433 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19434 @item ROM
19435 Section will reside in ROM.
19436 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19437 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19438 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19439 Section is not empty.
19440 @item NEVER_LOAD
19441 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19442 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19443 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19444 COFF shared library information.
19445 @item IS_COMMON
19446 Section contains common symbols.
19447 @end table
19448 @end table
19449 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19450 @cindex read-only sections
19451 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19452 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19453 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19454 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19455 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19456 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19457 enhancement to debugging performance.
19458
19459 The default is off.
19460
19461 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19462 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19463 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19464 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19465
19466 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19467 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19468 @end table
19469
19470 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19471 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19472 name and remembers it that way.
19473
19474 @cindex shared libraries
19475 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19476 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19477 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19478 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19479
19480 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19481 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19482
19483 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19484 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19485 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19486 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19487 debugging a core file).
19488
19489 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19490 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19491 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19492
19493 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19494 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19495 particularly large or there are many of them.
19496
19497 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19498 commands:
19499
19500 @table @code
19501 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19502 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19503 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19504 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19505 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19506 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19507 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19508 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19509
19510 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19511 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19512 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19513 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19514 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19515 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19516 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19517 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19518 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19519
19520 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19521 @item show auto-solib-add
19522 Display the current autoloading mode.
19523 @end table
19524
19525 @cindex load shared library
19526 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19527 command:
19528
19529 @table @code
19530 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19531 @kindex info share
19532 @item info share @var{regex}
19533 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19534 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19535 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19536 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19537
19538 @kindex info dll
19539 @item info dll @var{regex}
19540 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19541
19542 @kindex sharedlibrary
19543 @kindex share
19544 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19545 @itemx share @var{regex}
19546 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19547 Unix regular expression.
19548 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19549 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19550 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19551 loaded.
19552
19553 @item nosharedlibrary
19554 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19555 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19556 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19557 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19558 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19559 discarded.
19560 @end table
19561
19562 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19563 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19564 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19565 Catchpoints}).
19566
19567 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19568 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19569 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19570 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19571
19572 @table @code
19573 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19574 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19575 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19576 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19577 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19578 shared library.
19579
19580 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19581 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19582 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19583 library events happen.
19584 @end table
19585
19586 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19587 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19588 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19589 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19590 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19591 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19592 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19593 not.
19594
19595 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19596 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19597 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19598 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19599 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19600
19601 @table @code
19602 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19603 @cindex system root, alternate
19604 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19605 @kindex set sysroot
19606 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19607 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19608 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19609 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19610 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19611 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19612 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19613 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19614 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19615 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19616 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19617 @var{path}.
19618
19619 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19620 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19621 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19622 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19623 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19624 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19625 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19626 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19627 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19628 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19629 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19630 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19631 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19632 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19633
19634 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19635 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19636 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19637 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19638 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19639
19640 @smallexample
19641 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19642 @end smallexample
19643
19644 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19645 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19646 system:
19647
19648 @smallexample
19649 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19650 @end smallexample
19651
19652 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19653 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19654 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19655 colons:
19656
19657 @smallexample
19658 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19659 @end smallexample
19660
19661 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19662 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19663 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19664 @samp{z}):
19665
19666 @smallexample
19667 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19668 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19669 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19670 @end smallexample
19671
19672 @noindent
19673 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19674 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19675 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19676
19677 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19678 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19679
19680 @smallexample
19681 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19682 @end smallexample
19683
19684 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19685 if you don't want or need to.
19686
19687 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19688 sysroot}.
19689
19690 @cindex default system root
19691 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19692 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19693 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19694 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19695 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19696 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19697 location.
19698
19699 @kindex show sysroot
19700 @item show sysroot
19701 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19702
19703 @kindex set solib-search-path
19704 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19705 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19706 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19707 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19708 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19709 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19710 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19711 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19712 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19713 of shared library symbols.
19714
19715 @kindex show solib-search-path
19716 @item show solib-search-path
19717 Display the current shared library search path.
19718
19719 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19720 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19721 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19722 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19723 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19724
19725 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19726 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19727 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19728 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19729 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19730 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19731 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19732 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19733 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19734 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19735 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19736 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19737 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19738 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19739 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19740 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19741 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19742 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19743 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19744 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19745 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19746 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19747
19748 @table @code
19749 @item unix
19750 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19751 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19752 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19753 the forward slash.
19754
19755 @item dos-based
19756 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19757 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19758 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19759 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19760 considered directory separators.
19761
19762 @item auto
19763 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19764 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19765 This is the default.
19766 @end table
19767 @end table
19768
19769 @cindex file name canonicalization
19770 @cindex base name differences
19771 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19772 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19773 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19774 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19775 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19776 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19777 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19778 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19779 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19780 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19781 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19782 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19783 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19784 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19785 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19786
19787 @table @code
19788 @item set basenames-may-differ
19789 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19790 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19791
19792 @item show basenames-may-differ
19793 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19794 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19795 @end table
19796
19797 @node File Caching
19798 @section File Caching
19799 @cindex caching of opened files
19800 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19801
19802 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19803 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19804 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19805 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19806
19807 @table @code
19808 @kindex maint info bfds
19809 @item maint info bfds
19810 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19811 @value{GDBN}.
19812
19813 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19814 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19815 @kindex bfd caching
19816 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19817 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19818 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19819 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19820 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19821 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19822 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19823 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19824 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19825
19826 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19827 @kindex bfd caching
19828 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19829 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19830
19831 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19832 @kindex bfd caching
19833 @item show debug bfd-cache
19834 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19835 @end table
19836
19837 @node Separate Debug Files
19838 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19839 @cindex separate debugging information files
19840 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19841 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19842 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19843 @cindex global debugging information directories
19844 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19845 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19846
19847 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19848 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19849 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19850 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19851 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19852 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19853 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19854
19855 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19856 file:
19857
19858 @itemize @bullet
19859 @item
19860 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19861 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19862 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19863 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19864 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19865 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19866 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19867 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19868
19869 @item
19870 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19871 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19872 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19873 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19874 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19875 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19876 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19877 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19878 below.
19879 @end itemize
19880
19881 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19882 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19883
19884 @itemize @bullet
19885 @item
19886 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19887 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19888 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19889 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19890 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19891
19892 @item
19893 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19894 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19895 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19896 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19897 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19898 hex characters, not 10.)
19899 @end itemize
19900
19901 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19902 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19903 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19904 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19905 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19906 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19907
19908 @itemize @minus
19909 @item
19910 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19911 @item
19912 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19913 @item
19914 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19915 @item
19916 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19917 @end itemize
19918
19919 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19920 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19921 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19922 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19923 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19924
19925 @table @code
19926
19927 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19928 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19929 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19930 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19931 concatenating them by a path separator.
19932
19933 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19934 @item show debug-file-directory
19935 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19936 information files.
19937
19938 @end table
19939
19940 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19941 @cindex debug link sections
19942 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19943 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19944
19945 @itemize
19946 @item
19947 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19948 a zero byte,
19949 @item
19950 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19951 boundary within the section, and
19952 @item
19953 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19954 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19955 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19956 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19957 @end itemize
19958
19959 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19960 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19961 described above.
19962
19963 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19964 @cindex build ID sections
19965 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19966 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19967 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19968 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19969 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19970 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19971 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19972 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19973 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19974
19975 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19976 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19977 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19978 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19979 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19980 in an ordinary executable.
19981
19982 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19983 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19984 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19985 following commands:
19986
19987 @smallexample
19988 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19989 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19990 @end smallexample
19991
19992 @noindent
19993 These commands remove the debugging
19994 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19995 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19996 two files:
19997
19998 @itemize @bullet
19999 @item
20000 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20001 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20002
20003 @smallexample
20004 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20005 @end smallexample
20006
20007 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20008 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20009 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20010 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20011
20012 @item
20013 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20014 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20015 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20016 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20017 @end itemize
20018
20019 @noindent
20020
20021 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20022 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20023 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20024
20025 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20026 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20027 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20028 @c different ways!
20029 @ifhtml
20030 @display
20031 @html
20032 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20033 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20034 @end html
20035 @end display
20036 @end ifhtml
20037 @ifnothtml
20038 @display
20039 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20040 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20041 @end display
20042 @end ifnothtml
20043
20044 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20045 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20046 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20047 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20048 CRC.
20049
20050 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20051 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20052 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20053 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20054 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20055
20056 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20057 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20058 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20059 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20060 @code{0xffffffff}.
20061
20062 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20063 @smallexample
20064 unsigned long
20065 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20066 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20067 @{
20068 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20069 @{
20070 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20071 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20072 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20073 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20074 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20075 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20076 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20077 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20078 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20079 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20080 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20081 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20082 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20083 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20084 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20085 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20086 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20087 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20088 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20089 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20090 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20091 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20092 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20093 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20094 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20095 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20096 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20097 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20098 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20099 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20100 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20101 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20102 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20103 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20104 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20105 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20106 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20107 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20108 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20109 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20110 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20111 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20112 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20113 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20114 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20115 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20116 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20117 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20118 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20119 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20120 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20121 0x2d02ef8d
20122 @};
20123 unsigned char *end;
20124
20125 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20126 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20127 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20128 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20129 @}
20130 @end smallexample
20131
20132 @noindent
20133 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20134
20135 @node MiniDebugInfo
20136 @section Debugging information in a special section
20137 @cindex separate debug sections
20138 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20139
20140 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20141 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20142 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20143 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20144
20145 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20146 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20147 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20148 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20149 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20150 debugging information might be included in the section.
20151
20152 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20153 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20154 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20155
20156 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20157 standard utilities:
20158
20159 @smallexample
20160 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20161 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20162 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20163 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20164
20165 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20166 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20167 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20168 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20169 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20170 | sort > funcsyms
20171
20172 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20173 # table.
20174 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20175
20176 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20177 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20178
20179 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20180 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20181 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20182 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20183
20184 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20185 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20186
20187 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20188 # original binary.
20189 xz mini_debuginfo
20190 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20191 @end smallexample
20192
20193 @node Index Files
20194 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20195 @cindex index files
20196 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20197
20198 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20199 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20200 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20201 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20202 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20203 startup.
20204
20205 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20206 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20207 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20208
20209 @smallexample
20210 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20211 @end smallexample
20212
20213 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20214
20215 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20216 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20217
20218 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20219 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20220 using @command{objcopy}.
20221
20222 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20223
20224 @table @code
20225 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20226 @kindex save gdb-index
20227 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20228 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20229 default creates it produces a single file
20230 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20231 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20232 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20233 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20234 given @var{directory}.
20235 @end table
20236
20237 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20238 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20239
20240 @smallexample
20241 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20242 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20243 @end smallexample
20244
20245 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20246
20247 @smallexample
20248 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20249 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20250 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20251 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20252 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20253 @end smallexample
20254
20255 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20256 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20257 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20258 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20259 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20260 The default is @code{off}.
20261 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20262 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20263
20264 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20265 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20266
20267 @smallexample
20268 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20269 @end smallexample
20270
20271 Instead you must do, for example,
20272
20273 @smallexample
20274 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20275 @end smallexample
20276
20277 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20278 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20279 currently work for programs using Ada.
20280
20281 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20282
20283 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20284 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20285 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20286 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20287
20288 @table @code
20289
20290 @item set index-cache on
20291 @itemx set index-cache off
20292 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20293
20294 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20295 @itemx show index-cache directory
20296 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20297
20298 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20299 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20300 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20301 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20302 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20303 differ according to local convention.
20304
20305 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20306 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20307
20308 @item show index-cache stats
20309 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20310
20311 @end table
20312
20313 @node Symbol Errors
20314 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20315
20316 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20317 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20318 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20319 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20320 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20321 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20322 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20323 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20324 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20325 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20326 Messages}).
20327
20328 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20329
20330 @table @code
20331 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20332
20333 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20334 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20335 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20336 in its outer scope blocks.
20337
20338 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20339 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20340 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20341 function.
20342
20343 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20344
20345 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20346 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20347 do so.
20348
20349 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20350 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20351 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20352 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20353 Messages}.)
20354
20355 @item bad block start address patched
20356
20357 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20358 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20359 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20360
20361 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20362 starting on the previous source line.
20363
20364 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20365
20366 @cindex foo
20367 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20368 larger than the size of the string table.
20369
20370 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20371 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20372 with this name.
20373
20374 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20375
20376 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20377 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20378 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20379
20380 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20381 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20382 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20383 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20384 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20385 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20386
20387 @item stub type has NULL name
20388
20389 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20390
20391 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20392 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20393 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20394 it.
20395
20396 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20397
20398 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20399
20400 @end table
20401
20402 @node Data Files
20403 @section GDB Data Files
20404
20405 @cindex prefix for data files
20406 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20407 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20408
20409 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20410 is currently using.
20411
20412 @table @code
20413 @kindex set data-directory
20414 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20415 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20416 to @var{directory}.
20417
20418 @kindex show data-directory
20419 @item show data-directory
20420 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20421 @end table
20422
20423 @cindex default data directory
20424 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20425 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20426 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20427 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20428 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20429 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20430 location.
20431
20432 The data directory may also be specified with the
20433 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20434 @xref{Mode Options}.
20435
20436 @node Targets
20437 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20438
20439 @cindex debugging target
20440 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20441
20442 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20443 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20444 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20445 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20446 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20447 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20448 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20449 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20450
20451 @cindex target architecture
20452 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20453 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20454 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20455 command.
20456
20457 @table @code
20458 @kindex set architecture
20459 @kindex show architecture
20460 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20461 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20462 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20463 supported architectures.
20464
20465 @item show architecture
20466 Show the current target architecture.
20467
20468 @item set processor
20469 @itemx processor
20470 @kindex set processor
20471 @kindex show processor
20472 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20473 and @code{show architecture}.
20474 @end table
20475
20476 @menu
20477 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20478 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20479 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20480 @end menu
20481
20482 @node Active Targets
20483 @section Active Targets
20484
20485 @cindex stacking targets
20486 @cindex active targets
20487 @cindex multiple targets
20488
20489 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20490 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20491 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20492 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20493 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20494 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20495 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20496 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20497 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20498
20499 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20500 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20501 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20502 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20503
20504 @node Target Commands
20505 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20506
20507 @table @code
20508 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20509 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20510 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20511 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20512 protocol of the target machine.
20513
20514 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20515 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20516 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20517
20518 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20519 after executing the command.
20520
20521 @kindex help target
20522 @item help target
20523 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20524 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20525 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20526
20527 @item help target @var{name}
20528 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20529 select it.
20530
20531 @kindex set gnutarget
20532 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20533 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20534 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20535 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20536 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20537 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20538
20539 @quotation
20540 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20541 you must know the actual BFD name.
20542 @end quotation
20543
20544 @noindent
20545 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20546
20547 @kindex show gnutarget
20548 @item show gnutarget
20549 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20550 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20551 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20552 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20553 @end table
20554
20555 @cindex common targets
20556 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20557 configuration):
20558
20559 @table @code
20560 @kindex target
20561 @item target exec @var{program}
20562 @cindex executable file target
20563 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20564 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20565
20566 @item target core @var{filename}
20567 @cindex core dump file target
20568 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20569 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20570
20571 @item target remote @var{medium}
20572 @cindex remote target
20573 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20574 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20575 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20576
20577 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20578 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20579
20580 @smallexample
20581 target remote /dev/ttya
20582 @end smallexample
20583
20584 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20585 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20586 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20587 clobbered by the download.
20588
20589 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20590 @cindex built-in simulator target
20591 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20592 In general,
20593 @smallexample
20594 target sim
20595 load
20596 run
20597 @end smallexample
20598 @noindent
20599 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20600 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20601 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20602 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20603 Processors}.
20604
20605 @item target native
20606 @cindex native target
20607 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20608 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20609 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20610 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20611
20612 @end table
20613
20614 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20615 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20616
20617 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20618 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20619 various aspects of this process.
20620
20621 @table @code
20622
20623 @item set hash
20624 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20625 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20626 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20627 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20628 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20629 monitor.
20630
20631 @item show hash
20632 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20633 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20634
20635 @item set debug monitor
20636 @kindex set debug monitor
20637 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20638 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20639 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20640
20641 @item show debug monitor
20642 @kindex show debug monitor
20643 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20644 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20645 @end table
20646
20647 @table @code
20648
20649 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20650 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20651 @anchor{load}
20652 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20653 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20654 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20655 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20656 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20657 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20658
20659 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20660 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20661 target is @dots{}}''
20662
20663 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20664 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20665 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20666 specifies a fixed address.
20667 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20668
20669 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20670 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20671 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20672
20673 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20674 load programs into flash memory.
20675
20676 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20677 @end table
20678
20679 @table @code
20680
20681 @kindex flash-erase
20682 @item flash-erase
20683 @anchor{flash-erase}
20684
20685 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20686
20687 @end table
20688
20689 @node Byte Order
20690 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20691
20692 @cindex choosing target byte order
20693 @cindex target byte order
20694
20695 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20696 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20697 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20698 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20699 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20700 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20701
20702 @table @code
20703 @kindex set endian
20704 @item set endian big
20705 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20706
20707 @item set endian little
20708 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20709
20710 @item set endian auto
20711 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20712 executable.
20713
20714 @item show endian
20715 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20716
20717 @end table
20718
20719 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20720 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20721 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20722 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20723 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20724 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20725 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20726 and @code{big} otherwise.
20727
20728 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20729 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20730 target system.
20731
20732
20733 @node Remote Debugging
20734 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20735 @cindex remote debugging
20736
20737 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20738 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20739 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20740 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20741 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20742
20743 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20744 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20745 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20746 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20747 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20748 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20749
20750 Other remote targets may be available in your
20751 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20752
20753 @menu
20754 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20755 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20756 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20757 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20758 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20759 @end menu
20760
20761 @node Connecting
20762 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20763 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20764 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20765 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20766 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20767 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20768 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20769
20770 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20771 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20772 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20773 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20774
20775 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20776
20777 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20778 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20779 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20780 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20781
20782 @table @asis
20783
20784 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20785 @item Result of detach or program exit
20786 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20787 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20788 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20789
20790 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20791 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20792 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20793 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20794
20795 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20796 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20797 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20798 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20799
20800 @item Specifying the program to debug
20801 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20802 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20803 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20804 target.
20805
20806 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20807 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20808 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20809
20810 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20811 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20812 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20813 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20814
20815 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20816 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20817 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20818 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20819 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20820 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20821 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20822 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20823 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20824
20825 @item The @code{run} command
20826 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20827 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20828 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20829 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20830 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20831
20832 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20833 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20834 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20835 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20836 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20837
20838 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20839 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20840 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20841 @code{target remote} mode.
20842
20843 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20844 @item Attaching
20845 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20846 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20847 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20848
20849 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20850 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20851 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20852 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20853 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20854
20855 @end table
20856
20857 @anchor{Host and target files}
20858 @subsection Host and Target Files
20859 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20860 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20861
20862 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20863 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20864 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20865 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20866 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20867
20868 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20869 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20870 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20871 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20872 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20873
20874 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20875 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20876 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20877 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20878 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20879 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20880 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20881 target libraries.
20882
20883 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20884 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20885 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20886 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20887 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20888 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20889 programs.
20890
20891 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20892 @cindex remote connection commands
20893 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20894 local Unix domain socket, or
20895 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20896 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20897 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20898 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20899 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20900 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20901
20902 @table @code
20903
20904 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20905 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20906 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20907 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20908 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20909
20910 @smallexample
20911 target remote /dev/ttyb
20912 @end smallexample
20913
20914 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20915 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20916 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20917 @code{target} command.
20918
20919 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20920 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20921 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20922 @cindex Unix domain socket
20923 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20924 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20925
20926 @smallexample
20927 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20928 @end smallexample
20929
20930 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20931 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20932 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20933 of connection.
20934 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20935 Unix domain sockets.
20936
20937 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20938 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20939 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20940 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20941 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20942 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20943 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20944 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20945 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20946 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20947 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20948 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20949 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20950 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20951 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20952 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20953 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20954 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20955 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20956 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20957 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20958 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20959
20960 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20961 @code{manyfarms}:
20962
20963 @smallexample
20964 target remote manyfarms:2828
20965 @end smallexample
20966
20967 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20968 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20969 square bracket syntax:
20970
20971 @smallexample
20972 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20973 @end smallexample
20974
20975 @noindent
20976 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20977
20978 @smallexample
20979 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20980 @end smallexample
20981
20982 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20983 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20984 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20985 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20986 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20987 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20988
20989 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20990 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20991 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20992 port 1234 on your local machine:
20993
20994 @smallexample
20995 target remote :1234
20996 @end smallexample
20997 @noindent
20998
20999 Note that the colon is still required here.
21000
21001 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21002 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21003 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21004 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21005 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21006 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21007 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21008 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21009 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21010 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21011 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21012 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21013 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21014
21015 @smallexample
21016 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21017 @end smallexample
21018
21019 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21020 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21021 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21022 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21023
21024 @item target remote | @var{command}
21025 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21026 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21027 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21028 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21029 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21030 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21031 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21032 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21033 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21034
21035 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21036 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21037 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21038
21039 @end table
21040
21041 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21042 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21043 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21044 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21045 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21046 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21047 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21051 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21052 @end smallexample
21053
21054 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21055 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21056 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21057 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21058
21059 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21060 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21061
21062 @table @code
21063 @kindex detach (remote)
21064 @item detach
21065 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21066 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21067 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21068 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21069 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21070 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21071 still connected to the target.
21072
21073 @kindex disconnect
21074 @item disconnect
21075 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21076 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21077 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21078 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21079 another target.
21080
21081 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21082 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21083 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21084 @kindex monitor
21085 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21086 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21087 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21088 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21089 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21090 and implement.
21091 @end table
21092
21093 @node File Transfer
21094 @section Sending files to a remote system
21095 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21096 @cindex file transfer
21097 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21098
21099 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21100 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21101 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21102 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21103 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21104 the only way to upload or download files.
21105
21106 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21107
21108 @table @code
21109 @kindex remote put
21110 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21111 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21112 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21113
21114 @kindex remote get
21115 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21116 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21117 on the host system.
21118
21119 @kindex remote delete
21120 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21121 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21122
21123 @end table
21124
21125 @node Server
21126 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21127
21128 @kindex gdbserver
21129 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21130 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21131 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21132 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21133 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21134
21135 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21136 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21137 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21138 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21139 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21140 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21141 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21142 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21143 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21144 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21145 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21146 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21147 choice for debugging.
21148
21149 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21150 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21151 protocol.
21152
21153 @quotation
21154 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21155 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21156 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21157 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21158 @code{gdbserver}.
21159 @end quotation
21160
21161 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21162 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21163 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21164 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21165
21166 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21167 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21168 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21169 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21170 system does all the symbol handling.
21171
21172 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21173 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21174 syntax is:
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21178 @end smallexample
21179
21180 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21181 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21182 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21183 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21184 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21185 @file{/dev/com1}:
21186
21187 @smallexample
21188 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21189 @end smallexample
21190
21191 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21192 with it.
21193
21194 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21195
21196 @smallexample
21197 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21198 @end smallexample
21199
21200 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21201 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21202 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21203 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21204 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21205 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21206 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21207 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21208 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21209 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21210 @code{target remote} command.
21211
21212 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21213 with ssh:
21214
21215 @smallexample
21216 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21217 @end smallexample
21218
21219 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21220 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21221 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21222 You could elide it if you want to.
21223
21224 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21225 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21226 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21227 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21228
21229 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21230 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21231 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21232 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21233
21234 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21235 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21236
21237 @smallexample
21238 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21239 @end smallexample
21240
21241 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21242 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21243
21244 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21245 @value{GDBN} attach command
21246 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21247
21248 @pindex pidof
21249 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21250 @code{pidof} utility:
21251
21252 @smallexample
21253 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21254 @end smallexample
21255
21256 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21257 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21258 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21259
21260 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21261
21262 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21263 port.
21264
21265 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21266 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21267 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21268 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21269 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21270 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21271 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21272 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21273
21274 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21275 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21276 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21277
21278 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21279 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21280 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21281 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21282 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21283 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21284 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21285 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21286 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21287 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21288 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21289 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21290
21291 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21292 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21293
21294 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21295 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21296 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21297 program. For more information,
21298 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21299
21300 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21301 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21302 status information about the debugging process.
21303 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21304 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21305 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21306 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21307
21308 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21309 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21310 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21311 Possible options are:
21312
21313 @table @code
21314 @item none
21315 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21316 @item all
21317 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21318 @item timestamps
21319 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21320 @end table
21321
21322 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21323 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21324
21325 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21326 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21327 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21328 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21329 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21330
21331 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21332 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21333 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21334 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21335
21336 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21337 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21338 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21339 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21340
21341 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21342 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21343 environment:
21344
21345 @smallexample
21346 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21347 @end smallexample
21348
21349 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21350 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21351
21352 @smallexample
21353 $ gdbserver --selftest
21354 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21355 @end smallexample
21356
21357 These tests are disabled in release.
21358 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21359
21360 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21361 @itemize
21362
21363 @item
21364 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21365
21366 @item
21367 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21368 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21369 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21370 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21371 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21372 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21373
21374 @item
21375 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21376 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21377 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21378 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21379 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21380 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21381 program is already on the target.
21382
21383 @end itemize
21384
21385 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21386 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21387 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21388
21389 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21390 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21391 Here are the available commands.
21392
21393 @table @code
21394 @item monitor help
21395 List the available monitor commands.
21396
21397 @item monitor set debug 0
21398 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21399 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21400
21401 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21402 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21403 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21404 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21405
21406 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21407 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21408 Possible options are:
21409
21410 @table @code
21411 @item none
21412 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21413 @item all
21414 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21415 @item timestamps
21416 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21417 @end table
21418
21419 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21420 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21421
21422 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21423 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21424 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21425 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21426 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21427 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21428
21429 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21430 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21431
21432 @item monitor exit
21433 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21434 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21435 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21436 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21437 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21438
21439 @end table
21440
21441 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21442 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21443
21444 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21445 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21446
21447 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21448 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21449 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21450 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21451 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21452 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21453 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21454 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21455 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21456 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21457 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21458 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21459
21460 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21461
21462 @table @code
21463 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21464
21465 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21466 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21467 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21468
21469 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21470
21471 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21472 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21473 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21474 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21475 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21476 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21477
21478 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21479
21480 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21481 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21482 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21483 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21484 command for that. For example:
21485
21486 @smallexample
21487 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21488 @end smallexample
21489
21490 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21491 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21492 @end table
21493
21494 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21495 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21496 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21497 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21498 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21499 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21500 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21501 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21502 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21503 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21504
21505 @smallexample
21506 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21510
21511 @smallexample
21512 $ gdb myprogram
21513 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21514 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21515 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21516 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21517 @end smallexample
21518
21519 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21520 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21521 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21522 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21523 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21524 tracing.
21525
21526 @node Remote Configuration
21527 @section Remote Configuration
21528
21529 @kindex set remote
21530 @kindex show remote
21531 This section documents the configuration options available when
21532 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21533 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21534 system-call-allowed}.
21535
21536 @table @code
21537 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21538 @cindex address size for remote targets
21539 @cindex bits in remote address
21540 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21541 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21542 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21543 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21544
21545 @item show remoteaddresssize
21546 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21547
21548 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21549 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21550 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21551 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21552 remote targets.
21553
21554 @item show serial baud
21555 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21556
21557 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21558 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21559 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21560
21561 @item show serial parity
21562 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21563
21564 @item set remotebreak
21565 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21566 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21567 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21568 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21569 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21570 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21571 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21572 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21573
21574 @item show remotebreak
21575 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21576 interrupt the remote program.
21577
21578 @item set remoteflow on
21579 @itemx set remoteflow off
21580 @kindex set remoteflow
21581 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21582 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21583
21584 @item show remoteflow
21585 @kindex show remoteflow
21586 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21587
21588 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21589 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21590 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21591 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21592 @code{ascii}.
21593
21594 @item show remotelogbase
21595 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21596 protocol.
21597
21598 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21599 @cindex record serial communications on file
21600 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21601 default is not to record at all.
21602
21603 @item show remotelogfile.
21604 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21605 serial communications.
21606
21607 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21608 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21609 @cindex remote timeout
21610 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21611 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21612
21613 @item show remotetimeout
21614 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21615 responses.
21616
21617 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21618 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21619 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21620 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21621 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21622 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21623 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21624 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21625 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21626 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21627
21628 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21629 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21630 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21631 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21632
21633 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21634 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21635 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21636 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21637 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21638 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21639 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21640 length.
21641
21642 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21643 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21644 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21645
21646 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21647 @itemx show remote exec-file
21648 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21649 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21650 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21651 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21652 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21653 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21654
21655 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21656 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21657 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21658 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21659 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21660 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21661 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21662 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21663 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21664 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21665
21666 @item show interrupt-sequence
21667 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21668 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21669 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21670 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21671
21672 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21673 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21674 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21675 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21676 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21677 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21678
21679 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21680 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21681 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21682
21683 @kindex set tcp
21684 @kindex show tcp
21685 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21686 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21687 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21688 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21689 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21690 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21691 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21692 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21693 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21694
21695 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21696 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21697
21698 @item show tcp auto-retry
21699 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21700
21701 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21702 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21703 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21704 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21705 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21706 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21707 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21708 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21709 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21710 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21711 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21712
21713 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21714 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21715 @end table
21716
21717 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21718 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21719 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21720 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21721 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21722 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21723 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21724 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21725 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21726
21727 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21728 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21729 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21730 @value{GDBN} developers.
21731
21732 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21733 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21734 are:
21735
21736 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21737 @item Command Name
21738 @tab Remote Packet
21739 @tab Related Features
21740
21741 @item @code{fetch-register}
21742 @tab @code{p}
21743 @tab @code{info registers}
21744
21745 @item @code{set-register}
21746 @tab @code{P}
21747 @tab @code{set}
21748
21749 @item @code{binary-download}
21750 @tab @code{X}
21751 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21752
21753 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21754 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21755 @tab @code{info auxv}
21756
21757 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21758 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21759 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21760
21761 @item @code{attach}
21762 @tab @code{vAttach}
21763 @tab @code{attach}
21764
21765 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21766 @tab @code{vCont}
21767 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21768
21769 @item @code{run}
21770 @tab @code{vRun}
21771 @tab @code{run}
21772
21773 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21774 @tab @code{Z0}
21775 @tab @code{break}
21776
21777 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21778 @tab @code{Z1}
21779 @tab @code{hbreak}
21780
21781 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21782 @tab @code{Z2}
21783 @tab @code{watch}
21784
21785 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21786 @tab @code{Z3}
21787 @tab @code{rwatch}
21788
21789 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21790 @tab @code{Z4}
21791 @tab @code{awatch}
21792
21793 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21794 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21795 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21796
21797 @item @code{target-features}
21798 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21799 @tab @code{set architecture}
21800
21801 @item @code{library-info}
21802 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21803 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21804
21805 @item @code{memory-map}
21806 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21807 @tab @code{info mem}
21808
21809 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21810 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21811 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21812
21813 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21814 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21815 @tab @code{info spu}
21816
21817 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21818 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21819 @tab @code{info spu}
21820
21821 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21822 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21823 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21824
21825 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21826 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21827 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21828
21829 @item @code{threads}
21830 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21831 @tab @code{info threads}
21832
21833 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21834 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21835 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21836
21837 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21838 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21839 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21840
21841 @item @code{search-memory}
21842 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21843 @tab @code{find}
21844
21845 @item @code{supported-packets}
21846 @tab @code{qSupported}
21847 @tab Remote communications parameters
21848
21849 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21850 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21851 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21852
21853 @item @code{pass-signals}
21854 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21855 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21856
21857 @item @code{program-signals}
21858 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21859 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21860
21861 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21862 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21863 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21864
21865 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21866 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21867 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21868
21869 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21870 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21871 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21872
21873 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21874 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21875 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21876
21877 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21878 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21879 @tab @code{remote delete}
21880
21881 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21882 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21883 @tab Host I/O
21884
21885 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21886 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21887 @tab Host I/O
21888
21889 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21890 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21891 @tab Host I/O
21892
21893 @item @code{noack-packet}
21894 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21895 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21896
21897 @item @code{osdata}
21898 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21899 @tab @code{info os}
21900
21901 @item @code{query-attached}
21902 @tab @code{qAttached}
21903 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21904
21905 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21906 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21907 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21908
21909 @item @code{trace-status}
21910 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21911 @tab @code{tstatus}
21912
21913 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21914 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21915 @tab Traceframe info
21916
21917 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21918 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21919 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21920
21921 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21922 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21923 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21924
21925 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21926 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21927 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21928
21929 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21930 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21931 @tab @code{set environment}
21932
21933 @item @code{environment-unset}
21934 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21935 @tab @code{unset environment}
21936
21937 @item @code{environment-reset}
21938 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21939 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21940
21941 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21942 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21943 @tab @code{set cwd}
21944
21945 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21946 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21947 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21948
21949 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21950 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21951 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21952
21953 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21954 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21955 @tab @code{break}
21956
21957 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21958 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21959 @tab @code{hbreak}
21960
21961 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21962 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21963 @tab @code{fork}
21964
21965 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21966 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21967 @tab @code{vfork}
21968
21969 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21970 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21971 @tab @code{exec}
21972
21973 @item @code{thread-events}
21974 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21975 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21976
21977 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21978 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21979 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21980
21981 @end multitable
21982
21983 @node Remote Stub
21984 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21985
21986 @cindex debugging stub, example
21987 @cindex remote stub, example
21988 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21989 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21990 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21991 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21992 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21993 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21994 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21995 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21996
21997 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21998 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21999 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22000 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22001 program, you need:
22002
22003 @enumerate
22004 @item
22005 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22006 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22007 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22008
22009 @item
22010 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22011 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22012
22013 @item
22014 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22015 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22016 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22017 documentation.
22018 @end enumerate
22019
22020 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22021 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22022 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22023
22024 @table @emph
22025 @item On the host,
22026 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22027 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22028 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22029
22030 @item On the target,
22031 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22032 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22033 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22034
22035 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22036 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22037 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22038 @end table
22039
22040 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22041 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22042 @sc{sparc} boards.
22043
22044 @cindex remote serial stub list
22045 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22046
22047 @table @code
22048
22049 @item i386-stub.c
22050 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22051 @cindex Intel
22052 @cindex i386
22053 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22054
22055 @item m68k-stub.c
22056 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22057 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22058 @cindex m680x0
22059 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22060
22061 @item sh-stub.c
22062 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22063 @cindex Renesas
22064 @cindex SH
22065 For Renesas SH architectures.
22066
22067 @item sparc-stub.c
22068 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22069 @cindex Sparc
22070 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22071
22072 @item sparcl-stub.c
22073 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22074 @cindex Fujitsu
22075 @cindex SparcLite
22076 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22077
22078 @end table
22079
22080 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22081 recently added stubs.
22082
22083 @menu
22084 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22085 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22086 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22087 @end menu
22088
22089 @node Stub Contents
22090 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22091
22092 @cindex remote serial stub
22093 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22094 subroutines:
22095
22096 @table @code
22097 @item set_debug_traps
22098 @findex set_debug_traps
22099 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22100 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22101 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22102 program's startup code.
22103
22104 @item handle_exception
22105 @findex handle_exception
22106 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22107 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22108 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22109 run when a trap is triggered.
22110
22111 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22112 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22113 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22114 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22115 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22116 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22117 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22118 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22119 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22120 machine.
22121
22122 @item breakpoint
22123 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22124 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22125 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22126 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22127 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22128 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22129 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22130 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22131 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22132 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22133 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22134
22135 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22136 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22137 start of your debugging session.
22138 @end table
22139
22140 @node Bootstrapping
22141 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22142
22143 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22144 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22145 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22146 debugging target machine.
22147
22148 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22149 serial port.
22150
22151 @table @code
22152 @item int getDebugChar()
22153 @findex getDebugChar
22154 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22155 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22156 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22157
22158 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22159 @findex putDebugChar
22160 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22161 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22162 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22163 @end table
22164
22165 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22166 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22167 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22168 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22169 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22170 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22171 remote system to stop.
22172
22173 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22174 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22175 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22176 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22177
22178 Other routines you need to supply are:
22179
22180 @table @code
22181 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22182 @findex exceptionHandler
22183 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22184 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22185 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22186 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22187 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22188 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22189 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22190 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22191 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22192 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22193 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22194 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22195 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22196
22197 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22198 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22199 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22200 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22201 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22202
22203 @item void flush_i_cache()
22204 @findex flush_i_cache
22205 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22206 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22207 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22208
22209 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22210 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22211 @end table
22212
22213 @noindent
22214 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22215
22216 @table @code
22217 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22218 @findex memset
22219 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22220 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22221 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22222 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22223 @end table
22224
22225 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22226 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22227 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22228 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22229
22230
22231 @node Debug Session
22232 @subsection Putting it All Together
22233
22234 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22235 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22236 steps.
22237
22238 @enumerate
22239 @item
22240 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22241 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22242 @display
22243 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22244 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22245 @end display
22246
22247 @item
22248 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22249 procedure is called:
22250
22251 @smallexample
22252 set_debug_traps();
22253 breakpoint();
22254 @end smallexample
22255
22256 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22257 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22258 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22259 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22260 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22261 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22262 progress.
22263
22264 @item
22265 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22266 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22267
22268 @smallexample
22269 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22270 @end smallexample
22271
22272 @noindent
22273 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22274 function in your program, that function is called when
22275 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22276 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22277 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22278
22279 @item
22280 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22281 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22282
22283 @item
22284 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22285 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22286
22287 @item
22288 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22289 @c document that. FIXME.
22290 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22291 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22292
22293 @item
22294 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22295 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22296
22297 @end enumerate
22298
22299 @node Configurations
22300 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22301
22302 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22303 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22304 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22305
22306 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22307 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22308 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22309 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22310 are quite different from each other.
22311
22312 @menu
22313 * Native::
22314 * Embedded OS::
22315 * Embedded Processors::
22316 * Architectures::
22317 @end menu
22318
22319 @node Native
22320 @section Native
22321
22322 This section describes details specific to particular native
22323 configurations.
22324
22325 @menu
22326 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22327 * Process Information:: Process information
22328 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22329 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22330 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22331 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22332 @end menu
22333
22334 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22335 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22336
22337 @cindex libkvm
22338 @cindex kernel memory image
22339 @cindex kernel crash dump
22340
22341 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22342 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22343 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22344 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22345 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22346 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22347 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22348 @code{kvm} target:
22349
22350 @smallexample
22351 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22352 @end smallexample
22353
22354 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22355 argument:
22356
22357 @smallexample
22358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22359 @end smallexample
22360
22361 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22362 available:
22363
22364 @table @code
22365 @kindex kvm
22366 @item kvm pcb
22367 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22368
22369 @item kvm proc
22370 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22371 modern FreeBSD systems.
22372 @end table
22373
22374 @node Process Information
22375 @subsection Process Information
22376 @cindex /proc
22377 @cindex examine process image
22378 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22379
22380 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22381 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22382 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22383 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22384 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22385 any process running on your system.
22386
22387 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22388 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22389 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22390 systems.
22391
22392 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22393 information.
22394
22395 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22396 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22397 information available from a live process. Process information is
22398 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22399 systems.
22400
22401 @table @code
22402 @kindex info proc
22403 @cindex process ID
22404 @item info proc
22405 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22406 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22407 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22408 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22409 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22410 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22411 executable file's absolute file name.
22412
22413 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22414 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22415 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22416 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22417 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22418 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22419
22420 @item info proc cmdline
22421 @cindex info proc cmdline
22422 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22423 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22424
22425 @item info proc cwd
22426 @cindex info proc cwd
22427 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22428 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22429
22430 @item info proc exe
22431 @cindex info proc exe
22432 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22433 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22434
22435 @item info proc files
22436 @cindex info proc files
22437 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22438 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22439 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22440 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22441 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22442 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22443 FreeBSD.
22444
22445 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22446 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22447
22448 @smallexample
22449 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22450 process 22136
22451 Open files:
22452
22453 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22454 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22455 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22456 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22457 root dir - r-------- /
22458 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22459 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22460 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22461 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22462 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22463 @end smallexample
22464
22465 @item info proc mappings
22466 @cindex memory address space mappings
22467 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22468 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22469 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22470 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22471 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22472
22473 @item info proc stat
22474 @itemx info proc status
22475 @cindex process detailed status information
22476 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22477 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22478 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22479 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22480 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22481
22482 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22483 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22484
22485 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22486 proc status}.
22487
22488 @item info proc all
22489 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22490 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22491
22492 @ignore
22493 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22494 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22495 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22496 @kindex info proc times
22497 @item info proc times
22498 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22499 its children.
22500
22501 @kindex info proc id
22502 @item info proc id
22503 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22504 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22505 @end ignore
22506
22507 @item set procfs-trace
22508 @kindex set procfs-trace
22509 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22510 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22511
22512 @item show procfs-trace
22513 @kindex show procfs-trace
22514 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22515
22516 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22517 @kindex set procfs-file
22518 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22519 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22520 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22521 standard output.
22522
22523 @item show procfs-file
22524 @kindex show procfs-file
22525 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22526
22527 @item proc-trace-entry
22528 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22529 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22530 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22531 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22532 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22533 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22534 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22535 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22536 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22537
22538 @item info pidlist
22539 @kindex info pidlist
22540 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22541 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22542 processes and all the threads within each process.
22543
22544 @item info meminfo
22545 @kindex info meminfo
22546 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22547 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22548 @end table
22549
22550 @node DJGPP Native
22551 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22552 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22553 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22554 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22555
22556 @cindex DPMI
22557 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22558 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22559 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22560 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22561
22562 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22563 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22564 subsection describes those commands.
22565
22566 @table @code
22567 @kindex info dos
22568 @item info dos
22569 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22570 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22571
22572 @kindex sysinfo
22573 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22574 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22575 @item info dos sysinfo
22576 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22577 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22578 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22579
22580 @cindex GDT
22581 @cindex LDT
22582 @cindex IDT
22583 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22584 @cindex descriptor tables display
22585 @item info dos gdt
22586 @itemx info dos ldt
22587 @itemx info dos idt
22588 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22589 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22590 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22591 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22592 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22593 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22594 rights.
22595
22596 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22597 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22598 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22599 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22600 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22601
22602 @cindex garbled pointers
22603 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22604 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22605 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22606 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22607 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22608 debugged program's data segment:
22609
22610 @smallexample
22611 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22612 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22613 @end smallexample
22614
22615 @noindent
22616 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22617 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22618
22619 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22620 @item info dos pde
22621 @itemx info dos pte
22622 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22623 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22624 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22625 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22626 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22627 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22628 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22629 that is currently in use.
22630
22631 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22632 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22633 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22634 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22635 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22636 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22637 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22638
22639 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22640 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22641 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22642 controller.
22643
22644 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22645
22646 @cindex physical address from linear address
22647 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22648 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22649 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22650 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22651 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22652 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22653 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22654
22655 @smallexample
22656 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22657 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22658 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22659 @end smallexample
22660
22661 @noindent
22662 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22663 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22664 attributes of that page.
22665
22666 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22667 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22668 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22669 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22670 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22671 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22672
22673 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22674 transfer buffer:
22675
22676 @smallexample
22677 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22678 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22679 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22680 @end smallexample
22681
22682 @noindent
22683 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22684 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22685 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22686 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22687 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22688
22689 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22690 @end table
22691
22692 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22693 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22694 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22695 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22696
22697 @table @code
22698 @kindex set com1base
22699 @kindex set com1irq
22700 @kindex set com2base
22701 @kindex set com2irq
22702 @kindex set com3base
22703 @kindex set com3irq
22704 @kindex set com4base
22705 @kindex set com4irq
22706 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22707 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22708 port.
22709
22710 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22711 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22712 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22713
22714 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22715 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22716 other 3 COM ports.
22717
22718 @kindex show com1base
22719 @kindex show com1irq
22720 @kindex show com2base
22721 @kindex show com2irq
22722 @kindex show com3base
22723 @kindex show com3irq
22724 @kindex show com4base
22725 @kindex show com4irq
22726 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22727 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22728 lines used by the COM ports.
22729
22730 @item info serial
22731 @kindex info serial
22732 @cindex DOS serial port status
22733 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22734 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22735 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22736 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22737 @end table
22738
22739
22740 @node Cygwin Native
22741 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22742 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22743 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22744 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22745
22746 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22747 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22748
22749 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22750 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22751 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22752 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22753 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22754 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22755 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22756 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22757
22758 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22759 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22760 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22761
22762 @table @code
22763 @kindex info w32
22764 @item info w32
22765 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22766 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22767
22768 @item info w32 selector
22769 This command displays information returned by
22770 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22771 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22772 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22773 Without argument, this command displays information
22774 about the six segment registers.
22775
22776 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22777 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22778 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22779 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22780
22781 @kindex signal-event
22782 @item signal-event @var{id}
22783 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22784 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22785
22786 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22787 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22788 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22789 (for x86_64 versions):
22790
22791 @itemize @minus
22792 @item
22793 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22794 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22795 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22796
22797 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22798 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22799 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22800 to attach.
22801
22802 @item
22803 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22804 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22805 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22806 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22807 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22808 @end itemize
22809
22810 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22811 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22812 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22813 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22814 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22815 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22816 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22817 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22818 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22819 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22820 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22821
22822 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22823 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22824 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22825 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22826
22827 @kindex set new-console
22828 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22829 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22830 be started in a new console on next start.
22831 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22832 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22833
22834 @kindex show new-console
22835 @item show new-console
22836 Displays whether a new console is used
22837 when the debuggee is started.
22838
22839 @kindex set new-group
22840 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22841 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22842 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22843 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22844 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22845
22846 @kindex show new-group
22847 @item show new-group
22848 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22849
22850 @kindex set debugevents
22851 @item set debugevents
22852 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22853 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22854 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22855 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22856 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22857
22858 @kindex set debugexec
22859 @item set debugexec
22860 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22861 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22862
22863 @kindex set debugexceptions
22864 @item set debugexceptions
22865 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22866 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22867
22868 @kindex set debugmemory
22869 @item set debugmemory
22870 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22871 and writes by the debugger.
22872
22873 @kindex set shell
22874 @item set shell
22875 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22876 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22877
22878 @kindex show shell
22879 @item show shell
22880 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22881
22882 @end table
22883
22884 @menu
22885 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22886 @end menu
22887
22888 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22889 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22890 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22891 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22892
22893 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22894 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22895 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22896 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22897 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22898 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22899 ``minimal symbols''.
22900
22901 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22902 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22903 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22904 program run once to completion.
22905
22906 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22907
22908 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22909 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22910 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22911 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22912 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22913 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22914 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22915 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22916 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22917
22918 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22919 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22920 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22921 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22922 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22923 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22924
22925 @smallexample
22926 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22927 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22928
22929 Non-debugging symbols:
22930 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22931 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22932 @end smallexample
22933
22934 @smallexample
22935 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22936 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22937
22938 Non-debugging symbols:
22939 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22940 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22941 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22942 [etc...]
22943 @end smallexample
22944
22945 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22946
22947 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22948 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22949 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22950 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22951 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22952 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22953 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22954
22955 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22956 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22957 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22958 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22959 problem:
22960
22961 @smallexample
22962 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22963 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22964 @end smallexample
22965
22966 @smallexample
22967 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22968 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22969 @end smallexample
22970
22971 And two possible solutions:
22972
22973 @smallexample
22974 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22975 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22976 @end smallexample
22977
22978 @smallexample
22979 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22980 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22981 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22982 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22983 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22984 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22985 @end smallexample
22986
22987 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22988 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22989 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22990 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22991 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22992
22993 @smallexample
22994 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22995 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22996 @end smallexample
22997
22998 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22999 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23000 safe.
23001
23002 @node Hurd Native
23003 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23004 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23005
23006 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23007 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23008
23009 @table @code
23010 @item set signals
23011 @itemx set sigs
23012 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23013 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23014 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23015 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23016 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23017 @code{signals}.
23018
23019 @item show signals
23020 @itemx show sigs
23021 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23022 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23023 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23024
23025 @item set signal-thread
23026 @itemx set sigthread
23027 @kindex set signal-thread
23028 @kindex set sigthread
23029 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23030 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23031 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23032 signal-thread}.
23033
23034 @item show signal-thread
23035 @itemx show sigthread
23036 @kindex show signal-thread
23037 @kindex show sigthread
23038 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23039 delivered a signal.
23040
23041 @item set stopped
23042 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23043 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23044 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23045 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23046
23047 @item show stopped
23048 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23049 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23050 stopped.
23051
23052 @item set exceptions
23053 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23054 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23055 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23056 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23057 trapping on.
23058
23059 @item show exceptions
23060 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23061 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23062
23063 @item set task pause
23064 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23065 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23066 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23067 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23068 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23069 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23070 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23071 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23072 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23073
23074 @item show task pause
23075 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23076 Show the current state of task suspension.
23077
23078 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23079 @cindex task suspend count
23080 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23081 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23082 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23083
23084 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23085 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23086
23087 @item set task exception-port
23088 @itemx set task excp
23089 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23090 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23091 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23092 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23093
23094 @item set noninvasive
23095 @cindex noninvasive task options
23096 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23097 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23098 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23099 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23100
23101 @item info send-rights
23102 @itemx info receive-rights
23103 @itemx info port-rights
23104 @itemx info port-sets
23105 @itemx info dead-names
23106 @itemx info ports
23107 @itemx info psets
23108 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23109 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23110 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23111 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23112 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23113 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23114 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23115 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23116 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23117
23118 @item set thread pause
23119 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23120 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23121 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23122 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23123 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23124 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23125 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23126 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23127 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23128 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23129 only the current thread.
23130
23131 @item show thread pause
23132 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23133 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23134
23135 @item set thread run
23136 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23137
23138 @item show thread run
23139 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23140
23141 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23142 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23143 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23144 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23145 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23146 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23147 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23148
23149 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23150 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23151 detaching.
23152
23153 @item set thread exception-port
23154 @itemx set thread excp
23155 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23156 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23157 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23158
23159 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23160 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23161 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23162 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23163
23164 @item set thread default
23165 @itemx show thread default
23166 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23167 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23168 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23169 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23170 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23171 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23172 the non-default commands.
23173 @end table
23174
23175 @node Darwin
23176 @subsection Darwin
23177 @cindex Darwin
23178
23179 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23180
23181 @table @code
23182 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23183 @kindex set debug darwin
23184 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23185 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23186
23187 @item show debug darwin
23188 @kindex show debug darwin
23189 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23190
23191 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23192 @kindex set debug mach-o
23193 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23194 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23195 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23196 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23197 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23198 usage.
23199
23200 @item show debug mach-o
23201 @kindex show debug mach-o
23202 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23203
23204 @item set mach-exceptions on
23205 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23206 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23207 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23208 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23209 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23210 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23211
23212 @item show mach-exceptions
23213 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23214 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23215 @end table
23216
23217
23218 @node Embedded OS
23219 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23220
23221 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23222 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23223 architectures.
23224
23225 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23226 various real-time operating systems.
23227
23228 @node Embedded Processors
23229 @section Embedded Processors
23230
23231 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23232 configurations.
23233
23234 @cindex send command to simulator
23235 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23236 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23237
23238 @table @code
23239 @item sim @var{command}
23240 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23241 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23242 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23243 acceptable commands.
23244 @end table
23245
23246
23247 @menu
23248 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23249 * ARM:: ARM
23250 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23251 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23252 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23253 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23254 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23255 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23256 * CRIS:: CRIS
23257 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23258 @end menu
23259
23260 @node ARC
23261 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23262 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23263 @cindex ARC specific commands
23264 @cindex ARC600
23265 @cindex ARC700
23266 @cindex ARC EM
23267 @cindex ARC HS
23268
23269 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23270
23271 @table @code
23272 @item set debug arc
23273 @kindex set debug arc
23274 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23275 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23276
23277 @item show debug arc
23278 @kindex show debug arc
23279 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23280
23281 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23282 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23283 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23284
23285 @end table
23286
23287 @node ARM
23288 @subsection ARM
23289
23290 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23291
23292 @table @code
23293 @item set arm disassembler
23294 @kindex set arm
23295 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23296 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23297
23298 @item show arm disassembler
23299 @kindex show arm
23300 Show the current disassembly style.
23301
23302 @item set arm apcs32
23303 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23304 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23305
23306 @item show arm apcs32
23307 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23308
23309 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23310 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23311 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23312
23313 @table @code
23314 @item auto
23315 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23316 @item softfpa
23317 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23318 processors.
23319 @item fpa
23320 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23321 @item softvfp
23322 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23323 @item vfp
23324 VFP co-processor.
23325 @end table
23326
23327 @item show arm fpu
23328 Show the current type of the FPU.
23329
23330 @item set arm abi
23331 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23332
23333 @item show arm abi
23334 Show the currently used ABI.
23335
23336 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23337 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23338 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23339 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23340 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23341 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23342 register).
23343
23344 @item show arm fallback-mode
23345 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23346
23347 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23348 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23349 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23350 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23351 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23352
23353 @item show arm force-mode
23354 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23355
23356 @item set debug arm
23357 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23358 target support subsystem.
23359
23360 @item show debug arm
23361 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23362 @end table
23363
23364 @table @code
23365 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23366 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23367
23368 @table @code
23369 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23370 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23371 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23372 The default value is @code{all}.
23373
23374 @table @code
23375 @item none
23376 @item demon
23377 @item angel
23378 @item redboot
23379 @item all
23380 @end table
23381 @end table
23382 @end table
23383
23384 @node M68K
23385 @subsection M68k
23386
23387 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23388
23389 @node MicroBlaze
23390 @subsection MicroBlaze
23391 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23392 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23393
23394 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23395 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23396 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23397 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23398 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23399 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23400 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23401 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23402 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23403 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23404 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23405
23406 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23407
23408 @table @code
23409 @item target remote :1234
23410 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23411 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23412
23413 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23414 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23415 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23416
23417 @item load
23418 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23419
23420 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23421 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23422
23423 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23424 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23425 @end table
23426
23427 @node MIPS Embedded
23428 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23429
23430 @noindent
23431 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23432
23433 @table @code
23434 @item set mipsfpu double
23435 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23436 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23437 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23438 @itemx show mipsfpu
23439 @kindex set mipsfpu
23440 @kindex show mipsfpu
23441 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23442 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23443 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23444 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23445 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23446 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23447 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23448 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23449 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23450 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23451 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23452 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23453 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23454
23455 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23456 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23457 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23458
23459 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23460 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23461 @end table
23462
23463 @node OpenRISC 1000
23464 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23465 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23466
23467 @noindent
23468 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23469 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23470 FPGA's.
23471
23472 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23473 a target:
23474
23475 @table @code
23476
23477 @kindex target sim
23478 @item target sim
23479
23480 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23481 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23482 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23483 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23484
23485 Example: @code{target sim}
23486
23487 @item set debug or1k
23488 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23489 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23490
23491 @item show debug or1k
23492 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23493 @end table
23494
23495 @node PowerPC Embedded
23496 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23497
23498 @cindex DVC register
23499 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23500 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23501
23502 @smallexample
23503 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23504 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23505 @end smallexample
23506
23507 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23508 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23509 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23510 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23511 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23512 or newer.
23513
23514 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23515 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23516 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23517 watching variables of scalar types.
23518
23519 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23520 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23521
23522 @smallexample
23523 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23524 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23525 @end smallexample
23526
23527 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23528 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23529
23530 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23531 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23532 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23533 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23534 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23535 use the @code{break-range} command.
23536
23537 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23538
23539 @table @code
23540 @kindex break-range
23541 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23542 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23543 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23544 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23545 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23546 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23547 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23548 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23549 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23550
23551 @kindex set powerpc
23552 @item set powerpc soft-float
23553 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23554 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23555 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23556 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23557
23558 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23559 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23560 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23561 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23562 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23563 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23564 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23565 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23566
23567 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23568 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23569 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23570 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23571 address of its first byte.
23572
23573 @end table
23574
23575 @node AVR
23576 @subsection Atmel AVR
23577 @cindex AVR
23578
23579 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23580 following AVR-specific commands:
23581
23582 @table @code
23583 @item info io_registers
23584 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23585 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23586 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23587 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23588 @end table
23589
23590 @node CRIS
23591 @subsection CRIS
23592 @cindex CRIS
23593
23594 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23595 following CRIS-specific commands:
23596
23597 @table @code
23598 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23599 @cindex CRIS version
23600 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23601 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23602 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23603
23604 @item show cris-version
23605 Show the current CRIS version.
23606
23607 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23608 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23609 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23610 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23611 @code{R59}.
23612
23613 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23614 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23615
23616 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23617 @cindex CRIS mode
23618 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23619 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23620 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23621
23622 @item show cris-mode
23623 Show the current CRIS mode.
23624 @end table
23625
23626 @node Super-H
23627 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23628 @cindex Super-H
23629
23630 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23631 commands:
23632
23633 @table @code
23634 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23635 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23636 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23637 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23638 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23639 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23640 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23641 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23642 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23643 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23644 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23645 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23646
23647 @item show sh calling-convention
23648 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23649 Show the current calling convention setting.
23650
23651 @end table
23652
23653
23654 @node Architectures
23655 @section Architectures
23656
23657 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23658 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23659
23660 @menu
23661 * AArch64::
23662 * i386::
23663 * Alpha::
23664 * MIPS::
23665 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23666 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23667 * PowerPC::
23668 * Nios II::
23669 * Sparc64::
23670 * S12Z::
23671 @end menu
23672
23673 @node AArch64
23674 @subsection AArch64
23675 @cindex AArch64 support
23676
23677 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23678 following special commands:
23679
23680 @table @code
23681 @item set debug aarch64
23682 @kindex set debug aarch64
23683 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23684 messages are to be displayed.
23685
23686 @item show debug aarch64
23687 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23688
23689 @end table
23690
23691 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23692 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23693
23694 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23695 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23696 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23697 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23698 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23699 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23700
23701 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23702 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23703 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23704 target process.
23705
23706
23707 @node i386
23708 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23709
23710 @table @code
23711 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23712 @kindex set struct-convention
23713 @cindex struct return convention
23714 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23715 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23716 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23717 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23718 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23719 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23720 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23721 be returned in a register.
23722
23723 @item show struct-convention
23724 @kindex show struct-convention
23725 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23726 from functions.
23727 @end table
23728
23729
23730 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23731 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23732
23733 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23734 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23735 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23736 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23737 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23738 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23739 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23740
23741 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23742 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23743 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23744 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23745 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23746 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23747
23748 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23749 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23750 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23751
23752 @smallexample
23753 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23754 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23755 @end smallexample
23756
23757 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23758 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23759 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23760 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23761 the pointer.
23762
23763 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23764 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23765 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23766 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23767 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23768
23769 @table @code
23770 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23771 @kindex show mpx bound
23772 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23773
23774 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23775 @kindex set mpx bound
23776 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23777 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23778 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23779 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23780 @end table
23781
23782 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23783 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23784 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23785 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23786
23787 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23788 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23789 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23790 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23791 function.
23792
23793 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23794 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23795 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23796 continuing the execution. For example:
23797
23798 @smallexample
23799 $ break *upper
23800 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23801 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23802 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23803 $ print $bnd0
23804 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23805 @end smallexample
23806
23807 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23808 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23809 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23810
23811 @node Alpha
23812 @subsection Alpha
23813
23814 See the following section.
23815
23816 @node MIPS
23817 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23818
23819 @cindex stack on Alpha
23820 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23821 @cindex Alpha stack
23822 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23823 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23824 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23825 find the beginning of a function.
23826
23827 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23828 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23829 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23830 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23831 commands:
23832
23833 @table @code
23834 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23835 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23836 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23837 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23838 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23839 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23840 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23841 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23842
23843 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23844 Display the current limit.
23845 @end table
23846
23847 @noindent
23848 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23849 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23850
23851 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23852 programs:
23853
23854 @table @code
23855 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23856 @kindex set mips abi
23857 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23858 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23859 values of @var{arg} are:
23860
23861 @table @samp
23862 @item auto
23863 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23864 default).
23865 @item o32
23866 @item o64
23867 @item n32
23868 @item n64
23869 @item eabi32
23870 @item eabi64
23871 @end table
23872
23873 @item show mips abi
23874 @kindex show mips abi
23875 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23876
23877 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23878 @kindex set mips compression
23879 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23880 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23881 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23882 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23883 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23884 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23885 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23886 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23887 provided by the executable.
23888
23889 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23890 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23891 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23892 identified as such.
23893
23894 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23895 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23896 implicitly from an executable.
23897
23898 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23899 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23900 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23901 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23902 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23903
23904 @item show mips compression
23905 @kindex show mips compression
23906 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23907 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23908
23909 @item set mipsfpu
23910 @itemx show mipsfpu
23911 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23912
23913 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23914 @kindex set mips mask-address
23915 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23916 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23917 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23918 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23919 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23920
23921 @item show mips mask-address
23922 @kindex show mips mask-address
23923 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23924 not.
23925
23926 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23927 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23928 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23929 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23930 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23931 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23932
23933 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23934 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23935 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23936
23937 @item set debug mips
23938 @kindex set debug mips
23939 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23940 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23941
23942 @item show debug mips
23943 @kindex show debug mips
23944 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23945 @end table
23946
23947
23948 @node HPPA
23949 @subsection HPPA
23950 @cindex HPPA support
23951
23952 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23953 following special commands:
23954
23955 @table @code
23956 @item set debug hppa
23957 @kindex set debug hppa
23958 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23959 messages are to be displayed.
23960
23961 @item show debug hppa
23962 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23963
23964 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23965 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23966 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23967 given @var{address}.
23968
23969 @end table
23970
23971
23972 @node SPU
23973 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23974 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23975 @cindex SPU
23976
23977 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23978 it provides the following special commands:
23979
23980 @table @code
23981 @item info spu event
23982 @kindex info spu
23983 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23984 and pending event status.
23985
23986 @item info spu signal
23987 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23988 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23989 notification channels.
23990
23991 @item info spu mailbox
23992 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23993 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23994 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23995
23996 @item info spu dma
23997 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23998 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23999 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24000
24001 @item info spu proxydma
24002 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24003 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24004 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24005
24006 @end table
24007
24008 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24009 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24010 special commands:
24011
24012 @table @code
24013 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24014 @kindex set spu
24015 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24016 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24017 function. The default is @code{off}.
24018
24019 @item show spu stop-on-load
24020 @kindex show spu
24021 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24022
24023 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24024 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24025 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24026 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24027 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24028 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24029
24030 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24031 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24032
24033 @end table
24034
24035 @node PowerPC
24036 @subsection PowerPC
24037 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24038
24039 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24040 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24041 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24042 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24043 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24044
24045 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24046 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24047 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24048
24049 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24050 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24051
24052 @node Nios II
24053 @subsection Nios II
24054 @cindex Nios II architecture
24055
24056 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24057 it provides the following special commands:
24058
24059 @table @code
24060
24061 @item set debug nios2
24062 @kindex set debug nios2
24063 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24064 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24065
24066 @item show debug nios2
24067 @kindex show debug nios2
24068 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24069 @end table
24070
24071 @node Sparc64
24072 @subsection Sparc64
24073 @cindex Sparc64 support
24074 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24075 @subsubsection ADI Support
24076
24077 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24078 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24079 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24080 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24081 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24082 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24083 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24084 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24085 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24086 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24087 signal.
24088
24089 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24090 ADI-enabled.
24091
24092 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24093 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24094
24095
24096 @table @code
24097 @kindex adi examine
24098 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24099
24100 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24101 cacheline.
24102
24103 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24104 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24105 block size, to display.
24106
24107 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24108 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24109
24110 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24111
24112 @smallexample
24113 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24114 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24115 @end smallexample
24116
24117 @kindex adi assign
24118 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24119
24120 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24121 to an address.
24122
24123 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24124 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24125 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24126
24127 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24128 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24129
24130 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24131
24132 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24133 variable "shmaddr":
24134
24135 @smallexample
24136 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24137 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24138 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24139 @end smallexample
24140
24141 @end table
24142
24143 @node S12Z
24144 @subsection S12Z
24145 @cindex S12Z support
24146
24147 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24148 it provides the following special command:
24149
24150 @table @code
24151 @item maint info bdccsr
24152 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24153 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24154 BDCCSR register.
24155 @end table
24156
24157
24158 @node Controlling GDB
24159 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24160
24161 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24162 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24163 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24164 described here.
24165
24166 @menu
24167 * Prompt:: Prompt
24168 * Editing:: Command editing
24169 * Command History:: Command history
24170 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24171 * Numbers:: Numbers
24172 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24173 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24174 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24175 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24176 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24177 @end menu
24178
24179 @node Prompt
24180 @section Prompt
24181
24182 @cindex prompt
24183
24184 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24185 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24186 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24187 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24188 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24189 which one you are talking to.
24190
24191 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24192 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24193 or a prompt that does not.
24194
24195 @table @code
24196 @kindex set prompt
24197 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24198 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24199
24200 @kindex show prompt
24201 @item show prompt
24202 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24203 @end table
24204
24205 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24206 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24207 are:
24208
24209 @table @code
24210 @kindex set extended-prompt
24211 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24212 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24213 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24214 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24215 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24216 is displayed.
24217
24218 For example:
24219
24220 @smallexample
24221 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24222 @end smallexample
24223
24224 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24225 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24226
24227 @kindex show extended-prompt
24228 @item show extended-prompt
24229 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24230 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24231 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24232 @end table
24233
24234 @node Editing
24235 @section Command Editing
24236 @cindex readline
24237 @cindex command line editing
24238
24239 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24240 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24241 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24242 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24243 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24244 debugging sessions.
24245
24246 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24247 command @code{set}.
24248
24249 @table @code
24250 @kindex set editing
24251 @cindex editing
24252 @item set editing
24253 @itemx set editing on
24254 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24255
24256 @item set editing off
24257 Disable command line editing.
24258
24259 @kindex show editing
24260 @item show editing
24261 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24262 @end table
24263
24264 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24265 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24266 @end ifset
24267 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24268 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24269 @end ifclear
24270 for more details about the Readline
24271 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24272 encouraged to read that chapter.
24273
24274 @node Command History
24275 @section Command History
24276 @cindex command history
24277
24278 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24279 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24280 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24281 history facility.
24282
24283 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24284 package, to provide the history facility.
24285 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24286 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24287 @end ifset
24288 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24289 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24290 @end ifclear
24291 for the detailed description of the History library.
24292
24293 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24294 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24295 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24296 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24297 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24298 pressed on a line by itself.
24299
24300 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24301 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24302 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24303 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24304
24305 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24306 history.
24307
24308 @table @code
24309 @cindex history substitution
24310 @cindex history file
24311 @kindex set history filename
24312 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24313 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24314 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24315 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24316 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24317 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24318 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24319 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24320 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24321 is not set.
24322
24323 @cindex save command history
24324 @kindex set history save
24325 @item set history save
24326 @itemx set history save on
24327 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24328 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24329
24330 @item set history save off
24331 Stop recording command history in a file.
24332
24333 @cindex history size
24334 @kindex set history size
24335 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24336 @item set history size @var{size}
24337 @itemx set history size unlimited
24338 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24339 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24340 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24341 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24342 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24343 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24344
24345 @cindex remove duplicate history
24346 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24347 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24348 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24349 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24350 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24351 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24352 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24353 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24354 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24355
24356 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24357 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24358
24359 @end table
24360
24361 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24362 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24363 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24364 @end ifset
24365 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24366 @xref{Event Designators},
24367 @end ifclear
24368 for more details.
24369
24370 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24371 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24372 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24373 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24374 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24375 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24376 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24377 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24378
24379 The commands to control history expansion are:
24380
24381 @table @code
24382 @item set history expansion on
24383 @itemx set history expansion
24384 @kindex set history expansion
24385 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24386
24387 @item set history expansion off
24388 Disable history expansion.
24389
24390 @c @group
24391 @kindex show history
24392 @item show history
24393 @itemx show history filename
24394 @itemx show history save
24395 @itemx show history size
24396 @itemx show history expansion
24397 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24398 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24399 @c @end group
24400 @end table
24401
24402 @table @code
24403 @kindex show commands
24404 @cindex show last commands
24405 @cindex display command history
24406 @item show commands
24407 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24408
24409 @item show commands @var{n}
24410 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24411
24412 @item show commands +
24413 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24414 @end table
24415
24416 @node Screen Size
24417 @section Screen Size
24418 @cindex size of screen
24419 @cindex screen size
24420 @cindex pagination
24421 @cindex page size
24422 @cindex pauses in output
24423
24424 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24425 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24426 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24427 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24428 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24429 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24430 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24431 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24432 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24433 following line.
24434
24435 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24436 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24437 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24438 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24439 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24440 width} commands:
24441
24442 @table @code
24443 @kindex set height
24444 @kindex set width
24445 @kindex show width
24446 @kindex show height
24447 @item set height @var{lpp}
24448 @itemx set height unlimited
24449 @itemx show height
24450 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24451 @itemx set width unlimited
24452 @itemx show width
24453 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24454 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24455 commands display the current settings.
24456
24457 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24458 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24459 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24460 buffer.
24461
24462 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24463 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24464
24465 @item set pagination on
24466 @itemx set pagination off
24467 @kindex set pagination
24468 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24469 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24470 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24471 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24472
24473 @item show pagination
24474 @kindex show pagination
24475 Show the current pagination mode.
24476 @end table
24477
24478 @node Numbers
24479 @section Numbers
24480 @cindex number representation
24481 @cindex entering numbers
24482
24483 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24484 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24485 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24486 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24487 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24488 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24489 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24490 both input and output with the commands described below.
24491
24492 @table @code
24493 @kindex set input-radix
24494 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24495 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24496 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24497 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24498 example, any of
24499
24500 @smallexample
24501 set input-radix 012
24502 set input-radix 10.
24503 set input-radix 0xa
24504 @end smallexample
24505
24506 @noindent
24507 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24508 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24509 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24510 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24511 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24512 change the radix.
24513
24514 @kindex set output-radix
24515 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24516 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24517 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24518 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24519
24520 @kindex show input-radix
24521 @item show input-radix
24522 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24523
24524 @kindex show output-radix
24525 @item show output-radix
24526 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24527
24528 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24529 @itemx show radix
24530 @kindex set radix
24531 @kindex show radix
24532 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24533 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24534 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24535 default value of 10.
24536
24537 @end table
24538
24539 @node ABI
24540 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24541
24542 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24543 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24544 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24545 current ABI.
24546
24547 @cindex OS ABI
24548 @kindex set osabi
24549 @kindex show osabi
24550 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24551
24552 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24553 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24554 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24555 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24556 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24557 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24558 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24559 platform provides.
24560
24561 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24562 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24563 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24564 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24565
24566 @table @code
24567 @item show osabi
24568 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24569
24570 @item set osabi
24571 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24572
24573 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24574 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24575 @end table
24576
24577 @cindex float promotion
24578
24579 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24580 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24581 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24582 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24583 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24584 @code{double} and then passed.
24585
24586 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24587 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24588 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24589
24590 @table @code
24591 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24592 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24593 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24594 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24595 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24596
24597 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24598 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24599 functions.
24600
24601 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24602 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24603 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24604 @end table
24605
24606 @kindex set cp-abi
24607 @kindex show cp-abi
24608 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24609 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24610 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24611 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24612 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24613 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24614 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24615 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24616 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24617 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24618 ``auto''.
24619
24620 @table @code
24621 @item show cp-abi
24622 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24623
24624 @item set cp-abi
24625 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24626
24627 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24628 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24629 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24630 @end table
24631
24632 @node Auto-loading
24633 @section Automatically loading associated files
24634 @cindex auto-loading
24635
24636 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24637 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24638 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24639 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24640 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24641 sources).
24642
24643 @menu
24644 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24645 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24646
24647 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24648 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24649 @end menu
24650
24651 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24652 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24653 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24654
24655 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24656 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24657 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24658
24659 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24660 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24661
24662 @table @code
24663 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24664 @kindex set auto-load off
24665 @item set auto-load off
24666 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24667 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24668 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24669 @smallexample
24670 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24671 @end smallexample
24672
24673 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24674 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24675 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24676 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24677 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24678 @code{set auto-load no}.
24679
24680 @anchor{show auto-load}
24681 @kindex show auto-load
24682 @item show auto-load
24683 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24684 or disabled.
24685
24686 @smallexample
24687 (gdb) show auto-load
24688 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24689 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24690 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24691 is on.
24692 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24693 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24694 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24695 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24696 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24697 @end smallexample
24698
24699 @anchor{info auto-load}
24700 @kindex info auto-load
24701 @item info auto-load
24702 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24703 not.
24704
24705 @smallexample
24706 (gdb) info auto-load
24707 gdb-scripts:
24708 Loaded Script
24709 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24710 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24711 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24712 loaded.
24713 python-scripts:
24714 Loaded Script
24715 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24716 @end smallexample
24717 @end table
24718
24719 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24720
24721 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24722 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24723 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24724 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24725 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24726 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24727 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24728 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24729 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24730 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24731 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24732 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24733 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24734 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24735 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24736 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24737 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24738 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24739 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24740 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24741 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24742 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24743 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24744 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24745 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24746 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24747 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24748 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24749 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24750 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24751 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24752 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24753 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24754 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24755 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24756 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24757 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24758 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24759 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24760 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24761 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24762 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24763 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24764 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24765 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24766 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24767 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24768 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24769 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24770 @end multitable
24771
24772 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24773 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24774 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24775
24776 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24777 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24778 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24779
24780 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24781 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24782
24783 @table @code
24784 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24785 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24786 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24787 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24788 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24789
24790 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24791 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24792 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24793 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24794 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24795
24796 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24797 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24798 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24799 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24800 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24801 @end table
24802
24803 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24804 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24805 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24806
24807 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24808
24809 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24810 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24811
24812 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24813 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24814 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24815 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24816 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24817 library.
24818
24819 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24820 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24821
24822 @table @code
24823 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24824 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24825 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24826 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24827
24828 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24829 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24830 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24831 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24832 enabled or disabled.
24833
24834 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24835 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24836 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24837 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24838 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24839 @end table
24840
24841 @node Auto-loading safe path
24842 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24843 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24844
24845 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24846 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24847 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24848 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24849 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24850
24851 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24852 get loaded:
24853
24854 @smallexample
24855 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24856 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24857 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24858 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24859 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24860 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24861 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24862 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24863 @end smallexample
24864
24865 @noindent
24866 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24867 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24868
24869 @smallexample
24870 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24871 @end smallexample
24872
24873 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24874
24875 @table @code
24876 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24877 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24878 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24879 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24880 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24881 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24882 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24883 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24884 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24885 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24886
24887 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24888 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24889 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24890
24891 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24892 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24893 @item show auto-load safe-path
24894 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24895 scripts.
24896
24897 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24898 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24899 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24900 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24901 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24902 by the host platform path separator in use.
24903 @end table
24904
24905 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24906 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24907 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24908 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24909 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24910
24911 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24912 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24913 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24914 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24915 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24916 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24917 init file in the current directory
24918 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24919
24920 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24921 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24922
24923 @table @asis
24924 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24925 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24926 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24927 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24928
24929 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24930 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24931 @value{GDBN} session.
24932
24933 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24934 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24935 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24936 from trusted sources.
24937
24938 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24939 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24940 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24941 trusted sources.
24942 @end table
24943
24944 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24945 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24946
24947 @table @asis
24948 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24949 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24950
24951 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24952 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24953 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24954 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24955 @end table
24956
24957 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24958 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24959 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24960 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24961 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24962 recommended to be entered.
24963
24964 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24965 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24966 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24967
24968 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24969 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24970 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24971 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24972 be printed.
24973
24974 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24975 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24976 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24977
24978 @smallexample
24979 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24980 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24981 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24982 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24983 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24984 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24985 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24986 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24987 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24988 @end smallexample
24989
24990 @table @code
24991 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24992 @kindex set debug auto-load
24993 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24994 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24995
24996 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24997 @kindex show debug auto-load
24998 @item show debug auto-load
24999 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25000 on or off.
25001 @end table
25002
25003 @node Messages/Warnings
25004 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25005
25006 @cindex verbose operation
25007 @cindex optional warnings
25008 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25009 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25010 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25011 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25012
25013 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25014 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25015 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25016
25017 @table @code
25018 @kindex set verbose
25019 @item set verbose on
25020 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25021
25022 @item set verbose off
25023 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25024
25025 @kindex show verbose
25026 @item show verbose
25027 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25028 @end table
25029
25030 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25031 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25032 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25033 Symbol Files}).
25034
25035 @table @code
25036
25037 @kindex set complaints
25038 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25039 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25040 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25041 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25042 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25043
25044 @kindex show complaints
25045 @item show complaints
25046 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25047
25048 @end table
25049
25050 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25051 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25052 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25053 you try to run a program which is already running:
25054
25055 @smallexample
25056 (@value{GDBP}) run
25057 The program being debugged has been started already.
25058 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25059 @end smallexample
25060
25061 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25062 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25063
25064 @table @code
25065
25066 @kindex set confirm
25067 @cindex flinching
25068 @cindex confirmation
25069 @cindex stupid questions
25070 @item set confirm off
25071 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25072 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25073 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25074
25075 @item set confirm on
25076 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25077
25078 @kindex show confirm
25079 @item show confirm
25080 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25081
25082 @end table
25083
25084 @cindex command tracing
25085 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25086 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25087 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25088 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25089
25090 @table @code
25091 @kindex set trace-commands
25092 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25093 @item set trace-commands on
25094 Enable command tracing.
25095 @item set trace-commands off
25096 Disable command tracing.
25097 @item show trace-commands
25098 Display the current state of command tracing.
25099 @end table
25100
25101 @node Debugging Output
25102 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25103 @cindex optional debugging messages
25104
25105 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25106 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25107 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25108 section documents those commands.
25109
25110 @table @code
25111 @kindex set exec-done-display
25112 @item set exec-done-display
25113 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25114 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25115 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25116 @kindex show exec-done-display
25117 @item show exec-done-display
25118 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25119 notification.
25120 @kindex set debug
25121 @cindex ARM AArch64
25122 @item set debug aarch64
25123 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25124 The default is off.
25125 @kindex show debug
25126 @item show debug aarch64
25127 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25128 ARM AArch64.
25129 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25130 @cindex architecture debugging info
25131 @item set debug arch
25132 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25133 @item show debug arch
25134 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25135 @item set debug aix-solib
25136 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25137 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25138 support module. The default is off.
25139 @item show debug aix-thread
25140 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25141 @item set debug aix-thread
25142 @cindex AIX threads
25143 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25144 module.
25145 @item show debug aix-thread
25146 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25147 @item set debug check-physname
25148 @cindex physname
25149 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25150 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25151 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25152 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25153 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25154 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25155 @item show debug check-physname
25156 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25157 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25158 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25159 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25160 exported symbols. The default is off.
25161 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25162 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25163 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25164 @item set debug dwarf-die
25165 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25166 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25167 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25168 A value of zero turns off the display.
25169 @item show debug dwarf-die
25170 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25171 @item set debug dwarf-line
25172 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25173 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25174 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25175 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25176 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25177 @item show debug dwarf-line
25178 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25179 @item set debug dwarf-read
25180 @cindex DWARF Reading
25181 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25182 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25183 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25184 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25185 @item show debug dwarf-read
25186 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25187 @item set debug displaced
25188 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25189 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25190 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25191 @item show debug displaced
25192 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25193 related to displaced stepping.
25194 @item set debug event
25195 @cindex event debugging info
25196 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25197 default is off.
25198 @item show debug event
25199 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25200 info.
25201 @item set debug expression
25202 @cindex expression debugging info
25203 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25204 expression parsing. The default is off.
25205 @item show debug expression
25206 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25207 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25208 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25209 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25210 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25211 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25212 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25213 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25214 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25215 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25216 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25217 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25218 @item set debug frame
25219 @cindex frame debugging info
25220 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25221 default is off.
25222 @item show debug frame
25223 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25224 info.
25225 @item set debug gnu-nat
25226 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25227 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25228 @item show debug gnu-nat
25229 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25230 @item set debug infrun
25231 @cindex inferior debugging info
25232 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25233 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25234 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25235 @item show debug infrun
25236 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25237 @item set debug jit
25238 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25239 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25240 @item show debug jit
25241 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25242 @item set debug lin-lwp
25243 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25244 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25245 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25246 @item show debug lin-lwp
25247 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25248 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25249 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25250 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25251 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25252 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25253 @item set debug mach-o
25254 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25255 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25256 processing. The default is off.
25257 @item show debug mach-o
25258 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25259 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25260 @item set debug notification
25261 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25262 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25263 The default is off.
25264 @item show debug notification
25265 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25266 @item set debug observer
25267 @cindex observer debugging info
25268 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25269 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25270 @item show debug observer
25271 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25272 @item set debug overload
25273 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25274 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25275 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25276 is off.
25277 @item show debug overload
25278 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25279 debugging info.
25280 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25281 @cindex debug expression parser
25282 @item set debug parser
25283 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25284 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25285 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25286 details. The default is off.
25287 @item show debug parser
25288 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25289 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25290 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25291 @cindex debug remote protocol
25292 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25293 @cindex display remote packets
25294 @item set debug remote
25295 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25296 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25297 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25298 @item show debug remote
25299 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25300
25301 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25302 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25303 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25304 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25305
25306 @item set debug serial
25307 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25308 default is off.
25309 @item show debug serial
25310 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25311 info.
25312 @item set debug solib-frv
25313 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25314 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25315 @item show debug solib-frv
25316 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25317 messages.
25318 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25319 @cindex symbol lookup
25320 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25321 The default is 0 (off).
25322 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25323 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25324 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25325 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25326 @item set debug symfile
25327 @cindex symbol file functions
25328 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25329 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25330 @item show debug symfile
25331 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25332 @item set debug symtab-create
25333 @cindex symbol table creation
25334 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25335 The default is 0 (off).
25336 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25337 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25338 @item show debug symtab-create
25339 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25340 @item set debug target
25341 @cindex target debugging info
25342 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25343 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25344 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25345 value of large memory transfers.
25346 @item show debug target
25347 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25348 info.
25349 @item set debug timestamp
25350 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25351 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25352 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25353 message.
25354 @item show debug timestamp
25355 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25356 debugging info.
25357 @item set debug varobj
25358 @cindex variable object debugging info
25359 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25360 info. The default is off.
25361 @item show debug varobj
25362 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25363 debugging info.
25364 @item set debug xml
25365 @cindex XML parser debugging
25366 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25367 @item show debug xml
25368 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25369 @end table
25370
25371 @node Other Misc Settings
25372 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25373 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25374
25375 @table @code
25376 @kindex set interactive-mode
25377 @item set interactive-mode
25378 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25379 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25380 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25381 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25382 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25383 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25384 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25385 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25386
25387 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25388 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25389 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25390 inside a cygwin window.
25391
25392 @kindex show interactive-mode
25393 @item show interactive-mode
25394 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25395 @end table
25396
25397 @node Extending GDB
25398 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25399 @cindex extending GDB
25400
25401 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25402 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25403 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25404 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25405 being debugged.
25406
25407 @menu
25408 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25409 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25410 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25411 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25412 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25413 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25414 @end menu
25415
25416 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25417 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25418 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25419 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25420 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25421 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25422
25423 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25424 setting:
25425
25426 @table @code
25427 @kindex set script-extension
25428 @kindex show script-extension
25429 @item set script-extension off
25430 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25431
25432 @item set script-extension soft
25433 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25434 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25435 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25436 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25437
25438 @item set script-extension strict
25439 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25440 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25441 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25442
25443 @item show script-extension
25444 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25445
25446 @end table
25447
25448 @node Sequences
25449 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25450
25451 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25452 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25453 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25454 files.
25455
25456 @menu
25457 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25458 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25459 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25460 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25461 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25462 @end menu
25463
25464 @node Define
25465 @subsection User-defined Commands
25466
25467 @cindex user-defined command
25468 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25469 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25470 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25471 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25472 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25473 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25474
25475 @smallexample
25476 define adder
25477 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25478 end
25479 @end smallexample
25480
25481 @noindent
25482 To execute the command use:
25483
25484 @smallexample
25485 adder 1 2 3
25486 @end smallexample
25487
25488 @noindent
25489 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25490 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25491 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25492 functions calls.
25493
25494 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25495 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25496 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25497 been passed.
25498
25499 @smallexample
25500 define adder
25501 if $argc == 2
25502 print $arg0 + $arg1
25503 end
25504 if $argc == 3
25505 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25506 end
25507 end
25508 @end smallexample
25509
25510 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25511 to process a variable number of arguments:
25512
25513 @smallexample
25514 define adder
25515 set $i = 0
25516 set $sum = 0
25517 while $i < $argc
25518 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25519 set $i = $i + 1
25520 end
25521 print $sum
25522 end
25523 @end smallexample
25524
25525 @table @code
25526
25527 @kindex define
25528 @item define @var{commandname}
25529 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25530 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25531 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25532 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25533 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25534 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25535
25536 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25537 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25538 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25539
25540 @kindex document
25541 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25542 @item document @var{commandname}
25543 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25544 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25545 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25546 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25547 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25548 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25549
25550 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25551 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25552 does not change the documentation.
25553
25554 @kindex dont-repeat
25555 @cindex don't repeat command
25556 @item dont-repeat
25557 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25558 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25559 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25560
25561 @kindex help user-defined
25562 @item help user-defined
25563 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25564 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25565 included (if any).
25566
25567 @kindex show user
25568 @item show user
25569 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25570 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25571 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25572 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25573 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25574
25575 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25576 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25577 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25578 @item show max-user-call-depth
25579 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25580 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25581 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25582 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25583 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25584 @end table
25585
25586 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25587 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25588
25589 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25590 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25591 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25592
25593 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25594 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25595 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25596 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25597
25598 @node Hooks
25599 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25600 @cindex command hooks
25601 @cindex hooks, for commands
25602 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25603
25604 @kindex hook
25605 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25606 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25607 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25608 before that command.
25609
25610 @cindex hooks, post-command
25611 @kindex hookpost
25612 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25613 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25614 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25615 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25616 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25617
25618 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25619 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25620
25621 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25622 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25623
25624 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25625 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25626 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25627 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25628 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25629
25630 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25631 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25632 you could define:
25633
25634 @smallexample
25635 define hook-stop
25636 handle SIGALRM nopass
25637 end
25638
25639 define hook-run
25640 handle SIGALRM pass
25641 end
25642
25643 define hook-continue
25644 handle SIGALRM pass
25645 end
25646 @end smallexample
25647
25648 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25649 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25650 you could define:
25651
25652 @smallexample
25653 define hook-echo
25654 echo <<<---
25655 end
25656
25657 define hookpost-echo
25658 echo --->>>\n
25659 end
25660
25661 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25662 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25663 (@value{GDBP})
25664
25665 @end smallexample
25666
25667 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25668 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25669 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25670 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25671 @c or not?
25672 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25673 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25674 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25675
25676 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25677 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25678 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25679
25680 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25681 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25682
25683 @node Command Files
25684 @subsection Command Files
25685
25686 @cindex command files
25687 @cindex scripting commands
25688 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25689 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25690 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25691 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25692 terminal.
25693
25694 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25695 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25696 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25697 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25698 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25699
25700 @table @code
25701 @kindex source
25702 @cindex execute commands from a file
25703 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25704 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25705 @end table
25706
25707 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25708 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25709 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25710 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25711 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25712
25713 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25714 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25715 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25716 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25717 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25718 is not relevant to scripts.
25719
25720 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25721 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25722 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25723 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25724 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25725 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25726 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25727 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25728 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25729 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25730 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25731 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25732 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25733 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25734
25735 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25736 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25737 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25738
25739 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25740 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25741 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25742 when called from command files.
25743
25744 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25745 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25746 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25747 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25748 the next command.
25749
25750 @smallexample
25751 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25752 @end smallexample
25753
25754 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25755 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25756 would be directed to @file{log}.
25757
25758 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25759 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25760 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25761 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25762 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25763 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25764 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25765 conditionally, etc.
25766
25767 @table @code
25768 @kindex if
25769 @kindex else
25770 @item if
25771 @itemx else
25772 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25773 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25774 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25775 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25776 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25777 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25778 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25779
25780 @kindex while
25781 @item while
25782 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25783 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25784 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25785 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25786 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25787 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25788
25789 @kindex loop_break
25790 @item loop_break
25791 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25792 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25793 line.
25794
25795 @kindex loop_continue
25796 @item loop_continue
25797 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25798 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25799 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25800 the controlling expression.
25801
25802 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25803 @item end
25804 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25805 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25806 @end table
25807
25808
25809 @node Output
25810 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25811
25812 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25813 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25814 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25815 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25816 want.
25817
25818 @table @code
25819 @kindex echo
25820 @item echo @var{text}
25821 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25822 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25823 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25824 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25825 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25826 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25827 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25828 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25829 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25830 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25831 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25832
25833 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25834 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25835
25836 @smallexample
25837 echo This is some text\n\
25838 which is continued\n\
25839 onto several lines.\n
25840 @end smallexample
25841
25842 produces the same output as
25843
25844 @smallexample
25845 echo This is some text\n
25846 echo which is continued\n
25847 echo onto several lines.\n
25848 @end smallexample
25849
25850 @kindex output
25851 @item output @var{expression}
25852 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25853 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25854 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25855 on expressions.
25856
25857 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25858 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25859 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25860 Formats}, for more information.
25861
25862 @kindex printf
25863 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25864 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25865 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25866 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25867 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25868 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25869 executing the code below:
25870
25871 @smallexample
25872 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25873 @end smallexample
25874
25875 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25876 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25877 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25878 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25879 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25880 printed.
25881
25882 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25883
25884 @smallexample
25885 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25886 @end smallexample
25887
25888 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25889 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25890 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25891
25892 @itemize @bullet
25893 @item
25894 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25895
25896 @item
25897 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25898 width.
25899
25900 @item
25901 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25902 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25903
25904 @item
25905 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25906 supported.
25907
25908 @item
25909 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25910
25911 @item
25912 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25913 @end itemize
25914
25915 @noindent
25916 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25917 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25918 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25919 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25920
25921 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25922 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25923 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25924 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25925 supported.
25926
25927 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25928 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25929 together with a floating point specifier.
25930 letters:
25931
25932 @itemize @bullet
25933 @item
25934 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25935
25936 @item
25937 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25938
25939 @item
25940 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25941 @end itemize
25942
25943 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25944 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25945 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25946
25947 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25948 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25949
25950 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25951 @smallexample
25952 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25953 @end smallexample
25954
25955 @anchor{eval}
25956 @kindex eval
25957 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25958 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25959 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25960
25961 @end table
25962
25963 @node Auto-loading sequences
25964 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25965 @cindex native script auto-loading
25966
25967 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25968 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25969 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25970 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25971
25972 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25973 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25974
25975 @table @code
25976 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25977 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25978 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25979 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25980
25981 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25982 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25983 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25984 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25985 disabled.
25986
25987 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25988 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25989 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25990 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25991 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25992 auto-loaded.
25993 @end table
25994
25995 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25996 matching names are printed.
25997
25998 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25999 @include python.texi
26000
26001 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26002 @include guile.texi
26003
26004 @node Auto-loading extensions
26005 @section Auto-loading extensions
26006 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26007
26008 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26009 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26010 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26011 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26012 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26013
26014 @menu
26015 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26016 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26017 * Which flavor to choose?::
26018 @end menu
26019
26020 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26021 debugging commands and features.
26022
26023 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26024 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26025 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26026 for more information.
26027 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26028 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26029
26030 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26031 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26032
26033 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26034 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26035 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26036 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26037 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26038
26039 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26040 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26041 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26042 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26043
26044 @table @code
26045 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26046 GDB's own command language
26047 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26048 Python
26049 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26050 Guile
26051 @end table
26052
26053 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26054 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26055 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26056 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26057 script in the specified extension language.
26058
26059 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26060 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26061
26062 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26063 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26064
26065 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26066 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26067 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26068 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26069 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26070 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26071
26072 @table @code
26073 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26074 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26075 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26076 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26077 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26078 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26079
26080 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26081 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26082
26083 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26084 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26085 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26086 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26087
26088 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26089 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26090 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26091 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26092 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26093 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26094 platform.
26095
26096 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26097 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26098 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26099
26100 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26101 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26102 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26103 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26104
26105 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26106 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26107 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26108 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26109 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26110 @end table
26111
26112 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26113 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26114 @var{objfile} is opened.
26115 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26116 is evaluated more than once.
26117
26118 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26119 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26120 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26121
26122 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26123 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26124 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26125 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26126 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26127 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26128 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26129
26130 The following entries are supported:
26131
26132 @table @code
26133 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26134 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26135 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26136 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26137 @end table
26138
26139 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26140
26141 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26142 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26143 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26144 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26145 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26146
26147 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26148 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26149
26150 @example
26151 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26152 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26153 asm("\
26154 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26155 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26156 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26157 .popsection \n\
26158 ");
26159 @end example
26160
26161 @noindent
26162 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26163 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26164
26165 @example
26166 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26167 @end example
26168
26169 The script name may include directories if desired.
26170
26171 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26172 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26173
26174 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26175 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26176 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26177 will remove duplicates.
26178
26179 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26180
26181 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26182 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26183 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26184 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26185 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26186 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26187 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26188 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26189 on its name.
26190
26191 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26192 testsuite.
26193
26194 @example
26195 #include "symcat.h"
26196 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26197 asm(
26198 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26199 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26200 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26201 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26202 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26203 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26204 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26205 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26206 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26207 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26208 ".byte 0\n"
26209 ".popsection\n"
26210 );
26211 @end example
26212
26213 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26214 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26215 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26216 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26217
26218 @node Which flavor to choose?
26219 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26220
26221 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26222 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26223
26224 @noindent
26225 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26226
26227 @itemize @bullet
26228 @item
26229 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26230
26231 @item
26232 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26233
26234 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26235 in the source search path.
26236 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26237 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26238
26239 @item
26240 Doesn't require source code additions.
26241 @end itemize
26242
26243 @noindent
26244 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26245
26246 @itemize @bullet
26247 @item
26248 Works with static linking.
26249
26250 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26251 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26252 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26253 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26254 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26255
26256 @item
26257 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26258
26259 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26260 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26261
26262 @item
26263 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26264
26265 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26266 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26267 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26268 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26269 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26270 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26271 @end itemize
26272
26273 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26274 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26275
26276 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26277 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26278 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26279
26280 @subsection Python comes first
26281
26282 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26283 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26284 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26285 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26286 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26287 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26288 pretty-printed form of a value).
26289 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26290 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26291 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26292
26293 @node Aliases
26294 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26295 @cindex aliases for commands
26296
26297 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26298 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26299 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26300 that involves less typing.
26301
26302 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26303 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26304 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26305
26306 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26307 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26308 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26309
26310 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26311
26312 @table @code
26313
26314 @kindex alias
26315 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26316
26317 @end table
26318
26319 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26320 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26321 underscores.
26322
26323 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26324 that is being aliased.
26325
26326 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26327 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26328 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26329
26330 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26331 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26332
26333 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26334 of a command so that there is less to type.
26335 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26336 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26337 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26338 The following will accomplish this.
26339
26340 @smallexample
26341 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26342 @end smallexample
26343
26344 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26345 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26346 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26347 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26348
26349 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26350 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26351 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26352 of a command.
26353
26354 @smallexample
26355 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26356 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26357 (gdb) set p elms 20
26358 (gdb) show p elms
26359 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26360 @end smallexample
26361
26362 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26363 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26364 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26365
26366 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26367 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26368
26369 @smallexample
26370 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26371 @end smallexample
26372
26373 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26374 alias for a more complex command.
26375 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26376
26377 @smallexample
26378 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26379 (gdb) spe 20
26380 @end smallexample
26381
26382 @node Interpreters
26383 @chapter Command Interpreters
26384 @cindex command interpreters
26385
26386 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26387 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26388 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26389
26390 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26391 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26392 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26393 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26394
26395 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26396 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26397 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26398 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26399
26400 @table @code
26401 @item console
26402 @cindex console interpreter
26403 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26404 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26405 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26406
26407 @item mi
26408 @cindex mi interpreter
26409 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26410 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26411 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26412 Interface}.
26413
26414 @item mi2
26415 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26416 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26417
26418 @item mi1
26419 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26420 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26421
26422 @end table
26423
26424 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26425
26426 @kindex interpreter-exec
26427 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26428 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26429 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26430
26431 @smallexample
26432 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26433 @end smallexample
26434
26435 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26436 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26437
26438 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26439 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26440 permanently.
26441
26442 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26443
26444 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26445 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26446 device (usually a tty).
26447
26448 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26449 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26450 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26451 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26452 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26453 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26454 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26455 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26456 the separate MI interpreter.
26457
26458 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26459 @code{new-ui} command:
26460
26461 @kindex new-ui
26462 @cindex new user interface
26463 @smallexample
26464 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26465 @end smallexample
26466
26467 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26468 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26469 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26470 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26471 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26472 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26473
26474 @smallexample
26475 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26476 @end smallexample
26477
26478 @noindent
26479 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26480
26481 @node TUI
26482 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26483 @cindex TUI
26484 @cindex Text User Interface
26485
26486 @menu
26487 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26488 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26489 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26490 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26491 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26492 @end menu
26493
26494 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26495 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26496 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26497 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26498 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26499 is available.
26500
26501 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26502 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26503 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26504 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26505 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26506 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26507
26508 @node TUI Overview
26509 @section TUI Overview
26510
26511 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26512
26513 @table @emph
26514 @item command
26515 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26516 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26517 managed using readline.
26518
26519 @item source
26520 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26521 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26522
26523 @item assembly
26524 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26525
26526 @item register
26527 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26528 when their values change.
26529 @end table
26530
26531 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26532 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26533 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26534 indicates the breakpoint type:
26535
26536 @table @code
26537 @item B
26538 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26539
26540 @item b
26541 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26542
26543 @item H
26544 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26545
26546 @item h
26547 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26548 @end table
26549
26550 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26551
26552 @table @code
26553 @item +
26554 Breakpoint is enabled.
26555
26556 @item -
26557 Breakpoint is disabled.
26558 @end table
26559
26560 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26561 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26562 changes.
26563
26564 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26565 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26566 layouts:
26567
26568 @itemize @bullet
26569 @item
26570 source only,
26571
26572 @item
26573 assembly only,
26574
26575 @item
26576 source and assembly,
26577
26578 @item
26579 source and registers, or
26580
26581 @item
26582 assembly and registers.
26583 @end itemize
26584
26585 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26586
26587 @table @emph
26588 @item target
26589 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26590 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26591
26592 @item process
26593 Gives the current process or thread number.
26594 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26595
26596 @item function
26597 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26598 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26599 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26600 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26601
26602 @item line
26603 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26604 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26605
26606 @item pc
26607 Indicates the current program counter address.
26608 @end table
26609
26610 @node TUI Keys
26611 @section TUI Key Bindings
26612 @cindex TUI key bindings
26613
26614 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26615 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26616 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26617 @end ifset
26618 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26619 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26620 @end ifclear
26621 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26622 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26623
26624 @table @kbd
26625 @kindex C-x C-a
26626 @item C-x C-a
26627 @kindex C-x a
26628 @itemx C-x a
26629 @kindex C-x A
26630 @itemx C-x A
26631 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26632 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26633 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26634 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26635 The screen is then refreshed.
26636
26637 @kindex C-x 1
26638 @item C-x 1
26639 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26640 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26641 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26642
26643 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26644
26645 @kindex C-x 2
26646 @item C-x 2
26647 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26648 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26649 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26650 previous layout and the new one.
26651
26652 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26653
26654 @kindex C-x o
26655 @item C-x o
26656 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26657 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26658 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26659
26660 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26661
26662 @kindex C-x s
26663 @item C-x s
26664 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26665 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26666 @end table
26667
26668 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26669
26670 @table @asis
26671 @kindex PgUp
26672 @item @key{PgUp}
26673 Scroll the active window one page up.
26674
26675 @kindex PgDn
26676 @item @key{PgDn}
26677 Scroll the active window one page down.
26678
26679 @kindex Up
26680 @item @key{Up}
26681 Scroll the active window one line up.
26682
26683 @kindex Down
26684 @item @key{Down}
26685 Scroll the active window one line down.
26686
26687 @kindex Left
26688 @item @key{Left}
26689 Scroll the active window one column left.
26690
26691 @kindex Right
26692 @item @key{Right}
26693 Scroll the active window one column right.
26694
26695 @kindex C-L
26696 @item @kbd{C-L}
26697 Refresh the screen.
26698 @end table
26699
26700 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26701 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26702 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26703 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26704 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26705
26706 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26707 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26708 @cindex TUI single key mode
26709
26710 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26711 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26712 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26713
26714 @table @kbd
26715 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26716 @item c
26717 continue
26718
26719 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26720 @item d
26721 down
26722
26723 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26724 @item f
26725 finish
26726
26727 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26728 @item n
26729 next
26730
26731 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26732 @item o
26733 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26734
26735 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26736 @item q
26737 exit the SingleKey mode.
26738
26739 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26740 @item r
26741 run
26742
26743 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26744 @item s
26745 step
26746
26747 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26748 @item i
26749 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26750
26751 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26752 @item u
26753 up
26754
26755 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26756 @item v
26757 info locals
26758
26759 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26760 @item w
26761 where
26762 @end table
26763
26764 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26765 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26766 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26767 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26768 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26769 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26770
26771
26772 @node TUI Commands
26773 @section TUI-specific Commands
26774 @cindex TUI commands
26775
26776 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26777 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26778 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26779 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26780
26781 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26782 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26783 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26784 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26785 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26786
26787 @table @code
26788 @item tui enable
26789 @kindex tui enable
26790 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26791 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26792 otherwise a default layout is used.
26793
26794 @item tui disable
26795 @kindex tui disable
26796 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26797
26798 @item info win
26799 @kindex info win
26800 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26801
26802 @item layout @var{name}
26803 @kindex layout
26804 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26805 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26806 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26807
26808 @table @code
26809 @item next
26810 Display the next layout.
26811
26812 @item prev
26813 Display the previous layout.
26814
26815 @item src
26816 Display the source and command windows.
26817
26818 @item asm
26819 Display the assembly and command windows.
26820
26821 @item split
26822 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26823
26824 @item regs
26825 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26826 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26827 register, assembler, and command windows.
26828 @end table
26829
26830 @item focus @var{name}
26831 @kindex focus
26832 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26833 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26834
26835 @table @code
26836 @item next
26837 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26838
26839 @item prev
26840 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26841
26842 @item src
26843 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26844
26845 @item asm
26846 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26847
26848 @item regs
26849 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26850
26851 @item cmd
26852 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26853 @end table
26854
26855 @item refresh
26856 @kindex refresh
26857 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26858
26859 @item tui reg @var{group}
26860 @kindex tui reg
26861 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26862 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26863 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26864 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26865 following groups are available on most targets:
26866 @table @code
26867 @item next
26868 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26869 through all of the available register groups.
26870
26871 @item prev
26872 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26873 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26874 @var{next}.
26875
26876 @item general
26877 Display the general registers.
26878 @item float
26879 Display the floating point registers.
26880 @item system
26881 Display the system registers.
26882 @item vector
26883 Display the vector registers.
26884 @item all
26885 Display all registers.
26886 @end table
26887
26888 @item update
26889 @kindex update
26890 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26891
26892 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26893 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26894 @kindex winheight
26895 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26896 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26897 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26898 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26899 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26900 @end table
26901
26902 @node TUI Configuration
26903 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26904 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26905
26906 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26907
26908 @table @code
26909 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26910 @kindex set tui border-kind
26911 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26912 The possible values are the following:
26913 @table @code
26914 @item space
26915 Use a space character to draw the border.
26916
26917 @item ascii
26918 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26919
26920 @item acs
26921 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26922 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26923 @end table
26924
26925 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26926 @kindex set tui border-mode
26927 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26928 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26929 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26930 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26931 @table @code
26932 @item normal
26933 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26934
26935 @item standout
26936 Use standout mode.
26937
26938 @item reverse
26939 Use reverse video mode.
26940
26941 @item half
26942 Use half bright mode.
26943
26944 @item half-standout
26945 Use half bright and standout mode.
26946
26947 @item bold
26948 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26949
26950 @item bold-standout
26951 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26952 @end table
26953
26954 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
26955 @kindex set tui tab-width
26956 @kindex tabset
26957 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26958 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26959 assembly windows.
26960 @end table
26961
26962 @node Emacs
26963 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26964
26965 @cindex Emacs
26966 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26967 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26968 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26969 @value{GDBN}.
26970
26971 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26972 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26973 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26974 created Emacs buffer.
26975 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26976
26977 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26978 things:
26979
26980 @itemize @bullet
26981 @item
26982 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26983 the GUD buffer.
26984
26985 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26986 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26987
26988 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26989 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26990 in this way.
26991
26992 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26993 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26994 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26995 stop.
26996
26997 @item
26998 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26999
27000 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27001 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27002 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27003 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27004 and the source.
27005
27006 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27007 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27008 @end itemize
27009
27010 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27011 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27012 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27013 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27014
27015 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27016 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27017 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27018 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27019 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27020 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27021 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27022 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27023 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27024
27025 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27026 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27027 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27028 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27029
27030 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27031 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27032 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27033 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27034 one you want.
27035
27036 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27037 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27038
27039 @table @kbd
27040 @item C-h m
27041 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27042
27043 @item C-c C-s
27044 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27045 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27046
27047 @item C-c C-n
27048 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27049 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27050 to show the current file and location.
27051
27052 @item C-c C-i
27053 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27054 display window accordingly.
27055
27056 @item C-c C-f
27057 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27058 @code{finish} command.
27059
27060 @item C-c C-r
27061 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27062 command.
27063
27064 @item C-c <
27065 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27066 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27067 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27068
27069 @item C-c >
27070 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27071 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27072 @end table
27073
27074 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27075 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27076
27077 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27078 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27079 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27080 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27081 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27082 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27083 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27084
27085 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27086 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27087 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27088 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27089 frame.
27090
27091 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27092 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27093 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27094 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27095 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27096 to correspond properly with the code.
27097
27098 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27099 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27100 Emacs Manual}).
27101
27102 @node GDB/MI
27103 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27104
27105 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27106
27107 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27108 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27109 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27110 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27111 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27112 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27113
27114 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27115 in the form of a reference manual.
27116
27117 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27118 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27119 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27120
27121 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27122
27123 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27124 This chapter uses the following notation:
27125
27126 @itemize @bullet
27127 @item
27128 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27129
27130 @item
27131 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27132 it may or may not be given.
27133
27134 @item
27135 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27136 may repeat zero or more times.
27137
27138 @item
27139 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27140 may repeat one or more times.
27141
27142 @item
27143 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27144 @end itemize
27145
27146 @ignore
27147 @heading Dependencies
27148 @end ignore
27149
27150 @menu
27151 * GDB/MI General Design::
27152 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27153 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27154 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27155 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27156 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27157 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27158 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27159 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27160 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27161 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27162 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27163 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27164 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27165 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27166 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27167 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27168 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27169 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27170 @ignore
27171 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27172 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27173 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27174 @end ignore
27175 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27176 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27177 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27178 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27179 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27180 @end menu
27181
27182 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27183 @node GDB/MI General Design
27184 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27185 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27186
27187 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27188 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27189 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27190 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27191 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27192 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27193 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27194 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27195 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27196 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27197
27198 The important examples of notifications are:
27199 @itemize @bullet
27200
27201 @item
27202 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27203 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27204 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27205 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27206 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27207 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27208 command itself was successfully executed.
27209
27210 @item
27211 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27212 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27213 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27214 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27215 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27216 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27217
27218 @item
27219 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27220 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27221 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27222 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27223 orthogonal frontend design.
27224
27225 @end itemize
27226
27227 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27228 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27229 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27230 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27231 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27232 the user interface.
27233
27234
27235 @menu
27236 * Context management::
27237 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27238 * Thread groups::
27239 @end menu
27240
27241 @node Context management
27242 @subsection Context management
27243
27244 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27245
27246 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27247 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27248 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27249 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27250 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27251 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27252 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27253 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27254 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27255
27256 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27257 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27258 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27259 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27260 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27261 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27262 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27263 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27264 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27265 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27266 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27267
27268 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27269 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27270 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27271 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27272 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27273 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27274 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27275 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27276 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27277 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27278
27279 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27280 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27281 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27282 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27283 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27284 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27285 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27286 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27287 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27288 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27289 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27290 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27291 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27292 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27293 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27294 @samp{--frame} options.
27295
27296 @subsubsection Language
27297
27298 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27299 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27300 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27301 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27302 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27303 For instance:
27304
27305 @smallexample
27306 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27307 ^done,value="4"
27308 (gdb)
27309 @end smallexample
27310
27311 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27312 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27313 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27314
27315 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27316 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27317
27318 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27319 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27320 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27321 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27322 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27323 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27324 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27325 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27326 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27327
27328 @table @code
27329 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27330 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27331 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27332
27333 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27334 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27335 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27336
27337 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27338 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27339 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27340 MI commands even while the target is running.
27341
27342 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27343 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27344 @end table
27345
27346 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27347 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27348 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27349 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27350 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27351 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27352
27353 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27354 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27355 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27356 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27357 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27358 are running.
27359
27360 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27361 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27362 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27363 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27364 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27365 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27366 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27367 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27368 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27369 @samp{--thread} option).
27370
27371 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27372 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27373 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27374 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27375
27376 @node Thread groups
27377 @subsection Thread groups
27378 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27379 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27380 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27381 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27382 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27383
27384 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27385 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27386 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27387 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27388 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27389 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27390 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27391 into processes.
27392
27393 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27394 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27395 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27396 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27397 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27398 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27399 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27400 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27401 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27402 the members of specific thread group.
27403
27404 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27405 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27406 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27407 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27408 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27409 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27410 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27411 after attaching to that thread group.
27412
27413 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27414 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27415 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27416 such thread groups.
27417
27418 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27419 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27420 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27421
27422 @menu
27423 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27424 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27425 @end menu
27426
27427 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27428 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27429
27430 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27431 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27432 @table @code
27433 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27434 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27435
27436 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27437 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27438 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27439
27440 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27441 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27442 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27443
27444 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27445 "any sequence of digits"
27446
27447 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27448 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27449
27450 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27451 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27452
27453 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27454 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27455
27456 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27457 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27458 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27459
27460 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27461 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27462
27463 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27464 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27465 @end table
27466
27467 @noindent
27468 Notes:
27469
27470 @itemize @bullet
27471 @item
27472 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27473 output is described below.
27474
27475 @item
27476 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27477 finishes.
27478
27479 @item
27480 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27481 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27482 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27483 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27484 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27485 @end itemize
27486
27487 Pragmatics:
27488
27489 @itemize @bullet
27490 @item
27491 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27492
27493 @item
27494 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27495 @end itemize
27496
27497 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27498 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27499
27500 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27501 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27502 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27503 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27504 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27505 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27506
27507 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27508 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27509 @var{token}.
27510
27511 @table @code
27512 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27513 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27514
27515 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27516 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27517
27518 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27519 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27520
27521 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27522 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27523
27524 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27525 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27526
27527 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27528 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27529
27530 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27531 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27532
27533 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27534 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27535
27536 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27537 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27538
27539 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27540 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27541 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27542
27543 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27544 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27545
27546 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27547 @code{ @var{string} }
27548
27549 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27550 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27551
27552 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27553 @code{@var{c-string}}
27554
27555 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27556 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27557
27558 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27559 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27560 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27561
27562 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27563 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27564
27565 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27566 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27567
27568 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27569 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27570
27571 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27572 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27573
27574 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27575 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27576
27577 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27578 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27579 @end table
27580
27581 @noindent
27582 Notes:
27583
27584 @itemize @bullet
27585 @item
27586 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27587
27588 @item
27589 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27590 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27591 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27592 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27593 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27594 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27595 prior command.
27596
27597 @item
27598 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27599 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27600 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27601 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27602
27603 @item
27604 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27605 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27606 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27607 @samp{*}.
27608
27609 @item
27610 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27611 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27612 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27613 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27614
27615 @item
27616 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27617 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27618 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27619 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27620
27621 @item
27622 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27623 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27624 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27625
27626 @item
27627 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27628 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27629 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27630 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27631
27632 @item
27633 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27634 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27635 @var{values}.
27636
27637
27638 @end itemize
27639
27640 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27641 details about the various output records.
27642
27643 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27644 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27645 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27646
27647 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27648 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27649
27650 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27651 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27652 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27653 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27654 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27655 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27656
27657 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27658 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27659 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27660
27661 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27662 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27663 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27664 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27665
27666 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27667 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27668
27669 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27670 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27671 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27672 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27673 might change.
27674
27675 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27676 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27677 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27678 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27679
27680 @itemize @bullet
27681 @item
27682 New MI commands may be added.
27683
27684 @item
27685 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27686
27687 @item
27688 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27689 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27690
27691 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27692 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27693
27694 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27695 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27696 @end itemize
27697
27698 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27699 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27700 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27701 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27702 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27703
27704 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27705 @c version?
27706
27707 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27708 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27709 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27710 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27711 @cindex mailing lists
27712
27713 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27714 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27715 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27716
27717 @menu
27718 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27719 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27720 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27721 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27722 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27723 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27724 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27725 @end menu
27726
27727 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27728 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27729
27730 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27731 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27732 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27733 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27734
27735 @table @code
27736 @findex ^done
27737 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27738 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27739 values.
27740
27741 @item "^running"
27742 @findex ^running
27743 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27744 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27745 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27746 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27747 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27748 which threads are resumed.
27749
27750 @item "^connected"
27751 @findex ^connected
27752 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27753
27754 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27755 @findex ^error
27756 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27757 the corresponding error message.
27758
27759 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27760 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27761 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27762
27763 @table @samp
27764 @item "undefined-command"
27765 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27766 @end table
27767
27768 @item "^exit"
27769 @findex ^exit
27770 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27771
27772 @end table
27773
27774 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27775 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27776
27777 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27778 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27779 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27780 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27781 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27782
27783 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27784 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27785 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27786 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27787 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27788
27789 @table @code
27790 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27791 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27792 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27793
27794 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27795 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27796 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27797 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27798
27799 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27800 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27801 internals.
27802 @end table
27803
27804 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27805 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27806
27807 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27808 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27809 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27810 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27811 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27812 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27813
27814 The following is the list of possible async records:
27815
27816 @table @code
27817
27818 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27819 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27820 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27821 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27822 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27823 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27824 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27825 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27826 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27827 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27828 it run freely.
27829
27830 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27831 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27832 following values:
27833
27834 @table @code
27835 @item breakpoint-hit
27836 A breakpoint was reached.
27837 @item watchpoint-trigger
27838 A watchpoint was triggered.
27839 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27840 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27841 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27842 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27843 @item function-finished
27844 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27845 @item location-reached
27846 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27847 @item watchpoint-scope
27848 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27849 @item end-stepping-range
27850 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27851 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27852 @item exited-signalled
27853 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27854 @item exited
27855 The inferior exited.
27856 @item exited-normally
27857 The inferior exited normally.
27858 @item signal-received
27859 A signal was received by the inferior.
27860 @item solib-event
27861 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27862 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27863 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27864 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27865 @item fork
27866 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27867 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27868 @item vfork
27869 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27870 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27871 @item syscall-entry
27872 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27873 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27874 @item syscall-return
27875 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27876 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27877 @item exec
27878 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27879 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27880 @end table
27881
27882 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27883 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27884 Depending on whether all-stop
27885 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27886 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27887 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27888 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27889 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27890 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27891 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27892 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27893 if such information is not available.
27894
27895 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27896 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27897 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27898 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27899 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27900 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27901 cannot be used in any way.
27902
27903 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27904 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27905 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27906 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27907 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27908 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27909
27910 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27911 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27912 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27913 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27914 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27915 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27916
27917 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27918 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27919 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27920 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27921 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27922
27923 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27924 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27925 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27926 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27927 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27928 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27929 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27930 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27931 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27932
27933 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27934 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27935
27936 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27937 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27938 that thread.
27939
27940 @item =library-loaded,...
27941 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27942 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27943 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27944 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27945 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27946 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27947 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27948 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27949 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27950 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27951 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27952 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27953 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27954 to this library.
27955
27956 @item =library-unloaded,...
27957 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27958 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27959 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27960 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27961 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27962 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27963 thread groups.
27964
27965 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27966 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27967 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27968 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27969 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27970
27971 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27972 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27973 initial value @var{initial}.
27974
27975 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27976 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27977 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27978 trace state variables are deleted.
27979
27980 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27981 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27982 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27983 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27984 value of trace state variable is known.
27985
27986 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27987 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27988 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27989 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27990 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27991 user.
27992
27993 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27994 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27995 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27996
27997 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27998 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27999
28000 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28001 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28002 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28003 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28004 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28005
28006 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28007 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28008 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28009 for existing method and format values.
28010
28011 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28012 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28013 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28014 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28015 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28016 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28017
28018 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28019 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28020 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28021 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28022 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28023 executable code.
28024 @end table
28025
28026 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28027 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28028
28029 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28030 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28031 following fields:
28032
28033 @table @code
28034 @item number
28035 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
28036 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
28037 @samp{1.2}.
28038
28039 @item type
28040 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28041 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28042
28043 @item catch-type
28044 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28045 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28046
28047 @item disp
28048 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28049 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28050 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28051
28052 @item enabled
28053 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28054 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28055 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28056
28057 @item addr
28058 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28059 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28060 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28061 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28062 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28063
28064 @item func
28065 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28066 If not known, this field is not present.
28067
28068 @item filename
28069 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28070 If not known, this field is not present.
28071
28072 @item fullname
28073 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28074 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28075
28076 @item line
28077 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28078 If not known, this field is not present.
28079
28080 @item at
28081 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28082 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28083 by a symbol name.
28084
28085 @item pending
28086 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28087 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28088
28089 @item evaluated-by
28090 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28091 @samp{target}.
28092
28093 @item thread
28094 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28095 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28096
28097 @item task
28098 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28099 field will hold the task identifier.
28100
28101 @item cond
28102 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28103
28104 @item ignore
28105 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28106
28107 @item enable
28108 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28109
28110 @item traceframe-usage
28111 FIXME.
28112
28113 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28114 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28115
28116 @item mask
28117 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28118
28119 @item pass
28120 A tracepoint's pass count.
28121
28122 @item original-location
28123 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28124 This field is optional.
28125
28126 @item times
28127 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28128
28129 @item installed
28130 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28131 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28132 is not.
28133
28134 @item what
28135 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28136
28137 @end table
28138
28139 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28140 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28141
28142 @smallexample
28143 -> -break-insert main
28144 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28145 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28146 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28147 times="0"@}
28148 <- (gdb)
28149 @end smallexample
28150
28151 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28152 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28153
28154 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28155 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28156 fields:
28157
28158 @table @code
28159 @item level
28160 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28161 zero. This field is always present.
28162
28163 @item func
28164 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28165 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28166
28167 @item addr
28168 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28169
28170 @item file
28171 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28172 address. This field may be absent.
28173
28174 @item line
28175 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28176 may be absent.
28177
28178 @item from
28179 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28180 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28181
28182 @end table
28183
28184 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28185 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28186
28187 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28188 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28189 stated otherwise.
28190
28191 @table @code
28192 @item id
28193 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28194
28195 @item target-id
28196 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28197
28198 @item details
28199 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28200 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28201 frontend. This field is optional.
28202
28203 @item name
28204 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28205 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28206 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28207 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28208 field is omitted.
28209
28210 @item state
28211 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28212 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28213
28214 @item frame
28215 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28216 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28217 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28218
28219 @item core
28220 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28221 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28222 @end table
28223
28224 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28225 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28226
28227 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28228 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28229 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28230 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28231 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28232 the @code{exception-message} field.
28233
28234 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28235 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28236 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28237 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28238
28239 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28240 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28241 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28242 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28243
28244 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28245 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28246
28247 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28248
28249 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28250 information of the breakpoint.
28251
28252 @smallexample
28253 -> -break-insert main
28254 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28255 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28256 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28257 times="0"@}
28258 <- (gdb)
28259 @end smallexample
28260
28261 @subheading Program Execution
28262
28263 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28264 reason that execution stopped.
28265
28266 @smallexample
28267 -> -exec-run
28268 <- ^running
28269 <- (gdb)
28270 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28271 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28272 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28273 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28274 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28275 <- (gdb)
28276 -> -exec-continue
28277 <- ^running
28278 <- (gdb)
28279 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28280 <- (gdb)
28281 @end smallexample
28282
28283 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28284
28285 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28286
28287 @smallexample
28288 -> (gdb)
28289 <- -gdb-exit
28290 <- ^exit
28291 @end smallexample
28292
28293 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28294 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28295 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28296 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28297 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28298 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28299
28300 @subheading A Bad Command
28301
28302 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28303
28304 @smallexample
28305 -> -rubbish
28306 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28307 <- (gdb)
28308 @end smallexample
28309
28310
28311 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28312 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28313 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28314
28315 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28316 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28317
28318 @subheading Motivation
28319
28320 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28321
28322 @subheading Introduction
28323
28324 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28325
28326 @subheading Commands
28327
28328 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28329
28330 @subsubheading Synopsis
28331
28332 @smallexample
28333 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 @subsubheading Result
28337
28338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28339
28340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28341
28342 @subsubheading Example
28343
28344 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28345 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28346
28347
28348 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28349 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28350 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28351
28352 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28353 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28354 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28355 breakpoints.
28356
28357 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28358 @findex -break-after
28359
28360 @subsubheading Synopsis
28361
28362 @smallexample
28363 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28364 @end smallexample
28365
28366 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28367 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28368 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28369 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28370
28371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28372
28373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28374
28375 @subsubheading Example
28376
28377 @smallexample
28378 (gdb)
28379 -break-insert main
28380 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28381 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28382 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28383 times="0"@}
28384 (gdb)
28385 -break-after 1 3
28386 ~
28387 ^done
28388 (gdb)
28389 -break-list
28390 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28391 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28392 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28393 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28394 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28395 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28396 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28397 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28398 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28399 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28400 (gdb)
28401 @end smallexample
28402
28403 @ignore
28404 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28405 @findex -break-catch
28406 @end ignore
28407
28408 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28409 @findex -break-commands
28410
28411 @subsubheading Synopsis
28412
28413 @smallexample
28414 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28415 @end smallexample
28416
28417 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28418 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28419 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28420 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28421 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28422 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28423
28424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28425
28426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28427
28428 @subsubheading Example
28429
28430 @smallexample
28431 (gdb)
28432 -break-insert main
28433 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28434 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28435 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28436 times="0"@}
28437 (gdb)
28438 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28439 ^done
28440 (gdb)
28441 @end smallexample
28442
28443 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28444 @findex -break-condition
28445
28446 @subsubheading Synopsis
28447
28448 @smallexample
28449 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28450 @end smallexample
28451
28452 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28453 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28454 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28455 command below).
28456
28457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28458
28459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28460
28461 @subsubheading Example
28462
28463 @smallexample
28464 (gdb)
28465 -break-condition 1 1
28466 ^done
28467 (gdb)
28468 -break-list
28469 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28470 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28471 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28472 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28473 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28474 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28475 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28476 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28477 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28478 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28479 (gdb)
28480 @end smallexample
28481
28482 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28483 @findex -break-delete
28484
28485 @subsubheading Synopsis
28486
28487 @smallexample
28488 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28489 @end smallexample
28490
28491 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28492 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28493
28494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28495
28496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28497
28498 @subsubheading Example
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 (gdb)
28502 -break-delete 1
28503 ^done
28504 (gdb)
28505 -break-list
28506 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28507 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28508 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28509 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28510 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28511 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28512 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28513 body=[]@}
28514 (gdb)
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28518 @findex -break-disable
28519
28520 @subsubheading Synopsis
28521
28522 @smallexample
28523 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28524 @end smallexample
28525
28526 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28527 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28528
28529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28530
28531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28532
28533 @subsubheading Example
28534
28535 @smallexample
28536 (gdb)
28537 -break-disable 2
28538 ^done
28539 (gdb)
28540 -break-list
28541 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28542 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28543 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28544 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28545 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28546 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28547 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28548 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28549 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28550 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28551 (gdb)
28552 @end smallexample
28553
28554 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28555 @findex -break-enable
28556
28557 @subsubheading Synopsis
28558
28559 @smallexample
28560 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28561 @end smallexample
28562
28563 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28564
28565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28566
28567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28568
28569 @subsubheading Example
28570
28571 @smallexample
28572 (gdb)
28573 -break-enable 2
28574 ^done
28575 (gdb)
28576 -break-list
28577 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28578 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28579 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28580 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28581 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28582 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28583 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28584 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28585 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28586 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28587 (gdb)
28588 @end smallexample
28589
28590 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28591 @findex -break-info
28592
28593 @subsubheading Synopsis
28594
28595 @smallexample
28596 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28597 @end smallexample
28598
28599 @c REDUNDANT???
28600 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28601
28602 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28603 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28604 table.
28605
28606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28607
28608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28609
28610 @subsubheading Example
28611 N.A.
28612
28613 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28614 @findex -break-insert
28615 @anchor{-break-insert}
28616
28617 @subsubheading Synopsis
28618
28619 @smallexample
28620 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28621 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28622 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28623 @end smallexample
28624
28625 @noindent
28626 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28627
28628 @table @var
28629 @item linespec location
28630 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28631
28632 @item explicit location
28633 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28634 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28635 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28636
28637 @table @samp
28638 @item --source @var{filename}
28639 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28640 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28641
28642 @item --function @var{function}
28643 The name of a function or method.
28644
28645 @item --label @var{label}
28646 The name of a label.
28647
28648 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28649 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28650 @end table
28651
28652 @item address location
28653 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28654 @end table
28655
28656 @noindent
28657 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28658
28659 @table @samp
28660 @item -t
28661 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28662 @item -h
28663 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28664 @item -f
28665 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28666 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28667 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28668 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28669 cannot be parsed.
28670 @item -d
28671 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28672 @item -a
28673 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28674 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28675 @item -c @var{condition}
28676 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28677 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28678 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28679 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28680 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28681 @var{thread-id}.
28682 @end table
28683
28684 @subsubheading Result
28685
28686 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28687 resulting breakpoint.
28688
28689 Note: this format is open to change.
28690 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28691
28692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28693
28694 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28695 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28696
28697 @subsubheading Example
28698
28699 @smallexample
28700 (gdb)
28701 -break-insert main
28702 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28703 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28704 times="0"@}
28705 (gdb)
28706 -break-insert -t foo
28707 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28708 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28709 times="0"@}
28710 (gdb)
28711 -break-list
28712 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28713 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28714 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28715 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28716 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28717 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28718 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28719 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28720 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28721 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28722 times="0"@},
28723 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28724 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28725 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28726 times="0"@}]@}
28727 (gdb)
28728 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28729 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28730 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28731 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28732 @c times="0"@}
28733 @c (gdb)
28734 @end smallexample
28735
28736 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28737 @findex -dprintf-insert
28738
28739 @subsubheading Synopsis
28740
28741 @smallexample
28742 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28743 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28744 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28745 [ @var{argument} ]
28746 @end smallexample
28747
28748 @noindent
28749 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28750 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28751
28752 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28753
28754 @table @samp
28755 @item -t
28756 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28757 @item -f
28758 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28759 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28760 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28761 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28762 cannot be parsed.
28763 @item -d
28764 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28765 @item -c @var{condition}
28766 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28767 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28768 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28769 to @var{ignore-count}.
28770 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28771 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28772 @var{thread-id}.
28773 @end table
28774
28775 @subsubheading Result
28776
28777 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28778 resulting breakpoint.
28779
28780 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28781
28782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28783
28784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28785
28786 @subsubheading Example
28787
28788 @smallexample
28789 (gdb)
28790 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28791 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28792 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28793 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28794 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28795 original-location="foo"@}
28796 (gdb)
28797 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28798 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28799 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28800 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28801 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28802 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28803 (gdb)
28804 @end smallexample
28805
28806 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28807 @findex -break-list
28808
28809 @subsubheading Synopsis
28810
28811 @smallexample
28812 -break-list
28813 @end smallexample
28814
28815 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28816
28817 @table @samp
28818 @item Number
28819 number of the breakpoint
28820 @item Type
28821 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28822 @item Disposition
28823 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28824 or @samp{nokeep}
28825 @item Enabled
28826 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28827 @item Address
28828 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28829 @item What
28830 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28831 name, line number
28832 @item Thread-groups
28833 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28834 @item Times
28835 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28836 @end table
28837
28838 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28839 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28840
28841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28842
28843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28844
28845 @subsubheading Example
28846
28847 @smallexample
28848 (gdb)
28849 -break-list
28850 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28851 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28852 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28853 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28854 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28855 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28856 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28857 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28858 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28859 times="0"@},
28860 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28861 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28862 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28863 (gdb)
28864 @end smallexample
28865
28866 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28867
28868 @smallexample
28869 (gdb)
28870 -break-list
28871 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28872 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28873 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28874 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28875 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28876 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28877 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28878 body=[]@}
28879 (gdb)
28880 @end smallexample
28881
28882 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28883 @findex -break-passcount
28884
28885 @subsubheading Synopsis
28886
28887 @smallexample
28888 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28889 @end smallexample
28890
28891 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28892 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28893 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28894 command @samp{passcount}.
28895
28896 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28897 @findex -break-watch
28898
28899 @subsubheading Synopsis
28900
28901 @smallexample
28902 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28903 @end smallexample
28904
28905 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28906 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28907 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28908 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28909 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28910 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28911 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28912 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28913
28914 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28915 breakpoints inserted.
28916
28917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28918
28919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28920 @samp{rwatch}.
28921
28922 @subsubheading Example
28923
28924 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28925
28926 @smallexample
28927 (gdb)
28928 -break-watch x
28929 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28930 (gdb)
28931 -exec-continue
28932 ^running
28933 (gdb)
28934 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28935 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28936 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28937 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28938 (gdb)
28939 @end smallexample
28940
28941 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28942 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28943 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28944
28945 @smallexample
28946 (gdb)
28947 -break-watch C
28948 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28949 (gdb)
28950 -exec-continue
28951 ^running
28952 (gdb)
28953 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28954 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28955 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28956 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28957 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28958 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28959 (gdb)
28960 -exec-continue
28961 ^running
28962 (gdb)
28963 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28964 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28965 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28966 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28967 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28968 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28969 (gdb)
28970 @end smallexample
28971
28972 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28973 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28974 deleted.
28975
28976 @smallexample
28977 (gdb)
28978 -break-watch C
28979 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28980 (gdb)
28981 -break-list
28982 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28983 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28984 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28985 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28986 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28987 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28988 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28989 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28990 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28991 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28992 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28993 times="1"@},
28994 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28995 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28996 (gdb)
28997 -exec-continue
28998 ^running
28999 (gdb)
29000 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29001 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29002 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29003 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29004 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29005 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29006 (gdb)
29007 -break-list
29008 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29009 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29010 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29011 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29012 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29013 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29014 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29015 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29016 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29017 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29018 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29019 times="1"@},
29020 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29021 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29022 (gdb)
29023 -exec-continue
29024 ^running
29025 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29026 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29027 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29028 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29029 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29030 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29031 (gdb)
29032 -break-list
29033 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29034 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29035 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29036 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29037 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29038 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29039 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29040 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29041 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29042 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29043 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29044 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29045 (gdb)
29046 @end smallexample
29047
29048
29049 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29050 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29051 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29052
29053 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29054 catchpoints.
29055
29056 @menu
29057 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29058 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29059 @end menu
29060
29061 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29062 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29063
29064 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29065 @findex -catch-load
29066
29067 @subsubheading Synopsis
29068
29069 @smallexample
29070 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29074 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29075 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29076 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29077 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29078
29079
29080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29081
29082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29083
29084 @subsubheading Example
29085
29086 @smallexample
29087 -catch-load -t foo.so
29088 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29089 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29090 (gdb)
29091 @end smallexample
29092
29093
29094 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29095 @findex -catch-unload
29096
29097 @subsubheading Synopsis
29098
29099 @smallexample
29100 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29101 @end smallexample
29102
29103 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29104 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29105 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29106 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29107 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29108
29109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29110
29111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29112
29113 @subsubheading Example
29114
29115 @smallexample
29116 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29117 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29118 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29119 (gdb)
29120 @end smallexample
29121
29122 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29123 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29124
29125 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29126 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29127
29128 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29129 @findex -catch-assert
29130
29131 @subsubheading Synopsis
29132
29133 @smallexample
29134 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29135 @end smallexample
29136
29137 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29138
29139 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29140
29141 @table @samp
29142 @item -c @var{condition}
29143 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29144 @item -d
29145 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29146 @item -t
29147 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29148 @end table
29149
29150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29151
29152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29153
29154 @subsubheading Example
29155
29156 @smallexample
29157 -catch-assert
29158 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29159 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29160 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29161 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29162 (gdb)
29163 @end smallexample
29164
29165 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29166 @findex -catch-exception
29167
29168 @subsubheading Synopsis
29169
29170 @smallexample
29171 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29172 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29173 @end smallexample
29174
29175 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29176 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29177 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29178 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29179 catchpoints.
29180
29181 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29182
29183 @table @samp
29184 @item -c @var{condition}
29185 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29186 @item -d
29187 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29188 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29189 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29190 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29191 @item -t
29192 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29193 @item -u
29194 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29195 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29196 @end table
29197
29198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29199
29200 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29201 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29202
29203 @subsubheading Example
29204
29205 @smallexample
29206 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29207 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29208 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29209 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29210 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29211 (gdb)
29212 @end smallexample
29213
29214 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29215 @findex -catch-handlers
29216
29217 @subsubheading Synopsis
29218
29219 @smallexample
29220 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29221 [ -t ]
29222 @end smallexample
29223
29224 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29225 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29226 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29227 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29228 catchpoints.
29229
29230 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29231
29232 @table @samp
29233 @item -c @var{condition}
29234 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29235 @item -d
29236 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29237 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29238 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29239 @item -t
29240 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29241 @end table
29242
29243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29244
29245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29246
29247 @subsubheading Example
29248
29249 @smallexample
29250 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29251 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29252 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29253 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29254 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29255 (gdb)
29256 @end smallexample
29257
29258 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29259 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29260 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29261
29262 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29263 @findex -exec-arguments
29264
29265
29266 @subsubheading Synopsis
29267
29268 @smallexample
29269 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29270 @end smallexample
29271
29272 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29273 @samp{-exec-run}.
29274
29275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29276
29277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29278
29279 @subsubheading Example
29280
29281 @smallexample
29282 (gdb)
29283 -exec-arguments -v word
29284 ^done
29285 (gdb)
29286 @end smallexample
29287
29288
29289 @ignore
29290 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29291 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29292
29293 @subsubheading Synopsis
29294
29295 @smallexample
29296 -exec-show-arguments
29297 @end smallexample
29298
29299 Print the arguments of the program.
29300
29301 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29302
29303 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29304
29305 @subsubheading Example
29306 N.A.
29307 @end ignore
29308
29309
29310 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29311 @findex -environment-cd
29312
29313 @subsubheading Synopsis
29314
29315 @smallexample
29316 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29317 @end smallexample
29318
29319 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29320
29321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29322
29323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29324
29325 @subsubheading Example
29326
29327 @smallexample
29328 (gdb)
29329 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29330 ^done
29331 (gdb)
29332 @end smallexample
29333
29334
29335 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29336 @findex -environment-directory
29337
29338 @subsubheading Synopsis
29339
29340 @smallexample
29341 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29342 @end smallexample
29343
29344 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29345 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29346 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29347 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29348 occurs as normal.
29349 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29350 multiple directories in a single command
29351 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29352 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29353 If blanks are needed as
29354 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29355 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29356 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29357 character must not be used
29358 in any directory name.
29359 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29360
29361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29362
29363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29364
29365 @subsubheading Example
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 (gdb)
29369 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29370 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29371 (gdb)
29372 -environment-directory ""
29373 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29374 (gdb)
29375 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29376 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29377 (gdb)
29378 -environment-directory -r
29379 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29380 (gdb)
29381 @end smallexample
29382
29383
29384 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29385 @findex -environment-path
29386
29387 @subsubheading Synopsis
29388
29389 @smallexample
29390 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29391 @end smallexample
29392
29393 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29394 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29395 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29396 supplied in addition to the
29397 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29398 occurs as normal.
29399 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29400 multiple directories in a single command
29401 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29402 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29403 If blanks are needed as
29404 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29405 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29406 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29407 character must not be used
29408 in any directory name.
29409 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29410
29411
29412 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29413
29414 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29415
29416 @subsubheading Example
29417
29418 @smallexample
29419 (gdb)
29420 -environment-path
29421 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29422 (gdb)
29423 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29424 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29425 (gdb)
29426 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29427 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29428 (gdb)
29429 @end smallexample
29430
29431
29432 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29433 @findex -environment-pwd
29434
29435 @subsubheading Synopsis
29436
29437 @smallexample
29438 -environment-pwd
29439 @end smallexample
29440
29441 Show the current working directory.
29442
29443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29444
29445 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29446
29447 @subsubheading Example
29448
29449 @smallexample
29450 (gdb)
29451 -environment-pwd
29452 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29453 (gdb)
29454 @end smallexample
29455
29456 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29457 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29458 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29459
29460
29461 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29462 @findex -thread-info
29463
29464 @subsubheading Synopsis
29465
29466 @smallexample
29467 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29468 @end smallexample
29469
29470 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29471 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29472 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29473 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29474 current thread.
29475
29476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29477
29478 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29479 about all threads.
29480
29481 @subsubheading Result
29482
29483 The result contains the following attributes:
29484
29485 @table @samp
29486 @item threads
29487 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29488 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29489
29490 @item current-thread-id
29491 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29492 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29493 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29494 the command.
29495
29496 @end table
29497
29498 @subsubheading Example
29499
29500 @smallexample
29501 -thread-info
29502 ^done,threads=[
29503 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29504 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29505 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29506 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29507 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29508 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29509 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29510 state="running"@}],
29511 current-thread-id="1"
29512 (gdb)
29513 @end smallexample
29514
29515 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29516 @findex -thread-list-ids
29517
29518 @subsubheading Synopsis
29519
29520 @smallexample
29521 -thread-list-ids
29522 @end smallexample
29523
29524 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29525 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29526 threads.
29527
29528 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29529 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29530
29531 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29532
29533 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29534
29535 @subsubheading Example
29536
29537 @smallexample
29538 (gdb)
29539 -thread-list-ids
29540 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29541 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29542 (gdb)
29543 @end smallexample
29544
29545
29546 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29547 @findex -thread-select
29548
29549 @subsubheading Synopsis
29550
29551 @smallexample
29552 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29553 @end smallexample
29554
29555 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29556 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29557 topmost frame for that thread.
29558
29559 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29560 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29561
29562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29563
29564 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29565
29566 @subsubheading Example
29567
29568 @smallexample
29569 (gdb)
29570 -exec-next
29571 ^running
29572 (gdb)
29573 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29574 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29575 (gdb)
29576 -thread-list-ids
29577 ^done,
29578 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29579 number-of-threads="3"
29580 (gdb)
29581 -thread-select 3
29582 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29583 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29584 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29585 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29586 (gdb)
29587 @end smallexample
29588
29589 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29590 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29591 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29592
29593 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29594 @findex -ada-task-info
29595
29596 @subsubheading Synopsis
29597
29598 @smallexample
29599 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29600 @end smallexample
29601
29602 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29603 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29604
29605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29606
29607 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29608 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29609
29610 @subsubheading Result
29611
29612 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29613 defined for each Ada task:
29614
29615 @table @samp
29616 @item current
29617 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29618
29619 @item id
29620 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29621
29622 @item task-id
29623 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29624
29625 @item thread-id
29626 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29627 task.
29628
29629 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29630 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29631 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29632
29633 @item parent-id
29634 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29635 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29636
29637 @item priority
29638 The base priority of the task.
29639
29640 @item state
29641 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29642 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29643
29644 @item name
29645 The name of the task.
29646
29647 @end table
29648
29649 @subsubheading Example
29650
29651 @smallexample
29652 -ada-task-info
29653 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29654 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29655 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29656 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29657 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29658 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29659 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29660 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29661 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29662 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29663 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29664 (gdb)
29665 @end smallexample
29666
29667 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29668 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29669 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29670
29671 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29672 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29673 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29674 other cases.
29675
29676 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29677 @findex -exec-continue
29678
29679 @subsubheading Synopsis
29680
29681 @smallexample
29682 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29683 @end smallexample
29684
29685 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29686 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29687 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29688 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29689 @itemize @bullet
29690 @item
29691 breakpoints or watchpoints
29692 @item
29693 signals or exceptions
29694 @item
29695 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29696 @item
29697 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29698 @end itemize
29699 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29700 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29701 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29702 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29703 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29704 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29705
29706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29707
29708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29709
29710 @subsubheading Example
29711
29712 @smallexample
29713 -exec-continue
29714 ^running
29715 (gdb)
29716 @@Hello world
29717 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29718 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29719 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29720 (gdb)
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723
29724 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29725 @findex -exec-finish
29726
29727 @subsubheading Synopsis
29728
29729 @smallexample
29730 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29731 @end smallexample
29732
29733 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29734 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29735 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29736 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29737 function was called.
29738
29739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29740
29741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29742
29743 @subsubheading Example
29744
29745 Function returning @code{void}.
29746
29747 @smallexample
29748 -exec-finish
29749 ^running
29750 (gdb)
29751 @@hello from foo
29752 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29753 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29754 (gdb)
29755 @end smallexample
29756
29757 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29758 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29759 value itself.
29760
29761 @smallexample
29762 -exec-finish
29763 ^running
29764 (gdb)
29765 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29766 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29767 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29768 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29769 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29770 (gdb)
29771 @end smallexample
29772
29773
29774 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29775 @findex -exec-interrupt
29776
29777 @subsubheading Synopsis
29778
29779 @smallexample
29780 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29781 @end smallexample
29782
29783 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29784 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29785 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29786 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29787 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29788
29789 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29790 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29791 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29792 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29793
29794 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29795 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29796 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29797 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29798
29799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29800
29801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29802
29803 @subsubheading Example
29804
29805 @smallexample
29806 (gdb)
29807 111-exec-continue
29808 111^running
29809
29810 (gdb)
29811 222-exec-interrupt
29812 222^done
29813 (gdb)
29814 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29815 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29816 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29817 (gdb)
29818
29819 (gdb)
29820 -exec-interrupt
29821 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29822 (gdb)
29823 @end smallexample
29824
29825 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29826 @findex -exec-jump
29827
29828 @subsubheading Synopsis
29829
29830 @smallexample
29831 -exec-jump @var{location}
29832 @end smallexample
29833
29834 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29835 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29836 different forms of @var{location}.
29837
29838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29839
29840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29841
29842 @subsubheading Example
29843
29844 @smallexample
29845 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29846 *running,thread-id="all"
29847 ^running
29848 @end smallexample
29849
29850
29851 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29852 @findex -exec-next
29853
29854 @subsubheading Synopsis
29855
29856 @smallexample
29857 -exec-next [--reverse]
29858 @end smallexample
29859
29860 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29861 of the next source line is reached.
29862
29863 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29864 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29865 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29866 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29867 source line where the function was called.
29868
29869
29870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29871
29872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29873
29874 @subsubheading Example
29875
29876 @smallexample
29877 -exec-next
29878 ^running
29879 (gdb)
29880 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29881 (gdb)
29882 @end smallexample
29883
29884
29885 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29886 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29887
29888 @subsubheading Synopsis
29889
29890 @smallexample
29891 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29892 @end smallexample
29893
29894 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29895 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29896 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29897 printed as well.
29898
29899 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29900 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29901 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29902 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29903 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29904
29905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29906
29907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29908
29909 @subsubheading Example
29910
29911 @smallexample
29912 (gdb)
29913 -exec-next-instruction
29914 ^running
29915
29916 (gdb)
29917 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29918 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29919 (gdb)
29920 @end smallexample
29921
29922
29923 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29924 @findex -exec-return
29925
29926 @subsubheading Synopsis
29927
29928 @smallexample
29929 -exec-return
29930 @end smallexample
29931
29932 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29933 Displays the new current frame.
29934
29935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29936
29937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29938
29939 @subsubheading Example
29940
29941 @smallexample
29942 (gdb)
29943 200-break-insert callee4
29944 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29945 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29946 (gdb)
29947 000-exec-run
29948 000^running
29949 (gdb)
29950 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29951 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29952 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29953 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29954 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29955 (gdb)
29956 205-break-delete
29957 205^done
29958 (gdb)
29959 111-exec-return
29960 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29961 args=[@{name="strarg",
29962 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29963 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29964 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29965 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29966 (gdb)
29967 @end smallexample
29968
29969
29970 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29971 @findex -exec-run
29972
29973 @subsubheading Synopsis
29974
29975 @smallexample
29976 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29977 @end smallexample
29978
29979 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29980 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29981 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29982 the program has exited exceptionally.
29983
29984 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29985 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29986 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29987 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29988 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29989
29990 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29991 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29992 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29993 (@pxref{Starting}).
29994
29995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29996
29997 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29998
29999 @subsubheading Examples
30000
30001 @smallexample
30002 (gdb)
30003 -break-insert main
30004 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30005 (gdb)
30006 -exec-run
30007 ^running
30008 (gdb)
30009 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30010 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30011 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30012 (gdb)
30013 @end smallexample
30014
30015 @noindent
30016 Program exited normally:
30017
30018 @smallexample
30019 (gdb)
30020 -exec-run
30021 ^running
30022 (gdb)
30023 x = 55
30024 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30025 (gdb)
30026 @end smallexample
30027
30028 @noindent
30029 Program exited exceptionally:
30030
30031 @smallexample
30032 (gdb)
30033 -exec-run
30034 ^running
30035 (gdb)
30036 x = 55
30037 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30038 (gdb)
30039 @end smallexample
30040
30041 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30042 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 (gdb)
30046 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30047 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30048 @end smallexample
30049
30050
30051 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30052
30053
30054 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30055 @findex -exec-step
30056
30057 @subsubheading Synopsis
30058
30059 @smallexample
30060 -exec-step [--reverse]
30061 @end smallexample
30062
30063 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30064 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30065 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30066 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30067 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30068 previously executed source line.
30069
30070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30071
30072 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30073
30074 @subsubheading Example
30075
30076 Stepping into a function:
30077
30078 @smallexample
30079 -exec-step
30080 ^running
30081 (gdb)
30082 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30083 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30084 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30085 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30086 (gdb)
30087 @end smallexample
30088
30089 Regular stepping:
30090
30091 @smallexample
30092 -exec-step
30093 ^running
30094 (gdb)
30095 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30096 (gdb)
30097 @end smallexample
30098
30099
30100 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30101 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30102
30103 @subsubheading Synopsis
30104
30105 @smallexample
30106 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30107 @end smallexample
30108
30109 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30110 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30111 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30112 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30113 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30114 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30115 as well.
30116
30117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30118
30119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30120
30121 @subsubheading Example
30122
30123 @smallexample
30124 (gdb)
30125 -exec-step-instruction
30126 ^running
30127
30128 (gdb)
30129 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30130 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30131 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30132 (gdb)
30133 -exec-step-instruction
30134 ^running
30135
30136 (gdb)
30137 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30138 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30139 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30140 (gdb)
30141 @end smallexample
30142
30143
30144 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30145 @findex -exec-until
30146
30147 @subsubheading Synopsis
30148
30149 @smallexample
30150 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30151 @end smallexample
30152
30153 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30154 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30155 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30156 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30157
30158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30159
30160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30161
30162 @subsubheading Example
30163
30164 @smallexample
30165 (gdb)
30166 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30167 ^running
30168 (gdb)
30169 x = 55
30170 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30171 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30172 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30173 (gdb)
30174 @end smallexample
30175
30176 @ignore
30177 @subheading -file-clear
30178 Is this going away????
30179 @end ignore
30180
30181 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30182 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30183 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30184
30185 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30186 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30187
30188 @smallexample
30189 -enable-frame-filters
30190 @end smallexample
30191
30192 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30193 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30194 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30195 request that this functionality be enabled.
30196
30197 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30198
30199 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30200 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30201
30202 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30203 @findex -stack-info-frame
30204
30205 @subsubheading Synopsis
30206
30207 @smallexample
30208 -stack-info-frame
30209 @end smallexample
30210
30211 Get info on the selected frame.
30212
30213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30214
30215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30216 (without arguments).
30217
30218 @subsubheading Example
30219
30220 @smallexample
30221 (gdb)
30222 -stack-info-frame
30223 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30224 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30225 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30226 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30227 (gdb)
30228 @end smallexample
30229
30230 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30231 @findex -stack-info-depth
30232
30233 @subsubheading Synopsis
30234
30235 @smallexample
30236 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30240 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30241
30242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30243
30244 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30245
30246 @subsubheading Example
30247
30248 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30249
30250 @smallexample
30251 (gdb)
30252 -stack-info-depth
30253 ^done,depth="12"
30254 (gdb)
30255 -stack-info-depth 4
30256 ^done,depth="4"
30257 (gdb)
30258 -stack-info-depth 12
30259 ^done,depth="12"
30260 (gdb)
30261 -stack-info-depth 11
30262 ^done,depth="11"
30263 (gdb)
30264 -stack-info-depth 13
30265 ^done,depth="12"
30266 (gdb)
30267 @end smallexample
30268
30269 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30270 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30271 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30272
30273 @subsubheading Synopsis
30274
30275 @smallexample
30276 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30277 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30278 @end smallexample
30279
30280 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30281 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30282 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30283 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30284 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30285 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30286 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30287 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30288
30289 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30290 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30291 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30292 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30293 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30294 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30295
30296 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30297 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30298 are still displayed, however.
30299
30300 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30301 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30302
30303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30304
30305 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30306 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30307 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30308
30309 @subsubheading Example
30310
30311 @smallexample
30312 (gdb)
30313 -stack-list-frames
30314 ^done,
30315 stack=[
30316 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30317 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30318 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30319 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30320 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30321 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30322 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30323 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30324 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30325 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30326 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30327 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30328 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30329 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30330 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30331 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30332 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30333 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30334 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30335 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30336 (gdb)
30337 -stack-list-arguments 0
30338 ^done,
30339 stack-args=[
30340 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30341 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30342 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30343 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30344 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30345 (gdb)
30346 -stack-list-arguments 1
30347 ^done,
30348 stack-args=[
30349 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30350 frame=@{level="1",
30351 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30352 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30353 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30354 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30355 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30356 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30357 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30358 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30359 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30360 (gdb)
30361 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30362 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30363 (gdb)
30364 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30365 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30366 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30367 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30368 (gdb)
30369 @end smallexample
30370
30371 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30372
30373
30374 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30375 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30376 @findex -stack-list-frames
30377
30378 @subsubheading Synopsis
30379
30380 @smallexample
30381 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30382 @end smallexample
30383
30384 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30385 following info:
30386
30387 @table @samp
30388 @item @var{level}
30389 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30390 @item @var{addr}
30391 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30392 @item @var{func}
30393 Function name.
30394 @item @var{file}
30395 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30396 @item @var{fullname}
30397 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30398 @item @var{line}
30399 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30400 @item @var{from}
30401 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30402 if the frame's function is not known.
30403 @item @var{arch}
30404 Frame's architecture.
30405 @end table
30406
30407 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30408 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30409 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30410 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30411 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30412 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30413 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30414 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30415 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30416
30417 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30418
30419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30420
30421 @subsubheading Example
30422
30423 Full stack backtrace:
30424
30425 @smallexample
30426 (gdb)
30427 -stack-list-frames
30428 ^done,stack=
30429 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30430 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30431 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30432 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30433 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30434 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30435 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30436 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30437 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30438 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30439 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30440 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30441 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30442 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30443 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30444 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30445 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30446 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30447 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30448 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30449 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30450 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30451 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30452 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30453 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30454 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30455 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30456 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30457 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30458 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30459 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30460 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30461 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30462 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30463 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30464 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30465 (gdb)
30466 @end smallexample
30467
30468 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30469
30470 @smallexample
30471 (gdb)
30472 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30473 ^done,stack=
30474 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30475 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30476 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30477 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30478 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30479 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30480 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30481 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30482 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30483 (gdb)
30484 @end smallexample
30485
30486 Show a single frame:
30487
30488 @smallexample
30489 (gdb)
30490 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30491 ^done,stack=
30492 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30493 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30494 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30495 (gdb)
30496 @end smallexample
30497
30498
30499 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30500 @findex -stack-list-locals
30501 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30502
30503 @subsubheading Synopsis
30504
30505 @smallexample
30506 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30507 @end smallexample
30508
30509 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30510 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30511 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30512 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30513 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30514 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30515 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30516 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30517 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30518 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30519
30520 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30521 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30522 variables are still displayed, however.
30523
30524 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30525 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30526
30527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30528
30529 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30530
30531 @subsubheading Example
30532
30533 @smallexample
30534 (gdb)
30535 -stack-list-locals 0
30536 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30537 (gdb)
30538 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30539 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30540 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30541 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30542 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30543 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30544 (gdb)
30545 @end smallexample
30546
30547 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30548 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30549 @findex -stack-list-variables
30550
30551 @subsubheading Synopsis
30552
30553 @smallexample
30554 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30555 @end smallexample
30556
30557 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30558 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30559 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30560 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30561 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30562 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30563 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30564
30565 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30566 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30567 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30568
30569 @subsubheading Example
30570
30571 @smallexample
30572 (gdb)
30573 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30574 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30575 (gdb)
30576 @end smallexample
30577
30578
30579 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30580 @findex -stack-select-frame
30581
30582 @subsubheading Synopsis
30583
30584 @smallexample
30585 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30586 @end smallexample
30587
30588 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30589 the stack.
30590
30591 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30592 option to every command.
30593
30594 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30595
30596 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30597 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30598
30599 @subsubheading Example
30600
30601 @smallexample
30602 (gdb)
30603 -stack-select-frame 2
30604 ^done
30605 (gdb)
30606 @end smallexample
30607
30608 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30609 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30610 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30611
30612 @ignore
30613
30614 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30615
30616 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30617 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30618 used by @code{Insight}.
30619
30620 The two main reasons for that are:
30621
30622 @enumerate 1
30623 @item
30624 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30625
30626 @item
30627 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30628 now).
30629 @end enumerate
30630
30631 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30632 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30633 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30634 hints about their use.
30635
30636 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30637 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30638 least, the following operations:
30639
30640 @itemize @bullet
30641 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30642 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30643 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30644 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30645 @end itemize
30646
30647 @end ignore
30648
30649 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30650
30651 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30652
30653 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30654 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30655 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30656 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30657 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30658 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30659 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30660 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30661 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30662 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30663 object, or to change display format.
30664
30665 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30666 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30667 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30668 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30669 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30670 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30671 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30672 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30673 child will be created.
30674
30675 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30676 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30677 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30678 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30679 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30680
30681 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30682 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30683 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30684 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30685 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30686 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30687 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30688 variables that frontend has created.
30689
30690 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30691 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30692 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30693 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30694 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30695 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30696 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30697 implicitly updated.
30698
30699 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30700 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30701 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30702 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30703 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30704 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30705 frame. Consider this example:
30706
30707 @smallexample
30708 void do_work(...)
30709 @{
30710 struct work_state state;
30711
30712 if (...)
30713 do_work(...);
30714 @}
30715 @end smallexample
30716
30717 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30718 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30719 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30720 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30721 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30722
30723 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30724 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30725 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30726 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30727 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30728 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30729
30730 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30731 access this functionality:
30732
30733 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30734 @item @strong{Operation}
30735 @tab @strong{Description}
30736
30737 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30738 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30739 @item @code{-var-create}
30740 @tab create a variable object
30741 @item @code{-var-delete}
30742 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30743 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30744 @tab set the display format of this variable
30745 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30746 @tab show the display format of this variable
30747 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30748 @tab tells how many children this object has
30749 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30750 @tab return a list of the object's children
30751 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30752 @tab show the type of this variable object
30753 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30754 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30755 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30756 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30757 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30758 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30759 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30760 @tab get the value of this variable
30761 @item @code{-var-assign}
30762 @tab set the value of this variable
30763 @item @code{-var-update}
30764 @tab update the variable and its children
30765 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30766 @tab set frozeness attribute
30767 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30768 @tab set range of children to display on update
30769 @end multitable
30770
30771 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30772 how it can be used.
30773
30774 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30775
30776 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30777 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30778
30779 @smallexample
30780 -enable-pretty-printing
30781 @end smallexample
30782
30783 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30784 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30785 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30786 request that this functionality be enabled.
30787
30788 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30789
30790 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30791 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30792
30793 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30794 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30795
30796 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30797 @findex -var-create
30798
30799 @subsubheading Synopsis
30800
30801 @smallexample
30802 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30803 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30804 @end smallexample
30805
30806 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30807 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30808 register.
30809
30810 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30811 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30812 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30813 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30814 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30815
30816 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30817 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30818 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30819 object must be created.
30820
30821 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30822 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30823
30824 @itemize @bullet
30825 @item
30826 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30827
30828 @item
30829 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30830
30831 @item
30832 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30833 @end itemize
30834
30835 @cindex dynamic varobj
30836 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30837 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30838 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30839 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30840 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30841 compatibility for existing clients.
30842
30843 @subsubheading Result
30844
30845 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30846 are:
30847
30848 @table @samp
30849 @item name
30850 The name of the varobj.
30851
30852 @item numchild
30853 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30854 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30855 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30856
30857 @item value
30858 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30859 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30860 will not be interesting.
30861
30862 @item type
30863 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30864 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30865 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30866 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30867 @emph{declared} one.
30868
30869 @item thread-id
30870 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30871 thread's global identifier.
30872
30873 @item has_more
30874 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30875 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30876
30877 @item dynamic
30878 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30879 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30880 then this attribute will not be present.
30881
30882 @item displayhint
30883 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30884 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30885 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30886 @end table
30887
30888 Typical output will look like this:
30889
30890 @smallexample
30891 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30892 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30893 @end smallexample
30894
30895
30896 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30897 @findex -var-delete
30898
30899 @subsubheading Synopsis
30900
30901 @smallexample
30902 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30903 @end smallexample
30904
30905 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30906 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30907
30908 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30909
30910
30911 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30912 @findex -var-set-format
30913
30914 @subsubheading Synopsis
30915
30916 @smallexample
30917 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30918 @end smallexample
30919
30920 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30921 @var{format-spec}.
30922
30923 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30924 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30925
30926 @smallexample
30927 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30928 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30929 @end smallexample
30930
30931 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30932 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30933 for pointers, etc.).
30934
30935 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30936 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30937 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30938 zero-hexadecimal format.
30939
30940 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30941 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30942
30943 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30944 @findex -var-show-format
30945
30946 @subsubheading Synopsis
30947
30948 @smallexample
30949 -var-show-format @var{name}
30950 @end smallexample
30951
30952 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30953
30954 @smallexample
30955 @var{format} @expansion{}
30956 @var{format-spec}
30957 @end smallexample
30958
30959
30960 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30961 @findex -var-info-num-children
30962
30963 @subsubheading Synopsis
30964
30965 @smallexample
30966 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30967 @end smallexample
30968
30969 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30970
30971 @smallexample
30972 numchild=@var{n}
30973 @end smallexample
30974
30975 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30976 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30977 be available.
30978
30979
30980 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30981 @findex -var-list-children
30982
30983 @subsubheading Synopsis
30984
30985 @smallexample
30986 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30987 @end smallexample
30988 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30989
30990 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30991 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30992 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30993 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30994 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30995 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30996 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30997 and unions.
30998
30999 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31000 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31001 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31002 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31003 reported.
31004
31005 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31006 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31007 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31008 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31009 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31010 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31011 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31012 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31013 the visible items.
31014
31015 For each child the following results are returned:
31016
31017 @table @var
31018
31019 @item name
31020 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31021
31022 @item exp
31023 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31024 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31025
31026 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31027 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31028
31029 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31030 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31031 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31032 type and value are not present.
31033
31034 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31035 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31036 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31037
31038 @item numchild
31039 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31040 0.
31041
31042 @item type
31043 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31044 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31045 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31046 @emph{declared} one.
31047
31048 @item value
31049 If values were requested, this is the value.
31050
31051 @item thread-id
31052 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31053 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31054
31055 @item frozen
31056 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31057
31058 @item displayhint
31059 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31060 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31061 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31062
31063 @item dynamic
31064 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31065 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31066 then this attribute will not be present.
31067
31068 @end table
31069
31070 The result may have its own attributes:
31071
31072 @table @samp
31073 @item displayhint
31074 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31075 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31076 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31077
31078 @item has_more
31079 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31080 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31081 @end table
31082
31083 @subsubheading Example
31084
31085 @smallexample
31086 (gdb)
31087 -var-list-children n
31088 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31089 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31090 (gdb)
31091 -var-list-children --all-values n
31092 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31093 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31094 @end smallexample
31095
31096
31097 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31098 @findex -var-info-type
31099
31100 @subsubheading Synopsis
31101
31102 @smallexample
31103 -var-info-type @var{name}
31104 @end smallexample
31105
31106 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31107 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31108 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31109
31110 @smallexample
31111 type=@var{typename}
31112 @end smallexample
31113
31114
31115 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31116 @findex -var-info-expression
31117
31118 @subsubheading Synopsis
31119
31120 @smallexample
31121 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31122 @end smallexample
31123
31124 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31125 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31126 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31127
31128 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31129 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31130
31131 @smallexample
31132 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31133 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 @noindent
31137 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31138 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31139
31140 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31141 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31142 is of limited use.
31143
31144 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31145 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31146
31147 @subsubheading Synopsis
31148
31149 @smallexample
31150 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31151 @end smallexample
31152
31153 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31154 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31155 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31156 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31157 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31158 watchpoint from a variable object.
31159
31160 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31161 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31162
31163 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31164 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31165 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31166 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31167 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31168 @smallexample
31169 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31170 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31171 @end smallexample
31172
31173 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31174 @findex -var-show-attributes
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31183
31184 @smallexample
31185 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31186 @end smallexample
31187
31188 @noindent
31189 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31190
31191 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31192 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31193
31194 @subsubheading Synopsis
31195
31196 @smallexample
31197 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31198 @end smallexample
31199
31200 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31201 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31202 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31203 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31204 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31205 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31206 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31207
31208 @smallexample
31209 value=@var{value}
31210 @end smallexample
31211
31212 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31213 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31214
31215 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31216 @findex -var-assign
31217
31218 @subsubheading Synopsis
31219
31220 @smallexample
31221 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31222 @end smallexample
31223
31224 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31225 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31226 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31227 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31228
31229 @subsubheading Example
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 (gdb)
31233 -var-assign var1 3
31234 ^done,value="3"
31235 (gdb)
31236 -var-update *
31237 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31238 (gdb)
31239 @end smallexample
31240
31241 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31242 @findex -var-update
31243
31244 @subsubheading Synopsis
31245
31246 @smallexample
31247 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31248 @end smallexample
31249
31250 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31251 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31252 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31253 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31254 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31255 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31256 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31257 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31258 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31259 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31260 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31261 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31262 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31263
31264 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31265 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31266 diagnostic.
31267
31268 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31269 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31270
31271 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31272 @samp{changelist}.
31273
31274 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31275
31276 @table @samp
31277 @item name
31278 The name of the varobj.
31279
31280 @item value
31281 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31282 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31283
31284 @item in_scope
31285 @anchor{-var-update}
31286 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31287
31288 @table @code
31289 @item "true"
31290 The variable object's current value is valid.
31291
31292 @item "false"
31293 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31294 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31295 scope.
31296
31297 @item "invalid"
31298 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31299 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31300 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31301 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31302 objects.
31303 @end table
31304
31305 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31306 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31307
31308 @item type_changed
31309 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31310 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31311 be @samp{false}.
31312
31313 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31314 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31315 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31316 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31317 unset.
31318
31319 @item new_type
31320 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31321 hold the new type.
31322
31323 @item new_num_children
31324 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31325 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31326
31327 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31328 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31329 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31330 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31331 children which may be available.
31332
31333 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31334 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31335 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31336 only happen at the end of the update range).
31337
31338 @item displayhint
31339 The display hint, if any.
31340
31341 @item has_more
31342 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31343 available outside the varobj's update range.
31344
31345 @item dynamic
31346 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31347 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31348 then this attribute will not be present.
31349
31350 @item new_children
31351 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31352 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31353 be listed in this attribute.
31354 @end table
31355
31356 @subsubheading Example
31357
31358 @smallexample
31359 (gdb)
31360 -var-assign var1 3
31361 ^done,value="3"
31362 (gdb)
31363 -var-update --all-values var1
31364 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31365 type_changed="false"@}]
31366 (gdb)
31367 @end smallexample
31368
31369 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31370 @findex -var-set-frozen
31371 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31372
31373 @subsubheading Synopsis
31374
31375 @smallexample
31376 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31377 @end smallexample
31378
31379 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31380 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31381 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31382 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31383 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31384 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31385 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31386 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31387 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31388 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31389 @code{-var-update} does.
31390
31391 @subsubheading Example
31392
31393 @smallexample
31394 (gdb)
31395 -var-set-frozen V 1
31396 ^done
31397 (gdb)
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31401 @findex -var-set-update-range
31402 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31403
31404 @subsubheading Synopsis
31405
31406 @smallexample
31407 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31408 @end smallexample
31409
31410 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31411 @code{-var-update}.
31412
31413 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31414 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31415 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31416 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31417
31418 @subsubheading Example
31419
31420 @smallexample
31421 (gdb)
31422 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31423 ^done
31424 @end smallexample
31425
31426 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31427 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31428 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31429
31430 @subsubheading Synopsis
31431
31432 @smallexample
31433 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31434 @end smallexample
31435
31436 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31437
31438 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31439 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31440
31441 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31442 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31443 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31444 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31445 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31446 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31447 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31448
31449 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31450 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31451 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31452 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31453
31454 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31455 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31456 can be used to check this.
31457
31458 @subsubheading Example
31459
31460 Resetting the visualizer:
31461
31462 @smallexample
31463 (gdb)
31464 -var-set-visualizer V None
31465 ^done
31466 @end smallexample
31467
31468 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31469
31470 @smallexample
31471 (gdb)
31472 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31473 ^done
31474 @end smallexample
31475
31476 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31477 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31478
31479 @smallexample
31480 (gdb)
31481 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31482 ^done
31483 @end smallexample
31484
31485 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31486 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31487 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31488
31489 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31490 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31491 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31492 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31493
31494 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31495 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31496
31497 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31498 @c @subheading -data-assign
31499 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31500 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31501 @c set variable
31502 @c @subsubheading Example
31503 @c N.A.
31504
31505 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31506 @findex -data-disassemble
31507
31508 @subsubheading Synopsis
31509
31510 @smallexample
31511 -data-disassemble
31512 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31513 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31514 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31515 -- @var{mode}
31516 @end smallexample
31517
31518 @noindent
31519 Where:
31520
31521 @table @samp
31522 @item @var{start-addr}
31523 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31524 @item @var{end-addr}
31525 is the end address
31526 @item @var{addr}
31527 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31528 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31529 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31530 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31531 @item @var{filename}
31532 is the name of the file to disassemble
31533 @item @var{linenum}
31534 is the line number to disassemble around
31535 @item @var{lines}
31536 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31537 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31538 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31539 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31540 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31541 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31542 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31543 are displayed.
31544 @item @var{mode}
31545 is one of:
31546 @itemize @bullet
31547 @item 0 disassembly only
31548 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31549 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31550 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31551 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31552 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31553 @end itemize
31554
31555 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31556 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31557 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31558 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31559 @end table
31560
31561 @subsubheading Result
31562
31563 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31564 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31565 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31566
31567 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31568 following fields:
31569
31570 @table @code
31571 @item address
31572 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31573
31574 @item func-name
31575 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31576
31577 @item offset
31578 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31579
31580 @item inst
31581 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31582
31583 @item opcodes
31584 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31585 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31586
31587 @end table
31588
31589 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31590 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31591
31592 @table @code
31593 @item line
31594 The line number within @samp{file}.
31595
31596 @item file
31597 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31598 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31599 used.
31600
31601 @item fullname
31602 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31603 using the source file search path
31604 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31605 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31606
31607 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31608 present in the debug information.
31609
31610 @item line_asm_insn
31611 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31612 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31613 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31614 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31615 @samp{opcodes}.
31616
31617 @end table
31618
31619 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31620 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31621 adjust its format.
31622
31623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31624
31625 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31626
31627 @subsubheading Example
31628
31629 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31630
31631 @smallexample
31632 (gdb)
31633 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31634 ^done,
31635 asm_insns=[
31636 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31637 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31638 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31639 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31640 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31641 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31642 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31643 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31644 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31645 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31646 (gdb)
31647 @end smallexample
31648
31649 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31650 @code{main}.
31651
31652 @smallexample
31653 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31654 ^done,asm_insns=[
31655 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31656 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31657 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31658 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31659 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31660 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31661 [@dots{}]
31662 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31663 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31664 (gdb)
31665 @end smallexample
31666
31667 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31668
31669 @smallexample
31670 (gdb)
31671 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31672 ^done,asm_insns=[
31673 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31674 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31675 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31676 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31677 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31678 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31679 (gdb)
31680 @end smallexample
31681
31682 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31683
31684 @smallexample
31685 (gdb)
31686 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31687 ^done,asm_insns=[
31688 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31689 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31690 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31691 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31692 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31693 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31694 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31695 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31696 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31697 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31698 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31699 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31700 (gdb)
31701 @end smallexample
31702
31703
31704 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31705 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31706
31707 @subsubheading Synopsis
31708
31709 @smallexample
31710 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31711 @end smallexample
31712
31713 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31714 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31715 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31716
31717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31718
31719 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31720 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31721 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31722
31723 @subsubheading Example
31724
31725 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31726 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31727 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31728 output.
31729
31730 @smallexample
31731 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31732 211^done,value="1"
31733 (gdb)
31734 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31735 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31736 (gdb)
31737 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31738 411^done,value="4"
31739 (gdb)
31740 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31741 511^done,value="4"
31742 (gdb)
31743 @end smallexample
31744
31745
31746 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31747 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31748
31749 @subsubheading Synopsis
31750
31751 @smallexample
31752 -data-list-changed-registers
31753 @end smallexample
31754
31755 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31756
31757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31758
31759 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31760 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31761
31762 @subsubheading Example
31763
31764 On a PPC MBX board:
31765
31766 @smallexample
31767 (gdb)
31768 -exec-continue
31769 ^running
31770
31771 (gdb)
31772 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31773 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31774 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31775 (gdb)
31776 -data-list-changed-registers
31777 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31778 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31779 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31780 (gdb)
31781 @end smallexample
31782
31783
31784 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31785 @findex -data-list-register-names
31786
31787 @subsubheading Synopsis
31788
31789 @smallexample
31790 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31791 @end smallexample
31792
31793 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31794 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31795 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31796 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31797 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31798 include empty register names.
31799
31800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31801
31802 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31803 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31804 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31805
31806 @subsubheading Example
31807
31808 For the PPC MBX board:
31809 @smallexample
31810 (gdb)
31811 -data-list-register-names
31812 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31813 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31814 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31815 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31816 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31817 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31818 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31819 (gdb)
31820 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31821 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31822 (gdb)
31823 @end smallexample
31824
31825 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31826 @findex -data-list-register-values
31827
31828 @subsubheading Synopsis
31829
31830 @smallexample
31831 -data-list-register-values
31832 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31833 @end smallexample
31834
31835 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31836 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31837 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31838 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31839 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31840 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31841
31842 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31843
31844 @table @code
31845 @item x
31846 Hexadecimal
31847 @item o
31848 Octal
31849 @item t
31850 Binary
31851 @item d
31852 Decimal
31853 @item r
31854 Raw
31855 @item N
31856 Natural
31857 @end table
31858
31859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31860
31861 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31862 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31863
31864 @subsubheading Example
31865
31866 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31867 don't appear in the actual output):
31868
31869 @smallexample
31870 (gdb)
31871 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31872 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31873 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31874 (gdb)
31875 -data-list-register-values x
31876 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31877 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31878 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31879 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31880 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31881 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31882 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31883 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31884 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31885 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31886 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31887 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31888 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31889 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31890 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31891 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31892 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31893 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31894 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31895 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31896 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31897 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31898 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31899 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31900 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31901 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31902 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31903 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31904 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31905 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31906 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31907 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31908 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31909 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31910 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31911 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31912 (gdb)
31913 @end smallexample
31914
31915
31916 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31917 @findex -data-read-memory
31918
31919 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31920
31921 @subsubheading Synopsis
31922
31923 @smallexample
31924 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31925 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31926 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31927 @end smallexample
31928
31929 @noindent
31930 where:
31931
31932 @table @samp
31933 @item @var{address}
31934 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31935 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31936 quoted using the C convention.
31937
31938 @item @var{word-format}
31939 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31940 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31941 ,Output Formats}).
31942
31943 @item @var{word-size}
31944 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31945
31946 @item @var{nr-rows}
31947 The number of rows in the output table.
31948
31949 @item @var{nr-cols}
31950 The number of columns in the output table.
31951
31952 @item @var{aschar}
31953 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31954 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31955 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31956 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31957
31958 @item @var{byte-offset}
31959 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31960 @end table
31961
31962 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31963 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31964 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31965 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31966 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31967 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31968 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31969 @samp{addr}.
31970
31971 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31972 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31973 @samp{prev-page}.
31974
31975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31976
31977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31978 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31979
31980 @subsubheading Example
31981
31982 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31983 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31984 word. Display each word in hex.
31985
31986 @smallexample
31987 (gdb)
31988 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31989 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31990 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31991 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31992 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31993 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31994 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31995 (gdb)
31996 @end smallexample
31997
31998 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31999 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32000
32001 @smallexample
32002 (gdb)
32003 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32004 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32005 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32006 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32007 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32008 (gdb)
32009 @end smallexample
32010
32011 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32012 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32013 used as the non-printable character.
32014
32015 @smallexample
32016 (gdb)
32017 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32018 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32019 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32020 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32021 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32022 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32023 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32024 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32025 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32026 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32027 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32028 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32029 (gdb)
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32033 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32034
32035 @subsubheading Synopsis
32036
32037 @smallexample
32038 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32039 @var{address} @var{count}
32040 @end smallexample
32041
32042 @noindent
32043 where:
32044
32045 @table @samp
32046 @item @var{address}
32047 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32048 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32049 quoted using the C convention.
32050
32051 @item @var{count}
32052 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32053 literal.
32054
32055 @item @var{offset}
32056 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32057 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32058 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32059 arithmetics itself.
32060
32061 @end table
32062
32063 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32064 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32065 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32066 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32067 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32068 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32069
32070 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32071 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32072 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32073 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32074 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32075 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32076 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32077 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32078
32079 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32080 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32081 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32082 and has the following fields:
32083
32084 @table @code
32085 @item begin
32086 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32087
32088 @item end
32089 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32090
32091 @item offset
32092 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32093 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32094
32095 @item contents
32096 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32097
32098 @end table
32099
32100
32101
32102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32103
32104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32105
32106 @subsubheading Example
32107
32108 @smallexample
32109 (gdb)
32110 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32111 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32112 end="0xbffff15e",
32113 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32114 (gdb)
32115 @end smallexample
32116
32117
32118 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32119 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32120
32121 @subsubheading Synopsis
32122
32123 @smallexample
32124 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32125 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32126 @end smallexample
32127
32128 @noindent
32129 where:
32130
32131 @table @samp
32132 @item @var{address}
32133 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32134 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32135 be quoted using the C convention.
32136
32137 @item @var{contents}
32138 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32139 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32140
32141 @item @var{count}
32142 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32143 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32144 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32145 @var{count} memory units.
32146
32147 @end table
32148
32149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32150
32151 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32152
32153 @subsubheading Example
32154
32155 @smallexample
32156 (gdb)
32157 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32158 ^done
32159 (gdb)
32160 @end smallexample
32161
32162 @smallexample
32163 (gdb)
32164 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32165 ^done
32166 (gdb)
32167 @end smallexample
32168
32169 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32170 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32171 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32172
32173 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32174 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32175
32176 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32177 @findex -trace-find
32178
32179 @subsubheading Synopsis
32180
32181 @smallexample
32182 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32183 @end smallexample
32184
32185 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32186 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32187 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32188
32189 @table @samp
32190
32191 @item none
32192 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32193
32194 @item frame-number
32195 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32196 that index.
32197
32198 @item tracepoint-number
32199 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32200 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32201
32202 @item pc
32203 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32204 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32205 address.
32206
32207 @item pc-inside-range
32208 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32209 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32210 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32211
32212 @item pc-outside-range
32213 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32214 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32215 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32216
32217 @item line
32218 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32219 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32220 the specified location.
32221
32222 @end table
32223
32224 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32225 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32226
32227 @table @samp
32228 @item found
32229 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32230 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32231
32232 @item traceframe
32233 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32234 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32235
32236 @item tracepoint
32237 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32238 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32239
32240 @item frame
32241 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32242 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32243 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32244
32245 @end table
32246
32247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32248
32249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32250
32251 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32252 @findex -trace-define-variable
32253
32254 @subsubheading Synopsis
32255
32256 @smallexample
32257 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32258 @end smallexample
32259
32260 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32261 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32262 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32263 with the @samp{$} character.
32264
32265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32266
32267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32268
32269 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32270 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32271
32272 @subsubheading Synopsis
32273
32274 @smallexample
32275 -trace-frame-collected
32276 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32277 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32278 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32279 [--memory-contents]
32280 @end smallexample
32281
32282 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32283 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32284 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32285 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32286 See the output description table below for more details.
32287
32288 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32289 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32290 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32291 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32292 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32293
32294 For instance, if the actions were
32295 @smallexample
32296 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32297 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32298 @end smallexample
32299
32300 @noindent
32301 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32302 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32303 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32304 objects would be computed expressions.
32305
32306 An example output would be:
32307
32308 @smallexample
32309 (gdb)
32310 -trace-frame-collected
32311 ^done,
32312 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32313 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32314 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32315 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32316 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32317 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32318 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32319 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32320 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32321 ...
32322 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32323 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32324 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32325 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32326 (gdb)
32327 @end smallexample
32328
32329 Where:
32330
32331 @table @code
32332 @item explicit-variables
32333 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32334 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32335 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32336 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32337 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32338 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32339 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32340 arrays, structures and unions.
32341
32342 @item computed-expressions
32343 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32344 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32345 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32346 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32347
32348 @item registers
32349 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32350 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32351 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32352 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32353 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32354
32355 @item tvars
32356 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32357 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32358 current value are returned.
32359
32360 @item memory
32361 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32362 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32363 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32364
32365 @table @code
32366 @item address
32367 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32368
32369 @item length
32370 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32371
32372 @item contents
32373 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32374 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32375
32376 @end table
32377
32378 @end table
32379
32380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32381
32382 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32383
32384 @subsubheading Example
32385
32386 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32387 @findex -trace-list-variables
32388
32389 @subsubheading Synopsis
32390
32391 @smallexample
32392 -trace-list-variables
32393 @end smallexample
32394
32395 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32396 table has the following fields:
32397
32398 @table @samp
32399 @item name
32400 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32401
32402 @item initial
32403 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32404 field is always present.
32405
32406 @item current
32407 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32408 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32409 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32410 presently running.
32411
32412 @end table
32413
32414 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32415
32416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32417
32418 @subsubheading Example
32419
32420 @smallexample
32421 (gdb)
32422 -trace-list-variables
32423 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32424 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32425 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32426 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32427 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32428 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32429 (gdb)
32430 @end smallexample
32431
32432 @subheading -trace-save
32433 @findex -trace-save
32434
32435 @subsubheading Synopsis
32436
32437 @smallexample
32438 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32439 @end smallexample
32440
32441 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32442 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32443 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32444 to perform the save.
32445
32446 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32447 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32448 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32449
32450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32451
32452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32453
32454
32455 @subheading -trace-start
32456 @findex -trace-start
32457
32458 @subsubheading Synopsis
32459
32460 @smallexample
32461 -trace-start
32462 @end smallexample
32463
32464 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32465 have any fields.
32466
32467 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32468
32469 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32470
32471 @subheading -trace-status
32472 @findex -trace-status
32473
32474 @subsubheading Synopsis
32475
32476 @smallexample
32477 -trace-status
32478 @end smallexample
32479
32480 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32481 the following fields:
32482
32483 @table @samp
32484
32485 @item supported
32486 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32487 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32488 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32489 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32490 started. This field is always present.
32491
32492 @item running
32493 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32494 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32495 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32496
32497 @item stop-reason
32498 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32499 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32500 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32501 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32502 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32503 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32504 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32505 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32506 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32507
32508 @item stopping-tracepoint
32509 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32510 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32511 @samp{passcount}.
32512
32513 @item frames
32514 @itemx frames-created
32515 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32516 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32517 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32518 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32519
32520 @item buffer-size
32521 @itemx buffer-free
32522 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32523 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32524
32525 @item circular
32526 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32527 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32528 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32529 and may fill up.
32530
32531 @item disconnected
32532 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32533 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32534 that the trace run will stop.
32535
32536 @item trace-file
32537 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32538 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32539
32540 @end table
32541
32542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32543
32544 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32545
32546 @subheading -trace-stop
32547 @findex -trace-stop
32548
32549 @subsubheading Synopsis
32550
32551 @smallexample
32552 -trace-stop
32553 @end smallexample
32554
32555 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32556 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32557 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32558
32559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32560
32561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32562
32563
32564 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32565 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32566 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32567
32568
32569 @ignore
32570 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32571 @findex -symbol-info-address
32572
32573 @subsubheading Synopsis
32574
32575 @smallexample
32576 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32577 @end smallexample
32578
32579 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32580
32581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32582
32583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32584
32585 @subsubheading Example
32586 N.A.
32587
32588
32589 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32590 @findex -symbol-info-file
32591
32592 @subsubheading Synopsis
32593
32594 @smallexample
32595 -symbol-info-file
32596 @end smallexample
32597
32598 Show the file for the symbol.
32599
32600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32601
32602 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32603 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32604
32605 @subsubheading Example
32606 N.A.
32607
32608
32609 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32610 @findex -symbol-info-function
32611
32612 @subsubheading Synopsis
32613
32614 @smallexample
32615 -symbol-info-function
32616 @end smallexample
32617
32618 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32619
32620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32621
32622 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32623
32624 @subsubheading Example
32625 N.A.
32626
32627
32628 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32629 @findex -symbol-info-line
32630
32631 @subsubheading Synopsis
32632
32633 @smallexample
32634 -symbol-info-line
32635 @end smallexample
32636
32637 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32638
32639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32640
32641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32642 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32643
32644 @subsubheading Example
32645 N.A.
32646
32647
32648 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32649 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32650
32651 @subsubheading Synopsis
32652
32653 @smallexample
32654 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32655 @end smallexample
32656
32657 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32658
32659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32660
32661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32662
32663 @subsubheading Example
32664 N.A.
32665
32666
32667 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32668 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32669
32670 @subsubheading Synopsis
32671
32672 @smallexample
32673 -symbol-list-functions
32674 @end smallexample
32675
32676 List the functions in the executable.
32677
32678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32679
32680 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32681 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32682
32683 @subsubheading Example
32684 N.A.
32685 @end ignore
32686
32687
32688 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32689 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32690
32691 @subsubheading Synopsis
32692
32693 @smallexample
32694 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32695 @end smallexample
32696
32697 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32698 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32699 ascending PC order.
32700
32701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32702
32703 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32704
32705 @subsubheading Example
32706 @smallexample
32707 (gdb)
32708 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32709 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32710 (gdb)
32711 @end smallexample
32712
32713
32714 @ignore
32715 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32716 @findex -symbol-list-types
32717
32718 @subsubheading Synopsis
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 -symbol-list-types
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 List all the type names.
32725
32726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32727
32728 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32729 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32730
32731 @subsubheading Example
32732 N.A.
32733
32734
32735 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32736 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32737
32738 @subsubheading Synopsis
32739
32740 @smallexample
32741 -symbol-list-variables
32742 @end smallexample
32743
32744 List all the global and static variable names.
32745
32746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32747
32748 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32749
32750 @subsubheading Example
32751 N.A.
32752
32753
32754 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32755 @findex -symbol-locate
32756
32757 @subsubheading Synopsis
32758
32759 @smallexample
32760 -symbol-locate
32761 @end smallexample
32762
32763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32764
32765 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32766
32767 @subsubheading Example
32768 N.A.
32769
32770
32771 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32772 @findex -symbol-type
32773
32774 @subsubheading Synopsis
32775
32776 @smallexample
32777 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32778 @end smallexample
32779
32780 Show type of @var{variable}.
32781
32782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32783
32784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32785 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32786
32787 @subsubheading Example
32788 N.A.
32789 @end ignore
32790
32791
32792 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32793 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32794 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32795
32796 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32797 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32798
32799 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32800 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32801
32802 @subsubheading Synopsis
32803
32804 @smallexample
32805 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32806 @end smallexample
32807
32808 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32809 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32810 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32811 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32812 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32813 notification.
32814
32815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32816
32817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32818
32819 @subsubheading Example
32820
32821 @smallexample
32822 (gdb)
32823 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32824 ^done
32825 (gdb)
32826 @end smallexample
32827
32828
32829 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32830 @findex -file-exec-file
32831
32832 @subsubheading Synopsis
32833
32834 @smallexample
32835 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32836 @end smallexample
32837
32838 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32839 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32840 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32841 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32842 notification.
32843
32844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32845
32846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32847
32848 @subsubheading Example
32849
32850 @smallexample
32851 (gdb)
32852 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32853 ^done
32854 (gdb)
32855 @end smallexample
32856
32857
32858 @ignore
32859 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32860 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32861
32862 @subsubheading Synopsis
32863
32864 @smallexample
32865 -file-list-exec-sections
32866 @end smallexample
32867
32868 List the sections of the current executable file.
32869
32870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32871
32872 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32873 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32874 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32875
32876 @subsubheading Example
32877 N.A.
32878 @end ignore
32879
32880
32881 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32882 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32883
32884 @subsubheading Synopsis
32885
32886 @smallexample
32887 -file-list-exec-source-file
32888 @end smallexample
32889
32890 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32891 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32892 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32893 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32894
32895 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32896
32897 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32898
32899 @subsubheading Example
32900
32901 @smallexample
32902 (gdb)
32903 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32904 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32905 (gdb)
32906 @end smallexample
32907
32908
32909 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32910 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32911
32912 @subsubheading Synopsis
32913
32914 @smallexample
32915 -file-list-exec-source-files
32916 @end smallexample
32917
32918 List the source files for the current executable.
32919
32920 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32921 name) of a source file.
32922
32923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32924
32925 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32926 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32927
32928 @subsubheading Example
32929 @smallexample
32930 (gdb)
32931 -file-list-exec-source-files
32932 ^done,files=[
32933 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32934 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32935 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32936 (gdb)
32937 @end smallexample
32938
32939 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32940 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32941
32942 @subsubheading Synopsis
32943
32944 @smallexample
32945 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32946 @end smallexample
32947
32948 List the shared libraries in the program.
32949 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32950 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32951
32952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32953
32954 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32955 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32956 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32957 library. Each range has the following fields:
32958
32959 @table @samp
32960 @item from
32961 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32962 @item to
32963 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32964 @end table
32965
32966 @subsubheading Example
32967 @smallexample
32968 (gdb)
32969 -file-list-exec-source-files
32970 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32971 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32972 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32973 (gdb)
32974 @end smallexample
32975
32976
32977 @ignore
32978 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32979 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32980
32981 @subsubheading Synopsis
32982
32983 @smallexample
32984 -file-list-symbol-files
32985 @end smallexample
32986
32987 List symbol files.
32988
32989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32990
32991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32992
32993 @subsubheading Example
32994 N.A.
32995 @end ignore
32996
32997
32998 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32999 @findex -file-symbol-file
33000
33001 @subsubheading Synopsis
33002
33003 @smallexample
33004 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33005 @end smallexample
33006
33007 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33008 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33009 produced, except for a completion notification.
33010
33011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33012
33013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33014
33015 @subsubheading Example
33016
33017 @smallexample
33018 (gdb)
33019 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33020 ^done
33021 (gdb)
33022 @end smallexample
33023
33024 @ignore
33025 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33026 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33027 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33028
33029 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33030
33031 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33032
33033 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33034
33035 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33036
33037 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33038
33039 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33040
33041 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33042
33043 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33044
33045 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33046 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33047 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33048
33049 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33050
33051 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33052
33053 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33054
33055 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33056 @end ignore
33057
33058
33059 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33060 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33061 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33062
33063
33064 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33065 @findex -target-attach
33066
33067 @subsubheading Synopsis
33068
33069 @smallexample
33070 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33071 @end smallexample
33072
33073 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33074 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33075 group, the id previously returned by
33076 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33077
33078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33079
33080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33081
33082 @subsubheading Example
33083 @smallexample
33084 (gdb)
33085 -target-attach 34
33086 =thread-created,id="1"
33087 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33088 ^done
33089 (gdb)
33090 @end smallexample
33091
33092 @ignore
33093 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33094 @findex -target-compare-sections
33095
33096 @subsubheading Synopsis
33097
33098 @smallexample
33099 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33100 @end smallexample
33101
33102 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33103 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33104
33105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33106
33107 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33108
33109 @subsubheading Example
33110 N.A.
33111 @end ignore
33112
33113
33114 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33115 @findex -target-detach
33116
33117 @subsubheading Synopsis
33118
33119 @smallexample
33120 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33121 @end smallexample
33122
33123 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33124 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33125 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33126
33127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33128
33129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33130
33131 @subsubheading Example
33132
33133 @smallexample
33134 (gdb)
33135 -target-detach
33136 ^done
33137 (gdb)
33138 @end smallexample
33139
33140
33141 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33142 @findex -target-disconnect
33143
33144 @subsubheading Synopsis
33145
33146 @smallexample
33147 -target-disconnect
33148 @end smallexample
33149
33150 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33151 generally not resumed.
33152
33153 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33154
33155 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33156
33157 @subsubheading Example
33158
33159 @smallexample
33160 (gdb)
33161 -target-disconnect
33162 ^done
33163 (gdb)
33164 @end smallexample
33165
33166
33167 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33168 @findex -target-download
33169
33170 @subsubheading Synopsis
33171
33172 @smallexample
33173 -target-download
33174 @end smallexample
33175
33176 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33177 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33178
33179 @table @samp
33180 @item section
33181 The name of the section.
33182 @item section-sent
33183 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33184 @item section-size
33185 The size of the section.
33186 @item total-sent
33187 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33188 @item total-size
33189 The size of the overall executable to download.
33190 @end table
33191
33192 @noindent
33193 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33194 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33195
33196 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33197 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33198
33199 @table @samp
33200 @item section
33201 The name of the section.
33202 @item section-size
33203 The size of the section.
33204 @item total-size
33205 The size of the overall executable to download.
33206 @end table
33207
33208 @noindent
33209 At the end, a summary is printed.
33210
33211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33212
33213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33214
33215 @subsubheading Example
33216
33217 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33218 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33219
33220 @smallexample
33221 (gdb)
33222 -target-download
33223 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33224 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33225 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33226 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33227 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33228 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33229 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33230 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33231 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33232 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33233 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33234 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33235 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33236 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33237 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33238 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33239 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33240 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33241 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33242 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33243 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33244 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33245 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33246 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33247 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33248 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33249 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33250 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33251 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33252 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33253 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33254 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33255 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33256 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33257 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33258 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33259 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33260 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33261 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33262 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33263 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33264 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33265 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33266 write-rate="429"
33267 (gdb)
33268 @end smallexample
33269
33270
33271 @ignore
33272 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33273 @findex -target-exec-status
33274
33275 @subsubheading Synopsis
33276
33277 @smallexample
33278 -target-exec-status
33279 @end smallexample
33280
33281 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33282 not, for instance).
33283
33284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33285
33286 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33287
33288 @subsubheading Example
33289 N.A.
33290
33291
33292 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33293 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33294
33295 @subsubheading Synopsis
33296
33297 @smallexample
33298 -target-list-available-targets
33299 @end smallexample
33300
33301 List the possible targets to connect to.
33302
33303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33304
33305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33306
33307 @subsubheading Example
33308 N.A.
33309
33310
33311 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33312 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33313
33314 @subsubheading Synopsis
33315
33316 @smallexample
33317 -target-list-current-targets
33318 @end smallexample
33319
33320 Describe the current target.
33321
33322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33323
33324 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33325 other things).
33326
33327 @subsubheading Example
33328 N.A.
33329
33330
33331 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33332 @findex -target-list-parameters
33333
33334 @subsubheading Synopsis
33335
33336 @smallexample
33337 -target-list-parameters
33338 @end smallexample
33339
33340 @c ????
33341 @end ignore
33342
33343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33344
33345 No equivalent.
33346
33347 @subsubheading Example
33348 N.A.
33349
33350 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33351 @findex -target-flash-erase
33352
33353 @subsubheading Synopsis
33354
33355 @smallexample
33356 -target-flash-erase
33357 @end smallexample
33358
33359 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33360
33361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33362
33363 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33364 addresses and memory region sizes.
33365
33366 @smallexample
33367 (gdb)
33368 -target-flash-erase
33369 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33370 (gdb)
33371 @end smallexample
33372
33373 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33374 @findex -target-select
33375
33376 @subsubheading Synopsis
33377
33378 @smallexample
33379 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33380 @end smallexample
33381
33382 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33383
33384 @table @samp
33385 @item @var{type}
33386 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33387 @item @var{parameters}
33388 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33389 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33390 @end table
33391
33392 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33393 which the target program is, in the following form:
33394
33395 @smallexample
33396 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33397 args=[@var{arg list}]
33398 @end smallexample
33399
33400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33401
33402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33403
33404 @subsubheading Example
33405
33406 @smallexample
33407 (gdb)
33408 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33409 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33410 (gdb)
33411 @end smallexample
33412
33413 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33414 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33415 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33416
33417
33418 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33419 @findex -target-file-put
33420
33421 @subsubheading Synopsis
33422
33423 @smallexample
33424 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33425 @end smallexample
33426
33427 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33428 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33429
33430 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33431
33432 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33433
33434 @subsubheading Example
33435
33436 @smallexample
33437 (gdb)
33438 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33439 ^done
33440 (gdb)
33441 @end smallexample
33442
33443
33444 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33445 @findex -target-file-get
33446
33447 @subsubheading Synopsis
33448
33449 @smallexample
33450 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33451 @end smallexample
33452
33453 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33454 on the host system.
33455
33456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33457
33458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33459
33460 @subsubheading Example
33461
33462 @smallexample
33463 (gdb)
33464 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33465 ^done
33466 (gdb)
33467 @end smallexample
33468
33469
33470 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33471 @findex -target-file-delete
33472
33473 @subsubheading Synopsis
33474
33475 @smallexample
33476 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33477 @end smallexample
33478
33479 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33480
33481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33482
33483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33484
33485 @subsubheading Example
33486
33487 @smallexample
33488 (gdb)
33489 -target-file-delete remotefile
33490 ^done
33491 (gdb)
33492 @end smallexample
33493
33494
33495 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33496 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33497 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33498
33499 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33500 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33501
33502 @subsubheading Synopsis
33503
33504 @smallexample
33505 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33506 @end smallexample
33507
33508 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33509 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33510 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33511
33512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33513
33514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33515
33516 @subsubheading Result
33517
33518 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33519 defined for each exception:
33520
33521 @table @samp
33522 @item name
33523 The name of the exception.
33524
33525 @item address
33526 The address of the exception.
33527
33528 @end table
33529
33530 @subsubheading Example
33531
33532 @smallexample
33533 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33534 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33535 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33536 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33537 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33538 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33539 @end smallexample
33540
33541 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33542
33543 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33544 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33545 Catchpoint Commands}.
33546
33547
33548 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33549 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33550 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33551
33552 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33553 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33554 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33555 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33556
33557 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33558 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33559 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33560
33561 @subsubheading Synopsis
33562
33563 @smallexample
33564 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33565 @end smallexample
33566
33567 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33568
33569 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33570 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33571 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33572 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33573 dash.
33574
33575 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33576
33577 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33578
33579 @subsubheading Result
33580
33581 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33582
33583 @table @samp
33584 @item exists
33585 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33586 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33587
33588 @end table
33589
33590 @subsubheading Example
33591
33592 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33593
33594 @smallexample
33595 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33596 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33597 @end smallexample
33598
33599 @noindent
33600 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33601 to the debugger:
33602
33603 @smallexample
33604 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33605 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33606 @end smallexample
33607
33608 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33609 @findex -list-features
33610 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33611
33612 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33613 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33614 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33615 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33616 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33617 startup.
33618
33619 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33620 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33621 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33622 is given below.
33623
33624 Example output:
33625
33626 @smallexample
33627 (gdb) -list-features
33628 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33629 @end smallexample
33630
33631 The current list of features is:
33632
33633 @ftable @samp
33634 @item frozen-varobjs
33635 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33636 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33637 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33638 @item pending-breakpoints
33639 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33640 command.
33641 @item python
33642 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33643 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33644 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33645 @item thread-info
33646 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33647 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33648 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33649 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33650 @item breakpoint-notifications
33651 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33652 CLI will be announced via async records.
33653 @item ada-task-info
33654 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33655 @item language-option
33656 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33657 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33658 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33659 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33660 @item undefined-command-error-code
33661 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33662 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33663 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33664 @item exec-run-start-option
33665 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33666 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33667 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33668 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33669 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33670 @end ftable
33671
33672 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33673 @findex -list-target-features
33674
33675 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33676 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33677 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33678 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33679 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33680 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33681 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33682 Example output:
33683
33684 @smallexample
33685 (gdb) -list-target-features
33686 ^done,result=["async"]
33687 @end smallexample
33688
33689 The current list of features is:
33690
33691 @table @samp
33692 @item async
33693 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33694 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33695 while the target is running.
33696
33697 @item reverse
33698 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33699 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33700
33701 @end table
33702
33703 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33704 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33705 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33706
33707 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33708
33709 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33710 @findex -gdb-exit
33711
33712 @subsubheading Synopsis
33713
33714 @smallexample
33715 -gdb-exit
33716 @end smallexample
33717
33718 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33719
33720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33721
33722 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33723
33724 @subsubheading Example
33725
33726 @smallexample
33727 (gdb)
33728 -gdb-exit
33729 ^exit
33730 @end smallexample
33731
33732
33733 @ignore
33734 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33735 @findex -exec-abort
33736
33737 @subsubheading Synopsis
33738
33739 @smallexample
33740 -exec-abort
33741 @end smallexample
33742
33743 Kill the inferior running program.
33744
33745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33746
33747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33748
33749 @subsubheading Example
33750 N.A.
33751 @end ignore
33752
33753
33754 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33755 @findex -gdb-set
33756
33757 @subsubheading Synopsis
33758
33759 @smallexample
33760 -gdb-set
33761 @end smallexample
33762
33763 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33764 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33765
33766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33767
33768 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33769
33770 @subsubheading Example
33771
33772 @smallexample
33773 (gdb)
33774 -gdb-set $foo=3
33775 ^done
33776 (gdb)
33777 @end smallexample
33778
33779
33780 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33781 @findex -gdb-show
33782
33783 @subsubheading Synopsis
33784
33785 @smallexample
33786 -gdb-show
33787 @end smallexample
33788
33789 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33790
33791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33792
33793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33794
33795 @subsubheading Example
33796
33797 @smallexample
33798 (gdb)
33799 -gdb-show annotate
33800 ^done,value="0"
33801 (gdb)
33802 @end smallexample
33803
33804 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33805
33806
33807 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33808 @findex -gdb-version
33809
33810 @subsubheading Synopsis
33811
33812 @smallexample
33813 -gdb-version
33814 @end smallexample
33815
33816 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33817
33818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33819
33820 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33821 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33822
33823 @subsubheading Example
33824
33825 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33826 @c box in TeX.
33827 @smallexample
33828 (gdb)
33829 -gdb-version
33830 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33831 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33832 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33833 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33834 ~ certain conditions.
33835 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33836 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33837 ~ details.
33838 ~This GDB was configured as
33839 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33840 ^done
33841 (gdb)
33842 @end smallexample
33843
33844 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33845 @findex -list-thread-groups
33846
33847 @subheading Synopsis
33848
33849 @smallexample
33850 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33851 @end smallexample
33852
33853 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33854 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33855 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33856 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33857 top-level thread groups.
33858
33859 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33860 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33861 available on the target.
33862
33863 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33864 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33865 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33866 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33867 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33868 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33869 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33870 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33871
33872 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33873 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33874 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33875 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33876 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33877 @samp{threads} field.
33878
33879 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33880 the following caveats:
33881
33882 @itemize @bullet
33883 @item
33884 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33885 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33886 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33887
33888 @item
33889 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33890 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33891 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33892 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33893 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33894 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33895
33896 @end itemize
33897
33898 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33899 have the following fields:
33900
33901 @table @code
33902 @item id
33903 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33904 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33905 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33906
33907 @item type
33908 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33909 valid type.
33910
33911 @item pid
33912 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33913 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33914
33915 @item exit-code
33916 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33917 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33918 only if the process is not running.
33919
33920 @item num_children
33921 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33922 absent for an available thread group.
33923
33924 @item threads
33925 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33926 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33927 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33928
33929 @item cores
33930 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33931 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33932 such information is not available.
33933
33934 @item executable
33935 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33936 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33937 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33938
33939 @end table
33940
33941 @subheading Example
33942
33943 @smallexample
33944 @value{GDBP}
33945 -list-thread-groups
33946 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33947 -list-thread-groups 17
33948 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33949 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33950 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33951 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33952 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33953 -list-thread-groups --available
33954 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33955 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33956 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33957 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33958 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33959 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33960 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33961 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33962 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33963 @end smallexample
33964
33965 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33966 @findex -info-os
33967
33968 @subsubheading Synopsis
33969
33970 @smallexample
33971 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33972 @end smallexample
33973
33974 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33975 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33976 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33977 of data of that type.
33978
33979 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33980 system.
33981
33982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33983
33984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33985
33986 @subsubheading Example
33987
33988 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33989 like this:
33990
33991 @smallexample
33992 @value{GDBP}
33993 -info-os
33994 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33995 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33996 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33997 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33998 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33999 col2="CPUs"@},
34000 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34001 col2="File descriptors"@},
34002 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34003 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34004 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34005 col2="Message queues"@},
34006 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34007 col2="Processes"@},
34008 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34009 col2="Process groups"@},
34010 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34011 col2="Semaphores"@},
34012 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34013 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34014 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34015 col2="Sockets"@},
34016 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34017 col2="Threads"@}]
34018 @value{GDBP}
34019 -info-os processes
34020 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34021 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34022 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34023 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34024 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34025 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34026 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34027 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34028 ...
34029 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34030 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34031 (gdb)
34032 @end smallexample
34033
34034 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34035 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34036 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34037 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34038 @code{info os} omits it.)
34039
34040 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34041 @findex -add-inferior
34042
34043 @subheading Synopsis
34044
34045 @smallexample
34046 -add-inferior
34047 @end smallexample
34048
34049 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34050 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34051 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34052 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34053 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34054 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34055
34056 @subheading Example
34057
34058 @smallexample
34059 @value{GDBP}
34060 -add-inferior
34061 ^done,inferior="i3"
34062 @end smallexample
34063
34064 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34065 @findex -interpreter-exec
34066
34067 @subheading Synopsis
34068
34069 @smallexample
34070 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34071 @end smallexample
34072 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34073
34074 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34075
34076 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34077
34078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34079
34080 @subheading Example
34081
34082 @smallexample
34083 (gdb)
34084 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34085 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34086 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34087 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34088 ^done
34089 (gdb)
34090 @end smallexample
34091
34092 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34093 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34094
34095 @subheading Synopsis
34096
34097 @smallexample
34098 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34099 @end smallexample
34100
34101 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34102
34103 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34104
34105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34106
34107 @subheading Example
34108
34109 @smallexample
34110 (gdb)
34111 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34112 ^done
34113 (gdb)
34114 @end smallexample
34115
34116 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34117 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34118
34119 @subheading Synopsis
34120
34121 @smallexample
34122 -inferior-tty-show
34123 @end smallexample
34124
34125 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34126
34127 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34128
34129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34130
34131 @subheading Example
34132
34133 @smallexample
34134 (gdb)
34135 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34136 ^done
34137 (gdb)
34138 -inferior-tty-show
34139 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34140 (gdb)
34141 @end smallexample
34142
34143 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34144 @findex -enable-timings
34145
34146 @subheading Synopsis
34147
34148 @smallexample
34149 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34150 @end smallexample
34151
34152 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34153 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34154 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34155 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34156
34157 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34158
34159 No equivalent.
34160
34161 @subheading Example
34162
34163 @smallexample
34164 (gdb)
34165 -enable-timings
34166 ^done
34167 (gdb)
34168 -break-insert main
34169 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34170 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34171 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34172 times="0"@},
34173 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34174 (gdb)
34175 -enable-timings no
34176 ^done
34177 (gdb)
34178 -exec-run
34179 ^running
34180 (gdb)
34181 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34182 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34183 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34184 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34185 (gdb)
34186 @end smallexample
34187
34188 @node Annotations
34189 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34190
34191 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34192 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34193 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34194 relatively high level.
34195
34196 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34197 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34198
34199 @ignore
34200 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34201 @end ignore
34202
34203 @menu
34204 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34205 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34206 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34207 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34208 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34209 * Annotations for Running::
34210 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34211 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34212 @end menu
34213
34214 @node Annotations Overview
34215 @section What is an Annotation?
34216 @cindex annotations
34217
34218 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34219 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34220 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34221 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34222 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34223 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34224 cannot contain newline characters.
34225
34226 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34227 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34228 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34229 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34230 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34231 means those three characters as output.
34232
34233 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34234 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34235 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34236 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34237 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34238 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34239 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34240 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34241 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34242
34243 @table @code
34244 @kindex set annotate
34245 @item set annotate @var{level}
34246 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34247 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34248
34249 @item show annotate
34250 @kindex show annotate
34251 Show the current annotation level.
34252 @end table
34253
34254 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34255
34256 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34257
34258 @smallexample
34259 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34260 GNU gdb 6.0
34261 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34262 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34263 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34264 under certain conditions.
34265 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34266 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34267 for details.
34268 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34269
34270 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34271 (@value{GDBP})
34272 ^Z^Zprompt
34273 @kbd{quit}
34274
34275 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34276 $
34277 @end smallexample
34278
34279 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34280 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34281 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34282 output from @value{GDBN}.
34283
34284 @node Server Prefix
34285 @section The Server Prefix
34286 @cindex server prefix
34287
34288 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34289 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34290 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34291 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34292 a transparent manner.
34293
34294 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34295 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34296 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34297 @code{print} command.
34298
34299 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34300 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34301
34302 @node Prompting
34303 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34304
34305 @cindex annotations for prompts
34306 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34307 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34308 over, etc.
34309
34310 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34311 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34312 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34313 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34314 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34315 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34316 features the following annotations:
34317
34318 @smallexample
34319 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34320 ^Z^Zprompt
34321 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34322 @end smallexample
34323
34324 The input types are
34325
34326 @table @code
34327 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34328 @findex prompt annotation
34329 @findex post-prompt annotation
34330 @item prompt
34331 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34332
34333 @findex pre-commands annotation
34334 @findex commands annotation
34335 @findex post-commands annotation
34336 @item commands
34337 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34338 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34339
34340 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34341 @findex overload-choice annotation
34342 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34343 @item overload-choice
34344 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34345
34346 @findex pre-query annotation
34347 @findex query annotation
34348 @findex post-query annotation
34349 @item query
34350 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34351
34352 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34353 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34354 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34355 @item prompt-for-continue
34356 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34357 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34358 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34359 presence of annotations.
34360 @end table
34361
34362 @node Errors
34363 @section Errors
34364 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34365
34366 @findex quit annotation
34367 @smallexample
34368 ^Z^Zquit
34369 @end smallexample
34370
34371 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34372
34373 @findex error annotation
34374 @smallexample
34375 ^Z^Zerror
34376 @end smallexample
34377
34378 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34379
34380 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34381 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34382 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34383 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34384 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34385 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34386 to the top level.
34387
34388 @findex error-begin annotation
34389 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34390
34391 @smallexample
34392 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34393 @end smallexample
34394
34395 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34396 message.
34397
34398 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34399 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34400 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34401
34402 @node Invalidation
34403 @section Invalidation Notices
34404
34405 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34406 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34407 changed.
34408
34409 @table @code
34410 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34411 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34412
34413 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34414 have changed.
34415
34416 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34417 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34418
34419 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34420 deleted a breakpoint.
34421 @end table
34422
34423 @node Annotations for Running
34424 @section Running the Program
34425 @cindex annotations for running programs
34426
34427 @findex starting annotation
34428 @findex stopping annotation
34429 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34430 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34431
34432 @smallexample
34433 ^Z^Zstarting
34434 @end smallexample
34435
34436 is output. When the program stops,
34437
34438 @smallexample
34439 ^Z^Zstopped
34440 @end smallexample
34441
34442 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34443 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34444
34445 @table @code
34446 @findex exited annotation
34447 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34448 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34449 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34450
34451 @findex signalled annotation
34452 @findex signal-name annotation
34453 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34454 @findex signal-string annotation
34455 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34456 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34457 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34458 annotation continues:
34459
34460 @smallexample
34461 @var{intro-text}
34462 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34463 @var{name}
34464 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34465 @var{middle-text}
34466 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34467 @var{string}
34468 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34469 @var{end-text}
34470 @end smallexample
34471
34472 @noindent
34473 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34474 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34475 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34476 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34477 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34478
34479 @findex signal annotation
34480 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34481 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34482 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34483 terminated with it.
34484
34485 @findex breakpoint annotation
34486 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34487 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34488
34489 @findex watchpoint annotation
34490 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34491 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34492 @end table
34493
34494 @node Source Annotations
34495 @section Displaying Source
34496 @cindex annotations for source display
34497
34498 @findex source annotation
34499 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34500
34501 @smallexample
34502 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34503 @end smallexample
34504
34505 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34506 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34507 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34508 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34509 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34510 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34511 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34512 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34513 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34514 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34515 depend on the language).
34516
34517 @node JIT Interface
34518 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34519 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34520 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34521
34522 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34523 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34524 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34525 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34526
34527 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34528 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34529 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34530 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34531 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34532 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34533
34534 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34535 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34536 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34537 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34538 LLVM JIT.
34539
34540 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34541 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34542 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34543 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34544 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34545 out about additional code.
34546
34547 @menu
34548 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34549 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34550 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34551 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34552 @end menu
34553
34554 @node Declarations
34555 @section JIT Declarations
34556
34557 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34558 implement the interface:
34559
34560 @smallexample
34561 typedef enum
34562 @{
34563 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34564 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34565 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34566 @} jit_actions_t;
34567
34568 struct jit_code_entry
34569 @{
34570 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34571 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34572 const char *symfile_addr;
34573 uint64_t symfile_size;
34574 @};
34575
34576 struct jit_descriptor
34577 @{
34578 uint32_t version;
34579 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34580 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34581 uint32_t action_flag;
34582 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34583 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34584 @};
34585
34586 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34587 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34588
34589 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34590 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34591 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34592 @end smallexample
34593
34594 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34595 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34596 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34597
34598 @node Registering Code
34599 @section Registering Code
34600
34601 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34602
34603 @itemize @bullet
34604 @item
34605 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34606 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34607
34608 @item
34609 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34610 file.
34611
34612 @item
34613 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34614
34615 @item
34616 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34617
34618 @item
34619 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34620 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34621 @end itemize
34622
34623 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34624 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34625 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34626 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34627
34628 @node Unregistering Code
34629 @section Unregistering Code
34630
34631 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34632
34633 @itemize @bullet
34634 @item
34635 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34636
34637 @item
34638 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34639
34640 @item
34641 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34642 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34643 @end itemize
34644
34645 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34646 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34647
34648 @node Custom Debug Info
34649 @section Custom Debug Info
34650 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34651 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34652
34653 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34654 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34655 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34656 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34657 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34658 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34659 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34660 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34661 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34662
34663 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34664 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34665 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34666 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34667 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34668 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34669 compiler.
34670
34671 @menu
34672 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34673 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34674 @end menu
34675
34676 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34677 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34678 @kindex jit-reader-load
34679 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34680
34681 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34682 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34683
34684 @table @code
34685 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34686 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34687 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34688 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34689 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34690 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34691 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34692
34693 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34694 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34695 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34696 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34697 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34698
34699 @item jit-reader-unload
34700 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34701
34702 @end table
34703
34704 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34705 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34706 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34707
34708 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34709 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34710
34711 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34712 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34713 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34714 the system include directory.
34715
34716 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34717 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34718 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34719
34720 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34721 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34722
34723 @findex gdb_init_reader
34724 @smallexample
34725 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34726 @end smallexample
34727
34728 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34729
34730 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34731 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34732 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34733 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34734 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34735 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34736
34737 @smallexample
34738 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34739 @{
34740 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34741 int reader_version;
34742
34743 /* For use by the reader. */
34744 void *priv_data;
34745
34746 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34747 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34748 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34749 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34750 @};
34751 @end smallexample
34752
34753 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34754 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34755
34756 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34757 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34758 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34759 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34760 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34761 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34762 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34763 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34764 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34765 target's address space.
34766
34767 @node In-Process Agent
34768 @chapter In-Process Agent
34769 @cindex debugging agent
34770 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34771 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34772 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34773 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34774 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34775 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34776 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34777 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34778 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34779 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34780 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34781 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34782 behavior without interrupting it.
34783
34784 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34785 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34786 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34787 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34788 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34789 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34790 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34791 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34792 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34793
34794 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34795 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34796 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34797 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34798
34799 @anchor{Control Agent}
34800 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34801 debugging with the following commands:
34802
34803 @table @code
34804 @kindex set agent on
34805 @item set agent on
34806 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34807 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34808 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34809 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34810 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34811 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34812
34813 @kindex set agent off
34814 @item set agent off
34815 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34816 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34817
34818 @kindex show agent
34819 @item show agent
34820 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34821 the in-process agent.
34822 @end table
34823
34824 @menu
34825 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34826 @end menu
34827
34828 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34829 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34830 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34831
34832 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34833 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34834 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34835 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34836 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34837 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34838 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34839 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34840 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34841
34842 @menu
34843 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34844 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34845 @end menu
34846
34847 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34848 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34849 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34850
34851 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34852 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34853
34854 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34855 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34856 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34857 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34858
34859 @enumerate
34860 @item
34861 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34862 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34863 @item
34864 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34865 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34866 the other one.
34867 @end enumerate
34868
34869 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34870
34871 @enumerate
34872 @item
34873 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34874 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34875 @anchor{agent expression object}
34876 @item
34877 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34878 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34879 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34880 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34881 @item
34882 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34883 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34884
34885 @end enumerate
34886
34887 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34888 object:
34889
34890 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34891 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34892 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34893 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34894 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34895 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34896 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34897 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34898 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34899 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34900 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34901 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34902 memory address for collecting.
34903 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34904 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34905 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34906 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34907 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34908 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34909 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34910 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34911 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34912 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34913 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34914 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34915 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34916 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34917 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34918 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34919 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34920 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34921 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34922 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34923 @ref{agent expression object}
34924 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34925 @ref{agent expression object}
34926 @item actions @tab variable
34927 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34928 @end multitable
34929
34930 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34931 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34932 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34933
34934 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34935 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34936
34937 @table @samp
34938
34939 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34940 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34941 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34942 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34943 in IPA finally.
34944
34945 Replies:
34946 @table @samp
34947 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34948 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34949 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34950 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34951 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34952 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34953 @item E @var{NN}
34954 for an error
34955
34956 @end table
34957
34958 @item close
34959 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34960 is about to kill inferiors.
34961
34962 @item qTfSTM
34963 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34964 @item qTsSTM
34965 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34966 @item qTSTMat
34967 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34968 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34969 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34970
34971 Replies:
34972 @table @samp
34973 @item E @var{NN}
34974 for an error
34975 @end table
34976 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34977 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34978 @end table
34979
34980 @node GDB Bugs
34981 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34982 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34983 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34984
34985 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34986
34987 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34988 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34989 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34990 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34991
34992 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34993 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34994
34995 @menu
34996 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34997 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34998 @end menu
34999
35000 @node Bug Criteria
35001 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35002 @cindex bug criteria
35003
35004 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35005
35006 @itemize @bullet
35007 @cindex fatal signal
35008 @cindex debugger crash
35009 @cindex crash of debugger
35010 @item
35011 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35012 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35013
35014 @cindex error on valid input
35015 @item
35016 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35017 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35018 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35019
35020 @cindex invalid input
35021 @item
35022 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35023 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35024 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35025 for traditional practice''.
35026
35027 @item
35028 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35029 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35030 @end itemize
35031
35032 @node Bug Reporting
35033 @section How to Report Bugs
35034 @cindex bug reports
35035 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35036
35037 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35038 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35039 contact that organization first.
35040
35041 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35042 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35043 distribution.
35044 @c should add a web page ref...
35045
35046 @ifset BUGURL
35047 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35048 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35049 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35050 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35051 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35052 be used.
35053
35054 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35055 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35056 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35057 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35058
35059 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35060 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35061 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35062 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35063 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35064 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35065 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35066 bug reports to the mailing list.
35067 @end ifset
35068 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35069 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35070 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35071 @end ifclear
35072 @end ifset
35073
35074 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35075 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35076 fact or leave it out, state it!
35077
35078 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35079 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35080 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35081 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35082 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35083 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35084 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35085 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35086 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35087
35088 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35089 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35090 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35091 self-contained.
35092
35093 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35094 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35095 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35096 bugs properly.
35097
35098 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35099
35100 @itemize @bullet
35101 @item
35102 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35103 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35104 version}.
35105
35106 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35107 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35108
35109 @item
35110 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35111 version number.
35112
35113 @item
35114 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35115 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35116 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35117 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35118
35119 @item
35120 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35121 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35122
35123 @item
35124 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35125 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35126 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35127 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35128 those compilers.
35129
35130 @item
35131 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35132 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35133 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35134 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35135
35136 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35137 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35138
35139 @item
35140 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35141 reproduce the bug.
35142
35143 @item
35144 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35145 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35146
35147 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35148 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35149 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35150 a chance to make a mistake.
35151
35152 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35153 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35154 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35155 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35156 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35157 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35158 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35159 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35160
35161 @pindex script
35162 @cindex recording a session script
35163 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35164 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35165 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35166 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35167
35168 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35169 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35170
35171 @item
35172 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35173 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35174 it by context, not by line number.
35175
35176 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35177 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35178
35179 @end itemize
35180
35181 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35182
35183 @itemize @bullet
35184 @item
35185 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35186
35187 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35188 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35189 changes will not affect it.
35190
35191 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35192 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35193 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35194 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35195
35196 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35197 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35198 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35199 less time, and so on.
35200
35201 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35202 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35203
35204 @item
35205 A patch for the bug.
35206
35207 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35208 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35209 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35210 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35211
35212 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35213 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35214 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35215 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35216
35217 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35218 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35219 help us to understand.
35220
35221 @item
35222 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35223
35224 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35225 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35226 @end itemize
35227
35228 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35229 @c and consists of the two following files:
35230 @c rluser.texi
35231 @c hsuser.texi
35232 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35233 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35234 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35235 @include rluser.texi
35236 @include hsuser.texi
35237 @end ifclear
35238
35239 @node In Memoriam
35240 @appendix In Memoriam
35241
35242 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35243 contributors:
35244
35245 @table @code
35246 @item Fred Fish
35247 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35248 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35249 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35250
35251 @item Michael Snyder
35252 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35253 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35254 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35255 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35256 @end table
35257
35258 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35259 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35260
35261 @node Formatting Documentation
35262 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35263
35264 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35265 @cindex reference card
35266 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35267 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35268 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35269 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35270 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35271 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35272
35273 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35274 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35275
35276 @smallexample
35277 make refcard.dvi
35278 @end smallexample
35279
35280 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35281 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35282 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35283 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35284 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35285
35286 @cindex documentation
35287
35288 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35289 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35290 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35291 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35292 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35293 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35294
35295 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35296 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35297 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35298 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35299 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35300 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35301 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35302 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35303
35304 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35305 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35306 @code{makeinfo}.
35307
35308 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35309 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35310 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35311
35312 @smallexample
35313 cd gdb
35314 make gdb.info
35315 @end smallexample
35316
35317 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35318 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35319 Texinfo definitions file.
35320
35321 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35322 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35323 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35324 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35325 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35326 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35327 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35328
35329 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35330 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35331 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35332 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35333 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35334 directory.
35335
35336 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35337 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35338 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35339 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35340
35341 @smallexample
35342 make gdb.dvi
35343 @end smallexample
35344
35345 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35346
35347 @node Installing GDB
35348 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35349 @cindex installation
35350
35351 @menu
35352 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35353 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35354 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35355 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35356 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35357 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35358 @end menu
35359
35360 @node Requirements
35361 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35362 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35363
35364 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35365 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35366
35367 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35368 @table @asis
35369 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35370 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35371 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35372
35373 @item GNU make
35374 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35375 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35376 @end table
35377
35378 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35379 @table @asis
35380 @item Expat
35381 @anchor{Expat}
35382 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35383 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35384 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35385 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35386 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35387 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35388
35389 Expat is used for:
35390
35391 @itemize @bullet
35392 @item
35393 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35394 @item
35395 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35396 @item
35397 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35398 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35399 @item
35400 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35401 @item
35402 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35403 @item
35404 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35405 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35406 @end itemize
35407
35408 @item Guile
35409 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35410 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35411 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35412 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35413 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35414 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35415
35416 @item iconv
35417 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35418 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35419 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35420 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35421
35422 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35423 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35424 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35425 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35426 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35427
35428 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35429 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35430 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35431 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35432 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35433
35434 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35435 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35436 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35437 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35438 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35439 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35440 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35441 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35442 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35443
35444 @item lzma
35445 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35446 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35447 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35448 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35449 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35450 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35451 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35452
35453 @item MPFR
35454 @anchor{MPFR}
35455 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35456 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35457 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35458 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35459 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35460 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35461 option to specify its location.
35462
35463 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35464 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35465 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35466 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35467
35468 @item Python
35469 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35470 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35471 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35472 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35473 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35474 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35475 installation of Python.
35476
35477 @item zlib
35478 @cindex compressed debug sections
35479 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35480 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35481 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35482 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35483 information in such binaries.
35484
35485 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35486 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35487 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35488 @end table
35489
35490 @node Running Configure
35491 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35492 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35493 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35494 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35495 build the @code{gdb} program.
35496 @iftex
35497 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35498 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35499 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35500 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35501 @end iftex
35502
35503 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35504 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35505 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35506
35507 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35508 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35509
35510 @table @code
35511 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35512 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35513
35514 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35515 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35516
35517 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35518 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35519
35520 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35521 @sc{gnu} include files
35522
35523 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35524 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35525
35526 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35527 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35528
35529 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35530 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35531 @end table
35532
35533 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35534
35535 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35536 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35537 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35538
35539 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35540 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35541 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35542 argument.
35543
35544 For example:
35545
35546 @smallexample
35547 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35548 ./configure
35549 make
35550 @end smallexample
35551
35552 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35553 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35554 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35555 directories.
35556
35557 @need 750
35558 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35559 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35560 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35561
35562 @smallexample
35563 sh configure
35564 @end smallexample
35565
35566 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35567 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35568 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35569 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35570 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35571 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35572 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35573 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35574 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35575
35576 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35577 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35578 install it with @code{make install}.
35579
35580 @node Separate Objdir
35581 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35582
35583 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35584 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35585 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35586 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35587 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35588 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35589 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35590 program specified there.
35591
35592 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35593 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35594 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35595 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35596 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35597 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35598
35599 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35600 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35601
35602 @smallexample
35603 @group
35604 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35605 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35606 cd ../gdb-sun4
35607 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35608 make
35609 @end group
35610 @end smallexample
35611
35612 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35613 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35614 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35615 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35616 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35617 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35618
35619 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35620 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35621 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35622 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35623 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35624
35625 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35626 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35627 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35628 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35629 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35630 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35631
35632 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35633 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35634 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35635
35636 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35637 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35638 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35639 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35640 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35641
35642 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35643 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35644 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35645 with each other.
35646
35647 @node Config Names
35648 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35649
35650 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35651 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35652 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35653 of information in the following pattern:
35654
35655 @smallexample
35656 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35657 @end smallexample
35658
35659 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35660 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35661 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35662
35663 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35664 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35665 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35666 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35667 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35668 abbreviations---for example:
35669
35670 @smallexample
35671 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35672 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35673 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35674 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35675 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35676 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35677 % sh config.sub sun4
35678 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35679 % sh config.sub sun3
35680 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35681 % sh config.sub i986v
35682 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35683 @end smallexample
35684
35685 @noindent
35686 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35687 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35688
35689 @node Configure Options
35690 @section @file{configure} Options
35691
35692 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35693 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35694 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35695 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35696 explanation of @file{configure}.
35697
35698 @smallexample
35699 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35700 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35701 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35702 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35703 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35704 @end smallexample
35705
35706 @noindent
35707 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35708 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35709 @samp{--}.
35710
35711 @table @code
35712 @item --help
35713 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35714
35715 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35716 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35717 @file{@var{dir}}.
35718
35719 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35720 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35721 @file{@var{dir}}.
35722
35723 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35724 @need 2000
35725 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35726 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35727 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35728 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35729 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35730 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35731 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35732 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35733 @var{dirname}.
35734
35735 @item --target=@var{target}
35736 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35737 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35738 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35739
35740 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35741 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35742 @end table
35743
35744 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35745 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35746 options not described here.
35747
35748 @table @code
35749 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35750 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35751 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35752 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35753 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35754
35755 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35756 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35757 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35758 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35759 @code{--datadir}).
35760
35761 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35762 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35763 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35764 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35765 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35766 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35767 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35768 after it is built.
35769
35770 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35771 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35772
35773 @item --disable-gdbmi
35774 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35775 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35776
35777 @item --enable-tui
35778 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35779 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35780 supported).
35781
35782 @item --with-curses
35783 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35784 terminal operations.
35785
35786 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
35787 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
35788 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
35789 details.
35790
35791 @item --with-system-readline
35792 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
35793 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35794
35795 @item --with-system-zlib
35796 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
35797 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35798
35799 @item --with-expat
35800 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
35801 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
35802 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
35803 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
35804 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
35805 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
35806 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
35807 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
35808
35809 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
35810
35811 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
35812 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
35813 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
35814 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
35815 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
35816
35817 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
35818 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
35819
35820 @item --with-lzma
35821 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
35822 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
35823 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
35824 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
35825 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
35826 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
35827
35828 @item --with-mpfr
35829 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
35830 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
35831 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
35832 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
35833 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
35834 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
35835 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
35836 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
35837 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
35838
35839 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
35840 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
35841 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
35842 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
35843 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
35844 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
35845 of Python supported by GDB is 2.4. The optional argument @var{python}
35846 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
35847 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
35848 Python is installed.
35849
35850 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
35851 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
35852 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
35853 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
35854 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
35855 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
35856 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
35857 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
35858 compile and link against Guile.
35859
35860 @item --without-included-regex
35861 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
35862 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
35863 the GNU C library.
35864
35865 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
35866 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
35867 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
35868 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
35869 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
35870 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
35871 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
35872 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
35873
35874 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35875 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
35876 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
35877 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
35878 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
35879 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
35880
35881 @item --enable-build-warnings
35882 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
35883 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
35884 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
35885 compiler you are using.
35886
35887 @item --enable-werror
35888 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
35889 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
35890 outputs any warning messages.
35891
35892 @item --enable-ubsan
35893 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
35894 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
35895 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
35896 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
35897 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
35898 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
35899 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
35900 @end table
35901
35902 @node System-wide configuration
35903 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35904 @cindex system-wide init file
35905
35906 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35907 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35908 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35909
35910 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35911
35912 @table @code
35913 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35914 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35915 @var{file}.
35916 @end table
35917
35918 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35919 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35920
35921 @itemize @bullet
35922 @item
35923 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35924 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35925 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35926 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35927 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35928 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35929
35930 @item
35931 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35932 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35933 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35934 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35935 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35936 @end itemize
35937
35938 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35939 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35940 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35941 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35942 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35943 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35944 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35945 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35946 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35947 reread.
35948
35949 @menu
35950 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35951 @end menu
35952
35953 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35954 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35955 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35956
35957 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35958 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35959 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35960 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35961 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35962 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35963
35964 The following scripts are currently available:
35965 @itemize @bullet
35966
35967 @item @file{elinos.py}
35968 @pindex elinos.py
35969 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35970 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35971 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35972 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35973 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35974 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35975
35976 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35977 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35978 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35979 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35980 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35981 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35982
35983 @end itemize
35984
35985 @node Maintenance Commands
35986 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35987 @cindex maintenance commands
35988 @cindex internal commands
35989
35990 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35991 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35992 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35993 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35994 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35995
35996 @table @code
35997 @kindex maint agent
35998 @kindex maint agent-eval
35999 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36000 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36001 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36002 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36003 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36004 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36005 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36006 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36007 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36008 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36009 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36010 addition and return the sum.
36011 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36012 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36013
36014 @kindex maint agent-printf
36015 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36016 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36017 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36018 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36019 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36020
36021 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36022 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36023 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36024 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36025 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36026 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36027 is shown:
36028
36029 @table @code
36030 @item breakpoint
36031 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36032
36033 @item watchpoint
36034 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36035
36036 @item longjmp
36037 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36038 @code{longjmp} calls.
36039
36040 @item longjmp resume
36041 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36042
36043 @item until
36044 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36045
36046 @item finish
36047 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36048
36049 @item shlib events
36050 Shared library events.
36051
36052 @end table
36053
36054 @kindex maint info btrace
36055 @item maint info btrace
36056 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36057
36058 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36059 @item maint btrace packet-history
36060 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36061 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36062 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36063 recording format.
36064
36065 @table @code
36066 @item bts
36067 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36068 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36069
36070 @table @asis
36071 @item Block number
36072 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36073 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36074 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36075 @end table
36076
36077 @item pt
36078 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36079 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36080 information is printed:
36081
36082 @table @asis
36083 @item Packet number
36084 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36085 @item Trace offset
36086 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36087 @item Packet opcode and payload
36088 @end table
36089 @end table
36090
36091 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36092 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36093 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36094 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36095 needed.
36096
36097 @kindex maint btrace clear
36098 @item maint btrace clear
36099 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36100 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36101
36102 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36103 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36104 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36105 buffer.
36106
36107 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36108 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36109 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36110 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36111 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36112 packet history.
36113
36114 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36115 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36116 @cindex displaced stepping support
36117 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36118 @item set displaced-stepping
36119 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36120 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36121 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36122 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36123 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36124 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36125
36126 @table @code
36127 @item set displaced-stepping on
36128 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36129 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36130
36131 @item set displaced-stepping off
36132 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36133 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36134
36135 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36136 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36137 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36138 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36139 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36140 @end table
36141
36142 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36143 @item maint check-psymtabs
36144 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36145 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36146
36147 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36148 @item maint check-symtabs
36149 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36150
36151 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36152 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36153 Expand symbol tables.
36154 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36155 names matching @var{regexp}.
36156
36157 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36158 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36159 @cindex demangler crashes
36160 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36161 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36162 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36163 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36164 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36165 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36166 option to terminate the current session.
36167
36168 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36169 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36170 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36171
36172 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36173 @item maint cplus namespace
36174 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36175
36176 @kindex maint deprecate
36177 @kindex maint undeprecate
36178 @cindex deprecated commands
36179 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36180 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36181 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36182 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36183 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36184 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36185 the replacement as part of the warning.
36186
36187 @kindex maint dump-me
36188 @item maint dump-me
36189 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36190 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36191 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36192 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36193
36194 @kindex maint internal-error
36195 @kindex maint internal-warning
36196 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36197 @cindex demangler crashes
36198 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36199 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36200 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36201
36202 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36203 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36204 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36205 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36206 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36207 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36208 @value{GDBN} session.
36209
36210 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36211 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36212
36213 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36214
36215 @smallexample
36216 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36217 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36218 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36219 debugging may prove unreliable.
36220 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36221 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36222 (@value{GDBP})
36223 @end smallexample
36224
36225 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36226 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36227 @cindex demangler crashes
36228
36229 @kindex maint set internal-error
36230 @kindex maint show internal-error
36231 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36232 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36233 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36234 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36235 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36236 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36237 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36238 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36239 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36240 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36241 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36242 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36243 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36244 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36245 described in the table below.
36246
36247 @table @samp
36248 @item quit
36249 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36250 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36251
36252 @item corefile
36253 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36254 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36255 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36256 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36257 disabled.
36258 @end table
36259
36260 @kindex maint packet
36261 @item maint packet @var{text}
36262 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36263 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36264 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36265 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36266 checksum.
36267
36268 @kindex maint print architecture
36269 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36270 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36271 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36272
36273 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36274 @item maint print c-tdesc
36275 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36276 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36277 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36278 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36279 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36280 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36281 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36282 modify XML target descriptions.
36283
36284 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36285 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36286 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36287 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36288
36289 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36290 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36291 @item maint check libthread-db
36292 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36293 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36294 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36295 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36296 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36297 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36298
36299 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36300 @item maint print dummy-frames
36301 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36302
36303 @smallexample
36304 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36305 @dots{}
36306 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36307 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36308 58 return (a + b);
36309 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36310 @dots{}
36311 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36312 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36313 (@value{GDBP})
36314 @end smallexample
36315
36316 Takes an optional file parameter.
36317
36318 @kindex maint print registers
36319 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36320 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36321 @kindex maint print register-groups
36322 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36323 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36324 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36325 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36326 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36327 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36328 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36329
36330 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36331 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36332 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36333 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36334 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36335 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36336 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36337 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36338
36339 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36340 write the information.
36341
36342 @kindex maint print reggroups
36343 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36344 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36345 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36346 information.
36347
36348 The register groups info looks like this:
36349
36350 @smallexample
36351 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36352 Group Type
36353 general user
36354 float user
36355 all user
36356 vector user
36357 system user
36358 save internal
36359 restore internal
36360 @end smallexample
36361
36362 @kindex flushregs
36363 @item flushregs
36364 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36365
36366 @kindex maint print objfiles
36367 @cindex info for known object files
36368 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36369 Print a dump of all known object files.
36370 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36371 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36372 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36373
36374 @kindex maint print user-registers
36375 @cindex user registers
36376 @item maint print user-registers
36377 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36378 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36379 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36380 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36381 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36382 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36383 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36384
36385 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36386 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36387 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36388 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36389 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36390 matching @var{regexp}.
36391 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36392 and the full path if known.
36393 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36394
36395 @kindex maint print statistics
36396 @cindex bcache statistics
36397 @item maint print statistics
36398 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36399 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36400 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36401 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36402 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36403 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36404 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36405 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36406 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36407 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36408 lengths.
36409
36410 @kindex maint print target-stack
36411 @cindex target stack description
36412 @item maint print target-stack
36413 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36414 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36415 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36416 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36417 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36418 address.
36419
36420 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36421 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36422
36423 @kindex maint print type
36424 @cindex type chain of a data type
36425 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36426 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36427 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36428 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36429 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36430 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36431
36432 @kindex maint selftest
36433 @cindex self tests
36434 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36435 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36436 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36437 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36438 name will by ran.
36439
36440 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36441 @cindex self tests
36442 @item maint info selftests
36443 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36444
36445 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36446 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36447 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36448 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36449 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36450 information.
36451
36452 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36453 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36454 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36455 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36456 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36457 always see the disassembly form.
36458
36459 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36460
36461 @smallexample
36462 (gdb) info addr argc
36463 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36464 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36465 @end smallexample
36466
36467 For more information on these expressions, see
36468 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36469
36470 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36471 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36472 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36473 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36474 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36475
36476 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36477 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36478 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36479 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36480 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36481 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36482 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36483 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36484 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36485
36486 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36487 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36488 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36489 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36490 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36491
36492 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36493 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36494 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36495 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36496 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36497 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36498
36499 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36500 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36501 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36502
36503 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36504 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36505 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36506 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36507
36508 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36509 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36510 @kindex maint set profile
36511 @kindex maint show profile
36512 @cindex profiling GDB
36513 @item maint set profile
36514 @itemx maint show profile
36515 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36516
36517 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36518 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36519 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36520 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36521 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36522 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36523 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36524
36525 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36526 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36527
36528 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36529 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36530 @cindex hardware debug registers
36531 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36532 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36533 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36534 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36535 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36536 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36537 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36538
36539 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36540 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36541 @item maint set show-all-tib
36542 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36543 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36544 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36545 command.
36546
36547 @kindex maint set target-async
36548 @kindex maint show target-async
36549 @item maint set target-async
36550 @itemx maint show target-async
36551 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36552 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36553 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36554 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36555
36556 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36557 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36558 @item maint set target-non-stop
36559 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36560
36561 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36562 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36563 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36564 if supported by the target.
36565
36566 @table @code
36567 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36568 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36569 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36570
36571 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36572 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36573 does not indicate support.
36574
36575 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36576 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36577 target supports it.
36578 @end table
36579
36580 @kindex maint set per-command
36581 @kindex maint show per-command
36582 @item maint set per-command
36583 @itemx maint show per-command
36584 @cindex resources used by commands
36585
36586 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36587 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36588
36589 @table @code
36590 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36591 @itemx maint show per-command space
36592 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36593 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36594 took, following the command's own output.
36595 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36596 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36597
36598 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36599 @itemx maint show per-command time
36600 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36601 for each command.
36602 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36603 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36604 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36605 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36606 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36607 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36608 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36609 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36610 spent by the program been debugged.
36611 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36612 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36613
36614 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36615 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36616 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36617 for each command.
36618 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36619
36620 @enumerate a
36621 @item
36622 number of symbol tables
36623 @item
36624 number of primary symbol tables
36625 @item
36626 number of blocks in the blockvector
36627 @end enumerate
36628 @end table
36629
36630 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36631 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36632 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36633 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36634 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36635 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36636 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36637 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36638 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36639 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36640
36641 @kindex maint space
36642 @cindex memory used by commands
36643 @item maint space @var{value}
36644 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36645 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36646
36647 @kindex maint time
36648 @cindex time of command execution
36649 @item maint time @var{value}
36650 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36651 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36652
36653 @kindex maint translate-address
36654 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36655 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36656 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36657 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36658 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36659 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36660 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36661
36662 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36663 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36664 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36665
36666 @end table
36667
36668 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36669 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36670
36671 @table @code
36672 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36673 @kindex set watchdog
36674 @cindex watchdog timer
36675 @cindex timeout for commands
36676 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36677 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36678 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36679
36680 @item show watchdog
36681 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36682 @end table
36683
36684 @node Remote Protocol
36685 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36686
36687 @menu
36688 * Overview::
36689 * Packets::
36690 * Stop Reply Packets::
36691 * General Query Packets::
36692 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36693 * Tracepoint Packets::
36694 * Host I/O Packets::
36695 * Interrupts::
36696 * Notification Packets::
36697 * Remote Non-Stop::
36698 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36699 * Examples::
36700 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36701 * Library List Format::
36702 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36703 * Memory Map Format::
36704 * Thread List Format::
36705 * Traceframe Info Format::
36706 * Branch Trace Format::
36707 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36708 @end menu
36709
36710 @node Overview
36711 @section Overview
36712
36713 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36714 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36715 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36716 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36717
36718 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36719 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36720
36721 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36722 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36723 @cindex remote serial protocol
36724 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36725 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36726 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36727 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36728 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36729
36730 @smallexample
36731 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36732 @end smallexample
36733 @noindent
36734
36735 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36736 @noindent
36737 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36738 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36739 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36740
36741 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36742 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36743
36744 @smallexample
36745 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36746 @end smallexample
36747
36748 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36749 @noindent
36750 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36751 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36752 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36753
36754 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36755 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36756 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36757 retransmission):
36758
36759 @smallexample
36760 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36761 <- @code{+}
36762 @end smallexample
36763 @noindent
36764
36765 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36766 once a connection is established.
36767 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36768
36769 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36770 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36771 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36772 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36773 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36774 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36775 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36776
36777 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36778 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36779 exceptions).
36780
36781 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36782 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36783 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36784 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36785
36786 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36787 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36788 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36789
36790 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36791 @anchor{Binary Data}
36792 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36793 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36794 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36795 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36796 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36797 binary data.
36798
36799 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36800 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36801 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36802 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36803 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36804 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36805 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36806 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36807 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36808 (described next).
36809
36810 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36811 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36812 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36813 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36814 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36815 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36816 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36817 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36818 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36819 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36820 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36821 3}} more times.
36822
36823 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36824 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36825 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36826 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36827 @samp{0*"00}.
36828
36829 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36830 error number. That number is not well defined.
36831
36832 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36833 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36834 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36835 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36836 on that response.
36837
36838 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36839 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36840 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36841 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36842 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36843 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36844
36845 @node Packets
36846 @section Packets
36847
36848 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36849 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36850 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36851 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36852
36853 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36854 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36855 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36856 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36857 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36858 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36859 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36860 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36861 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36862 @var{baz}.
36863
36864 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36865 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36866 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36867 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36868 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36869 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36870 pick any thread.
36871
36872 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36873 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36874 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36875 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36876 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36877 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36878 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36879 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36880 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36881 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36882 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36883 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36884 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36885
36886 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36887 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36888 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36889 more information.
36890
36891 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36892 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36893
36894 Here are the packet descriptions.
36895
36896 @table @samp
36897
36898 @item !
36899 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36900 @anchor{extended mode}
36901 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36902 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36903 debugged.
36904
36905 Reply:
36906 @table @samp
36907 @item OK
36908 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36909 @end table
36910
36911 @item ?
36912 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36913 @anchor{? packet}
36914 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36915 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36916 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36917
36918 Reply:
36919 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36920
36921 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36922 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36923 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36924 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36925 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36926
36927 Reply:
36928 @table @samp
36929 @item OK
36930 The arguments were set.
36931 @item E @var{NN}
36932 An error occurred.
36933 @end table
36934
36935 @item b @var{baud}
36936 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36937 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36938 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36939
36940 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36941 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36942 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36943
36944 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36945 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36946 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36947 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36948 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36949
36950 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36951 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36952 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36953 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36954
36955 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36956 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36957
36958 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36959 @anchor{bc}
36960 @item bc
36961 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36962 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36963
36964 Reply:
36965 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36966
36967 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36968 @anchor{bs}
36969 @item bs
36970 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36971 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36972
36973 Reply:
36974 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36975
36976 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36977 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36978 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36979 is omitted, resume at current address.
36980
36981 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36982 packet}.
36983
36984 Reply:
36985 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36986
36987 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36988 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36989 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36990 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36991
36992 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36993 packet}.
36994
36995 Reply:
36996 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36997
36998 @item d
36999 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37000 Toggle debug flag.
37001
37002 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37003 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37004
37005 @item D
37006 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37007 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37008 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37009 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37010 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37011
37012 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37013 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37014 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37015 big-endian hex string.
37016
37017 Reply:
37018 @table @samp
37019 @item OK
37020 for success
37021 @item E @var{NN}
37022 for an error
37023 @end table
37024
37025 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37026 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37027 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37028 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37029 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37030
37031 @item g
37032 @anchor{read registers packet}
37033 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37034 Read general registers.
37035
37036 Reply:
37037 @table @samp
37038 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37039 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37040 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37041 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37042 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37043 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37044
37045 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37046 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37047 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37048 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37049 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37050 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37051 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37052 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37053
37054 @smallexample
37055 -> @code{g}
37056 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37057 @end smallexample
37058
37059 @item E @var{NN}
37060 for an error.
37061 @end table
37062
37063 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37064 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37065 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37066 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37067
37068 Reply:
37069 @table @samp
37070 @item OK
37071 for success
37072 @item E @var{NN}
37073 for an error
37074 @end table
37075
37076 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37077 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37078 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37079 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37080 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37081 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37082 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37083 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37084 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37085
37086 Reply:
37087 @table @samp
37088 @item OK
37089 for success
37090 @item E @var{NN}
37091 for an error
37092 @end table
37093
37094 @c FIXME: JTC:
37095 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37096 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37097 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37098 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37099 @c described. For example:
37100 @c
37101 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37102 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37103 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37104 @c
37105 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37106 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37107 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37108
37109 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37110 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37111 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37112 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37113 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37114 step starting at that address.
37115
37116 @item I
37117 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37118 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37119 step packet}.
37120
37121 @item k
37122 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37123 Kill request.
37124
37125 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37126
37127 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37128 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37129
37130 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37131
37132 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37133 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37134 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37135
37136 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37137 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37138 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37139
37140 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37141 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37142 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37143 (@pxref{? packet}).
37144
37145 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37146 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37147 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37148 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37149 any particular boundary.
37150
37151 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37152 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37153 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37154 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37155 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37156 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37157 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37158 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37159
37160 Reply:
37161 @table @samp
37162 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37163 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37164 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37165 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37166 @item E @var{NN}
37167 @var{NN} is errno
37168 @end table
37169
37170 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37171 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37172 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37173 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37174 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37175
37176 Reply:
37177 @table @samp
37178 @item OK
37179 for success
37180 @item E @var{NN}
37181 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37182 written).
37183 @end table
37184
37185 @item p @var{n}
37186 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37187 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37188 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37189 register value is encoded.
37190
37191 Reply:
37192 @table @samp
37193 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37194 the register's value
37195 @item E @var{NN}
37196 for an error
37197 @item @w{}
37198 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37199 @end table
37200
37201 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37202 @anchor{write register packet}
37203 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37204 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37205 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37206 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37207
37208 Reply:
37209 @table @samp
37210 @item OK
37211 for success
37212 @item E @var{NN}
37213 for an error
37214 @end table
37215
37216 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37217 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37218 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37219 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37220 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37221 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37222
37223 @item r
37224 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37225 Reset the entire system.
37226
37227 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37228
37229 @item R @var{XX}
37230 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37231 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37232 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37233
37234 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37235
37236 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37237 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37238 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37239 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37240
37241 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37242 packet}.
37243
37244 Reply:
37245 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37246
37247 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37248 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37249 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37250 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37251 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37252
37253 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37254 packet}.
37255
37256 Reply:
37257 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37258
37259 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37260 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37261 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37262 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37263 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37264
37265 @item T @var{thread-id}
37266 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37267 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37268
37269 Reply:
37270 @table @samp
37271 @item OK
37272 thread is still alive
37273 @item E @var{NN}
37274 thread is dead
37275 @end table
37276
37277 @item v
37278 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37279 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37280
37281 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37282 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37283 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37284 The process ID is a
37285 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37286 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37287 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37288
37289 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37290 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37291 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37292 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37293 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37294 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37295 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37296 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37297
37298 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37299
37300 Reply:
37301 @table @samp
37302 @item E @var{nn}
37303 for an error
37304 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37305 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37306 @item OK
37307 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37308 @end table
37309
37310 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37311 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37312 @anchor{vCont packet}
37313 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37314
37315 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37316 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37317 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37318 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37319 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37320 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37321 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37322 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37323 error.
37324
37325 Currently supported actions are:
37326
37327 @table @samp
37328 @item c
37329 Continue.
37330 @item C @var{sig}
37331 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37332 @item s
37333 Step.
37334 @item S @var{sig}
37335 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37336 @item t
37337 Stop.
37338 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37339 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37340 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37341 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37342 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37343 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37344
37345 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37346 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37347 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37348 jumps to @var{start}).
37349
37350 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37351 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37352 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37353
37354 @end table
37355
37356 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37357 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37358 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37359
37360 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37361 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37362 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37363 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37364 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37365 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37366 as an implementation detail.
37367
37368 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37369 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37370 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37371 stopped.
37372
37373 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37374 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37375 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37376
37377 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37378 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37379
37380 Reply:
37381 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37382
37383 @item vCont?
37384 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37385 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37386
37387 Reply:
37388 @table @samp
37389 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37390 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37391 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37392 @item @w{}
37393 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37394 @end table
37395
37396 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37397 @item vCtrlC
37398 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37399 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37400 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37401 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37402 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37403 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37404 variant.
37405
37406 Reply:
37407 @table @samp
37408 @item E @var{nn}
37409 for an error
37410 @item OK
37411 for success
37412 @end table
37413
37414 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37415 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37416 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37417 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37418
37419 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37420 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37421 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37422 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37423 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37424 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37425 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37426 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37427 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37428 packet is received.
37429
37430 Reply:
37431 @table @samp
37432 @item OK
37433 for success
37434 @item E @var{NN}
37435 for an error
37436 @end table
37437
37438 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37439 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37440 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37441 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37442 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37443 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37444 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37445 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37446 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37447 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37448 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37449 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37450
37451
37452 Reply:
37453 @table @samp
37454 @item OK
37455 for success
37456 @item E.memtype
37457 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37458 @item E @var{NN}
37459 for an error
37460 @end table
37461
37462 @item vFlashDone
37463 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37464 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37465 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37466 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37467 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37468 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37469 request is completed.
37470
37471 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37472 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37473 @anchor{vKill packet}
37474 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37475 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37476 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37477 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37478
37479 Reply:
37480 @table @samp
37481 @item E @var{nn}
37482 for an error
37483 @item OK
37484 for success
37485 @end table
37486
37487 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37488 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37489 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37490 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37491 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37492
37493 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37494 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37495 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37496 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37497 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37498 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37499
37500 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37501 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37502 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37503 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37504 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37505 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37506 state.
37507
37508 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37509
37510 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37511
37512 Reply:
37513 @table @samp
37514 @item E @var{nn}
37515 for an error
37516 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37517 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37518 @end table
37519
37520 @item vStopped
37521 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37522 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37523
37524 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37525 @anchor{X packet}
37526 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37527 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37528 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37529 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37530 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37531
37532 Reply:
37533 @table @samp
37534 @item OK
37535 for success
37536 @item E @var{NN}
37537 for an error
37538 @end table
37539
37540 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37541 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37542 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37543 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37544 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37545 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37546 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37547
37548 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37549 separately.
37550
37551 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37552 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37553 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37554 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37555 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37556 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37557
37558 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37559 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37560 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37561 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37562 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37563 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37564
37565 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37566 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37567 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37568 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37569 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37570 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37571 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37572 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37573 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37574 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37575 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37576 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37577 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37578
37579 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37580 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37581
37582 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37583 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37584
37585 @table @samp
37586
37587 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37588 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37589 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37590
37591 @end table
37592
37593 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37594 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37595 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37596 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37597 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37598 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37599 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37600
37601 @table @samp
37602
37603 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37604 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37605 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37606
37607 @end table
37608
37609 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37610 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37611 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37612 target, is not defined.}
37613
37614 Reply:
37615 @table @samp
37616 @item OK
37617 success
37618 @item @w{}
37619 not supported
37620 @item E @var{NN}
37621 for an error
37622 @end table
37623
37624 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37625 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37626 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37627 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37628 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37629 address @var{addr}.
37630
37631 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37632 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37633 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37634 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37635
37636 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37637 movement.}
37638
37639 Reply:
37640 @table @samp
37641 @item OK
37642 success
37643 @item @w{}
37644 not supported
37645 @item E @var{NN}
37646 for an error
37647 @end table
37648
37649 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37650 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37651 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37652 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37653 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37654 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37655
37656 Reply:
37657 @table @samp
37658 @item OK
37659 success
37660 @item @w{}
37661 not supported
37662 @item E @var{NN}
37663 for an error
37664 @end table
37665
37666 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37667 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37668 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37669 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37670 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37671 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37672
37673 Reply:
37674 @table @samp
37675 @item OK
37676 success
37677 @item @w{}
37678 not supported
37679 @item E @var{NN}
37680 for an error
37681 @end table
37682
37683 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37684 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37685 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37686 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37687 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37688 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37689
37690 Reply:
37691 @table @samp
37692 @item OK
37693 success
37694 @item @w{}
37695 not supported
37696 @item E @var{NN}
37697 for an error
37698 @end table
37699
37700 @end table
37701
37702 @node Stop Reply Packets
37703 @section Stop Reply Packets
37704 @cindex stop reply packets
37705
37706 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37707 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37708 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37709 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37710 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37711 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37712 @value{GDBN} source code.
37713
37714 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37715 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37716 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37717
37718 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37719 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37720 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37721 components.
37722
37723 @table @samp
37724
37725 @item S @var{AA}
37726 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37727 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37728 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37729
37730 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37731 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37732 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37733 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37734 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37735 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37736 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37737 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37738
37739 @itemize @bullet
37740 @item
37741 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37742 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37743 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37744 two-digit hex number.
37745
37746 @item
37747 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37748 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37749
37750 @item
37751 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37752 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37753
37754 @item
37755 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37756 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37757 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37758 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37759
37760 @item
37761 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37762 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37763 future.
37764 @end itemize
37765
37766 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37767
37768 @table @samp
37769 @item watch
37770 @itemx rwatch
37771 @itemx awatch
37772 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37773 hex.
37774
37775 @item syscall_entry
37776 @itemx syscall_return
37777 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37778 syscall number, in hex.
37779
37780 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37781 @item library
37782 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37783 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37784 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37785
37786 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37787 @item replaylog
37788 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37789 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37790 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37791 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37792 for more information.
37793
37794 @item swbreak
37795 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37796 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37797 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37798 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37799 part must be left empty.
37800
37801 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37802 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37803 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37804 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37805 address.
37806
37807 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37808 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37809 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37810 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37811 indicating support.
37812
37813 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37814
37815 @item hwbreak
37816 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37817 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37818
37819 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37820 apply.
37821
37822 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37823 @item fork
37824 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37825 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37826 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37827 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37828 fork events.
37829
37830 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37831 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37832 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37833 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37834 indicating support.
37835
37836 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37837 @item vfork
37838 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37839 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37840 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37841 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37842 vfork events.
37843
37844 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37845 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37846 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37847 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37848 indicating support.
37849
37850 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37851 @item vforkdone
37852 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37853 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37854 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37855 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37856 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37857
37858 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37859 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37860 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37861 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37862 indicating support.
37863
37864 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37865 @item exec
37866 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37867 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37868 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37869
37870 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37871 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37872 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37873 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37874 indicating support.
37875
37876 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37877 @anchor{thread create event}
37878 @item create
37879 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37880 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37881 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37882 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37883 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37884 @var{r} part is ignored.
37885
37886 @end table
37887
37888 @item W @var{AA}
37889 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37890 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37891 applicable to certain targets.
37892
37893 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37894 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37895 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37896 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37897 hex strings.
37898
37899 @item X @var{AA}
37900 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37901 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37902
37903 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37904 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37905 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37906 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37907 hex strings.
37908
37909 @anchor{thread exit event}
37910 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37911 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37912
37913 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37914 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37915 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37916 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37917
37918 @item N
37919 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37920 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37921 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37922 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37923 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37924 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37925 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37926 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37927 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37928 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37929 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37930 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37931 support.
37932
37933 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37934 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37935 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37936 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37937 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37938
37939 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37940 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37941 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37942 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37943 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37944 system calls.
37945
37946 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37947 this very system call.
37948
37949 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37950 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37951 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37952 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37953 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37954 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37955
37956 @end table
37957
37958 @node General Query Packets
37959 @section General Query Packets
37960 @cindex remote query requests
37961
37962 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37963 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37964 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37965 sending information to and from the stub.
37966
37967 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37968 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37969 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37970 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37971 conventions:
37972
37973 @itemize @bullet
37974 @item
37975 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37976 @item
37977 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37978 letter.
37979 @item
37980 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37981 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37982 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37983 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37984 @end itemize
37985
37986 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37987 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37988 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37989 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37990 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37991 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37992 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37993 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37994 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37995 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37996 packet.}.
37997
37998 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37999 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38000 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38001 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38002 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38003
38004 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38005
38006 @table @samp
38007
38008 @item QAgent:1
38009 @itemx QAgent:0
38010 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38011 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38012
38013 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38014 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38015 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38016 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38017 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38018 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38019 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38020 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38021 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38022 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38023 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38024
38025 @item qC
38026 @cindex current thread, remote request
38027 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38028 Return the current thread ID.
38029
38030 Reply:
38031 @table @samp
38032 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38033 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38034 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38035 @item @r{(anything else)}
38036 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38037 @end table
38038
38039 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38040 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38041 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38042 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38043 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38044 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38045 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38046 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38047
38048 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38049 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38050 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38051 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38052 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38053 detect trailing zeros.
38054
38055 Reply:
38056 @table @samp
38057 @item E @var{NN}
38058 An error (such as memory fault)
38059 @item C @var{crc32}
38060 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38061 @end table
38062
38063 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38064 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38065 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38066 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38067 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38068 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38069 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38070 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38071 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38072 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38073 randomization.
38074
38075 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38076
38077 Reply:
38078 @table @samp
38079 @item OK
38080 The request succeeded.
38081
38082 @item E @var{nn}
38083 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38084
38085 @item @w{}
38086 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38087 by the stub.
38088 @end table
38089
38090 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38091 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38092 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38093 address space randomization.
38094
38095 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38096 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38097 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38098 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38099 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38100 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38101 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38102 inferior using a shell or not.
38103
38104 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38105 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38106 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38107 values are considered an error.
38108
38109 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38110 mode}).
38111
38112 Reply:
38113 @table @samp
38114 @item OK
38115 The request succeeded.
38116
38117 @item E @var{nn}
38118 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38119 @end table
38120
38121 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38122 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38123 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38124 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38125
38126 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38127 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38128
38129 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38130 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38131 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38132 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38133 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38134 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38135 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38136 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38137 environment}).
38138
38139 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38140 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38141 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38142 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38143 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38144 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38145 not be present.
38146
38147 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38148 mode}).
38149
38150 Reply:
38151 @table @samp
38152 @item OK
38153 The request succeeded.
38154 @end table
38155
38156 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38157 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38158 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38159 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38160 inferior.
38161
38162 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38163 @pxref{set environment}.
38164
38165 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38166 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38167 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38168 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38169 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38170 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38171 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38172 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38173
38174 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38175 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38176
38177 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38178 mode}).
38179
38180 Reply:
38181 @table @samp
38182 @item OK
38183 The request succeeded.
38184 @end table
38185
38186 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38187 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38188 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38189 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38190 inferior.
38191
38192 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38193 @pxref{unset environment}.
38194
38195 @item QEnvironmentReset
38196 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38197 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38198 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38199 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38200 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38201 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38202 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38203 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38204 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38205 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38206 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38207
38208 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38209 mode}).
38210
38211 Reply:
38212 @table @samp
38213 @item OK
38214 The request succeeded.
38215 @end table
38216
38217 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38218 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38219 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38220 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38221 inferior.
38222
38223 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38224 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38225 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38226 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38227 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38228 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38229
38230 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38231 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38232 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38233 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38234 directory to its original, empty value.
38235
38236 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38237 mode}).
38238
38239 Reply:
38240 @table @samp
38241 @item OK
38242 The request succeeded.
38243 @end table
38244
38245 @item qfThreadInfo
38246 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38247 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38248 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38249 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38250 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38251 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38252 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38253 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38254 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38255 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38256
38257 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38258
38259 Reply:
38260 @table @samp
38261 @item m @var{thread-id}
38262 A single thread ID
38263 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38264 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38265 @item l
38266 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38267 @end table
38268
38269 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38270 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38271 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38272 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38273 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38274 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38275 fields.
38276
38277 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38278 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38279 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38280 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38281 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38282
38283 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38284 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38285 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38286 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38287 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38288
38289 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38290 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38291
38292 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38293 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38294 information associated with the variable.)
38295
38296 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38297 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38298 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38299 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38300 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38301 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38302
38303 Reply:
38304 @table @samp
38305 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38306 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38307 local storage requested.
38308
38309 @item E @var{nn}
38310 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38311
38312 @item @w{}
38313 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38314 @end table
38315
38316 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38317 @cindex get thread information block address
38318 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38319 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38320
38321 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38322
38323 Reply:
38324 @table @samp
38325 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38326 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38327 thread information block.
38328
38329 @item E @var{nn}
38330 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38331 address could not be retrieved.
38332
38333 @item @w{}
38334 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38335 @end table
38336
38337 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38338 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38339 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38340 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38341 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38342 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38343 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38344
38345 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38346
38347 Reply:
38348 @table @samp
38349 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38350 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38351 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38352 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38353 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38354 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38355 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38356 @end table
38357
38358 @item qOffsets
38359 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38360 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38361 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38362 image.
38363
38364 Reply:
38365 @table @samp
38366 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38367 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38368 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38369 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38370 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38371 segments by the supplied offsets.
38372
38373 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38374 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38375 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38376
38377 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38378 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38379 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38380 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38381 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38382 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38383 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38384 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38385 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38386 @end table
38387
38388 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38389 @cindex thread information, remote request
38390 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38391 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38392 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38393 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38394
38395 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38396 (see below).
38397
38398 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38399
38400 @item QNonStop:1
38401 @itemx QNonStop:0
38402 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38403 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38404 @anchor{QNonStop}
38405 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38406 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38407
38408 Reply:
38409 @table @samp
38410 @item OK
38411 The request succeeded.
38412
38413 @item E @var{nn}
38414 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38415
38416 @item @w{}
38417 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38418 the stub.
38419 @end table
38420
38421 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38422 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38423 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38424 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38425
38426 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38427 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38428 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38429 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38430 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38431 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38432 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38433
38434 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38435 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38436 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38437
38438 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38439 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38440 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38441 report the requested syscalls.
38442
38443 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38444 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38445
38446 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38447 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38448 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38449 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38450
38451 Reply:
38452 @table @samp
38453 @item OK
38454 The request succeeded.
38455
38456 @item E @var{nn}
38457 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38458
38459 @item @w{}
38460 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38461 the stub.
38462 @end table
38463
38464 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38465 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38466 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38467 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38468
38469 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38470 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38471 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38472 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38473 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38474 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38475 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38476 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38477 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38478 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38479 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38480 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38481 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38482
38483 Reply:
38484 @table @samp
38485 @item OK
38486 The request succeeded.
38487
38488 @item E @var{nn}
38489 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38490
38491 @item @w{}
38492 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38493 the stub.
38494 @end table
38495
38496 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38497 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38498 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38499 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38500
38501 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38502 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38503 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38504 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38505 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38506 Others should be silently discarded.
38507
38508 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38509 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38510 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38511 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38512 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38513 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38514 signals.
38515
38516 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38517 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38518
38519 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38520 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38521 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38522 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38523 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38524
38525 Reply:
38526 @table @samp
38527 @item OK
38528 The request succeeded.
38529
38530 @item E @var{nn}
38531 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38532
38533 @item @w{}
38534 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38535 by the stub.
38536 @end table
38537
38538 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38539 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38540 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38541 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38542
38543 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38544 @item QThreadEvents:1
38545 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38546 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38547 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38548
38549 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38550 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38551 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38552 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38553 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38554 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38555 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38556 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38557 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38558 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38559
38560 Reply:
38561 @table @samp
38562 @item OK
38563 The request succeeded.
38564
38565 @item E @var{nn}
38566 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38567
38568 @item @w{}
38569 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38570 the stub.
38571 @end table
38572
38573 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38574 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38575
38576 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38577 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38578 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38579 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38580 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38581 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38582 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38583 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38584 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38585
38586 Reply:
38587 @table @samp
38588 @item OK
38589 A command response with no output.
38590 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38591 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38592 @item E @var{NN}
38593 Indicate a badly formed request.
38594 @item @w{}
38595 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38596 @end table
38597
38598 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38599 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38600 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38601 packets.)
38602
38603 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38604 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38605 @ifnotinfo
38606 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38607 @end ifnotinfo
38608 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38609 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38610 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38611 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38612 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38613
38614 Reply:
38615 @table @samp
38616 @item 0
38617 The pattern was not found.
38618 @item 1,address
38619 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38620 @item E @var{NN}
38621 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38622 @item @w{}
38623 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38624 @end table
38625
38626 @item QStartNoAckMode
38627 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38628 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38629 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38630 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38631
38632 Reply:
38633 @table @samp
38634 @item OK
38635 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38636 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38637 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38638 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38639 @item @w{}
38640 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38641 @end table
38642
38643 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38644 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38645 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38646 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38647 @anchor{qSupported}
38648 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38649 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38650 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38651 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38652 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38653 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38654 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38655 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38656 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38657 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38658 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38659 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38660 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38661 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38662
38663 Reply:
38664 @table @samp
38665 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38666 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38667 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38668 possible forms).
38669 @item @w{}
38670 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38671 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38672 @end table
38673
38674 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38675 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38676 are:
38677
38678 @table @samp
38679 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38680 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38681 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38682 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38683 @item @var{name}+
38684 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38685 need an associated value.
38686 @item @var{name}-
38687 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38688 @item @var{name}?
38689 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38690 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38691 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38692 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38693 @end table
38694
38695 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38696 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38697 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38698 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38699 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38700
38701 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38702 are defined:
38703
38704 @table @samp
38705 @item multiprocess
38706 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38707 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38708 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38709 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38710 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38711
38712 @item xmlRegisters
38713 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38714 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38715 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38716 description.
38717
38718 @item qRelocInsn
38719 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38720 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38721 instruction reply packet}).
38722
38723 @item swbreak
38724 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38725 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38726
38727 @item hwbreak
38728 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38729 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38730
38731 @item fork-events
38732 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38733 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38734 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38735 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38736
38737 @item vfork-events
38738 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38739 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38740 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38741 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38742
38743 @item exec-events
38744 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38745 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38746 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38747 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38748
38749 @item vContSupported
38750 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38751 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38752 @end table
38753
38754 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38755 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38756 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38757 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38758 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38759 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38760 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38761 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38762 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38763 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38764 all the features it supports.
38765
38766 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38767 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38768
38769 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38770 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38771 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38772 form response.
38773
38774 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38775 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38776 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38777 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38778
38779 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38780 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38781 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38782 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38783 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38784
38785 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38786
38787 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38788 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38789 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38790 @item Feature Name
38791 @tab Value Required
38792 @tab Default
38793 @tab Probe Allowed
38794
38795 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38796 @tab Yes
38797 @tab @samp{-}
38798 @tab No
38799
38800 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38801 @tab No
38802 @tab @samp{-}
38803 @tab Yes
38804
38805 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38806 @tab No
38807 @tab @samp{-}
38808 @tab Yes
38809
38810 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38811 @tab No
38812 @tab @samp{-}
38813 @tab Yes
38814
38815 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38816 @tab No
38817 @tab @samp{-}
38818 @tab Yes
38819
38820 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38821 @tab No
38822 @tab @samp{-}
38823 @tab Yes
38824
38825 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38826 @tab No
38827 @tab @samp{-}
38828 @tab Yes
38829
38830 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38831 @tab No
38832 @tab @samp{-}
38833 @tab Yes
38834
38835 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38836 @tab No
38837 @tab @samp{-}
38838 @tab No
38839
38840 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38841 @tab No
38842 @tab @samp{-}
38843 @tab Yes
38844
38845 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38846 @tab No
38847 @tab @samp{-}
38848 @tab Yes
38849
38850 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38851 @tab No
38852 @tab @samp{-}
38853 @tab Yes
38854
38855 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38856 @tab No
38857 @tab @samp{-}
38858 @tab Yes
38859
38860 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38861 @tab No
38862 @tab @samp{-}
38863 @tab Yes
38864
38865 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38866 @tab No
38867 @tab @samp{-}
38868 @tab Yes
38869
38870 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38871 @tab No
38872 @tab @samp{-}
38873 @tab Yes
38874
38875 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38876 @tab No
38877 @tab @samp{-}
38878 @tab Yes
38879
38880 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38881 @tab No
38882 @tab @samp{-}
38883 @tab Yes
38884
38885 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38886 @tab No
38887 @tab @samp{-}
38888 @tab Yes
38889
38890 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38891 @tab Yes
38892 @tab @samp{-}
38893 @tab Yes
38894
38895 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38896 @tab Yes
38897 @tab @samp{-}
38898 @tab Yes
38899
38900 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38901 @tab Yes
38902 @tab @samp{-}
38903 @tab Yes
38904
38905 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38906 @tab Yes
38907 @tab @samp{-}
38908 @tab Yes
38909
38910 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38911 @tab Yes
38912 @tab @samp{-}
38913 @tab Yes
38914
38915 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38916 @tab No
38917 @tab @samp{-}
38918 @tab Yes
38919
38920 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38921 @tab No
38922 @tab @samp{-}
38923 @tab Yes
38924
38925 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38926 @tab No
38927 @tab @samp{-}
38928 @tab Yes
38929
38930 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38931 @tab No
38932 @tab @samp{-}
38933 @tab Yes
38934
38935 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38936 @tab No
38937 @tab @samp{-}
38938 @tab No
38939
38940 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38941 @tab No
38942 @tab @samp{-}
38943 @tab No
38944
38945 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38946 @tab No
38947 @tab @samp{-}
38948 @tab No
38949
38950 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38951 @tab No
38952 @tab @samp{-}
38953 @tab No
38954
38955 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38956 @tab No
38957 @tab @samp{-}
38958 @tab No
38959
38960 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38961 @tab No
38962 @tab @samp{-}
38963 @tab No
38964
38965 @item @samp{QAgent}
38966 @tab No
38967 @tab @samp{-}
38968 @tab No
38969
38970 @item @samp{QAllow}
38971 @tab No
38972 @tab @samp{-}
38973 @tab No
38974
38975 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38976 @tab No
38977 @tab @samp{-}
38978 @tab No
38979
38980 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38981 @tab No
38982 @tab @samp{-}
38983 @tab No
38984
38985 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38986 @tab No
38987 @tab @samp{-}
38988 @tab No
38989
38990 @item @samp{tracenz}
38991 @tab No
38992 @tab @samp{-}
38993 @tab No
38994
38995 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38996 @tab No
38997 @tab @samp{-}
38998 @tab No
38999
39000 @item @samp{swbreak}
39001 @tab No
39002 @tab @samp{-}
39003 @tab No
39004
39005 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39006 @tab No
39007 @tab @samp{-}
39008 @tab No
39009
39010 @item @samp{fork-events}
39011 @tab No
39012 @tab @samp{-}
39013 @tab No
39014
39015 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39016 @tab No
39017 @tab @samp{-}
39018 @tab No
39019
39020 @item @samp{exec-events}
39021 @tab No
39022 @tab @samp{-}
39023 @tab No
39024
39025 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39026 @tab No
39027 @tab @samp{-}
39028 @tab No
39029
39030 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39031 @tab No
39032 @tab @samp{-}
39033 @tab No
39034
39035 @end multitable
39036
39037 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39038
39039 @table @samp
39040 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39041 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39042 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39043 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39044 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39045 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39046 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39047 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39048 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39049 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39050
39051 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39052 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39053 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39054
39055 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39056 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39057 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39058
39059 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39060 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39061 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39062
39063 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39064 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39065 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39066
39067 @item qXfer:features:read
39068 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39069 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39070
39071 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39072 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39073 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39074
39075 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39076 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39077 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39078
39079 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39080 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39081 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39082 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39083
39084 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39085 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39086 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39087
39088 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39089 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39090 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39091
39092 @item qXfer:spu:read
39093 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39094 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39095
39096 @item qXfer:spu:write
39097 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39098 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39099
39100 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39101 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39102 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39103
39104 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39105 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39106 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39107
39108 @item qXfer:threads:read
39109 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39110 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39111
39112 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39113 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39114 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39115
39116 @item qXfer:uib:read
39117 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39118 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39119
39120 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39121 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39122 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39123
39124 @item QNonStop
39125 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39126 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39127
39128 @item QCatchSyscalls
39129 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39130 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39131
39132 @item QPassSignals
39133 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39134 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39135
39136 @item QStartNoAckMode
39137 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39138 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39139
39140 @item multiprocess
39141 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39142 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39143 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39144 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39145 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39146 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39147 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39148 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39149 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39150 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39151 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39152
39153 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39154 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39155 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39156
39157 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39158 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39159 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39160 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39161
39162 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39163 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39164 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39165
39166 @item ReverseContinue
39167 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39168 (@pxref{bc}).
39169
39170 @item ReverseStep
39171 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39172 (@pxref{bs}).
39173
39174 @item TracepointSource
39175 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39176 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39177
39178 @item QAgent
39179 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39180
39181 @item QAllow
39182 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39183
39184 @item QDisableRandomization
39185 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39186
39187 @item StaticTracepoint
39188 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39189 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39190
39191 @item InstallInTrace
39192 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39193 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39194
39195 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39196 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39197 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39198 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39199
39200 @item QTBuffer:size
39201 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39202 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39203
39204 @item tracenz
39205 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39206 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39207 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39208
39209 @item BreakpointCommands
39210 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39211 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39212 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39213
39214 @item Qbtrace:off
39215 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39216
39217 @item Qbtrace:bts
39218 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39219
39220 @item Qbtrace:pt
39221 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39222
39223 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39224 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39225
39226 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39227 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39228
39229 @item swbreak
39230 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39231 breakpoints.
39232
39233 @item hwbreak
39234 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39235 breakpoints.
39236
39237 @item fork-events
39238 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39239
39240 @item vfork-events
39241 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39242 and vforkdone events.
39243
39244 @item exec-events
39245 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39246
39247 @item vContSupported
39248 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39249 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39250
39251 @item QThreadEvents
39252 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39253
39254 @item no-resumed
39255 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39256
39257 @end table
39258
39259 @item qSymbol::
39260 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39261 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39262 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39263 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39264
39265 Reply:
39266 @table @samp
39267 @item OK
39268 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39269 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39270 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39271 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39272 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39273 below.
39274 @end table
39275
39276 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39277 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39278
39279 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39280 target has previously requested.
39281
39282 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39283 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39284 will be empty.
39285
39286 Reply:
39287 @table @samp
39288 @item OK
39289 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39290 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39291 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39292 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39293 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39294 @end table
39295
39296 @item qTBuffer
39297 @itemx QTBuffer
39298 @itemx QTDisconnected
39299 @itemx QTDP
39300 @itemx QTDPsrc
39301 @itemx QTDV
39302 @itemx qTfP
39303 @itemx qTfV
39304 @itemx QTFrame
39305 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39306
39307 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39308
39309 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39310 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39311 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39312 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39313 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39314 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39315 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39316 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39317 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39318 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39319 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39320
39321 Reply:
39322 @table @samp
39323 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39324 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39325 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39326 the thread's attributes.
39327 @end table
39328
39329 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39330 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39331 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39332 packets.)
39333
39334 @item QTNotes
39335 @itemx qTP
39336 @itemx QTSave
39337 @itemx qTsP
39338 @itemx qTsV
39339 @itemx QTStart
39340 @itemx QTStop
39341 @itemx QTEnable
39342 @itemx QTDisable
39343 @itemx QTinit
39344 @itemx QTro
39345 @itemx qTStatus
39346 @itemx qTV
39347 @itemx qTfSTM
39348 @itemx qTsSTM
39349 @itemx qTSTMat
39350 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39351
39352 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39353 @cindex read special object, remote request
39354 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39355 @anchor{qXfer read}
39356 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39357 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39358 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39359 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39360 additional details about what data to access.
39361
39362 Reply:
39363 @table @samp
39364 @item m @var{data}
39365 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39366 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39367 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39368 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39369 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39370 request.
39371
39372 @item l @var{data}
39373 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39374 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39375 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39376
39377 @item l
39378 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39379 There is no more data to be read.
39380
39381 @item E00
39382 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39383
39384 @item E @var{nn}
39385 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39386 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39387
39388 @item @w{}
39389 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39390 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39391 @end table
39392
39393 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39394 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39395 formats, listed above.
39396
39397 @table @samp
39398 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39399 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39400 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39401 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39402
39403 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39404 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39405
39406 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39407 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39408
39409 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39410 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39411 packet may have one of the following values:
39412
39413 @table @code
39414 @item all
39415 Returns all available branch trace.
39416
39417 @item new
39418 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39419 the last read request.
39420
39421 @item delta
39422 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39423 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39424 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39425 used to stitch traces together.
39426
39427 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39428 @end table
39429
39430 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39431 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39432
39433 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39434 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39435
39436 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39437 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39438
39439 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39440 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39441
39442 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39443 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39444 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39445 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39446 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39447 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39448 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39449
39450 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39451 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39452
39453 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39454 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39455 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39456 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39457 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39458
39459 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39460 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39461
39462 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39463 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39464 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39465 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39466 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39467
39468 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39469 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39470 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39471
39472 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39473 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39474
39475 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39476 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39477 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39478 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39479 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39480 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39481 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39482 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39483
39484 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39485 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39486
39487 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39488 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39489
39490 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39491 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39492 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39493 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39494
39495 @table @code
39496 @item start=@var{address}
39497 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39498 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39499 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39500 chosen as the starting point.
39501
39502 @item prev=@var{address}
39503 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39504 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39505 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39506 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39507 exists prior to the starting point.
39508
39509 @end table
39510
39511 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39512 ignored.
39513
39514 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39515 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39516 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39517 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39518 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39519
39520 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39521 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39522
39523 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39524 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39525
39526 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39527 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39528 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39529 Action Lists}.
39530
39531 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39532 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39533 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39534
39535 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39536 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39537 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39538 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39539 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39540
39541 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39542 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39543 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39544
39545 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39546 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39547 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39548 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39549 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39550 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39551 in that context to be accessed.
39552
39553 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39554 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39555 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39556
39557 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39558 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39559 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39560 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39561 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39562
39563 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39564 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39565
39566 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39567 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39568
39569 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39570 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39571 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39572
39573 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39574 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39575
39576 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39577 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39578
39579 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39580 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39581
39582 This packet is not probed by default.
39583
39584 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39585 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39586 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39587 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39588 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39589
39590 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39591 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39592
39593 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39594 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39595 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39596 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39597
39598 @end table
39599
39600 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39601 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39602 @anchor{qXfer write}
39603 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39604 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39605 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39606 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39607 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39608 to access.
39609
39610 Reply:
39611 @table @samp
39612 @item @var{nn}
39613 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39614 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39615
39616 @item E00
39617 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39618
39619 @item E @var{nn}
39620 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39621 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39622
39623 @item @w{}
39624 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39625 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39626 @end table
39627
39628 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39629 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39630 formats, listed above.
39631
39632 @table @samp
39633 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39634 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39635 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39636 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39637 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39638
39639 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39640 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39641 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39642
39643 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39644 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39645 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39646 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39647 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39648 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39649 in that context to be accessed.
39650
39651 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39652 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39653 @end table
39654
39655 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39656 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39657 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39658 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39659 must respond with an empty packet.
39660
39661 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39662 @cindex query attached, remote request
39663 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39664 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39665 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39666 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39667 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39668 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39669 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39670
39671 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39672 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39673 the @code{quit} command.
39674
39675 Reply:
39676 @table @samp
39677 @item 1
39678 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39679 @item 0
39680 The remote server created a new process.
39681 @item E @var{NN}
39682 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39683 @end table
39684
39685 @item Qbtrace:bts
39686 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39687
39688 Reply:
39689 @table @samp
39690 @item OK
39691 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39692 @item E.errtext
39693 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39694 @end table
39695
39696 @item Qbtrace:pt
39697 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39698
39699 Reply:
39700 @table @samp
39701 @item OK
39702 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39703 @item E.errtext
39704 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39705 @end table
39706
39707 @item Qbtrace:off
39708 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39709
39710 Reply:
39711 @table @samp
39712 @item OK
39713 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39714 @item E.errtext
39715 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39716 @end table
39717
39718 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39719 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39720 btrace recording method in bts format.
39721
39722 Reply:
39723 @table @samp
39724 @item OK
39725 The ring buffer size has been set.
39726 @item E.errtext
39727 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39728 @end table
39729
39730 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39731 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39732 btrace recording method in pt format.
39733
39734 Reply:
39735 @table @samp
39736 @item OK
39737 The ring buffer size has been set.
39738 @item E.errtext
39739 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39740 @end table
39741
39742 @end table
39743
39744 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39745 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39746
39747 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39748 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39749 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39750
39751 @menu
39752 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39753 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39754 @end menu
39755
39756 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39757 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39758
39759 @menu
39760 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39761 @end menu
39762
39763 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39764 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39765 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39766
39767 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39768
39769 @table @r
39770
39771 @item 2
39772 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39773
39774 @item 3
39775 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39776
39777 @item 4
39778 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39779
39780 @end table
39781
39782 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39783 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39784
39785 @menu
39786 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39787 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39788 @end menu
39789
39790 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39791 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39792 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39793
39794 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39795 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39796 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39797 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39798 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39799 most-significant -- least-significant.
39800
39801 @table @r
39802
39803 @item MIPS32
39804 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39805 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39806 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39807
39808 @item MIPS64
39809 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39810 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39811 as @code{MIPS32}.
39812
39813 @end table
39814
39815 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39816 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39817 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39818
39819 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39820
39821 @table @r
39822
39823 @item 2
39824 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39825
39826 @item 3
39827 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39828
39829 @item 4
39830 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39831
39832 @item 5
39833 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39834
39835 @end table
39836
39837 @node Tracepoint Packets
39838 @section Tracepoint Packets
39839 @cindex tracepoint packets
39840 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39841
39842 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39843 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39844
39845 @table @samp
39846
39847 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39848 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39849 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39850 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39851 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39852 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39853 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39854 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39855 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39856 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39857 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39858 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39859 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39860 actions.
39861
39862 Replies:
39863 @table @samp
39864 @item OK
39865 The packet was understood and carried out.
39866 @item qRelocInsn
39867 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39868 @item @w{}
39869 The packet was not recognized.
39870 @end table
39871
39872 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39873 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39874 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39875 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39876 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39877 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39878 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39879
39880 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39881 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39882 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39883 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39884 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39885 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39886 tracepoint actions.
39887
39888 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39889 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39890 following forms:
39891
39892 @table @samp
39893
39894 @item R @var{mask}
39895 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39896 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39897 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39898 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39899 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39900
39901 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39902 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39903 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39904 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39905 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39906 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39907 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39908
39909 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39910 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39911 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39912 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39913 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39914 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39915 packet).
39916
39917 @end table
39918
39919 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39920 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39921 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39922 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39923 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39924 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39925 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39926 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39927
39928 Replies:
39929 @table @samp
39930 @item OK
39931 The packet was understood and carried out.
39932 @item qRelocInsn
39933 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39934 @item @w{}
39935 The packet was not recognized.
39936 @end table
39937
39938 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39939 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39940 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39941 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39942 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39943 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39944 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39945 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39946
39947 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39948 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39949 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39950 fit in a single packet.
39951 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39952 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39953
39954 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39955 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39956 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39957 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39958
39959 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39960 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39961 query packets.
39962
39963 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39964 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39965 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39966 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39967 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39968 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39969 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39970 be found.
39971
39972 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39973 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39974 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39975 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39976 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39977 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39978 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39979 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39980 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39981 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39982 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39983 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39984 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39985 variable.
39986
39987 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39988 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39989 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39990 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39991 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39992
39993 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39994 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39995 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39996 one of the following forms:
39997
39998 @table @samp
39999 @item F @var{f}
40000 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40001 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40002 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40003
40004 @item T @var{t}
40005 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40006 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40007
40008 @end table
40009
40010 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40011 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40012 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40013 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40014
40015 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40016 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40017 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40018 is a hexadecimal number.
40019
40020 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40021 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40022 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40023 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40024 numbers.
40025
40026 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40027 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40028 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40029
40030 @item qTMinFTPILen
40031 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40032 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40033 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40034 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40035 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40036 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40037 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40038 arrange for that.
40039
40040 Replies:
40041
40042 @table @samp
40043 @item 0
40044 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40045 @item @var{length}
40046 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40047 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40048 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40049 regardless of size.
40050 @item E
40051 An error has occurred.
40052 @item @w{}
40053 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40054 @end table
40055
40056 @item QTStart
40057 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40058 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40059 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40060 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40061 instruction reply packet}).
40062
40063 @item QTStop
40064 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40065 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40066
40067 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40068 @anchor{QTEnable}
40069 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40070 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40071 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40072 of data from it will resume.
40073
40074 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40075 @anchor{QTDisable}
40076 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40077 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40078 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40079 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40080
40081 @item QTinit
40082 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40083 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40084
40085 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40086 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40087 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40088 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40089 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40090
40091 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40092 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40093 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40094 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40095
40096 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40097 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40098 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40099 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40100 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40101 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40102
40103 @item qTStatus
40104 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40105 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40106
40107 The reply has the form:
40108
40109 @table @samp
40110
40111 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40112 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40113 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40114 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40115
40116 @end table
40117
40118 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40119 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40120
40121 @table @samp
40122
40123 @item tnotrun:0
40124 No trace has been run yet.
40125
40126 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40127 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40128 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40129 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40130 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40131
40132 @item tfull:0
40133 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40134
40135 @item tdisconnected:0
40136 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40137
40138 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40139 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40140
40141 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40142 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40143 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40144 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40145 is hex encoded.
40146
40147 @item tunknown:0
40148 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40149
40150 @end table
40151
40152 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40153 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40154 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40155 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40156 trace.
40157
40158 @table @samp
40159
40160 @item tframes:@var{n}
40161 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40162
40163 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40164 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40165 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40166
40167 @item tsize:@var{n}
40168 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40169
40170 @item tfree:@var{n}
40171 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40172
40173 @item circular:@var{n}
40174 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40175 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40176 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40177 and may fill up.
40178
40179 @item disconn:@var{n}
40180 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40181 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40182 that the trace run will stop.
40183
40184 @end table
40185
40186 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40187 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40188 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40189 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40190 address @var{addr}.
40191
40192 Replies:
40193 @table @samp
40194 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40195 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40196 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40197 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40198 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40199
40200 @end table
40201
40202 @item qTV:@var{var}
40203 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40204 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40205 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40206
40207 Replies:
40208 @table @samp
40209 @item V@var{value}
40210 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40211 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40212 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40213 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40214 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40215 program is running.
40216
40217 @item U
40218 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40219 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40220 was not collected.
40221 @end table
40222
40223 @item qTfP
40224 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40225 @itemx qTsP
40226 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40227 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40228 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40229 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40230 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40231 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40232
40233 @item qTfV
40234 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40235 @itemx qTsV
40236 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40237 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40238 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40239 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40240 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40241 trace state variables.
40242
40243 @item qTfSTM
40244 @itemx qTsSTM
40245 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40246 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40247 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40248 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40249 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40250 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40251 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40252 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40253
40254 Reply:
40255 @table @samp
40256 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40257 A single marker
40258 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40259 a comma-separated list of markers
40260 @item l
40261 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40262 @item E @var{nn}
40263 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40264 @item @w{}
40265 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40266 stub.
40267 @end table
40268
40269 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40270 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40271
40272 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40273 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40274 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40275 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40276 @dfn{last}).
40277
40278 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40279 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40280 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40281 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40282 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40283 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40284 tracepoint markers.
40285
40286 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40287 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40288 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40289 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40290 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40291 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40292
40293 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40294 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40295 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40296 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40297 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40298 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40299 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40300 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40301 available.
40302
40303 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40304 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40305 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40306
40307 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40308 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40309 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40310 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40311 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40312 use whatever size it prefers.
40313
40314 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40315 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40316 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40317 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40318 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40319
40320 @end table
40321
40322 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40323 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40324 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40325 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40326 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40327 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40328 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40329 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40330 it had executed in the original location.
40331
40332 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40333 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40334 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40335 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40336 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40337 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40338 format of the request is:
40339
40340 @table @samp
40341 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40342
40343 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40344 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40345 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40346 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40347 memory starting at @var{to}.
40348 @end table
40349
40350 Replies:
40351 @table @samp
40352 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40353 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40354 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40355 @item E @var{NN}
40356 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40357 relocating the instruction.
40358 @end table
40359
40360 @node Host I/O Packets
40361 @section Host I/O Packets
40362 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40363 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40364
40365 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40366 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40367 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40368 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40369 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40370 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40371 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40372 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40373 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40374 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40375
40376 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40377 its arguments. They have this format:
40378
40379 @table @samp
40380
40381 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40382 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40383 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40384 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40385 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40386 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40387 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40388 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40389 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40390
40391 @end table
40392
40393 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40394
40395 @table @samp
40396
40397 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40398 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40399 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40400 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40401 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40402 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40403 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40404 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40405 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40406 @var{attachment}.
40407
40408 @item @w{}
40409 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40410
40411 @end table
40412
40413 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40414
40415 @table @samp
40416 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40417 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40418 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40419 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40420 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40421 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40422 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40423
40424 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40425 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40426 -1 if an error occurs.
40427
40428 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40429 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40430 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40431 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40432 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40433 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40434 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40435 @var{count} was zero.
40436
40437 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40438 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40439 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40440 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40441 some characters were escaped.
40442
40443 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40444 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40445 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40446 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40447 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40448 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40449 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40450 error occurred.
40451
40452 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40453 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40454 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40455 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40456 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40457 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40458
40459 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40460 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40461 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40462
40463 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40464 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40465 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40466
40467 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40468 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40469 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40470 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40471 some characters were escaped.
40472
40473 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40474 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40475 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40476 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40477 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40478 inferior(s).
40479
40480 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40481 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40482 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40483 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40484 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40485 operation.
40486
40487 @end table
40488
40489 @node Interrupts
40490 @section Interrupts
40491 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40492 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40493
40494 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40495 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40496 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40497 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40498
40499 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40500 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40501 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40502 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40503 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40504
40505 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40506 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40507 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40508 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40509 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40510 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40511 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40512 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40513
40514 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40515 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40516 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40517
40518 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40519 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40520 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40521 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40522 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40523 @code{0x03}.
40524
40525 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40526 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40527 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40528 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40529 currently-executing threads and processes.
40530 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40531 running program, it should send one of the stop
40532 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40533 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40534 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40535 Interrupts received while the
40536 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40537 it is resumed next time.
40538
40539 @node Notification Packets
40540 @section Notification Packets
40541 @cindex notification packets
40542 @cindex packets, notification
40543
40544 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40545 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40546 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40547 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40548 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40549 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40550 is not a problem.
40551
40552 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40553 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40554 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40555 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40556 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40557 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40558 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40559
40560 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40561 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40562
40563 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40564 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40565 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40566 not they understand it.
40567
40568 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40569 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40570 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40571 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40572 recipients.
40573
40574 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40575 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40576 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40577 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40578 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40579
40580 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40581 @table @samp
40582 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40583 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40584 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40585 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40586 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40587 @item @var{ack}
40588 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40589 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40590 @end table
40591
40592 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40593 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40594
40595 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40596 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40597 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40598 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40599 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40600 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40601 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40602 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40603 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40604 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40605
40606 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40607 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40608 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40609 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40610 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40611 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40612
40613 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40614 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40615 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40616 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40617 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40618
40619 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40620 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40621 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40622 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40623 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40624 normally.
40625
40626 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40627 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40628 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40629 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40630 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40631 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40632 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40633 the process shall be repeated.
40634
40635 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40636 following example:
40637 @smallexample
40638 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40639 @code{...}
40640 -> @code{vStopped}
40641 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40642 -> @code{vStopped}
40643 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40644 -> @code{vStopped}
40645 <- @code{OK}
40646 @end smallexample
40647
40648 The following notifications are defined:
40649 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40650
40651 @item Notification
40652 @tab Ack
40653 @tab Event
40654 @tab Description
40655
40656 @item Stop
40657 @tab vStopped
40658 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40659 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40660 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40661 @value{GDBN}.
40662 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40663
40664 @end multitable
40665
40666 @node Remote Non-Stop
40667 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40668
40669 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40670 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40671 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40672 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40673
40674 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40675 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40676 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40677 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40678 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40679 probe the target state after a mode change.
40680
40681 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40682 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40683 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40684 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40685 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40686 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40687 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40688 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40689 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40690 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40691 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40692
40693 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40694 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40695 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40696 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40697 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40698 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40699 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40700 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40701 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40702 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40703 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40704 @samp{OK}.
40705
40706 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40707 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40708 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40709 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40710 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40711 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40712 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40713 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40714 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40715 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40716 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40717 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40718 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40719
40720 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40721 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40722
40723 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40724 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40725 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40726 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40727 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40728 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40729 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40730
40731 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40732 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40733 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40734 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40735 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40736
40737 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40738 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40739 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40740 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40741
40742 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40743 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40744 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40745 @pxref{qSupported}.
40746 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40747 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40748 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40749 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40750 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40751 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40752 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40753
40754 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40755 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40756 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40757 connection.
40758 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40759 new connection is established,
40760 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40761 for the current connection, once disabled.
40762
40763 @node Examples
40764 @section Examples
40765
40766 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40767 does not get any direct output:
40768
40769 @smallexample
40770 -> @code{R00}
40771 <- @code{+}
40772 @emph{target restarts}
40773 -> @code{?}
40774 <- @code{+}
40775 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40776 -> @code{+}
40777 @end smallexample
40778
40779 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40780
40781 @smallexample
40782 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40783 <- @code{+}
40784 -> @code{s}
40785 <- @code{+}
40786 @emph{time passes}
40787 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40788 -> @code{+}
40789 -> @code{g}
40790 <- @code{+}
40791 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40792 -> @code{+}
40793 @end smallexample
40794
40795 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40796 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40797 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40798
40799 @menu
40800 * File-I/O Overview::
40801 * Protocol Basics::
40802 * The F Request Packet::
40803 * The F Reply Packet::
40804 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40805 * Console I/O::
40806 * List of Supported Calls::
40807 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40808 * Constants::
40809 * File-I/O Examples::
40810 @end menu
40811
40812 @node File-I/O Overview
40813 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40814 @cindex file-i/o overview
40815
40816 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40817 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40818 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40819 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40820 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40821 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40822
40823 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40824 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40825 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40826 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40827 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40828
40829 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40830 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40831 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40832 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40833 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40834 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40835 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40836
40837 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40838 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40839 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40840 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40841 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40842
40843 @smallexample
40844 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40845 <- target requests 'system call X'
40846 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40847 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40848 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40849 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40850 @end smallexample
40851
40852 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40853 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40854 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40855 system are not supported by this protocol.
40856
40857 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40858
40859 @node Protocol Basics
40860 @subsection Protocol Basics
40861 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40862
40863 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40864 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40865 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40866 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40867 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40868 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40869 to call the appropriate host system call:
40870
40871 @itemize @bullet
40872 @item
40873 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40874
40875 @item
40876 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40877 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40878 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40879 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40880
40881 @end itemize
40882
40883 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40884
40885 @itemize @bullet
40886 @item
40887 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40888 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40889 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40890 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40891 packet.
40892
40893 @item
40894 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40895 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40896
40897 @item
40898 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40899
40900 @item
40901 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40902
40903 @item
40904 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40905 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40906 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40907 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40908 packet.
40909
40910 @end itemize
40911
40912 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40913 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40914
40915 @itemize @bullet
40916 @item
40917 Return value.
40918
40919 @item
40920 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40921
40922 @item
40923 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40924
40925 @end itemize
40926
40927 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40928 the latest continue or step action.
40929
40930 @node The F Request Packet
40931 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40932 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40933 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40934
40935 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40936
40937 @table @samp
40938 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40939
40940 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40941 This is just the name of the function.
40942
40943 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40944 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40945 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40946 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40947 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40948 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40949 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40950
40951 @end table
40952
40953
40954
40955 @node The F Reply Packet
40956 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40957 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40958 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40959
40960 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40961
40962 @table @samp
40963
40964 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40965
40966 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40967
40968 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40969 representation.
40970 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40971
40972 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40973 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40974 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40975
40976 @smallexample
40977 F0,0,C
40978 @end smallexample
40979
40980 @noindent
40981 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40982
40983 @smallexample
40984 F-1,4,C
40985 @end smallexample
40986
40987 @noindent
40988 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40989
40990 @end table
40991
40992
40993 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40994 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40995 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40996
40997 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40998 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40999 the target should behave as if it had
41000 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41001 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41002 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41003 packet.
41004
41005 It's important for the target to know in which
41006 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41007
41008 @itemize @bullet
41009 @item
41010 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41011
41012 @item
41013 The system call on the host has been finished.
41014
41015 @end itemize
41016
41017 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41018 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41019 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41020 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41021 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41022 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41023
41024 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41025 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41026 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41027 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41028 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41029 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41030 or the full action has been completed.
41031
41032 @node Console I/O
41033 @subsection Console I/O
41034 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41035
41036 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41037 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41038 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41039 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41040 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41041 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41042 conditions is met:
41043
41044 @itemize @bullet
41045 @item
41046 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41047 @code{read}
41048 system call is treated as finished.
41049
41050 @item
41051 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41052 newline.
41053
41054 @item
41055 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41056 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41057
41058 @end itemize
41059
41060 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41061 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41062 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41063 is stopped at the user's request.
41064
41065
41066 @node List of Supported Calls
41067 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41068 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41069
41070 @menu
41071 * open::
41072 * close::
41073 * read::
41074 * write::
41075 * lseek::
41076 * rename::
41077 * unlink::
41078 * stat/fstat::
41079 * gettimeofday::
41080 * isatty::
41081 * system::
41082 @end menu
41083
41084 @node open
41085 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41086 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41087
41088 @table @asis
41089 @item Synopsis:
41090 @smallexample
41091 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41092 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41093 @end smallexample
41094
41095 @item Request:
41096 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41097
41098 @noindent
41099 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41100
41101 @table @code
41102 @item O_CREAT
41103 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41104 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41105 are concerned.
41106
41107 @item O_EXCL
41108 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41109 an error and open() fails.
41110
41111 @item O_TRUNC
41112 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41113 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41114 truncated to zero length.
41115
41116 @item O_APPEND
41117 The file is opened in append mode.
41118
41119 @item O_RDONLY
41120 The file is opened for reading only.
41121
41122 @item O_WRONLY
41123 The file is opened for writing only.
41124
41125 @item O_RDWR
41126 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41127 @end table
41128
41129 @noindent
41130 Other bits are silently ignored.
41131
41132
41133 @noindent
41134 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41135
41136 @table @code
41137 @item S_IRUSR
41138 User has read permission.
41139
41140 @item S_IWUSR
41141 User has write permission.
41142
41143 @item S_IRGRP
41144 Group has read permission.
41145
41146 @item S_IWGRP
41147 Group has write permission.
41148
41149 @item S_IROTH
41150 Others have read permission.
41151
41152 @item S_IWOTH
41153 Others have write permission.
41154 @end table
41155
41156 @noindent
41157 Other bits are silently ignored.
41158
41159
41160 @item Return value:
41161 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41162 occurred.
41163
41164 @item Errors:
41165
41166 @table @code
41167 @item EEXIST
41168 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41169
41170 @item EISDIR
41171 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41172
41173 @item EACCES
41174 The requested access is not allowed.
41175
41176 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41177 @var{pathname} was too long.
41178
41179 @item ENOENT
41180 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41181
41182 @item ENODEV
41183 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41184
41185 @item EROFS
41186 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41187 write access was requested.
41188
41189 @item EFAULT
41190 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41191
41192 @item ENOSPC
41193 No space on device to create the file.
41194
41195 @item EMFILE
41196 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41197
41198 @item ENFILE
41199 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41200 has been reached.
41201
41202 @item EINTR
41203 The call was interrupted by the user.
41204 @end table
41205
41206 @end table
41207
41208 @node close
41209 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41210 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41211
41212 @table @asis
41213 @item Synopsis:
41214 @smallexample
41215 int close(int fd);
41216 @end smallexample
41217
41218 @item Request:
41219 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41220
41221 @item Return value:
41222 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41223
41224 @item Errors:
41225
41226 @table @code
41227 @item EBADF
41228 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41229
41230 @item EINTR
41231 The call was interrupted by the user.
41232 @end table
41233
41234 @end table
41235
41236 @node read
41237 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41238 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41239
41240 @table @asis
41241 @item Synopsis:
41242 @smallexample
41243 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41244 @end smallexample
41245
41246 @item Request:
41247 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41248
41249 @item Return value:
41250 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41251 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41252 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41253
41254 @item Errors:
41255
41256 @table @code
41257 @item EBADF
41258 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41259 reading.
41260
41261 @item EFAULT
41262 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41263
41264 @item EINTR
41265 The call was interrupted by the user.
41266 @end table
41267
41268 @end table
41269
41270 @node write
41271 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41272 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41273
41274 @table @asis
41275 @item Synopsis:
41276 @smallexample
41277 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41278 @end smallexample
41279
41280 @item Request:
41281 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41282
41283 @item Return value:
41284 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41285 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41286 is returned.
41287
41288 @item Errors:
41289
41290 @table @code
41291 @item EBADF
41292 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41293 writing.
41294
41295 @item EFAULT
41296 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41297
41298 @item EFBIG
41299 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41300 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41301
41302 @item ENOSPC
41303 No space on device to write the data.
41304
41305 @item EINTR
41306 The call was interrupted by the user.
41307 @end table
41308
41309 @end table
41310
41311 @node lseek
41312 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41313 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41314
41315 @table @asis
41316 @item Synopsis:
41317 @smallexample
41318 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41319 @end smallexample
41320
41321 @item Request:
41322 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41323
41324 @var{flag} is one of:
41325
41326 @table @code
41327 @item SEEK_SET
41328 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41329
41330 @item SEEK_CUR
41331 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41332 bytes.
41333
41334 @item SEEK_END
41335 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41336 bytes.
41337 @end table
41338
41339 @item Return value:
41340 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41341 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41342 value of -1 is returned.
41343
41344 @item Errors:
41345
41346 @table @code
41347 @item EBADF
41348 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41349
41350 @item ESPIPE
41351 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41352
41353 @item EINVAL
41354 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41355
41356 @item EINTR
41357 The call was interrupted by the user.
41358 @end table
41359
41360 @end table
41361
41362 @node rename
41363 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41364 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41365
41366 @table @asis
41367 @item Synopsis:
41368 @smallexample
41369 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41370 @end smallexample
41371
41372 @item Request:
41373 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41374
41375 @item Return value:
41376 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41377
41378 @item Errors:
41379
41380 @table @code
41381 @item EISDIR
41382 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41383 directory.
41384
41385 @item EEXIST
41386 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41387
41388 @item EBUSY
41389 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41390 process.
41391
41392 @item EINVAL
41393 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41394 of itself.
41395
41396 @item ENOTDIR
41397 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41398 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41399 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41400
41401 @item EFAULT
41402 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41403
41404 @item EACCES
41405 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41406
41407 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41408
41409 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41410
41411 @item ENOENT
41412 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41413
41414 @item EROFS
41415 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41416
41417 @item ENOSPC
41418 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41419 directory entry.
41420
41421 @item EINTR
41422 The call was interrupted by the user.
41423 @end table
41424
41425 @end table
41426
41427 @node unlink
41428 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41429 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41430
41431 @table @asis
41432 @item Synopsis:
41433 @smallexample
41434 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41435 @end smallexample
41436
41437 @item Request:
41438 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41439
41440 @item Return value:
41441 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41442
41443 @item Errors:
41444
41445 @table @code
41446 @item EACCES
41447 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41448
41449 @item EPERM
41450 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41451
41452 @item EBUSY
41453 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41454 being used by another process.
41455
41456 @item EFAULT
41457 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41458
41459 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41460 @var{pathname} was too long.
41461
41462 @item ENOENT
41463 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41464
41465 @item ENOTDIR
41466 A component of the path is not a directory.
41467
41468 @item EROFS
41469 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41470
41471 @item EINTR
41472 The call was interrupted by the user.
41473 @end table
41474
41475 @end table
41476
41477 @node stat/fstat
41478 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41479 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41480 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41481
41482 @table @asis
41483 @item Synopsis:
41484 @smallexample
41485 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41486 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41487 @end smallexample
41488
41489 @item Request:
41490 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41491 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41492
41493 @item Return value:
41494 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41495
41496 @item Errors:
41497
41498 @table @code
41499 @item EBADF
41500 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41501
41502 @item ENOENT
41503 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41504 path is an empty string.
41505
41506 @item ENOTDIR
41507 A component of the path is not a directory.
41508
41509 @item EFAULT
41510 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41511
41512 @item EACCES
41513 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41514
41515 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41516 @var{pathname} was too long.
41517
41518 @item EINTR
41519 The call was interrupted by the user.
41520 @end table
41521
41522 @end table
41523
41524 @node gettimeofday
41525 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41526 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41527
41528 @table @asis
41529 @item Synopsis:
41530 @smallexample
41531 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41532 @end smallexample
41533
41534 @item Request:
41535 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41536
41537 @item Return value:
41538 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41539
41540 @item Errors:
41541
41542 @table @code
41543 @item EINVAL
41544 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41545
41546 @item EFAULT
41547 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41548 @end table
41549
41550 @end table
41551
41552 @node isatty
41553 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41554 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41555
41556 @table @asis
41557 @item Synopsis:
41558 @smallexample
41559 int isatty(int fd);
41560 @end smallexample
41561
41562 @item Request:
41563 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41564
41565 @item Return value:
41566 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41567
41568 @item Errors:
41569
41570 @table @code
41571 @item EINTR
41572 The call was interrupted by the user.
41573 @end table
41574
41575 @end table
41576
41577 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41578 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41579 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41580 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41581 needed.
41582
41583
41584 @node system
41585 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41586 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41587
41588 @table @asis
41589 @item Synopsis:
41590 @smallexample
41591 int system(const char *command);
41592 @end smallexample
41593
41594 @item Request:
41595 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41596
41597 @item Return value:
41598 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41599 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41600 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41601 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41602 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41603 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41604 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41605
41606 @item Errors:
41607
41608 @table @code
41609 @item EINTR
41610 The call was interrupted by the user.
41611 @end table
41612
41613 @end table
41614
41615 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41616 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41617 the host is simplified before it's returned
41618 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41619 is discarded, and the return value consists
41620 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41621
41622 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41623 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41624 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41625
41626 @table @code
41627 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41628 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41629 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41630 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41631
41632 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41633 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41634 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41635 protocol.
41636 @end table
41637
41638 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41639 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41640 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41641
41642 @menu
41643 * Integral Datatypes::
41644 * Pointer Values::
41645 * Memory Transfer::
41646 * struct stat::
41647 * struct timeval::
41648 @end menu
41649
41650 @node Integral Datatypes
41651 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41652 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41653
41654 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41655 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41656 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41657
41658 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41659 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41660
41661 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41662
41663 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41664 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41665
41666 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41667
41668 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41669 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41670 byte order.
41671
41672 @node Pointer Values
41673 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41674 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41675
41676 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41677 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41678 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41679 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41680
41681 @smallexample
41682 @code{1aaf/12}
41683 @end smallexample
41684
41685 @noindent
41686 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41687 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41688 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41689 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41690
41691 @smallexample
41692 @code{123456/d}
41693 @end smallexample
41694
41695 @node Memory Transfer
41696 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41697 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41698
41699 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41700 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41701 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41702 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41703 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41704 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41705 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41706
41707
41708 @node struct stat
41709 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41710 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41711
41712 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41713 is defined as follows:
41714
41715 @smallexample
41716 struct stat @{
41717 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41718 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41719 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41720 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41721 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41722 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41723 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41724 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41725 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41726 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41727 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41728 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41729 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41730 @};
41731 @end smallexample
41732
41733 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41734 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41735 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41736
41737 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41738 range of values.
41739
41740 @table @code
41741
41742 @item st_dev
41743 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41744
41745 @item st_ino
41746 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41747
41748 @item st_mode
41749 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41750 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41751
41752 @item st_uid
41753 @itemx st_gid
41754 @itemx st_rdev
41755 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41756
41757 @item st_atime
41758 @itemx st_mtime
41759 @itemx st_ctime
41760 These values have a host and file system dependent
41761 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41762 support exact timing values.
41763 @end table
41764
41765 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41766 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41767 continuing.
41768
41769 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41770 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41771 get truncated on the target.
41772
41773 @node struct timeval
41774 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41775 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41776
41777 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41778 is defined as follows:
41779
41780 @smallexample
41781 struct timeval @{
41782 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41783 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41784 @};
41785 @end smallexample
41786
41787 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41788 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41789 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41790
41791 @node Constants
41792 @subsection Constants
41793 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41794
41795 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41796 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41797 values before and after the call as needed.
41798
41799 @menu
41800 * Open Flags::
41801 * mode_t Values::
41802 * Errno Values::
41803 * Lseek Flags::
41804 * Limits::
41805 @end menu
41806
41807 @node Open Flags
41808 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41809 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41810
41811 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41812
41813 @smallexample
41814 O_RDONLY 0x0
41815 O_WRONLY 0x1
41816 O_RDWR 0x2
41817 O_APPEND 0x8
41818 O_CREAT 0x200
41819 O_TRUNC 0x400
41820 O_EXCL 0x800
41821 @end smallexample
41822
41823 @node mode_t Values
41824 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41825 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41826
41827 All values are given in octal representation.
41828
41829 @smallexample
41830 S_IFREG 0100000
41831 S_IFDIR 040000
41832 S_IRUSR 0400
41833 S_IWUSR 0200
41834 S_IXUSR 0100
41835 S_IRGRP 040
41836 S_IWGRP 020
41837 S_IXGRP 010
41838 S_IROTH 04
41839 S_IWOTH 02
41840 S_IXOTH 01
41841 @end smallexample
41842
41843 @node Errno Values
41844 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41845 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41846
41847 All values are given in decimal representation.
41848
41849 @smallexample
41850 EPERM 1
41851 ENOENT 2
41852 EINTR 4
41853 EBADF 9
41854 EACCES 13
41855 EFAULT 14
41856 EBUSY 16
41857 EEXIST 17
41858 ENODEV 19
41859 ENOTDIR 20
41860 EISDIR 21
41861 EINVAL 22
41862 ENFILE 23
41863 EMFILE 24
41864 EFBIG 27
41865 ENOSPC 28
41866 ESPIPE 29
41867 EROFS 30
41868 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41869 EUNKNOWN 9999
41870 @end smallexample
41871
41872 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41873 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41874
41875 @node Lseek Flags
41876 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41877 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41878
41879 @smallexample
41880 SEEK_SET 0
41881 SEEK_CUR 1
41882 SEEK_END 2
41883 @end smallexample
41884
41885 @node Limits
41886 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41887 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41888
41889 All values are given in decimal representation.
41890
41891 @smallexample
41892 INT_MIN -2147483648
41893 INT_MAX 2147483647
41894 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41895 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41896 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41897 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41898 @end smallexample
41899
41900 @node File-I/O Examples
41901 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41902 @cindex file-i/o examples
41903
41904 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41905 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41906
41907 @smallexample
41908 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41909 @emph{request memory read from target}
41910 -> @code{m1234,6}
41911 <- XXXXXX
41912 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41913 -> @code{F6}
41914 @end smallexample
41915
41916 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41917 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41918
41919 @smallexample
41920 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41921 @emph{request memory write to target}
41922 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41923 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41924 -> @code{F6}
41925 @end smallexample
41926
41927 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41928 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41929
41930 @smallexample
41931 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41932 -> @code{F-1,9}
41933 @end smallexample
41934
41935 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41936 host is called:
41937
41938 @smallexample
41939 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41940 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41941 <- @code{T02}
41942 @end smallexample
41943
41944 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41945 host is called:
41946
41947 @smallexample
41948 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41949 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41950 <- @code{T02}
41951 @end smallexample
41952
41953 @node Library List Format
41954 @section Library List Format
41955 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41956
41957 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41958 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41959 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41960 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41961 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41962 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41963 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41964 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41965 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41966 are loaded.
41967
41968 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41969 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41970 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41971 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41972
41973 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41974 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41975 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41976 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41977 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41978 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41979
41980 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41981 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41982
41983 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41984 offset, looks like this:
41985
41986 @smallexample
41987 <library-list>
41988 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41989 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41990 </library>
41991 </library-list>
41992 @end smallexample
41993
41994 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41995 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41996
41997 @smallexample
41998 <library-list>
41999 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42000 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42001 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42002 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42003 </library>
42004 </library-list>
42005 @end smallexample
42006
42007 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42008
42009 @smallexample
42010 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42011 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42012 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42013 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42014 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42015 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42016 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42017 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42018 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42019 @end smallexample
42020
42021 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42022 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42023 section for each library.
42024
42025 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42026 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42027 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42028
42029 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42030 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42031 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42032 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42033
42034 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42035 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42036 target, the following parameters are reported:
42037
42038 @itemize @minus
42039 @item
42040 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42041 @code{struct link_map}.
42042 @item
42043 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42044 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42045 @item
42046 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42047 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42048 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42049 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42050 @item
42051 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42052 @end itemize
42053
42054 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42055 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42056 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42057
42058 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42059 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42060
42061 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42062 looks like this:
42063
42064 @smallexample
42065 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42066 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42067 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42068 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42069 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42070 </library-list-svr>
42071 @end smallexample
42072
42073 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42074
42075 @smallexample
42076 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42077 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42078 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42079 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42080 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42081 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42082 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42083 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42084 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42085 @end smallexample
42086
42087 @node Memory Map Format
42088 @section Memory Map Format
42089 @cindex memory map format
42090
42091 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42092 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42093 memory map.
42094
42095 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42096 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42097 lists memory regions.
42098
42099 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42100 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42101
42102 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42103
42104 @smallexample
42105 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42106 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42107 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42108 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42109 <memory-map>
42110 region...
42111 </memory-map>
42112 @end smallexample
42113
42114 Each region can be either:
42115
42116 @itemize
42117
42118 @item
42119 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42120 bytes from there:
42121
42122 @smallexample
42123 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42124 @end smallexample
42125
42126
42127 @item
42128 A region of read-only memory:
42129
42130 @smallexample
42131 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42132 @end smallexample
42133
42134
42135 @item
42136 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42137 bytes in length:
42138
42139 @smallexample
42140 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42141 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42142 </memory>
42143 @end smallexample
42144
42145 @end itemize
42146
42147 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42148 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42149 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42150
42151 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42152
42153 @smallexample
42154 <!-- ................................................... -->
42155 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42156 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42157 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42158 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42159 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42160 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42161 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42162 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42163 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42164 and its type, or device. -->
42165 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42166 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42167 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42168 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42169 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42170 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42171 @end smallexample
42172
42173 @node Thread List Format
42174 @section Thread List Format
42175 @cindex thread list format
42176
42177 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42178 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42179 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42180 the following structure:
42181
42182 @smallexample
42183 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42184 <threads>
42185 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42186 ... description ...
42187 </thread>
42188 </threads>
42189 @end smallexample
42190
42191 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42192 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42193 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42194 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42195 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42196 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42197 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42198 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42199
42200
42201 @node Traceframe Info Format
42202 @section Traceframe Info Format
42203 @cindex traceframe info format
42204
42205 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42206 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42207 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42208 collected in a traceframe.
42209
42210 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42211 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42212
42213 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42214 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42215
42216 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42217
42218 @smallexample
42219 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42220 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42221 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42222 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42223 <traceframe-info>
42224 block...
42225 </traceframe-info>
42226 @end smallexample
42227
42228 Each traceframe block can be either:
42229
42230 @itemize
42231
42232 @item
42233 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42234 @var{length} bytes from there:
42235
42236 @smallexample
42237 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42238 @end smallexample
42239
42240 @item
42241 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42242 collected:
42243
42244 @smallexample
42245 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42246 @end smallexample
42247
42248 @end itemize
42249
42250 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42251
42252 @smallexample
42253 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42254 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42255
42256 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42257 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42258 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42259 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42260 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42261 @end smallexample
42262
42263 @node Branch Trace Format
42264 @section Branch Trace Format
42265 @cindex branch trace format
42266
42267 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42268 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42269 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42270 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42271
42272 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42273 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42274
42275 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42276 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42277
42278 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42279
42280 @smallexample
42281 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42282 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42283 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42284 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42285 <btrace>
42286 block...
42287 </btrace>
42288 @end smallexample
42289
42290 @itemize
42291
42292 @item
42293 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42294 and ending at @var{end}:
42295
42296 @smallexample
42297 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42298 @end smallexample
42299
42300 @end itemize
42301
42302 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42303
42304 @smallexample
42305 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42306 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42307
42308 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42309 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42310 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42311
42312 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42313
42314 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42315
42316 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42317 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42318 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42319 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42320 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42321
42322 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42323 @end smallexample
42324
42325 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42326 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42327 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42328
42329 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42330 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42331 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42332
42333 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42334 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42335
42336 @table @code
42337 @item bts
42338 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42339 @table @code
42340 @item size
42341 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42342 @end table
42343 @item pt
42344 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42345 PT}) format.
42346 @table @code
42347 @item size
42348 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42349 @end table
42350 @end table
42351
42352 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42353 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42354
42355 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42356
42357 @smallexample
42358 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42359 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42360
42361 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42362 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42363
42364 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42365 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42366 @end smallexample
42367
42368 @include agentexpr.texi
42369
42370 @node Target Descriptions
42371 @appendix Target Descriptions
42372 @cindex target descriptions
42373
42374 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42375 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42376 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42377 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42378 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42379 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42380 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42381
42382 @itemize @bullet
42383 @item
42384 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42385 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42386 @item
42387 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42388 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42389 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42390 @item
42391 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42392 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42393 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42394 @end itemize
42395
42396 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42397 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42398 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42399 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42400 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42401
42402 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42403 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42404
42405 @menu
42406 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42407 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42408 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42409 descriptions.
42410 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42411 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42412 @end menu
42413
42414 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42415 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42416
42417 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42418 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42419 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42420 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42421 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42422 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42423 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42424 Format}.
42425
42426 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42427 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42428 specify a file are:
42429
42430 @table @code
42431 @cindex set tdesc filename
42432 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42433 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42434
42435 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42436 @item unset tdesc filename
42437 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42438 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42439
42440 @cindex show tdesc filename
42441 @item show tdesc filename
42442 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42443 @end table
42444
42445
42446 @node Target Description Format
42447 @section Target Description Format
42448 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42449
42450 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42451 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42452 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42453 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42454 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42455 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42456 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42457
42458 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42459 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42460 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42461 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42462 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42463
42464 Here is a simple target description:
42465
42466 @smallexample
42467 <target version="1.0">
42468 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42469 </target>
42470 @end smallexample
42471
42472 @noindent
42473 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42474 the x86-64 architecture.
42475
42476 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42477 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42478 are explained further below.
42479
42480 @smallexample
42481 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42482 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42483 <target version="1.0">
42484 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42485 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42486 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42487 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42488 </target>
42489 @end smallexample
42490
42491 @noindent
42492 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42493 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42494 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42495 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42496 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42497 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42498 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42499 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42500 the version mismatch.
42501
42502 @subsection Inclusion
42503 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42504 @cindex XInclude
42505 @ifnotinfo
42506 @cindex <xi:include>
42507 @end ifnotinfo
42508
42509 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42510 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42511 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42512 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42513 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42514
42515 @smallexample
42516 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42517 @end smallexample
42518
42519 @noindent
42520 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42521 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42522 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42523 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42524 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42525 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42526 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42527 original description.
42528
42529 @subsection Architecture
42530 @cindex <architecture>
42531
42532 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42533
42534 @smallexample
42535 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42536 @end smallexample
42537
42538 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42539 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42540
42541 @subsection OS ABI
42542 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42543
42544 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42545 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42546
42547 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42548
42549 @smallexample
42550 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42551 @end smallexample
42552
42553 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42554 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42555
42556 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42557 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42558
42559 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42560 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42561
42562 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42563
42564 @smallexample
42565 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42566 @end smallexample
42567
42568 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42569 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42570
42571 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42572 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42573 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42574 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42575 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42576 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42577 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42578
42579 @smallexample
42580 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42581 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42582 @end smallexample
42583
42584 @subsection Features
42585 @cindex <feature>
42586
42587 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42588 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42589 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42590 has this form:
42591
42592 @smallexample
42593 <feature name="@var{name}">
42594 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42595 @var{reg}@dots{}
42596 </feature>
42597 @end smallexample
42598
42599 @noindent
42600 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42601 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42602 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42603 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42604
42605 @subsection Types
42606
42607 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42608 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42609 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42610 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42611 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42612 and enum types.
42613
42614 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42615 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42616 Types must be defined before they are used.
42617
42618 @cindex <vector>
42619 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42620 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42621 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42622 @var{count}:
42623
42624 @smallexample
42625 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42626 @end smallexample
42627
42628 @cindex <union>
42629 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42630 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42631 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42632 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42633
42634 @smallexample
42635 <union id="@var{id}">
42636 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42637 @dots{}
42638 </union>
42639 @end smallexample
42640
42641 @cindex <struct>
42642 @cindex <flags>
42643 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42644 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42645 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42646 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42647 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42648 specified.
42649
42650 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42651
42652 @smallexample
42653 <struct id="@var{id}">
42654 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42655 @dots{}
42656 </struct>
42657 @end smallexample
42658
42659 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42660 No implicit padding is added.
42661
42662 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42663
42664 @smallexample
42665 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42666 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42667 @dots{}
42668 </struct>
42669 @end smallexample
42670
42671 @smallexample
42672 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42673 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42674 @dots{}
42675 </flags>
42676 @end smallexample
42677
42678 The @var{name} value is required.
42679 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42680 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42681 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42682
42683 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42684 is optional.
42685 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42686 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42687
42688 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42689 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42690
42691 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42692
42693 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42694 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42695
42696 @itemize @bullet
42697 @item
42698 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42699 @item
42700 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42701 @end itemize
42702
42703 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42704 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42705
42706 @itemize @bullet
42707 @item
42708 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42709
42710 @smallexample
42711 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42712 $1 = 42
42713 @end smallexample
42714
42715 @end itemize
42716
42717 @subsection Registers
42718 @cindex <reg>
42719
42720 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42721
42722 @smallexample
42723 <reg name="@var{name}"
42724 bitsize="@var{size}"
42725 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42726 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42727 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42728 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42729 @end smallexample
42730
42731 @noindent
42732 The components are as follows:
42733
42734 @table @var
42735
42736 @item name
42737 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42738
42739 @item bitsize
42740 The register's size, in bits.
42741
42742 @item regnum
42743 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42744 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42745 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42746 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42747 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42748 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42749 in order of increasing register number.
42750
42751 @item save-restore
42752 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42753 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42754 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42755 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42756 ABI.
42757
42758 @item type
42759 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42760 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42761 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42762 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42763 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42764 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42765
42766 @item group
42767 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42768 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42769 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42770 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42771 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42772 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42773 @code{info registers}.
42774
42775 @end table
42776
42777 @node Predefined Target Types
42778 @section Predefined Target Types
42779 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42780
42781 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42782 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42783 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42784 types. The currently supported types are:
42785
42786 @table @code
42787
42788 @item bool
42789 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42790
42791 @item int8
42792 @itemx int16
42793 @itemx int24
42794 @itemx int32
42795 @itemx int64
42796 @itemx int128
42797 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42798
42799 @item uint8
42800 @itemx uint16
42801 @itemx uint24
42802 @itemx uint32
42803 @itemx uint64
42804 @itemx uint128
42805 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42806
42807 @item code_ptr
42808 @itemx data_ptr
42809 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42810 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42811 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42812 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42813 may be marked as data pointers.
42814
42815 @item ieee_single
42816 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42817
42818 @item ieee_double
42819 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42820
42821 @item arm_fpa_ext
42822 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42823
42824 @item i387_ext
42825 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42826
42827 @item i386_eflags
42828 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42829
42830 @item i386_mxcsr
42831 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42832
42833 @end table
42834
42835 @node Enum Target Types
42836 @section Enum Target Types
42837 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42838
42839 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42840 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42841
42842 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42843
42844 @smallexample
42845 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42846 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42847 @dots{}
42848 </enum>
42849 @end smallexample
42850
42851 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42852
42853 @smallexample
42854 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42855 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42856 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42857 </enum>
42858 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42859 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42860 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42861 </flags>
42862 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42863 @end smallexample
42864
42865 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42866 would be printed as:
42867
42868 @smallexample
42869 (gdb) info register flags
42870 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42871 @end smallexample
42872
42873 @node Standard Target Features
42874 @section Standard Target Features
42875 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42876
42877 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42878 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42879 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42880 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42881 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42882 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42883 can recognize them.
42884
42885 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42886 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42887 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42888 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42889 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42890 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42891 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42892 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42893
42894 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42895 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42896 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42897
42898 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42899 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42900 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42901 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42902
42903 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42904 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42905 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42906
42907 @menu
42908 * AArch64 Features::
42909 * ARC Features::
42910 * ARM Features::
42911 * i386 Features::
42912 * MicroBlaze Features::
42913 * MIPS Features::
42914 * M68K Features::
42915 * NDS32 Features::
42916 * Nios II Features::
42917 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42918 * PowerPC Features::
42919 * S/390 and System z Features::
42920 * Sparc Features::
42921 * TIC6x Features::
42922 @end menu
42923
42924
42925 @node AArch64 Features
42926 @subsection AArch64 Features
42927 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42928
42929 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42930 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42931 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42932
42933 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42934 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42935 and @samp{fpcr}.
42936
42937 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42938 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42939 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42940
42941 @node ARC Features
42942 @subsection ARC Features
42943 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42944
42945 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42946 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42947 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42948 that one of the core registers features is present.
42949 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42950
42951 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42952 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42953 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42954 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42955 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42956 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42957 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42958
42959 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42960 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42961 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42962 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42963 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42964 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42965
42966 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42967 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42968 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42969 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42970 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42971 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42972 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42973 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42974 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42975 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42976
42977 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42978 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42979
42980 @node ARM Features
42981 @subsection ARM Features
42982 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42983
42984 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42985 ARM targets.
42986 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42987 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42988
42989 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42990 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42991 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42992 and @samp{xpsr}.
42993
42994 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42995 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42996
42997 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42998 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42999 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43000 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43001
43002 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43003 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43004 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43005 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43006 halves of the double-precision registers.
43007
43008 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43009 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43010 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43011 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43012 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43013 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43014
43015 @node i386 Features
43016 @subsection i386 Features
43017 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43018
43019 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43020 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43021
43022 @itemize @minus
43023 @item
43024 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43025 @item
43026 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43027 @item
43028 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43029 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43030 @item
43031 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43032 @item
43033 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43034 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43035 @end itemize
43036
43037 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43038
43039 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43040 describe registers:
43041
43042 @itemize @minus
43043 @item
43044 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43045 @item
43046 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43047 @item
43048 @samp{mxcsr}
43049 @end itemize
43050
43051 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43052 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43053 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43054
43055 @itemize @minus
43056 @item
43057 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43058 @item
43059 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43060 @end itemize
43061
43062 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43063 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43064
43065 @itemize @minus
43066 @item
43067 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43068 @item
43069 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43070 @end itemize
43071
43072 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43073 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43074
43075 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43076 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43077
43078 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43079 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43080 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43081
43082 @itemize @minus
43083 @item
43084 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43085 @end itemize
43086
43087 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43088
43089 @itemize @minus
43090 @item
43091 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43092 @end itemize
43093
43094 It should
43095 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43096
43097 @itemize @minus
43098 @item
43099 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43100 @item
43101 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43102 @end itemize
43103
43104 It should
43105 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43106
43107 @itemize @minus
43108 @item
43109 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43110 @end itemize
43111
43112 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43113 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43114 valid for i386 and amd64.
43115
43116 @node MicroBlaze Features
43117 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43118 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43119
43120 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43121 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43122 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43123 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43124 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43125
43126 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43127 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43128
43129 @node MIPS Features
43130 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43131 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43132
43133 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43134 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43135 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43136 on the target.
43137
43138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43139 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43140 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43141
43142 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43143 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43144 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43145 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43146
43147 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43148 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43149 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43150 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43151
43152 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43153 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43154 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43155
43156 @node M68K Features
43157 @subsection M68K Features
43158 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43159
43160 @table @code
43161 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43162 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43163 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43164 One of those features must be always present.
43165 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43166 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43167 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43168 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43169
43170 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43171 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43172 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43173 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43174 @end table
43175
43176 @node NDS32 Features
43177 @subsection NDS32 Features
43178 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43179
43180 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43181 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43182 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43183 and @samp{pc}.
43184
43185 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43186 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43187 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43188 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43189
43190 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43191 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43192 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43193 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43194 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43195 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43196 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43197
43198 @node Nios II Features
43199 @subsection Nios II Features
43200 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43201
43202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43203 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43204 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43205 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43206 @samp{mpuacc}).
43207
43208 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43209 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43210 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43211
43212 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43213 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43214 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43215
43216 @node PowerPC Features
43217 @subsection PowerPC Features
43218 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43219
43220 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43221 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43222 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43223 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43224
43225 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43226 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43227
43228 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43229 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43230 and @samp{vrsave}.
43231
43232 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43233 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
43234 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
43235 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
43236 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
43237 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
43238 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
43239 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
43240
43241 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43242 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43243 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43244 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43245 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43246 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43247 user.
43248
43249 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43250 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43251
43252 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43253 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43254
43255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43256 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43257
43258 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43259 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43260 64-bit wide.
43261
43262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43263 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43264 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43265 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43266
43267 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43268 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43269 64-bit wide.
43270
43271 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43272 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43273 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43274 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43275 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43276 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43277 wide.
43278
43279 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43280 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43281 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43282 @samp{cfpscr}.
43283
43284 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43285 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43286 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43287 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43288 wide.
43289
43290 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43291 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43292 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43293 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43294 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43295 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43296 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43297 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43298 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43299
43300 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43301 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43302
43303 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43304 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43305
43306 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43307 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43308
43309 @node S/390 and System z Features
43310 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43311 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43312 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43313
43314 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43315 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43316 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43317 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43318 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43319 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43320 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43321 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43322 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43323
43324 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43325 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43326 @samp{fpc}.
43327
43328 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43329 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43330
43331 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43332 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43333 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43334 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43335 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43336 32-bit wide.
43337
43338 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43339 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43340 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43341
43342 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43343 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43344 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43345 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43346 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43347 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43348 @samp{v31}.
43349
43350 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43351 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43352 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43353
43354 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43355 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43356 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43357
43358 @node Sparc Features
43359 @subsection Sparc Features
43360 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43361 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43362 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43363 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43364
43365 @itemize @minus
43366 @item
43367 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43368 @item
43369 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43370 @item
43371 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43372 @item
43373 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43374 @end itemize
43375
43376 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43377
43378 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43379 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43380
43381 @itemize @minus
43382 @item
43383 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43384 @item
43385 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43386 @end itemize
43387
43388 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43389 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43390
43391 @itemize @minus
43392 @item
43393 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43394 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43395 @item
43396 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43397 for sparc64
43398 @end itemize
43399
43400 @node TIC6x Features
43401 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43402 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43403 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43405 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43406 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43407
43408 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43409 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43410 through @samp{B31}.
43411
43412 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43413 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43414
43415 @node Operating System Information
43416 @appendix Operating System Information
43417 @cindex operating system information
43418
43419 @menu
43420 * Process list::
43421 @end menu
43422
43423 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43424 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43425 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43426 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43427 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43428 on a different aspect of target.
43429
43430 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43431 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43432 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43433 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43434
43435 @node Process list
43436 @appendixsection Process list
43437 @cindex operating system information, process list
43438
43439 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43440 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43441 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43442 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43443
43444 An example document is:
43445
43446 @smallexample
43447 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43448 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43449 <osdata type="processes">
43450 <item>
43451 <column name="pid">1</column>
43452 <column name="user">root</column>
43453 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43454 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43455 </item>
43456 </osdata>
43457 @end smallexample
43458
43459 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43460 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43461 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43462 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43463 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43464 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43465 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43466
43467 @node Trace File Format
43468 @appendix Trace File Format
43469 @cindex trace file format
43470
43471 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43472 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43473
43474 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43475 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43476 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43477 in the future.
43478
43479 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43480 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43481 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43482 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43483 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43484 of this section.
43485
43486 @table @code
43487 @item R @var{size}
43488 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43489 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43490 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43491 a single trace file.
43492
43493 @item status @var{status}
43494 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43495 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43496 file.
43497
43498 @item tp @var{payload}
43499 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43500 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43501 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43502 reply packets.
43503
43504 @item tsv @var{payload}
43505 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43506 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43507 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43508 reply packets.
43509
43510 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43511 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43512 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43513 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43514 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43515 file. Includes are not allowed.
43516
43517 @end table
43518
43519 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43520 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43521 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43522 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43523 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43524 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43525 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43526 endianness.
43527
43528 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43529
43530 @table @code
43531 @item R @var{bytes}
43532 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43533 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43534 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43535
43536 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43537 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43538 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43539 @var{length} bytes.
43540
43541 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43542 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43543 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43544
43545 @end table
43546
43547 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43548 of blocks.
43549
43550 @node Index Section Format
43551 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43552 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43553 @cindex index section format
43554
43555 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43556 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43557 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43558 description.
43559
43560 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43561 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43562 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43563 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43564 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43565 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43566
43567 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43568
43569 @enumerate
43570 @item
43571 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43572 unless otherwise noted:
43573
43574 @enumerate
43575 @item
43576 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43577 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43578 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43579 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43580 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43581 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43582 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43583
43584 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43585 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43586 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43587 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43588
43589 @item
43590 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43591
43592 @item
43593 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43594 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43595 to the next offset.
43596
43597 @item
43598 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43599
43600 @item
43601 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43602
43603 @item
43604 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43605 @end enumerate
43606
43607 @item
43608 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43609 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43610 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43611 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43612 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43613 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43614 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43615 CU indices.
43616
43617 @item
43618 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43619 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43620 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43621 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43622
43623 @item
43624 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43625 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43626
43627 @enumerate
43628 @item
43629 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43630
43631 @item
43632 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43633 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43634
43635 @item
43636 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43637 @end enumerate
43638
43639 @item
43640 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43641 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43642
43643 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43644 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43645 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43646 constant pool.
43647
43648 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43649 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43650 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43651
43652 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43653 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43654 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43655 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43656 index version:
43657
43658 @table @asis
43659 @item Version 4
43660 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43661
43662 @item Versions 5 to 7
43663 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43664 @end table
43665
43666 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43667
43668 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43669 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43670 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43671 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43672 collision.
43673
43674 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43675 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43676 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43677 the code.
43678
43679 @item
43680 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43681 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43682 strings.
43683
43684 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43685 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43686 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43687 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43688 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43689 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43690
43691 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43692 @end enumerate
43693
43694 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43695 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43696 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43697
43698 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43699 (bit 0 = LSB):
43700
43701 @table @asis
43702
43703 @item Bits 0-23
43704 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43705 @item Bits 24-27
43706 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43707 @item Bits 28-30
43708 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43709
43710 @table @asis
43711 @item 0
43712 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43713 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43714 with previous versions of the index.
43715 @item 1
43716 The symbol is a type.
43717 @item 2
43718 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43719 @item 3
43720 The symbol is a function.
43721 @item 4
43722 Any other kind of symbol.
43723 @item 5,6,7
43724 These values are reserved.
43725 @end table
43726
43727 @item Bit 31
43728 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43729
43730 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43731 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43732 @value{GDBN} sources.
43733
43734 @end table
43735
43736 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43737 global/static attributes in the index.
43738
43739 @smallexample
43740 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43741 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43742 switch (die->tag)
43743 @{
43744 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43745 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43746 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43747 kind = TYPE;
43748 is_static = 1;
43749 break;
43750 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43751 kind = VARIABLE;
43752 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43753 break;
43754 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43755 kind = FUNCTION;
43756 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43757 break;
43758 case DW_TAG_constant:
43759 kind = VARIABLE;
43760 is_static = ! is_external;
43761 break;
43762 case DW_TAG_variable:
43763 kind = VARIABLE;
43764 is_static = ! is_external;
43765 break;
43766 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43767 kind = TYPE;
43768 is_static = 0;
43769 break;
43770 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43771 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43772 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43773 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43774 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43775 kind = TYPE;
43776 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43777 break;
43778 default:
43779 assert (0);
43780 @}
43781 @end smallexample
43782
43783 @node Man Pages
43784 @appendix Manual pages
43785 @cindex Man pages
43786
43787 @menu
43788 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43789 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43790 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43791 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43792 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43793 @end menu
43794
43795 @node gdb man
43796 @heading gdb man
43797
43798 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43799
43800 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43801 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43802 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43803 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43804 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43805 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43806 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43807 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43808 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43809 @c man end
43810
43811 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43812 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43813 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43814 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43815
43816 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43817 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43818
43819 @itemize @bullet
43820 @item
43821 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43822
43823 @item
43824 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43825
43826 @item
43827 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43828
43829 @item
43830 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43831 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43832 @end itemize
43833
43834 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43835 Modula-2.
43836
43837 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43838 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43839 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43840 by using the command @code{help}.
43841
43842 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43843 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43844 executable program as the argument:
43845
43846 @smallexample
43847 gdb program
43848 @end smallexample
43849
43850 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43851
43852 @smallexample
43853 gdb program core
43854 @end smallexample
43855
43856 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43857 to debug a running process:
43858
43859 @smallexample
43860 gdb program 1234
43861 gdb -p 1234
43862 @end smallexample
43863
43864 @noindent
43865 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43866 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43867 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43868
43869 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43870
43871 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43872 @table @env
43873 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43874 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43875
43876 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43877 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43878
43879 @item bt
43880 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43881
43882 @item print @var{expr}
43883 Display the value of an expression.
43884
43885 @item c
43886 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43887
43888 @item next
43889 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43890 function calls in the line.
43891
43892 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43893 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43894
43895 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43896 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43897
43898 @item step
43899 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43900 function calls in the line.
43901
43902 @item help [@var{name}]
43903 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43904 about using @value{GDBN}.
43905
43906 @item quit
43907 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43908 @end table
43909
43910 @ifset man
43911 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43912 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43913 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43914 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43915 @end ifset
43916 @c man end
43917
43918 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43919 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43920 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43921 encountered with no
43922 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43923 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43924 Many options have
43925 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43926 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43927 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43928 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43929 more usual convention.)
43930
43931 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43932 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43933 option is used.
43934
43935 @table @env
43936 @item -help
43937 @itemx -h
43938 List all options, with brief explanations.
43939
43940 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43941 @itemx -s @var{file}
43942 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43943
43944 @item -write
43945 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43946
43947 @item -exec=@var{file}
43948 @itemx -e @var{file}
43949 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43950 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43951 dump.
43952
43953 @item -se=@var{file}
43954 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43955 file.
43956
43957 @item -core=@var{file}
43958 @itemx -c @var{file}
43959 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43960
43961 @item -command=@var{file}
43962 @itemx -x @var{file}
43963 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43964
43965 @item -ex @var{command}
43966 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43967
43968 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43969 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43970 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43971
43972 @item -nh
43973 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43974
43975 @item -nx
43976 @itemx -n
43977 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43978
43979 @item -quiet
43980 @itemx -q
43981 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43982 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43983
43984 @item -batch
43985 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43986 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43987 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43988 commands in the command files.
43989
43990 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43991 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43992 more useful, the message
43993
43994 @smallexample
43995 Program exited normally.
43996 @end smallexample
43997
43998 @noindent
43999 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44000 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44001
44002 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44003 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44004 instead of the current directory.
44005
44006 @item -fullname
44007 @itemx -f
44008 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44009 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44010 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44011 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44012 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44013 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44014 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44015 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44016
44017 @item -b @var{bps}
44018 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44019 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44020
44021 @item -tty=@var{device}
44022 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44023 @end table
44024 @c man end
44025
44026 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44027 @ifset man
44028 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44029 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44030 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44031
44032 @smallexample
44033 info gdb
44034 @end smallexample
44035
44036 @noindent
44037 should give you access to the complete manual.
44038
44039 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44040 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44041 @end ifset
44042 @c man end
44043
44044 @node gdbserver man
44045 @heading gdbserver man
44046
44047 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44048 @format
44049 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44050 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44051
44052 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44053
44054 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44055 @c man end
44056 @end format
44057
44058 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44059 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44060 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44061
44062 @ifclear man
44063 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44064 @end ifclear
44065 @ifset man
44066 Usage (server (target) side):
44067 @end ifset
44068
44069 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44070 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44071 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44072 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44073
44074 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44075 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44076 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44077
44078 @smallexample
44079 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44080 @end smallexample
44081
44082 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44083
44084 @smallexample
44085 @ifset man
44086 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44087 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44088 @end ifset
44089 @ifclear man
44090 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44091 @end ifclear
44092 @end smallexample
44093
44094 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44095 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44096 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44097
44098 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44099
44100 @smallexample
44101 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44102 @end smallexample
44103
44104 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44105 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44106 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44107 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44108 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44109 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44110 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44111 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44112 print an error message and exit.
44113
44114 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44115 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44116
44117 @smallexample
44118 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44119 @end smallexample
44120
44121 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44122 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44123
44124 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44125 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44126 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44127 the program you want to debug.
44128
44129 @smallexample
44130 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44131 @end smallexample
44132
44133 @ifclear man
44134 @subheading Usage (host side)
44135 @end ifclear
44136 @ifset man
44137 Usage (host side):
44138 @end ifset
44139
44140 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44141 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44142 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44143 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44144 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44145 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44146 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44147 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44148 descriptor. For example:
44149
44150 @smallexample
44151 @ifset man
44152 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44153 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44154 @end ifset
44155 @ifclear man
44156 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44157 @end ifclear
44158 @end smallexample
44159
44160 @noindent
44161 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44162
44163 @smallexample
44164 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44165 @end smallexample
44166
44167 @noindent
44168 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44169 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44170 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44171 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44172 `Connection refused'.
44173
44174 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44175 described in
44176 @ifset man
44177 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44178 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44179 @end ifset
44180 @ifclear man
44181 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44182 @end ifclear
44183 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44184
44185 @smallexample
44186 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44187 @end smallexample
44188
44189 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44190 case.
44191 @c man end
44192
44193 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44194 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44195
44196 @itemize @bullet
44197
44198 @item
44199 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44200
44201 @smallexample
44202 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44203 @end smallexample
44204
44205 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44206 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44207 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44208 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44209 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44210 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44211 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44212
44213 @item
44214 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44215 program:
44216
44217 @smallexample
44218 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44219 @end smallexample
44220
44221 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44222 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44223 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44224 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44225
44226 @item
44227 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44228
44229 @smallexample
44230 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44231 @end smallexample
44232
44233 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44234 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44235 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44236 debug several processes in the same session.
44237 @end itemize
44238
44239 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44240
44241 @table @env
44242
44243 @item --help
44244 List all options, with brief explanations.
44245
44246 @item --version
44247 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44248
44249 @item --attach
44250 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44251
44252 @smallexample
44253 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44254 @end smallexample
44255
44256 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44257 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44258
44259 @item --multi
44260 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44261 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44262 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44263 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44264
44265 @smallexample
44266 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44267 @end smallexample
44268
44269 @item --debug
44270 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44271 process.
44272 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44273 the developers.
44274
44275 @item --remote-debug
44276 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44277 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44278 the developers.
44279
44280 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44281 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44282 of debugging output.
44283 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44284
44285 @item --wrapper
44286 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44287 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44288 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44289 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44290
44291 @item --once
44292 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44293 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44294 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44295 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44296
44297 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44298
44299 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44300 @c QDisableRandomization.
44301
44302 @end table
44303 @c man end
44304
44305 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44306 @ifset man
44307 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44308 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44309 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44310
44311 @smallexample
44312 info gdb
44313 @end smallexample
44314
44315 should give you access to the complete manual.
44316
44317 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44318 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44319 @end ifset
44320 @c man end
44321
44322 @node gcore man
44323 @heading gcore
44324
44325 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44326
44327 @format
44328 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44329 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44330 @c man end
44331 @end format
44332
44333 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44334 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44335 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44336 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44337 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44338 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44339 its job the program remains running without any change.
44340 @c man end
44341
44342 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44343 @table @env
44344 @item -a
44345 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44346 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44347 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44348 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44349 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44350
44351 @item -o @var{prefix}
44352 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44353 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44354 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44355 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44356 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44357 @end table
44358 @c man end
44359
44360 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44361 @ifset man
44362 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44363 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44364 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44365
44366 @smallexample
44367 info gdb
44368 @end smallexample
44369
44370 @noindent
44371 should give you access to the complete manual.
44372
44373 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44374 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44375 @end ifset
44376 @c man end
44377
44378 @node gdbinit man
44379 @heading gdbinit
44380
44381 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44382
44383 @format
44384 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44385 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44386 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44387 @end ifset
44388
44389 ~/.gdbinit
44390
44391 ./.gdbinit
44392 @c man end
44393 @end format
44394
44395 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44396 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44397 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44398 described in
44399 @ifset man
44400 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44401 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44402 @end ifset
44403 @ifclear man
44404 @ref{Sequences}.
44405 @end ifclear
44406
44407 Please read more in
44408 @ifset man
44409 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44410 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44411 @end ifset
44412 @ifclear man
44413 @ref{Startup}.
44414 @end ifclear
44415
44416 @table @env
44417 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44418 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44419 @end ifset
44420 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44421 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44422 @end ifclear
44423 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44424 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44425 See more in
44426 @ifset man
44427 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44428 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44429 @end ifset
44430 @ifclear man
44431 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44432 @end ifclear
44433
44434 @item ~/.gdbinit
44435 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44436 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44437
44438 @item ./.gdbinit
44439 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44440 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44441 See more in
44442 @ifset man
44443 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44444 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44445 @end ifset
44446 @ifclear man
44447 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44448 @end ifclear
44449 @end table
44450 @c man end
44451
44452 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44453 @ifset man
44454 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44455
44456 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44457 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44458 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44459
44460 @smallexample
44461 info gdb
44462 @end smallexample
44463
44464 should give you access to the complete manual.
44465
44466 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44467 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44468 @end ifset
44469 @c man end
44470
44471 @node gdb-add-index man
44472 @heading gdb-add-index
44473 @pindex gdb-add-index
44474 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44475
44476 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44477
44478 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44479 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44480 @c man end
44481
44482 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44483 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44484 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44485 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44486 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44487 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44488
44489 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44490 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44491 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44492 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44493 named @code{.debug_*}).
44494
44495 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44496 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44497 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44498 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44499
44500 See more in
44501 @ifset man
44502 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44503 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44504 @end ifset
44505 @ifclear man
44506 @ref{Index Files}.
44507 @end ifclear
44508 @c man end
44509
44510 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44511 @ifset man
44512 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44513 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44514 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44515
44516 @smallexample
44517 info gdb
44518 @end smallexample
44519
44520 should give you access to the complete manual.
44521
44522 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44523 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44524 @end ifset
44525 @c man end
44526
44527 @include gpl.texi
44528
44529 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44530 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44531 @include fdl.texi
44532
44533 @node Concept Index
44534 @unnumbered Concept Index
44535
44536 @printindex cp
44537
44538 @node Command and Variable Index
44539 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44540
44541 @printindex fn
44542
44543 @tex
44544 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44545 % meantime:
44546 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44547 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44548 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44549 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44550 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44551 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44552 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44553 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44554 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44555 \page\colophon
44556 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44557 @end tex
44558
44559 @bye
This page took 1.011063 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.